129 0 23MB
Clinical Chemistry Analyzer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Contents Section 1: Introduction .....................................................................1 - 1 1. Document update ......................................................................................... 1 - 2 2. Legal information .......................................................................................... 1 - 4 3. Operational conditions ................................................................................. 1 - 6
Section 2: Specifications ..................................................................2 - 1 1. Technical specifications ............................................................................... 2 - 2 2. Physical specifications ................................................................................. 2 - 6
Section 3: Technology ......................................................................3 - 1 1. Optical principles .......................................................................................... 3 - 2 2. Fluidic principles ........................................................................................... 3 - 8 3. Temperature control ................................................................................... 3 - 12 4. Level detection and shock detection ........................................................ 3 - 22 5. Pressure detection ...................................................................................... 3 - 28
Section 4: Electric and electronic principles ..................................4 - 1 1. Mother board ................................................................................................. 4 - 3 2. Optical acquisition ...................................................................................... 4 - 14 3. Level detection ............................................................................................ 4 - 18 4. Sample relay board XAA491CS (1209109491) .......................................... 4 - 25 5. Pressure board (kit ref. 1300015280) ......................................................... 4 - 27 6. Internal computer 1300013734 .................................................................. 4 - 29 7. Power supply ............................................................................................... 4 - 30 ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
i
8. Connectors .................................................................................................. 4 - 34 9. Instrument synoptic .................................................................................... 4 - 82
Section 5: Software description.......................................................5 - 1 1. Services menu overview ............................................................................... 5 - 2 2. Software architecture ................................................................................... 5 - 3 3. Diagnostics menu description ..................................................................... 5 - 7 4. Initialization phases .................................................................................... 5 - 25
Section 6: Troubleshooting ..............................................................6 - 1 1. Error messages ............................................................................................. 6 - 2 2. Troubleshooting .......................................................................................... 6 - 42
Section 7: ISE module.......................................................................7 - 1 1. ISE module description ................................................................................ 7 - 2 2. Error messages ........................................................................................... 7 - 38 3. Procedures .................................................................................................. 7 - 42
Section 8: Exploded views................................................................8 - 1 1. Reagent tray .................................................................................................. 8 - 3 2. Reagent tray closing assy ............................................................................ 8 - 6 3. Sample tray .................................................................................................... 8 - 7 4. Optical bench ................................................................................................ 8 - 8 5. Reaction tray ................................................................................................. 8 - 9 6. Cuvette changer .......................................................................................... 8 - 11 7. Cuvette changer carriage assembly ......................................................... 8 - 15
ii
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
8. Cuvette changer load rack ......................................................................... 8 - 16 9. Cuvette changer unload rack .................................................................... 8 - 17 10. Ventilation .................................................................................................. 8 - 18 11. Arms assembly .......................................................................................... 8 - 19 12. Sample arm ................................................................................................ 8 - 23 13. Reagent arm .............................................................................................. 8 - 24 14. Arms assembly kits ................................................................................... 8 - 25 15. Mixer assembly ......................................................................................... 8 - 26 16. Syringe assy .............................................................................................. 8 - 28 17. Wash cup assy .......................................................................................... 8 - 29 18. Fluid part .................................................................................................... 8 - 30 19. Covering ..................................................................................................... 8 - 32 20. ISE module ................................................................................................. 8 - 34 21. ISE module electrode holder ................................................................... 8 - 36 22. ISE module syringes ................................................................................. 8 - 37 23. Computer ................................................................................................... 8 - 38 24. Cooling unit ............................................................................................... 8 - 40
Section 9: Additional spare parts ....................................................9 - 1 1. Tools ............................................................................................................... 9 - 2 2. Kits ................................................................................................................. 9 - 3 3. Fuses .............................................................................................................. 9 - 3 4. Stickers .......................................................................................................... 9 - 4 5. Other consumables ....................................................................................... 9 - 5
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
iii
Section 10: Host connection ..........................................................10 - 1 1. Physical connection .................................................................................... 10 - 2 2. Connection configuration on the instrument ........................................... 10 - 3 3. Connection protocol ................................................................................... 10 - 5 4. ASTM format ............................................................................................... 10 - 6 5. Bidirectional connection ............................................................................ 10 - 9 6. Data exchange examples ......................................................................... 10 - 11 7. Connection test ......................................................................................... 10 - 16 8. Troubleshooting ........................................................................................ 10 - 27
Section 11: Maintenance ................................................................11 - 1 1. Preventive maintenance ............................................................................. 11 - 2 2. Prevention against the electrostatic discharges ..................................... 11 - 4 3. Procedures .................................................................................................. 11 - 7
iv
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Section 1: Introduction
1. Document update ......................................................................................... 1 - 2 1.1. Revisions.................................................................................................................................... 1 - 2 1.2. What’s new? .............................................................................................................................. 1 - 2
2. Legal information .......................................................................................... 1 - 3 2.1. Declaration of Conformity.......................................................................................................... 2.2. Notice of liability ........................................................................................................................ 2.3. Trademarks ................................................................................................................................ 2.4. Graphics .................................................................................................................................... 2.5. Document symbols .................................................................................................................... 2.6. Copyright © 2016 by HORIBA ABX SAS ...................................................................................
1-3 1-3 1-3 1-3 1-3 1-4
3. Operational conditions ................................................................................. 1 - 5 3.1. Environment............................................................................................................................... 3.2. Location ..................................................................................................................................... 3.3. Grounding .................................................................................................................................. 3.4. Humidity and temperature conditions ....................................................................................... 3.5. Electromagnetic environment check ......................................................................................... 3.6. Main power supply .................................................................................................................... 3.7. Environmental protection........................................................................................................... 3.8. Storage conditions and transportation ...................................................................................... 3.9. Package .....................................................................................................................................
1-5 1-5 1-6 1-6 1-6 1-7 1-7 1-8 1-8
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
1-1
Introduction Document update
1. Document update 1.1.
Revisions
Reference
Internal reference
RAA023A RAA023B RAA023C RAA023DEN RAA023EEN RAA023FEN RAA023GEN RAA023HEN 1300021859
RAA023A RAA023B RAA023C RAA023DEN RAA023EEN RAA023FEN RAA023GEN RAA023HEN RAA023JEN
Software version ABX Pentra 400 Pentra C400 1.0.0 N/A 2.0.0 N/A 3.0.0 N/A 4.4.0 N/A 5.0.0 N/A 5.0.5 N/A 5.0.7 1.1.X 5.0.8 1.1.X 5.0.9 1.2.X
Document date issued August 2003 January 2004 December 2004 December 2007 June 2008 May 2010 September 2013 February 2014 June 2016
This document applies to the latest software version listed and higher versions. All information included in this document is current as of the date of creation of this version. Changes that may occur will be available on ITS Web site http://its-information.horiba-abx.com/. This manual applies to both ABX Pentra 400 and Pentra C400. For the ABX Pentra 400, this manual is intended for use on instruments with serial numbers above 2999 (V3). In some procedures, specific instructions are given for previous ABX Pentra 400 hardware versions: ■ V1 corresponds to instruments with serial numbers below 2000. ■ V2 corresponds to instruments with serial numbers between 2000 and 2999.
1.2.
What’s new?
Here is the list of major updates in this document release: Item
Chapter Section 2: Specifications Connections and characteristics of the new RAS376: Installation computer. New computer RAS392: Internal computer Spare parts replacement and Windows master RAS533: Windows master installation for the new computer. installation Electrical diagram of the new cooling unit New cooling unit models 115 V / 60 Hz with built-in power cable Section 3: Technology models 115 V / 60 Hz and circuit breakers. New reagent needle Drawing of the new reagent needle. Section 3: Technology
1-2
Description
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Introduction Document update
Item
Description
Spare parts references
Update of the spare parts references.
Modification of the warnings #620, 624, 650, 654 and 655. "Low pressure" Addition of the "low pressure" alarms in the alarms troubleshooting guide. Replacement of the isolator and the ISE waste ISE module tubing every six months. maintenance Replacement of the ISE syringes pistons once a year. New ISE syringe blocks with two covers and New ISE syringe four O-rings. blocks Maintenance and replacement of the new ISE syringe blocks. Addition of one spring on each ISE syringe ISE syringe motors motor. New lamp reference Modification of the lamp reference. Addition of the procedure to clean and C:\ and D:\ drives defragment the C:\ and D:\ drives. New quality control Update of the procedure to check pipetting solution accuracy and precision. New pressure Update of the procedure to replace the sensors and board pressure sensors and board. Windows master CD- Addition of the procedure to prepare the ROM Windows master CD-ROM. Warnings
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Chapter Section 4: Electric and electronic principles Section 8: Exploded views Section 9: Additional spare parts Section 6: Troubleshooting Section 6: Troubleshooting RAS388: ISE module maintenance RAS388: ISE module maintenance RAS538: ISE module spare part replacement RAS538: ISE module spare part replacement RAS376: Installation RAS378: 6 month maintenance RAS393: Check up after intervention RAS442: Pressure sensors RAS533: Windows master installation
1-3
Introduction Legal information
2. Legal information 2.1.
Declaration of Conformity
This product complies with the Standards and Directives named in the Declaration of Conformity. The latest version of the EC Declaration of Conformity for this product is available on www.horibaabx.com/documentation.
2.2.
Notice of liability
The information in this manual is distributed on an "As Is" basis, without warranty. While every precaution has been taken in the preparation of this manual, HORIBA Medical will not assume any liability to any persons or entities with respect to loss or damage, caused or alleged to be caused directly or indirectly by not following the instructions contained in this manual, or by using the computer software and hardware products described herein in a manner inconsistent with our product labelling.
2.3.
Trademarks
Microsoft and Windows are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation. Other product names mentioned within this publication may be trademarks or registered trademarks of their respective owners.
2.4.
Graphics
All graphics including screens, printouts and photographs are for illustration purposes only and are not contractual.
2.5.
Document symbols
To alert the operator of potentially hazardous conditions, symbols described in this chapter are provided wherever necessary throughout the manual.
Emphasizes information that must be followed to avoid hazard to either the operator or the environment, or both.
1-4
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Introduction Legal information
Emphasizes information that must be followed to avoid possible damage to the instrument or erroneous test results.
Emphasizes information that can be helpful to the operator before, during or after a specific operational function.
Gives a summary of what can be achieved if the task is performed.
2.6.
Copyright © 2016 by HORIBA ABX SAS
All rights reserved. No part of this publication may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or otherwise, without the prior written permission of HORIBA Medical. HORIBA ABX SAS Parc Euromédecine - Rue du Caducée B.P. 7290 34184 MONTPELLIER Cedex 4 - FRANCE Phone: +33 (0)4 67 14 15 16 Fax: +33 (0)4 67 14 15 17
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
1-5
Introduction Operational conditions
3. Operational conditions 3.1.
Environment
The operation of the ABX Pentra 400 / Pentra C400 should be restricted to indoor location use only. The instrument is operational at an altitude of maximum 3000 m (9840 ft). The instrument is designed for safety from voltage surges according to INSTALLATION CATEGORY II and POLLUTION DEGREE 2 (IEC 61010-1).
3.2.
Location
Keep in mind that the instrument weighs approximately 120 kg (265 lb). To move the instrument, four persons are required. The lifting handles provided in the installation kit must be used. ■ Place
your instrument on a clean and leveled table or workbench.
■ Avoid
exposure to sunlight.
■ Place
your instrument where it is not exposed to water or vapor.
■ Place
your instrument where it is not exposed to dust.
■ Avoid
direct exposure to air conditioner.
■ Place
your instrument where it is free from vibration or shock.
■ Place
your instrument where an independent power receptacle can be used.
■
Use a receptacle different from the one used by a device that easily generates noise such as a centrifuge, etc.
■ Provide
1-6
a space of at least 20 cm (7.9 in) at the back of the instrument for a proper ventilation.
■
Make sure to provide enough space to open the main cover easily. The instrument height is approximately 63 cm (24.8 in) closed cover and 105 cm (41.3 in) open cover.
■
Make sure to provide enough space on both sides of the instrument to access the computer connections and power supply connection.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Introduction Operational conditions
The Power switch and Power supply connection should always be accessible. When positioning the system for operational use, leave the required amount of space for easy access to these items.
3.3.
Grounding
Proper grounding is required when installing the system. Check the wall outlet ground (earth) for proper grounding to the facilities electrical ground. If you are unsure of the outlet grounding, contact your facilities engineer to verify the proper outlet ground.
3.4.
Humidity and temperature conditions ■ Instrument
operating temperature: from +15°C (+59°F) to +32°C (+90°F). If the instrument is stored at a temperature lower than 10°C (50°F), it should stand for one hour at normal room temperature before use.
■ Humidity
Conditions: Relative humidity of 20% - 85% maximum, without condensation.
■ Temperature
3.5.
gradient: 2°C (3.6°F) per hour.
Electromagnetic environment check
The instrument has been designed to produce less than the accepted level of electromagnetic interference in order to operate in conformity with its destination, allowing the correct operation of other instruments also in conformity with their destination.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
1-7
Introduction Operational conditions
In case of suspected electromagnetic noise, make sure that the instrument has not been placed in the proximity of electromagnetic fields or short wave emissions, e.g. Radar, X-rays, Scanners, Cell phones, etc.
Do not perform analysis while cover is open or not correctly fixed. Electromagnetic noise can affect the data or disrupt a nearby instrument.
3.6.
Main power supply
It is recommended to install the system on UPS (Uninterruptible Power Supply).
Grounding is required. Make sure the earth wall-plug is correctly connected to the laboratory grounding system. If there is no such system, a ground stake should be used. Use only the main supply cable delivered with the instrument. Main power supply voltage fluctuations must not exceed +/- 10% of the nominal voltage.
■ Always ■ To
3.7.
disconnect the system from the supply before servicing. prevent the risk of electrical shock, do not remove the covers or the back panel.
Environmental protection
Used accessories and consumables disposal Disposable used accessories and consumables must be collected by a laboratory specialized in elimination and recycling of this kind of material according to the local legislation.
Instrument disposal
This product should be disposed of and recycled at the end of the useful life in accordance with European Directive 2002/96/EC on Waste Electrical and Electronic Equipment (WEEE) and/or European Directive 2006/66/EC on batteries and accumulators.
1-8
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Introduction Operational conditions
3.8.
Storage conditions and transportation
Instrument storage and transportation temperatures: from -20°C (-4°F) to +50°C (+122°F). Analyzer exposure to rainfall and extended sunlight must be avoided. The outdoors storage of the analyzer is prohibited.
Before the shipping of an instrument by transporter, whatever the destination, an external decontamination of the instrument must be carried out.
Keep in mind that the instrument weighs approximately 120 kg (265 lb). To move the instrument, four persons are required. The lifting handles provided in the installation kit must be used. Before instrument removal from use, transportation or disposal, perform a general cleaning and a draining of your instrument.
3.9.
Package
Factory package of the analyzer ABX Pentra 400 / Pentra C400 and its implements consists of firm corrugated cardboard, polyethylene foil and inner foam plastic framework. Package protects analyzer and its implements from adverse factors of outside environment. Analyzer must be transported in its original factory package.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
1-9
Introduction Operational conditions
1 - 10
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Section 2: Specifications
1. Technical specifications............................................................................... 2 - 2 1.1. Intended use .............................................................................................................................. 1.2. Analysis methods....................................................................................................................... 1.3. Throughput ................................................................................................................................ 1.4. Reagent...................................................................................................................................... 1.5. Sample....................................................................................................................................... 1.6. Calibrator and control ................................................................................................................ 1.7. Computer characteristics .......................................................................................................... 1.8. Measurement .............................................................................................................................
2-2 2-2 2-2 2-2 2-3 2-4 2-4 2-4
2. Physical specifications ................................................................................. 2 - 6 2.1. Power requirements................................................................................................................... 2.2. Dimension and weight ............................................................................................................... 2.3. Sound level ................................................................................................................................ 2.4. Water requirement .....................................................................................................................
2-6 2-6 2-7 2-7
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
2-1
Specifications Technical specifications
1. Technical specifications 1.1.
Intended use
The ABX Pentra 400 / Pentra C400 system is a fully automated chemistry analyzer using colorimetry, turbidimetry and potentiometry technologies. It is mostly meant to be used for in vitro diagnostic analyses based on homogeneous samples such as serum, plasma, urine and whole blood.
1.2.
Analysis methods
The ABX Pentra 400 / Pentra C400 system allows analysis by: ■ Colorimetry ■ Turbidimetry ■ Potentiometry:
1.3.
1.4.
direct for serum and plasma, indirect for urine (ISE module option)
Throughput ■ Up
to 300 tests per hour without ISE
■ Up
to 400 tests per hour with ISE
Reagent
Packaging accepted ■ Twin
compartment cassette 30/10 from HORIBA Medical
■ Twin
compartment cassette 50/50 from HORIBA Medical
■ Twin
compartment cassette 70/30 from HORIBA Medical
■ Twin
compartment cassette 80/10 from HORIBA Medical
■ Single
compartment cassette 100 from HORIBA Medical
■ Reagent
rack
On board conditions ■ Capacity: ■
2-2
52 cassettes (39 tests with reagent racks)
Temperature: 44 positions refrigerated at 4°C - 10°C (39°F - 50°F) and eight positions at room temperature
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Specifications Technical specifications
Reagent management ■ Barcode
reagent identification
■ Back-up
for same reagent
■ Remaining
volume calculation
■ Automated
reagent on board stability check
Reagent sampling ■ Volume:
- Minimum: 2 µL with sample needle and 15 µL with reagent needle - Maximum: 600 µL ■ Capacitive
level detection
■ Insufficient
volume detection
■ Reagent
1.5.
preheating at 37°C +/- 0.5°C (98.6°F +/- 0.9°F)
Sample
Sample types ■ Serum ■ Plasma ■ Urine ■ Cerebrospinal ■ Whole
fluid (CSF)
blood
■ Homogeneous
liquid
Sample tube types accepted ■ Primary
and secondary tubes: - 4 and 5 mL (diameter: 13 mm) - 7 and 10 mL (diameter: 16 mm)
■ Sample
cups (700 µL)
On board conditions ■ Capacity:
60 samples
■ Continuous
loading
Sample management ■ Barcode
sample identification: Barcodes from two to 16 digits. Accepted barcode types: - ITF 2/5 (2 of 5 interleaved) with or without check digit - Code 39 with or without check digit - Code 128 - Codabar
■ Tube
presence detector
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
2-3
Specifications Technical specifications
Sampling ■ Volume:
- Minimum: 2 µL - Maximum: 95 µL for one step and 380 µL for four steps ■ Automatic
sample dilution: 1/2 to 1/22500
■ Automatic
post-concentration: x2 to x10
■ Capacitive
level detection
■ Shock ■ Clot
1.6.
detection
detection and insufficient volume detection
Calibrator and control
Calibrator/Control positioning Sample tray and reagent tray
Automatic standard dilution series
1.7.
■ Main
direct dilution ratio: 1/2 - 1/150
■ Main
indirect dilution ratio: 1/2 - 1/1508
Computer characteristics ■ Color
LCD touch screen: 12 in.
■ Operating
System: Windows 7™
■ Processor:
Atom™ 1.46 GHz
■ RAM
(Random Access Memory): 4 GB
■ Hard
drive: 250 GB
■ RS232C,
RJ45* LAN (Local Area Network), USB 2.0 (7 ports), Audio * Not used
1.8.
Measurement
Reaction system ■ Reaction ■ Cuvette
cuvettes: disposable acrylic cuvettes
volume: 150 µL - 600 µL
■ Automatic ■ "New
■ "Used
cuvette" holder capacity: 360 cuvettes
■ Mixing:
2-4
loading and unloading of cuvettes
cuvette" holder capacity: 360 cuvettes stirring paddle
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Specifications Technical specifications
■ Reaction
temperature: 37°C +/- 0.2°C (99°F +/- 0.36°F), air bath controlled
■ Measurement ■ Sampling ■ Reaction
cycle: 12 seconds
cycle: 12 seconds time: 12 seconds - 20 minutes
Optical system ■ Measurement ■ Light
principle: absorbance measurement (Bichromatic or Monochromatic)
source: tungsten-halogen lamp
■ Diffraction: ■ Detector:
concave reflective grating spectrograph
photodiode array
■ Wavelengths: ■ Optical
340, 380, 405, 420, 455, 490, 505, 520, 550, 560, 580, 600, 620, 660, 700 nm
linearity:
Wavelength 340 nm 380 nm 405 nm 420 nm 455 nm
Linearity (Absorbance) 2.95 2 2.5 3.5 2
Wavelength 490 nm 505 nm 520 nm 550 nm 560 nm
Linearity (Absorbance) 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5 2.5
Wavelength 580 nm 600 nm 620 nm 660 nm 700 nm
Linearity (Absorbance) 2.5 2.5 2.5 2 2
Algorithms supported ■ Factor ■ Slope
average
■ Linear
regression
■ Linear
interpolation
■ LOGIT/LOG4 ■ LOGIT/LOG5 ■ Exponential
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
2-5
Specifications Physical specifications
2. Physical specifications 2.1.
Power requirements ■ Power
supply: - Instrument: from 100 V to 240 V (+/- 10%), 50 Hz to 60 Hz - Cooling unit CU401 (depends on models): 100 V (+/- 10%), 50 Hz to 60 Hz 115 V (+/- 10%), 60 Hz 230 V (+/- 10%), 50 Hz 230 V (+/- 10%), 60 Hz - Cooling unit CU400 (depends on models): 100 V (+/- 10%), 50 Hz to 60 Hz 115 V (+/- 10%), 60 Hz 230 V (+/- 10%), 50 Hz to 60 Hz 240 V (+/- 10%), 50 Hz
■ Maximum
power consumption: - Instrument: 250 VA - Cooling unit CU401: 700 W - Cooling unit CU400: 450 W
■ Maximum
heat output: - Instrument + cooling unit CU401: 1940 BTU/h (2010 kJ/h) - Instrument + cooling unit CU400: 2080 BTU/h (2160 kJ/h)
■ Printer:
refer to your printer manual.
Fuses characteristics: Slow-blow internal fuses having the following characteristics: 2 x T 6.3 A H 250 V (5x20 mm)
2.2.
Dimension and weight ■ Instrument
dimensions: 101 x 71 x 63 cm (Width x Depth x Height)
■ Instrument
weight: 120 kg (265 lb)
■ Cooling
unit CU401: - Dimensions: 25 x 50 x 60 cm (Width x Depth x Height) - Weight: 39 kg (86 lb)
■ Cooling
unit CU400: - Dimensions: 29 x 42 x 40 cm (Width x Depth x Height) - Weight: 35 kg (77 lb)
2-6
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Specifications Physical specifications
2.3.
Sound level
The maximum sound level is < 60 dB (A).
2.4.
Water requirement ■ De-ionized/distilled
water
■ Water
specifications: - Resistivity > 5 Mohm.cm - Conductivity < 0.2 µS/cm
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
2-7
Specifications Physical specifications
2-8
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Section 3: Technology
1. Optical principles .......................................................................................... 3 - 2 1.1. Beer-Lambert law ...................................................................................................................... 3 - 2 1.2. Optical bench and spectrophotometer description................................................................... 3 - 3 1.3. Spectrophotometer initialization and absorbance measurements ............................................ 3 - 4
2. Fluidic principles ........................................................................................... 3 - 8 2.1. Instrument hydraulic diagram .................................................................................................... 3 - 8 2.2. Valves....................................................................................................................................... 3 - 10 2.3. Cooling system diagram .......................................................................................................... 3 - 11
3. Temperature control................................................................................... 3 - 12 3.1. PID control ............................................................................................................................... 3.2. Reagent tray ............................................................................................................................ 3.3. Reagent needle........................................................................................................................ 3.4. Reaction tray............................................................................................................................
3 - 12 3 - 15 3 - 20 3 - 21
4. Level detection and shock detection ........................................................ 3 - 22 4.1. Reagent level detection ........................................................................................................... 3 - 22 4.2. Sample level and shock detection........................................................................................... 3 - 26
5. Pressure detection...................................................................................... 3 - 28 5.1. General points.......................................................................................................................... 3 - 28 5.2. High pressure, low pressure and bad sampling detection ...................................................... 3 - 29
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
3-1
Technology Optical principles
1. Optical principles 1.1.
Beer-Lambert law
The biochemistry analysis principle is to mix some reagents with a sample to produce a chemical reaction. The reactive solution thus produced presents absorption properties at a specific wavelength. The absorbance measures the reactive solution capacity to absorb the light that travels through it, at a specific wavelength. The absorbance is defined as follows: A = log (I0 / I) A Absorbance I0 Intensity of light before it travels through the reactive solution I Intensity of light that has passed through the reactive solution Absorption of light as it travels through the reactive solution Cuvette with reactive solution
I0, Incident light intensity
I, Transmitted light intensity
Lamp
Detector
l = 0.6 cm
The Beer-Lambert law states that the measured absorbance at a specific wavelength is proportional to the length of solution that the light travels through, and also the concentration of the absorbing substance in the solution. A=ε*l*c A ε l c
Absorbance Absorption coefficient of the absorbing substance at a specific wavelength Length of solution that the light travels through Concentration of the absorbing substance in the solution
In the ABX Pentra 400 / Pentra C400 case, the length of solution that the light travels through is fixed (l = 0.6 cm) as the absorption coefficient of the absorbing substance at a specific wavelength. So, the measured absorbance at a specific wavelength is proportional to the concentration of the absorbing substance in the solution.
3-2
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Technology Optical principles
In conclusion, the concentration of the absorbing substance in the solution is a function of the intensity of light that has passed through the reactive solution, at a specific wavelength. c = [ 1 / (ε * l) ] * log (I0 / I) c ε l I0 I
1.2.
Concentration of the absorbing substance in the solution Absorption coefficient of the measured substance at the specific wavelength used Length of solution that the light travels through Intensity of light before it travels through the reactive solution Intensity of light that has passed through the reactive solution
Optical bench and spectrophotometer description
1.2.1. General principle Optical bench
■ White ■
Spectrophotometer
light from the halogen tungsten lamp is collected by the condensing lens.
Once reflected by the folding mirror and shaped by the second lens, the white light beam passes through the cuvette where it travels through the reactive solution.
■ White
light emerging from the cuvette is then coupled with the spectrograph entrance slit by the third
lens. ■
The concave reflective grating spreads the incoming white light into monochromatic radiations and reflects them onto the photodiode array.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
3-3
Technology Optical principles
1.2.2. Spectrophotometer principle ■ The
spectrograph entrance slit and concave reflective grating allow the spectrophotometer resolution.
■ The
concave reflective grating is an optical element, with equally spaced grooves on material surface, which: - disperses the incident white light into monochromatic radiations - and reflects them in discrete directions called diffraction orders. Lamp order -1 order -2
Photodiode array order 0 order +1 order +2
white light monochromatic radiations
Concave reflective grating
■ For
the ABX Pentra 400 / Pentra C400, the monochromatic radiations of diffraction order +1 are used and reflected onto the photodiode array.
■ The ■
1.3.
concave reflective grating focuses all the wavelengths onto the photodiode array.
For the ABX Pentra 400 / Pentra C400, the photodiode array measures the light intensity for 15 wavelengths: 340, 380, 405, 420, 455, 490, 505, 520, 550, 560, 580, 600, 620, 660, 700 nm.
Spectrophotometer initialization and absorbance measurements
During a complete spectrophotometer initialization, the steps 1 to 6 (described below) are performed. 1. Spectrophotometer gain adjustment and check For each wavelength, the light intensity is measured on air (without cuvette) and amplified by a multiplier coefficient. This multiplier coefficient named gain is adjusted to measure a light intensity on air (without cuvette) included between 57200 and 65535 (~ 61000). The gains, expressed in % in the Spectro menu (Services > Diagnostics > Spectro), correspond to the amplification percentages applied for each wavelength (from 0 to 100%). These amplification percentages are directly proportional to the multiplier coefficients applied for each wavelength. The gains should be included between 1 and 95%. ■ If one of the gains is > 95% and ≤ 98%, the lamp is still operational but dying and a warning is triggered
(#629 "The lamp is dying, it is still operational but you will need to change it soon."). ■ If
one of the gains is < 1% or > 98%, the lamp needs to be replaced at once and an alarm is triggered (#520 "The lamp has failed the gain check. Please change the lamp.").
% 1
3-4
95
98
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Technology Optical principles
2. Light stability check The light intensity is measured on air (without cuvette) for each wavelength to check the lamp stability.
Lamp
Detector IA, Light intensity on air
For each wavelength, the two following checks are performed: ■ The
absorbance is checked every 12 s during 600 s maximum to ensure that the difference between 2 consecutive absorbances is < 0.00022.
■ IA
is checked to ensure that it is included between 57200 and 65535.
3. Black intensity measurement The black intensity is measured in the black (with the inter-sector located between the sectors 1 and 6 of the reaction tray) for each wavelength. It is the residual intensity or electronic noise measured in the black. Inter-sector
Lamp
Detector IB, Black intensity
IB must be included between 1400 and 2000 for all the wavelengths. No warning or alarm is triggered if IB is out of these ranges.
4. Cuvette cleanness check The light intensity is measured through the empty cuvettes at 340 and 700 nm to check the presence and cleanness of one cuvette. Empty cuvette
Lamp
Detector IC, Light intensity on empty cuvette
The absorbance is calculated as follows: A = log [ (IA - IB) / (IC - IB) ] A IA IB IC
Absorbance Light intensity on air Black intensity Light intensity on empty cuvette
The absorbance at 340 and 700 nm is checked to ensure that it is included in the cuvette presence range as in the cuvette cleanness range.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
3-5
Technology Optical principles
Wavelength (nm) 340 700
Cuvette presence range (Absorbance) 0.03 - 10.0 0.03 - 10.0
Cuvette cleanness range (Absorbance) 0.060 - 0.120 0.050 - 0.090
5. Reference light intensity measurement Once the presence and cleanness of one cuvette are checked, the reference light intensity is measured through a water-filled cuvette (150 µL) for each wavelength. Water-filled cuvette
Lamp
Detector IW, Reference light intensity on water-filled cuvette
6. Reaction tray check The cuvette cleanness check is performed for all the cuvettes (see Cuvette cleanness check, page 3-5). One after the other, each reaction tray position is unloaded, then reloaded and the cuvette segment is checked. The cuvette segments with at least 4 clean cuvettes are kept on the reaction tray, the other ones are replaced. The steps 1 to 6 (described above) are automatically performed every time the instrument is: on ■ woken up after a "stand-by" ■ initialized after a lamp replacement from the Customer Services menu (Services > Customer Services > Cycles) or a modification of spectrophotometer gain adjustment from the Spectro menu (Services > Diagnostics > Spectro). ■ turned
Steps Gain adjustment and check Light stability check Light intensity on air (IA) Black intensity (IB) Cuvette cleanness check (IC) Reference light intensity (IW)
3-6
Start up or wake up
Cuvette segment replacement
Lamp replacement
Measure gain
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Routine
X
X
X X X
X
X
Exit "Diagnostics" menu
X
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Technology Optical principles
7. Absorbance measurement (Normal case) The light intensity is measured through the reactive solution at a specific wavelength. Cuvette with reactive solution
Lamp
Detector I, Transmitted light intensity
The absorbance is calculated as follows: A = log [ (IW - IB) / (I - IB) ] A IW IB I
Absorbance Reference light intensity on water-filled cuvette Black intensity Transmitted light intensity
8. Bichromatism principle The ABX Pentra 400 / Pentra C400 measures the absorbance at two different wavelengths to correct the absorbance due to a cuvette defect, some sample interferences, etc. The primary wavelength is used to measure the reactive solution absorbance. The secondary wavelength is used to measure the absorbance due to a cuvette defect, some sample interferences, etc. The absorbance is corrected as follows: A = A1 - A2 A Absorbance A1 Measured absorbance at the primary wavelength A2 Measured absorbance at the secondary wavelength
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
3-7
Technology Fluidic principles
2. Fluidic principles 2.1.
Instrument hydraulic diagram
Refer to the instrument hydraulic diagram on next page. Mark on diagram LV1, LV2, LV3 LV4, LV5 NEEDLE MANIFOLD (LV1-LV2) MANIFOLD (LV3-LV5) FILTER B1 B2 LOW MANIFOLD
E1 E2 0.89-xxx 2.06-xxx 2.29-xxx C4x6-xxx C4x7-xxx C6x9-xxx C7x10-xxx EAJ0003A 6.6-8 3027030 D7 E3
3-8
P/n EBA010A (1202351010) EBA011A (1202351011) 1300015267 XCA194B (1209122194) 9001072 (1229001072) XEC202AS (1209179202) XCA216BS (1209129216) XCA198B (1209122198) XCA197A (1209121197) EAB013A (1202211013) EAB015A (1202211015) EAE004A* EAE008A* EAE009A* EAE028A* EAE043A* A00AM07677* 0779145* EAJ003A (1202261003) 3027030 (1223027030) EAB041A (1202211041) EAB028A (1202211028)
Designation
Sales unit
VALVE, 2 WAYS ELECTROVALVE
1
VALVE, 3 WAYS ELECTROVALVE
1
MANIFOLD, WITH VALVES V1 AND V2
1
VALVE, 3 VALVES ASSY
1
FILTER, FILTER LIQUID COMPLETE
1
PUMP, WATER ASSY + METAL SHEET
1
PUMP, WASTE ASSY + METAL SHEET
1
FLUID, OVERFLOW MANIFOLD
1
FLUID, CONDENSATION MANIFOLD V1
1
FITTING, STRAIGHT 3.1/2.3 CLEAR
1
TUBING, TYGON 0.889 (0.035) TUBING, TYGON 2.06 (0.081) TUBING, TYGON 2.29 (0.090) TUBING, CRYSTAL 4X6 TUBING, CRYSTAL 4X7 TUBING, PVC 6X9 TUBING, PVC 7X9
Pack of 5 * * * * * * *
COLLAR, MEDIUM D=6-8
1
CLAMP, TUBE D7
1
FLUID, Y FITTING DI=6.25
1
FLUID, T FITTING TS7
1
FITTING, STRAIGHT 2.5/1.5
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Technology Fluidic principles
Mark on diagram
WASTE WASTE H2O
Sales unit
P/n
Designation
XCA196AS (1209129196)
FITTING, H2O/WASTE CONNECT.ASSY (Contains: 3 x FITTING, ANTI ROTATION WASHER EAC008A (1202221008), 3 x FITTING, LUER FEMALE 1 I=3MM EAC010A (1202221010), 3 x FITTING, LUER MALE/FEMALE I=2.5 EAC018A (1202221018))
XBA568F (1209114568) XBA574C (1209113574) LBH004A (1207791004)
FLUID, WATER STRAW ASSY
1
FLUID, WASTE STRAW ASSY
1
FLUID, 10 L CONTAINER
1
* Possible to order under the following references: - EAE004AS (1202249004) (2 metres) - EAE008AS (1202249008) (2 metres) - EAE009AS (1202249009) (2 metres) - EAE028AS (1202249028) (2 metres) - EAE043AS (1202249043) (2 metres) - A00AM07677S (1201907677) (2 metres) - 0779145S (1229779145) (2 metres)
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
3-9
Technology Fluidic principles
2.2.
Valves
2.2.1. Valves 3, 4 and 5 The valves 3, 4 and 5 are located on a "manifold" block behind the pumps. This block is visible as shown below. The valves are behind the plate and visible from the rear of the instrument after removing the rear plate (8 CHC screws).
V4 V5
A B E F C D
V3
2.2.2. Valves 1 and 2 The valves 1 and 2 are located right above the syringes and visible from the rear of the instrument after removing the plate.
V1
V2
V2 V1
Sample syringe Reagent syringe
3 - 10
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Technology Fluidic principles
2.3.
Cooling system diagram
Refer to the cooling system diagram on next page.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
3 - 11
Technology Temperature control
3. Temperature control 3.1.
PID control
3.1.1. General points The PIC U44 of the instrument mother board ensures the temperature control of: ■ the
cooled area of the reagent tray
■ the
reagent needle
■ the
reaction tray chamber.
The temperature control system used is a PID controller (Proportional-Integral-Derivative). The following diagram describes the PID controller principle.
TSetpoint
Error
+ -
PID
Order
TMeasured System
TSetpoint
Setpoint temperature
TMeasured
Measured temperature
Error
Error between the setpoint temperature and the measured temperature
PID
PID controller
System
Controlled system (cooling unit, heater of the reagent needle or reaction tray chamber)
Order
Order in % of the system cooling or heating capacity
■A
temperature sensor (NTC) measures the temperature within the cooled area of the reagent tray, the reagent needle or the reaction tray chamber.
■ The ■
3 - 12
error between the setpoint temperature and the measured temperature is calculated.
According to the calculated error, the PID controller sends an order to the system. This order is a percentage of the system cooling or heating capacity.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Technology Temperature control
The following diagram gives an example of response of a PID controlled system. Controlled value 1.4 1.3 1.2 1.1 1 0.9 0.8 0.7 0.6 0.5 0.4 0.3 0.2 0.1 0 0
Zero permanent error Excess + 10% Measured value Setpoint value - 10%
Time of response to reach the setpoint value 5
10
15
20
25
30
35
40
Time
Three parameters are used to adjust the PID controller: Gain (Proportional parameter), Ti (Integral parameter) and Td (Derivative parameter). The PID controller is adjusted to reach a compromise between: ■a
short time of response (determined by Ti)
■a
low excess (determined by Td)
■a
zero permanent error (ensured by Ti).
3.1.2. Instrument PID parameters The instrument PID parameters are displayed in the Heating menu (Services > Diagnostics > Heating).
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
3 - 13
Technology Temperature control
For each part (reagent needle, reaction tray chamber and cooled area of the reagent tray), the following temperature control values are given: Heading Gain Te/Ti Td/Te Te (s)
Description Proportional parameter of PID controller. Integral parameter of PID controller. Derivative parameter of PID controller. Frequency of the order sent by the PID controller to the system. For each cycle of a time Te, minimum time on which the signal Minimum T Off (ms) amplitude can be at 0. Assigned Value (°C) Setpoint temperature. Used for the Manual Mode only. Assigned Value (%) Order in % of the cooling or heating capacity. If checked, the temperature control is manually performed by Manual Mode using the Assigned Value in %. NTC Impedance NTC value for the setpoint temperature. Current (°C) Measured temperature. Power (%) Order in % of the cooling or heating capacity.
Do not modify the instrument PID parameters. Only the NTC value for the reaction tray chamber is modifiable by the technician.
The order is sent by the PID controller to the system via a PWM (Pulse-Width Modulation) signal. This PWM signal is proportional to the order in % of cooling or heating system capacity. The following diagram gives examples of PWM signals in relation with orders in % of cooling or heating system capacity. Amplitude
1
0 25%
0% 0
■ The
50%
75% Time
Te
2Te
3Te
4Te
PWM signal is sent in cycles of a time Te.
■ For
each cycle of a time Te, the time on which the signal amplitude is at 1, is proportional to the order in percentage of cooling or heating system capacity. For each cycle of a time Te, the time on which the signal amplitude is at 0 cannot be lower than the Minimum T Off. In this case, the time (on which the signal amplitude is at 0) is equal to 0.
3 - 14
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Technology Temperature control
3.2.
Reagent tray
3.2.1. Principle The reagent tray consists of 52 numbered positions of which 44 are refrigerated and 8 are at room temperature: ■ Cooled
area of the reagent tray, page 3-15
■ Temperate
area of the reagent tray, page 3-15.
Cooled area of the reagent tray ■ This
reagent tray area is refrigerated at 6°C using a cooling unit with a cooling loop inside the reagent tray. 8 fans (5V), located all along the cooling loop, continuously move the cooled air inside the reagent tray.
■A
temperature sensor (NTC) measures the temperature within the cooled area of the reagent tray. According to the measured temperature, the PIC U44 of the instrument mother board controls the cooling unit via a PWM signal (Te = 20 s).
■
The PWM signal is sent through the cooling unit control cable that connects the cooling unit to the instrument.
Round DIN connector (Cooling unit) Pin 1 Pin 2 Pin 3 Pin 4 Pin 5 Housing
Direction
Sub-D female connector Signal (Instrument) Management of cooling unit ON/OFF (via the relay) Pin 9 +5V Pin 5 Ground 0 V Low liquid level alarm Pin 4 0 V = OK; + 5 V = low level Compressor overload alarm Pin 6 0 V = OK; + 5 V = compressor OFF Pin 3 Solenoid valve control via the PWM signal + 5 V Pin 1 Shield Pin 2, 7, 8 Not connected
Temperate area of the reagent tray ■ This
reagent tray area is kept at room temperature using a fan. The fan (5 V) periodically moves hot-air (from the instrument inner area) into the temperate area of the reagent tray to warm it.
■A
temperature sensor (NTC) measures the temperature within the instrument. According to the measured temperature, the instrument mother board directly controls the fan via a PWM signal (Te = 10 s). For each cycle of a time Te, the time on which the fan is activated is inversely proportional to the temperature measured within the instrument. This is illustrated by the following diagram.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
3 - 15
Technology Temperature control
% of time on which the fan is activated
100%
Temperature
10% 14°C
35°C
The fan is activated only if the reagent tray is in its home position (to warm only the temperate reagent tray area).
2
1
Fan Reagent tray home position: 1- Position 36 in front of the yellow arrow 2- Temperate area in front of the fan
3 - 16
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Technology Temperature control
3.2.2. Cooling unit description The cooling unit consists of: ■
a glycol bath (glycol + distilled water) with an integrated recirculation pump that ensures constant conditions for the reagent tray cooling loop
■a
cooling circuit that cools the glycol bath.
The following diagram describes the cooling circuit principle. Glycol bath
4
3
Evaporator Solenoid valve
Capillary tube
Condenser
Dessicator
Compressor 1
■ The
2
Fan
refrigerant fluid used in the cooling circuit is a refrigerant gas of R-134 type (Freon).
■ The
1.
2.
3. 4.
refrigerant fluid circulating in the cooling circuit undergoes a transformation cycle of four steps. The fluid is in a gaseous state. It passes through the compressor where it is compressed and its temperature and pressure is raised. Its pressure is then controlled by a pressure sensor (only for cooling unit CU401). The fluid is in a gaseous state, in high pressure. It circulates through the condenser by a fan where it passes from a gaseous state into a liquid state and its temperature is slightly reduced. Then, the fluid circulates through the dessicator (where its impurities are eliminated) before passing through the capillary tube. The fluid is in a liquid state, in high pressure. It passes through the capillary tube where its temperature and pressure are reduced. This step is called the gas expansion. The fluid is in the beginning state of a liquid/gaseous transformation, in low pressure. It cools the glycol bath circulating through the evaporator, where it passes into a gaseous state and its temperature is slightly raised.
■ The
temperature control is performed by the solenoid valve that opens a bypass to inject the hot fluid into the evaporator. - If the solenoid valve is opened, the cooling capacity is reduced to zero. - If the solenoid valve is closed, the cooling capacity rises to its maximum.
■ According
to the temperature measured within the cooled area of the reagent tray, the PIC U44 of the instrument mother board controls the solenoid valve via a PWM signal (Te = 20 s).
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
3 - 17
3 - 18
(Top cover for CU400)
Voltage on connectors SK1, SK2, SK3 and SK4: main power supply
Cooling unit models with fuses
Only for CU401
Voltage on connector SK5: 5V / >100V depending on the valve state
Technology Temperature control
3.2.3. Cooling unit electric diagram
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Voltage on connectors SK1, SK2, SK3 and SK4: main power supply
Cooling unit models with circuit breakers
Voltage on connector SK5: 5V / >115V depending on the valve state
Technology Temperature control
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
3 - 19
Technology Temperature control
3.3.
Reagent needle ■ The reagent needle is a stainless steel needle with an external graphitized teflon coating and an internal
sheathing made up of a teflon capillary tube from one end to the other. ■ The
reagent needle preheats the reagents at 37°C (± 0.5°C) during the sampling thanks to a resistive coil wire located along the reagent needle. The resistive coil wire is powered by 24 V, its resistance is 36 Ω and its electric power is 16 W.
■A
temperature sensor (NTC) measures the temperature within the reagent needle. According to the measured temperature, the PIC U44 of the instrument mother board controls the heater via a PWM signal (Te = 0.5 s).
The NTC resistance is 6.02 kΩ at 37°C and 10 kΩ at 25°C.
■
The PWM signal (5V) is sent from the PIC U44 to the transistor Q3 of the instrument mother board. Then, the transistor Q3 converts and sends the PWM signal (24V) to power the heater.
■
During the reagent level detection, the reagent needle heater and NTC are respectively switched off by the relays K1 and K2 of the reagent level detection board in order not to disturb the reagent level detection.
Heater + NTC connector To J5 on reagent level detection board Level detection connector To J1 on reagent level detection board
3 - 20
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Technology Temperature control
3.4.
Reaction tray ■ The
reaction tray is located in a chamber heated at 37°C (± 0.2°C) thanks to a heater and a fan. The heater, located at the bottom of the chamber, is powered by 24 V, its resistance is 4.3 Ω and its electric power is 140 W. The fan (24 V), located right above the heater, continuously moves hot-air inside the reaction tray chamber.
■A
temperature sensor (NTC) measures the temperature within the reaction tray chamber. According to the measured temperature, the PIC U44 of the instrument mother board controls the heater via a PWM signal (Te = 2 s).
The NTC resistance is 6.08 kΩ at 37°C and 10 kΩ at 25°C.
■
The PIC U44 of the instrument mother board sends a control signal to the power supply. Then, the power supply converts the control signal and sends the PWM signal (24V) to power the heater.
Cooled air Reaction tray
NTC
Fan Heater
Hot air
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
3 - 21
Technology Level detection and shock detection
4. Level detection and shock detection 4.1.
Reagent level detection
The reagent level detection is a capacitive level detection and is ensured by the reagent level detection board. See Section 4: Electric and electronic principles, 3.3. Reagent level detection board, page 4-20. Depending on the model of the reagent level detection board you have on your instrument, the reagent level detection principle slightly differs.
4.1.1. Reagent level detection board XAA500FS (1209109500) The following diagram describes the reagent level detection principle.
Oscillator U1
Needle Detector
NTC
Relay K2
Heater
Relay K1
Data treatment
Instrument mother board
Reagent level detection board
1. The oscillator, built in the microcontroller U1, sends continuously a frequency of 12 MHz to the reagent needle. 2. When the reagent arm moves down, the instrument mother board sends the following to the microcontroller U1 of the reagent level detection board: - the sensitivity level (see Sensitivity level, page 3-23) set according to the liquid to be detected. - a start signal to start the capacitive level detection. 3. The microcontroller U1 sends a control signal to the relays K1 and K2 which respectively switch off the reagent needle heater and NTC in order not to disturb the capacitive level detection. 4. The microcontroller U1 sends a shield signal to the heating cable to override the cable noise and the capacitive effect of the heating cable. 5. The microcontroller U1 measures the voltage variation of the oscillator that directly depends on the capacitance measured between the reagent needle and the ground. First, a capacitive measurement is done on air. This measurement gives the reference value. 6. When the reagent needle reaches the liquid, the capacitance as well as the voltage variation change. 7. The microcontroller U1 compares the voltage variation measured with a threshold value. This threshold value is calculated from the calibration measurement (see Calibration, page 3-23) and the reference value.
3 - 22
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Technology Level detection and shock detection
8. A counter counts the number of times the threshold value is overrun. When the counter reaches a value determined by the sensitivity level (impulsion number), the reagent level detection is effective (the liquid has been detected). 9. The microcontroller U1 sends a level detection signal to the instrument mother board to stop the reagent arm movement. 10. The microcontroller U1 sends a control signal to the relays K1 and K2 that switch the reagent needle heater and NTC on. 11. The microcontroller U1 stops the shield signal.
Sensitivity level On certain liquids, foam could be created. The sensitivity level avoids the mix up, during the reagent level detection, between bubbles and liquid. It is determined according to the liquid type and the sampling location (cassette, rack, etc). Each sensitivity level corresponds to the number of times the threshold value is overrun before the reagent level detection is effective. The instrument mother board sends the sensitivity level in the form of an impulsion number, to the reagent level detection board. Sensitivity level
Impulsion number
Default 1 2 3 4 Calibration
0 1 2 3 4 7
Number of threshold overrun 4 8 12 14 20 N/A
Calibration The calibration determines the reagent needle sensitivity which could vary according to the needle. It is performed after each reagent needle replacement. The calibration cycle consists in performing, in the wash tower, a capacitive measurement on air then on water. The calibration result gives a reference threshold. This threshold will be compared to the measured voltage variation during the reagent level detection.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
3 - 23
Technology Level detection and shock detection
4.1.2. Reagent level detection board XAA500DS (1209108500) The following diagram describes the reagent level detection principle.
Oscillator
U2
Needle Detector
NTC
Relay K2
Heater
Relay K1
U3 Microcontroller Data treatment
Instrument mother board
Reagent level detection board
1. The oscillator, built in U2, sends continuously a frequency of 240 kHz to the reagent needle. 2. When the reagent arm moves down, the instrument mother board sends the following to the microcontroller U3 of the reagent level detection board: - the sensitivity level (see Sensitivity level, page 3-25) set according to the liquid to be detected. - a start signal to start the capacitive level detection. 3. The microcontroller U3 sends a control signal to the relays K1 and K2 which respectively switch off the reagent needle heater and NTC in order not to disturb the capacitive level detection. 4. U2 sends a shield signal to the heating cable to override the cable noise and the capacitive effect of the heating cable. 5. U2 measures the voltage variation of the oscillator that directly depends on the capacitance measured between the reagent needle and the ground. First, a capacitive measurement is done on air. This measurement gives the reference value. 6. When the reagent needle reaches the liquid, the capacitance as well as the voltage variation change. 7. The microcontroller U3 compares the voltage variation measured with a threshold value. This threshold value is calculated from the calibration measurement (see Calibration, page 3-25) and the reference value. 8. A counter counts the number of times the threshold value is overrun. When the counter reaches a value determined by the sensitivity level (impulsion number), the reagent level detection is effective (the liquid has been detected). 9. The microcontroller U3 sends a level detection signal to the instrument mother board to stop the reagent arm movement. 10. The microcontroller U3 sends a control signal to the relays K1 and K2 that switch the reagent needle heater and NTC on. 11. U2 stops the shield signal.
3 - 24
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Technology Level detection and shock detection
Sensitivity level On certain liquids, foam could be created. The sensitivity level avoids the mix up, during the reagent level detection, between bubbles and liquid. It is determined according to the liquid type and the sampling location (cassette, rack, etc). Each sensitivity level corresponds to the number of times the threshold value is overrun before the reagent level detection is effective. The instrument mother board sends the sensitivity level in the form of an impulsion number, to the reagent level detection board. Sensitivity level
Impulsion number
Default 1 2 3 4 Calibration
0 1 2 3 4 7
Number of threshold overrun 25 50 100 200 400 N/A
Calibration The calibration determines the reagent needle sensitivity which could vary according to the needle. It is performed after each reagent needle replacement. The calibration cycle consists in performing, in the wash tower, a capacitive measurement on air then on water. The calibration result gives a reference threshold. This threshold will be compared to the measured voltage variation during the reagent level detection. The calibration result is saved on a flash memory (built in U3) on the reagent level detection board. A reagent level detection could not be performed if a calibration has not been done.
Voltage measurements on the reagent level detection board See Section 4: Electric and electronic principles, 3.3.2. Reagent level detection board XAA500DS (1209108500), page 4-22. Configuration On air On distilled water (2 mL) Disconnect the level detection connector (J1)
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Voltage (V) 1.9 1.7 2.8
3 - 25
Technology Level detection and shock detection
4.2.
Sample level and shock detection
The sample level detection is a capacitive level detection and is ensured by the sample level detection board. See Section 4: Electric and electronic principles, 3.2. Sample level detection board XAA486AS (1209108486), page 4-18. The sample level detection board ensures also the sample shock detection. The following diagram describes the sample level detection principle.
Oscillator
PIC U2
Needle
Data treatment
Instrument mother board
Shock detection switch Sample level detection board
1. When the sample arm moves down, the instrument mother board sends a start signal to the PIC U2 of the sample level detection board to start the capacitive level detection. 2. The PIC U2 measures the frequency variation of the oscillator that directly depends on the capacitance measured between the sample needle and the ground. 3. When the sample needle reaches the liquid, the capacitance as well as the frequency variation change. The PIC U2 sends a level detection signal to the instrument mother board to stop the sample arm movement.
Frequency measurements on the sample level detection board ■ Plug a multimeter (frequency measurement function) into the PIC U2 between pin 1 (ground) and pin 5. See Section 4: Electric and electronic principles, 3.2. Sample level detection board XAA486AS (1209108486), page 4-18.
Configuration On air On distilled water (2 mL) Disconnect the level detection connector (J1) Ground
3 - 26
Frequency (kHz) about 47 about 35 > 100 < 10
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Technology Level detection and shock detection
The sample shock detection is enabled by the shock detection switch located on the sample arm.
Shock detection switch
In normal cases, the shock detection switch is in low position: the metal plate keeps the switch in low position. In case of shock, the shock detection switch is in high position: the metal plate raises and releases the switch. The shock detection switch sends a shock detection signal to the instrument mother board to stop the sample arm movement.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
3 - 27
Technology Pressure detection
5. Pressure detection 5.1.
General points
The pressure detection is ensured by two pressure sensors (reagent and sample) located in the syringe block support and the pressure board located behind the syringe block. See Section 4: Electric and electronic principles, 5. Pressure board (kit ref. 1300015280), page 4-27.
The following diagram describes the pressure detection principle.
Reagent pressure sensor
Sample pressure sensor
Pressure board
Signal measurement, amplification and digitisation
Mother board
Result check
1. When the syringes start, the instrument mother board sends a start signal to the pressure board to start the pressure detection. 2. The pressure board measures the signals (voltages) sent by the pressure sensors (reagent and sample). These signals directly depend on the pressures measured by the pressure sensors. 3. The pressure board amplifies and digitizes the signals, then sends the results to the instrument mother board. Two types of results are sent to the instrument mother board: - results before amplification - results after amplification. 4. The instrument mother board checks the results to ensure that they are not out of range.
3 - 28
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Technology Pressure detection
5.2.
High pressure, low pressure and bad sampling detection
The pressure sensors ensure the detection of the three following troubles: - High pressure on the sample or reagent hydraulic system (blockage) - Low pressure on the sample or reagent hydraulic system (water supply failure) - Bad sampling (fibrin, air bubbles).
High pressure on the sample or reagent hydraulic system (blockage) The results before amplification are checked to ensure that the pressure is lower than 2500 mbar. If the pressure is higher than 2500 mbar, there is a high pressure on the sample or reagent hydraulic system (blockage).
Low pressure on the sample or reagent hydraulic system (water supply failure) During rinsing cycles, the results before amplification are checked to ensure that the pressure is higher than 300 mbar. If the pressure is lower than 300 mbar during rinsing cycles, there is a low pressure on the sample or reagent hydraulic system (water supply failure).
Bad sampling (fibrin, air bubbles) To correctly detect a bad sampling (fibrin, air bubbles), the pressure sensors are calibrated as follows. ■
For each pressure sensor (reagent and sample), the system primes the fluids, then runs a 10 aspirations repetition with the syringe, alternating between low and high volumes.
■ At the end of the cycle, the factors A and B of the calibration curve on water (y = Ax + B) are calculated. ■
Then, the factors KA and KB are applied on the calibration curve on water to determine the low and high limits of the acceptable range. y(KA) = KA * (Ax + B) y(KB) = KB * (Ax + B) The factors KA and KB are fixed and must not be changed. KA: factor of air detection during aspiration KB: factor of blockage (fibrin, clamped tubing, ...)
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
3 - 29
Technology Pressure detection
result after amplification
water
KA
KB
Fibrin
Acceptable range
Air bubbles
volume During aspirations, the results after amplification are checked to ensure that they are within the acceptable range. If they are out of the acceptable range during aspirations, there is a bad sampling (fibrin, air bubbles). The pressure detection parameters are displayed in the Pressure menu (Services > Diagnostics > Pressure).
B A C D
For each pressure sensor (reagent and sample), the following parameters are displayed: - the high pressure threshold in mbar (A) - the low pressure threshold in mbar (B) - the factors A and B of the calibration curve on water as well as the factors KA and KB (C).
3 - 30
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Technology Pressure detection
Press Set Pressure to calibrate each pressure sensor. At the end of the cycle, the factors A and B of the calibration curve on water are displayed in the left window. If the results are correct, press OK to validate the calibration. The new factors are then displayed in the right window. If not, press CANCEL to cancel the calibration.
Please refer to the pressure sensors calibration procedure as described in the procedure RAS442: Pressure sensors, page 1 to calibrate the pressure sensors and make sure that the results are correct.
Press Read Pressure to display the pressure measured by each pressure sensor at any time. The results before and after amplification are displayed in the window (D). If the reading is done when the syringe is not working, the result before amplification should be near 0 and the result after amplification should range between 2000 and 5000. This reading allows you to check the pressure sensor functioning and the result amplification.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
3 - 31
Technology Pressure detection
3 - 32
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Section 4: Electric and electronic principles
1. Mother board................................................................................................. 4 - 3 1.1. Mother board synoptic .............................................................................................................. 4 - 4 1.2. Mother board configuration ....................................................................................................... 4 - 6 1.3. Mother board adjustments ........................................................................................................ 4 - 7 1.4. Mother board connections ........................................................................................................ 4 - 9 1.5. LEDs on mother board............................................................................................................. 4 - 11 1.6. Mother board Inputs & Outputs ............................................................................................... 4 - 12
2. Optical acquisition ...................................................................................... 4 - 14 2.1. Optical acquisition synoptic .................................................................................................... 4 - 14 2.2. Optical amplifier board XAA457BS (1209109457)................................................................... 4 - 16 2.3. Optical processing board XAA483CS (1209109483)............................................................... 4 - 16
3. Level detection ............................................................................................ 4 - 18 3.1. Level detection synoptic.......................................................................................................... 4 - 18 3.2. Sample level detection board XAA486AS (1209108486)......................................................... 4 - 18 3.3. Reagent level detection board................................................................................................. 4 - 20
4. Sample relay board XAA491CS (1209109491) .......................................... 4 - 25 5. Pressure board (kit ref. 1300015280)......................................................... 4 - 27 6. Internal computer 1300013734 .................................................................. 4 - 29 7. Power supply ............................................................................................... 4 - 30 7.1. Protection ................................................................................................................................ 4 - 30 7.2. Inputs/Outputs connectors...................................................................................................... 4 - 31 7.3. Power supply cables................................................................................................................ 4 - 33
8. Connectors .................................................................................................. 4 - 34 8.1. DAC024A (1201891024): CABLE, PRINTER IEEE1284 SHIELD.............................................. 8.2. DAC034A (1201891034): CABLE, CHILLER CABLE ............................................................... 8.3. DAC044A (1201891044): CABLE, USB EXT. CORD L=0.3 M ................................................. 8.4. DAD123A (1201921123): CABLE, PC/PRINT L=1000 5-25 P80 ............................................. 8.5. DAD124A (1201921124): CABLE, PC/RS L=1000 5-09 P80 ................................................... 8.6. DAD134B (1201922134): CABLE, ACQUISIT. BOARD CABLE V1 .......................................... 8.7. DAD134C (1201923134): CABLE, ACQUISIT. BOARD CABLE ............................................... 8.8. DAD135A (1201921135): CABLE, SAMP.RELAY PCB CABLE V1 .......................................... 8.9. DAD135B (1201922135): CABLE, SAMP.RELAY PCB CABLE ............................................... 8.10. DAL029A (1201961029): MOTOR, MIXER ASSY MOTOR .................................................... 8.11. XBA512B (1209112512): CABLE, MOTHER BOARD LEFT CABLE ...................................... 8.12. XBA513C (1209113513): CABLE, RIGHT CABLE ASSY P400 V1......................................... 8.13. XBA513E (1209115513): CABLE, RIGHT CABLE ASSY........................................................ 8.14. XBA514B (1209112514): CABLE, ELECTRO-VALVES .......................................................... 8.15. XBA517D (1209114517): CABLE, DET. BOARD CABLE P400.............................................. 8.16. XBA518A (1209111518): SENSOR, LB TRAY/ARM/MIX/HANDLER ..................................... 8.17. XBA519A (1209111519): SENSOR, LB+MOT.CABLE ARM/HANDL..................................... ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
4 - 36 4 - 37 4 - 38 4 - 38 4 - 39 4 - 40 4 - 41 4 - 42 4 - 43 4 - 44 4 - 45 4 - 47 4 - 48 4 - 49 4 - 50 4 - 51 4 - 52 4-1
Electric and electronic principles
8.18. XBA520A (1209111520): CABLE, ARMS/HANDLER CABLE ................................................ 8.19. XBA531B (1209112531): PCB, SAMPLE TRAY TUBE DETECTOR....................................... 8.20. XBA532DS (1209119532): SENSOR, RACK LOAD/UNLOAD ............................................... 8.21. XBA533B (1209112533): FAN, REACTION TRAY FAN.......................................................... 8.22. XBA534C (1209113534): HEATER, REACTION TRAY........................................................... 8.23. XBA535BS (1209119535): SENSOR, REAGENT & REACTION TEMP. ................................. 8.24. XBA536A (1209111536): SENSOR, REACT.TRAY HOME SENSOR ..................................... 8.25. XBA543A (3012277056): CABLE, PREAMP.TO MAIN BOARD ISE....................................... 8.26. XBA544C (1209113544): VALVE, ISE VALVE ASSY .............................................................. 8.27. XBA545B (1209112545): CABLE, ISE SYR. LB CABLE ........................................................ 8.28. XBA551A (1209111551): PCB, SAMPLE TRAY LED ............................................................. 8.29. XBA561D (1209114561): MIXER, MIXING PADDLE MOTOR ASSY...................................... 8.30. XBA563ET (1209119563): NEEDLE, SAMPLE P400 W FERRITE.......................................... 8.31. XBA564DT (1209119564): NEEDLE, REAGENT NEEDLE...................................................... 8.32. XBA571A (1209111571): CABLE, LEVEL DETECT TANKS ................................................... 8.33. XBA572A (1209111572): SENSOR, ROOM TEMP.SENSOR................................................. 8.34. XBA573A (1209111573): SENSOR, REAG.TRAY DOOR SENSOR ....................................... 8.35. XBA587B (1209111587): FAN, REAGENT TRAY FAN L=400................................................ 8.36. XBA588A (1209111588): CABLE, NEEDLE PRESS.CABLE .................................................. 8.37. XBA601BS (1209119601): PCB, PC WAKE UP BUTTON ..................................................... 8.38. XBA732AS (1209119732): CABLE, WASTE PUMP ADAPTOR/V1 ........................................ 8.39. XBA734AS (1209119734): CABLE, ADAP NEW RACK SENSOR/V1 .................................... 8.40. XBA756AS (1209119756): CABLE, ADAP OLD RACK SENSOR........................................... 8.41. XBA814A (1209111814): CABLE, INNER ARM CABLE ......................................................... 8.42. XBA815A (1209111815): CABLE, REAG MOTOR ADAPTOR CABLE ................................... 8.43. XBA847AT (1209119847): NEEDLE, SAMPLE PC400........................................................... 8.44. XDA820D (1209134820): MOTOR, REAGENT TRAY MOTOR............................................... 8.45. XDA871B (1209132871): MOTOR, SAMPLE TRAY MOTOR ASSY....................................... 8.46. XEC186AS (1209179186): SENSOR, REAG. TRAY HOME SENSOR.................................... 8.47. XEC202AS (1209179202): PUMP, WATER ASSY + METAL SHEET .....................................
4 - 53 4 - 54 4 - 55 4 - 56 4 - 57 4 - 58 4 - 59 4 - 60 4 - 61 4 - 62 4 - 63 4 - 64 4 - 65 4 - 66 4 - 67 4 - 68 4 - 69 4 - 70 4 - 71 4 - 72 4 - 73 4 - 74 4 - 74 4 - 75 4 - 76 4 - 77 4 - 78 4 - 79 4 - 80 4 - 81
9. Instrument synoptic .................................................................................... 4 - 82
4-2
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Electric and electronic principles Mother board
1. Mother board
Two mother board references are available depending on the instrument you have: ■ 1300013696 for ABX Pentra 400 ■ 1300013697 for Pentra C400
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
4-3
4-4
Screen
Printer
2 sensors tank full, tank empty for water and waste
Power supply voltages control
Lamp voltage control
IDEE reader Sample
IDEE reader Reagent
RS232
RS232
RS232
RS232
SPI bus
Mouse
Computer RS232
RS232
Mother board
Touch screen
Keyboard
Host
Reagent tray
Sample tray
Reaction tray
Sample arm
Reagent arm
Cuvette changer
Mixer 1 step by step motor 1 continuous motor 1 Home sensor
2 draining/rinsing pumps 2 tank empty/full sensors
6 electrovalves
Reagent syringe 1 step by step motor 1 Home switch
Sample syringe 1 step by step motor 1 Home switch
1 step by step motor 1 Hall effect Home sensor 1 Hall effect sensor for tray door with solenoid bolt
1 step by step motor + encoder 1 Home sensor 2 optical sensors tube/cup
1 step by step motor 1 Home sensor
2 step by step motors (µ step) 2 Home sensors V/H 1 level detection 1 fibrin detection 1 shock detection
2 step by step motors (µ step) 2 Home sensors V/H 1 level detection 1 fibrin detection
3 step by step motors 3 Home sensors
Temperature arm control 1 probe
Temperature reaction tray control 1 probe
1.1.
ISE module amplifier 6 inputs/outputs convertor 16 bits, 1 peristatic pump, step by step motor, 1 Home sensor, 1 optical sensor for air/liquid detection
Photometer amplifier 15 inputs/outputs convertor 20 bits
Temperature control
1 probe Reagent tray
Electric and electronic principles Mother board
Mother board synoptic
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Electric and electronic principles Mother board
Mother board synoptic
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
4-5
Electric and electronic principles Mother board
1.2.
Mother board configuration
E1 E3
E8
E2
E4
E5 E7 E6
Jumpers:
4-6
E1 =
1
2
E3 =
1 2
E2 =
2 1
4 3
E4 =
1 3
2 4
E5 =
2 1
4 3
E7 =
3 4
1 2
E8 =
3 4
1 2
E6 = 1 2
Jumper E3
RTS UART = CTS UART
Jumper Setting Short 1 - 2
Xon / Xoff Handshake (Default)
Jumper E5 E5 E5 (Default) E5 (Default)
RTS UART = RTS COM3 CTS UART = CTS COM3 RTS UART = CTS UART RTS COM3 = CTS COM3
Jumper Setting Short 1 - 2 Short 3 - 4 Short 1 - 3 Short 2 - 4
Hardware Handshake Hardware Handshake Xon / Xoff Handshake Xon / Xoff Handshake
Jumper E2 E2 E2 (Default) E2 (Default)
RTS UART = RTS COM4 CTS UART = CTS COM4 RTS UART = CTS UART RTS COM4 = CTS COM4
Jumper Setting Short 1 - 2 Short 3 - 4 Short 1 - 3 Short 2 - 4
Hardware Handshake Hardware Handshake Xon / Xoff Handshake Xon / Xoff Handshake
Jumper E1 (Default) E4 E4 E4 (Default) E4 (Default)
Pin 9 (Ri) = VCC RTS UART = RTS COM5 CTS UART = CTS COM5 RTS UART = CTS UART Pin 7 & 8 COM5 = NC
Jumper Setting Short 1 - 2 Short 1 - 2 Short 3 - 4 Short 1 - 3
Hardware Handshake Hardware Handshake Xon / Xoff Handshake Xon / Xoff Handshake
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Electric and electronic principles Mother board
1.3.
Jumper E8 E8 E8 (Default) E8 (Default) E7 E7 E7 (Default) E7 (Default) Jumper E6
Pressure Rge = RA0 PH2 = RA3 Pressure Rge = RA3 PH2 = RA0 Pressure Spl = RA0 PH2 = RA3 Pressure Spl = RA3 PH2 = RA0
Jumper Setting Short 1 - 2 Short 3 - 4 Short 1 - 3 Short 2 - 4 Short 1 - 2 Short 3 - 4 Short 1 - 3 Short 2 - 4
Measure by Slave #12 Measure by Slave #12 Trig by Slave #12 Trig by Slave #12 Measure by Slave #13 Measure by Slave #13 Trig by Slave #13 Trig by Slave #13
Main Reset (reserved)
Jumper Setting Open
Default
Mother board adjustments
Motor Reagent Syringe Sample Syringe Reagent Tray Sample Tray X/Y Mixer Mixer Rot. Reagent Arm Up/Down Sample Arm Up/Down Reagent Arm Rot. Sample Arm Cuvette motion Horizontal motion Vertical motion Reaction Tray
Test Point TP2 TP7 TP11 TP14 TP16 TP19 TP27 TP28 TP29 TP30 TP13 TP9 TP6 TP1
Potentiometer R6 R38 R70 R100 R128 R146 R222 R224 R225 R227 R115 R87 R56 R25
Target 1.2 V 1V 1V 1V 0.8 V 9V 0.6 V 1V 1V 0.6 V 0.6 V 0.8 V 1.2 V 2V
Range ±50 mV ±50 mV ±50 mV ±50 mV ±50 mV ±100 mV ±50 mV ±50 mV ±50 mV ±50 mV ±50 mV ±50 mV ±50 mV ±50 mV
Test points and potentiometers are located as shown on the following diagram.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
4-7
Electric and electronic principles Mother board
Reaction tray motor (R25 - TP1)
Horizontal motions motor (R87 - TP9)
Vertical motions motor (R56 - TP6)
Up\Down sample arm motor (R224 - TP28)
Rotation reagent arm motor (R222 - TP27)
Rotation sample arm motor (R227 - TP30) Up\Down reagent arm motor (R225 - TP29)
Cuvette motions motor (R115 - TP13)
Mixing motor (R146 - TP19) Reagent Syringe motor (R6 - TP2) Sample Syringe motor (R38 - TP7)
4-8
Reagent Tray motor (R70 - TP11)
Sample Tray motor (R100 - TP14)
XY Mixing motor (R128 - TP16)
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Electric and electronic principles Mother board
1.4.
Mother board connections
Refer to the following diagram.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
4-9
4 - 10
Permanent Fan (+24V)
Cover Solenoid
Needle Board
J4 on Heating
Cooling Unit
Mixing motor
Reaction Heating sensor
Inner Temperature sensor
Controled Fan (+5V)
XY Mixing motor
Reagent Refrigerated sensor
Sample Tray motor
XY Mixing motor home
Sample Tray home
Reagent Tray motor
Reagent Tray home
Sample Syringe motor
Sample Syringe home
Reagent Syringe motor
Reagent Syringe home
J3 on Pressure board
J48
J66
J35
J25
J16
J11
J6
Power Supply
J53
J46
J42
J67
J2
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN Fans
+24V
J54
J43 J44
J33
J51
J65
J49
J47
Pump
Water
Waste Pump
J56
J31 J28
J55
J52
Valves
J34
J62
Tank sensors J29
Motor
J57
J39
Home
J58
J1 on Sample Relay board
J12
J10
J59
J40
Reagent Arm Vertical
J50
J38
J1
J60
J41
Computer (RS232 # 4)
Motor + Home
J45
J37
J22
J19
J17
J61
J5
J26
Arm Cover Switch
J27
Reagent Arm Rotation
J63
J36
J30
Free
Optical Encoder
J4
ISE (RS232 #5)
Reagent Barcode
Reagent Cover Switch Mixer present switch
PC Wake up
J21
J14
J9
J3
ISE (RS232 #3)
J32
Rotation Motor
Sample Arm
Reagent Room Fan (+5v)
J2 on Reagent Arm board
J2 on Sample Arm board
Rotation Home
Sample Arm
New Segment available
Cuvette Motion home
Cuvette Motion motor
Not in position
Rack Used Segment
Translation Cuvette Loader
Motor + Home
Rack Used Segment full
Vertical Motion home
Vertical Motion motor
Low position
Vertical Motion motor
Reaction Tray home
Sample Arm Vertical
Motor + Home
J20
J15
J8
Reaction Tray motor
Cover sensor
Handling Cuvette
Processing board
J2 on Optical
Electric and electronic principles Mother board
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
-5V DS13
Reaction Room Heating DS10
Compressor Electrovalve DS11
Compressor Overload DS9
+5V DS14
VCC (+5V) DS15 +24V DS16
Cover solenoid DS12
Waste pump DS17
Water pump DS18
Tube / Cup DS7
DUART 1 DS3 DS2
Tube height DS6
1.5.
Needle Heating DS8
Reagent Tray Home DS5
DUART 2 DS4 DS1
Electric and electronic principles Mother board
LEDs on mother board
4 - 11
Electric and electronic principles Mother board
The following table describes the LEDs states. LED designation DS2 DUART 1
DS1
Green
DS4
Red
Reagent Tray Home Needle Heating
DS5 DS8
Red Green
Compressor Overload
DS9
Red
Compressor Electrovalve
DS11
Green
DS10
Red
Lit during reaction room heating
DS13 DS14
Red Red
Lit if power supply is present Lit if power supply is present
DS15
Red
Lit if power supply is present
DS16 DS12 DS17 DS18 DS7 DS6
Red Green Green Green Red Red
DUART 2
Reaction Room Heating Power supply -5V Power supply +5V Power supply VCC (+5V) Power supply +24V Cover solenoid Waste pump Water pump Tube/Cup Tube height
1.6.
DS1
LED color LED state Green Fixed lighting = normal state Blinking = RS232 dialog (emission or reception) Fixed lighting = normal state Red Blinking = RS232 dialog (reception or emission) Fixed lighting = normal state Blinking = RS232 dialog (emission or reception) Fixed lighting = normal state Blinking = RS232 dialog (reception or emission) Lit if reagent tray is in home position Lit during needle heating Lit = compressor OK Switch off = compressor overload Signal lit by intermittence: Lit = not cooling Switch off = cooling
Lit if power supply is present Lit if reagent tray cover is locked Lit if waste pump is running Lit if water pump is running Lit if tube is present Lit if sample cup is present1
Mother board Inputs & Outputs
Refer to the following diagram.
4 - 12
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
PHD14
Optical Encoder
Power Supply
Chiller On/Off
PH4
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
U37 HC574
Lamp_ON/OFF PC_ON/OFF Pwr_Sup_Status
GND
4 - 13
GND
GND
C455 100p
Lamp_Stand_By
Lamp_ON/OFF PC_ON/OFF Pwr_Sup_Status
CHA CHB
Chiller_Level
PHA PHB
1k
Lamp_Stand_By
VCC
19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12
R202
Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q5 Q6 Q7
Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q5 Q6 Q7
19 18 17 16 15 13 12 14
Chiller_Watchdog
DS12 Green
R183 4k7
U43 HC574
ENEV 1 OE CSR5 11 CLK
D(8) D(9) D(10) D(11) D(12) D(13) D(14) D(15)
GND
Q8 BC817
D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7
Chiller_Level
C456 100p
CR2 MURS120
2 3 4 5 6 8 9 7
ENEV 1 OE CSR5 11 CLK
D(0) D(1) D(2) D(3) D(4) D(5) D(6) D(7)
+24V
CR3 MURS120 R185 4k7
CSR5
C290 VCC 470u
Chiller_Watchdog
4VCC 3 J27 2 1
PH2
1 J49 2
R213 4k7
+24V
EV(6)
EV(5)
EV(4)
EV(3)
EV(2)
EV(1)
EV(0)
+24V
D(015)
Arm_switch
CS_REG_OUT
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 J34 8 9 10 11 12 13 14
R220 4k7
Cover Solenoid
EV Board
CPU&GLU
ENEV
1 2 3 4 1 3 4 2
EV(0.6)
D(015)
D(0) D(1) D(2) D(3) D(4) D(5) D(6) D(7)
19 18 12 13 14 15 16 17 HC573
Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q5 Q6 Q7
U33 LE D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 OE
Tube_Heigh
Tube_Cup
R147 10k
11 2 7 6 5 8 7 6 5 8 3 9 8 7 6 5 4 Chiller_Level 1
DS6 Red
R151 470R
VCC TxD
RxD
COM
16 COM 15 COM 14 COM 13 COM 12 COM 11 COM 10
VCC 10k 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 1
CAB_spl_Sensor
U36
U36 U36
U36
U36
U36
U36
VCC
8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5 10k
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
ULNZ003
GND
1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4
8 7 6 5 8 6 5 7 10k GND
UR27 UR27 UR27 UR27 UR26 UR26 UR26 UR26 UR29 UR29 UR29 UR29 UR28 UR28 UR28 UR28
CS_REG_IN
UR22 UR22 UR22 UR20 UR20 UR20 UR20 UR22 +24V
+24V
R186 4k7
Q9 IRLL3303 G
Green
DS17
R187 4k7
NI
R241 1R R237
GND
330R R155 330R
R130
GND
S
D
C292 C300
GND
GND
GND
HE2
1 2 J56
HE2
1 2 J55
100p 100n 100u
C251
To Relay board
Hard PC Wake up
Arm Cover Switch
Reagent Cover Switch
Mixer Position
Fill Tank Switch (NU)
Water Low Level Switch
Waste Full Switch
Water Pump
Waste Pump
HE10MD16
PH4 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 J36 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
PH4 1 2 3 J62 4
PH4 1 2 3 J30 4
PH4 1 2 3 J29 4
C293 C301
GND GND
PH4 1 2 3 J28 4
100p 100n 100u
C250
GND
CR4 MURS120
GND
S
D
CR5 MURS120
GND
Tube_Heigh
C213 100n C210 100n Tube_Cup
VCC +24V
C182 47p
Arms_Cover_SW
VCC
+24V
Barcode CAB_spl_Sensor Barcode
Green LED
Red LED
R123 10k
DS18 R215 4k7 R208 Green Q10 4k7 IRLL3303 G
R207 4k7
DS7 Red
R161 470R
R214 4k7
VCC
Fill_Tank_SW Reagent_Cover_SW Arms_Cover_SW PC_Wake_up
Water_Low_SW
Waste_Full_SW
GND GND
GND GND GND GND GND
1 2 3 J31 4
Electric and electronic principles Mother board
Electric and electronic principles Optical acquisition
2. Optical acquisition The optical acquisition consists in the treatment of the optical signal from the spectrophotometer. This signal is digitized and sent to the mother board operating system. This electronic functionality is run by two boards:
2.1.
■
the optical amplifier board XAA457BS (1209109457) (on which photodiode array is fixed) makes the current-power conversion of each wavelength. See 2.2. Optical amplifier board XAA457BS (1209109457), page 4-16.
■
the optical processing board XAA483CS (1209109483) makes the analogic-numeric conversion, the RAM storage and the data transmission to the mother board operating system. See 2.3. Optical processing board XAA483CS (1209109483), page 4-16.
Optical acquisition synoptic
OPTICAL PROCESSING BOARD A1_A18
BD32
SRAM SPI
MICROPROCESSOR
D0_D15 256 Ko x 16 bits
E P O T E N T I M E T E R S
OPTICAL AMPLIFIER BOARD D E T E C T O R
4 - 14
PRE AMPLI
AMPLI
CS2 CS7
ADC BUSY ADC RD ADC CONVST CDE MUX M U L T I P L E X E R
C O N V E R T O R
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Electric and electronic principles Optical acquisition
2.1.1. Analogical acquisition part ■ Detector:
photodiode system in a range of wavelength from 340 nm to 700 nm.
■ Pre
ampli: operational transimpedance amplificator used to perform the current-power conversion for each wavelength (15). According to the gain in the amplificator (68 millions on 340 nm wavelength) and the expected precision, only one resistance is placed in the anti-reaction loop. For each wavelength, the signal is filtered with a "low pass" at approximately 300 Hz.
■
Ampli: the gain is adjusted with a non-inverter assembly. An operational amplificator low noise, low drift (according to the temperature) and low offset power is used. This adjustment with potentiometers (E2pot) corrects doubt on luminosity and lamp ageing and doubt on photodiodes and passive components. It is performed for each wavelength and it is not modified during the measurement. The E2pot (50 kΩ) allows a gain between 1 and 6 with an adjustment of 0.2%. The signal is filtered with a "low pass" at approximately 1 KHz.
■ Multiplexer:
it combines the 15 wavelengths in one signal.
■ Subtractor
assembly: to use the full scale of the analogic/numeric convertor (- 2.5 V > + 2.5 V), 2.5 V are subtracted to the digitized signal. An ampli-op is assemblied in subtractor.
■ Convertor:
performs the analogic-numeric conversion.
2.1.2. Numerical acquisition part The intelligent part of this numerical acquisition is composed with a microprocessor and a SRAM. Application: ■A
"TOP_MEASURE" signal is generated at each beginning of a cuvette motion in front of the analysis window. It is provided by the microprocessor managing the reaction tray. This signal is wired on the microprocessor level 3 IT.
■
The microprocessor orders, by its I/O ports, the multiplexer to direct the signal of wavelength to measure to an analogic/numeric convertor.
■ The
microprocessor runs a conversion by the activation of the convertor "ADC_CONVST" pin wired in CS2.
■
When the conversion ends, the convertor picks up the "ADC_BUSY" signal and informs the microprocessor.
■ The
microprocessor receives data (16 bits) by activating the convertor "ADC_RD" pin wired in CS7.
■ At
the end of a 100 measurements batch on 2 different wavelengths, the microprocessor generates an "IT_SPI" signal for the master in order to receive measurement information via the SPI link between the mother board master microprocessor and the slave microprocessor of the optical processing board.
■
The amplification gain of each wavelength is adjusted by an E2POT. These E2POTs are commanded by the microprocessor via an internal SPI bus of the optical processing board.
Microprocessor: ■ Functioning
frequency = 25 MHz.
SRAM memory: ■ The
SRAM memory is constituted by a housing of 256 Ko x 16 bits. Its selection is performed by the "CSBOOT" signals of the microprocessor.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
4 - 15
Electric and electronic principles Optical acquisition
2.2.
Optical amplifier board XAA457BS (1209109457)
To J1 on Optical Processing Board
2.3.
Optical processing board XAA483CS (1209109483)
The optical processing board XAA483CS (1209109483) is meant to be used on both ABX Pentra 400 and Pentra C400. For the ABX Pentra 400, instruments must be equipped with the V5.0.6 software version or higher.
4 - 16
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Electric and electronic principles Optical acquisition
To J1 on Optical Amplifier board
To J1 on Mother board
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
4 - 17
Electric and electronic principles Level detection
3. Level detection 3.1.
Level detection synoptic
Mother board SAMPLE LEVEL DETECTION BOARD Shock detection switch µCTRL
SAMPLE ARM NEEDLE
CAPACITIVE DETECTION
36 Ω/16 W
HEATER SENSOR
3.2.
J40 5
PIC12C672 Start Scan 10 MHz VCC
REAGENT LEVEL DETECTION BOARD J5 24 V, VCC J4 Relay
J47 4
Heat Cmd Temp Sig
J1 VREF
REAGENT ARM NEEDLE
CAPACITIVE DETECTION
J1 VREF
J2
LVL Detect
J2 µCTRL
5
LVL Detect
J45
PIC12C672 Start Scan 10 MHz VCC
Sample level detection board XAA486AS (1209108486)
The sample level detection board, located on the sample arm, has two functions: ■ level ■
detection: detects the liquid level in different containers (sample tube, sample cup)
shock detection: detects possible collision between the sample arm and sample cup bottom or any other obstacle. To J40 on Mother Board
To Sample Needle
1
5
4 - 18
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Electric and electronic principles Level detection
Sample level detection functioning: The sample needle is connected in J1. It performs a capacitive link between ground and the J1 connection. The component U1 transforms the oscillation in a frequency around 47 kHz (pin 5 of U2). This frequency and its variation around the central frequency is analyzed by a microprocessor PIC U2. If a variance of frequency is detected (during level detection), the "LEVEL_DETECT" signal pin 6 is put to "1" and sent to the instrument mother board. If the detection is not performed and if the needle touches the sample cup bottom, the "shock detection" pin 2 of J2 sends a signal "1" to the instrument mother board.
R3 100k
R4 820k
VCC
VCC
VCC R1
C1
100k
100n
J1
8 2
v+
R2
GND
-
3+ 4 v-
R5 4k7
10MHz
GND
1 Level_detect Start_scan
U1 LM393
100k
GND
Y1 2 GP5/OSC1/CLKIN 3 GP4/OSC2/AN3/CLKOUT 4 GP3/MCLR/Vpp 5 GP2/TOCKI/AN2/INT 6 GP1/AN1/VREF 7 GP0/AN0 U2 PIC12C672
GND
Choc detect switch NO NC
SW1 VCC
GND
GND
1 2 3 J2 4 5 PH5
D 3.2mm FX2
FX3
FX1
GND
To check the detection functioning: ■ Use
a multimeter (Frequency measurement function) and plug it into U2 between chassis (ground) and pin 5: - The frequency must be about 47 KHz.
■ Disconnect
the sample needle (J1) and check the frequency again: - The frequency must be >100 KHz.
■ Reconnect
the sample needle.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
4 - 19
Electric and electronic principles Level detection
3.3.
Reagent level detection board
3.3.1. Reagent level detection board XAA500FS (1209109500) The reagent level detection board, located on the reagent arm, detects the liquid level in different reagent containers (cassette, reagent vial). It also switches off/on the reagent needle heater and the NTC. To Heating Needle
DS2
To J45 on Mother Board
TP1 (START_SCAN) TP2 (LEVEL_DETECT)
DS3
DS1
To J47 on Mother Board
Reagent level detection functioning: The reagent needle is connected in J1. It performs a capacitive link between ground and the connection J1. ■ The
instrument mother board sends the "START_SCAN" signal (5 V pulse, TP1) to the component U1. - The K1 and K2 relays cut the needle heating circuit (heater + NTC). - The component U1 sends a shield signal to the heating cable to override the cable noise and the capacitive effect of the heating cable.
■ The
component U1 sends a frequency of 12 MHz continuously to the needle.
■ The
needle sends a capacitive value to the component U1.
■ The component U1 transforms the capacitive value into a voltage. This voltage and its variation around
the threshold voltage are analyzed by the component U1. If a variance of voltage is detected, the component U1 sends the "LEVEL_DETECT" signal (5 V pulse, TP2) to the instrument mother board.
LEDs function: ■ The
LED DS1 is located between the relays K1 and K2. It gives the state of the relays K1 and K2: the LED is lit when the reagent needle heater and NTC are switched off.
■ The LED DS2 is located close to
the microcontroller U1. It gives the state of the reagent level detection board: the LED is lit permanently when the reagent level detection board detects a default.
■ The
LED DS3 is located under J6. It gives the following information: - the LED is lit when the reference value on air is acceptable, - the LED is unlit when the liquid is detected.
4 - 20
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
DS1
K1
K2
DS2
U1
TP1
TP2
DS3
Electric and electronic principles Level detection
4 - 21
Electric and electronic principles Level detection
3.3.2. Reagent level detection board XAA500DS (1209108500) The reagent level detection board, located on the reagent arm, detects the liquid level in different reagent containers (cassette, reagent vial). It also switches off/on the reagent needle heater and the NTC. Components side To Heating Needle
To J45 on Mother Board
R25 Q1
+C18 U1
D2 R20
K2
K1
J5
J4
J2
K
TP2
A LD2
C12
C14
D1
U2
J1 +C17 +C16
TP1
TP2 TP1
LD2 To J47 on Mother Board
Q4 R26 Q3
C28
R18 R19 R31
TP6 R22 C24 C20
R32
R21
C26
R28 R29
K
R17 LD1
R24 R23 R33 C21 R30
U3 C25
TP3
R27
TP5 TP4 U4
C22
D3 X1
Q2
Welding side
C19
LD1
Reagent level detection functioning: The reagent needle is connected in J1. It performs a capacitive link between ground and J1 connection. The component U2 (pin 17) sends a frequency of 240 kHz continuously to the needle. The component U3 (pin 9) receives the "START_SCAN" signal from the instrument mother board. During the level detection: - the K1 and K2 relays cut the needle heating circuit (heater + NTC). - the shield signal (VSSA), sent by the component U2, reaches the heating cable and thus the cable noise and the capacitive effect of the heating cable are overridden. The component U2 transforms the capacitive value into a voltage. This voltage and its variation around the threshold voltage are analyzed by the microcontroller U3. If a variance of voltage is detected (during level detection), the signal "LEVEL_DETECT" pin 5 is put to "1" and sent to the instrument mother board.
LEDs function:
4 - 22
■
The LED LD1 is located on the welding side close to the microcontroller U3. It gives the following information: - the reagent level detection state: it lits during 0.3 seconds when the liquid is detected. - the reagent level detection board state: if the reagent level detection board detects a default, the LED is lit permanently.
■
The LED LD2 is located on the components side between the relays K1 and K2. It gives the state of the relays K1 and K2: the LED is lit when the reagent needle heater and NTC are switched off.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
R17
2.2kohm
2
2K2-1%-0603
D 3.2mm
1
4 - 23
GND
FX2 FX3 FX1
2
1uF-16v-0603
1
HSMG-C670
C25 2 1
LD1
1
D3
1uF-16v-0603
C22 2 1
+3.3V
GND
C26 2 1
1uF-16v-0603
GND
1
1 2
2
U3
10K-1%-0603
10 kohm
R24
10 kohm
10K-1%-0603
R23
MC3494EG/R2 MC3494EG/R2 MC3494EG/R2
C17 + C16 +
2
BAS516
10 kohm
D2
R26
Q1 BC817
GND
2
1
GND
+5V
2
2 3 4
7 6 5
1 R20
8
HSMG-C670
LD2
100nF-16V-0603
2 1
10 kohm
10K-1%-0603
C19
1
K2
VSSA
VCC VSS P1.0/TACLK/ACLK/A0 XIN/P2.6/TA1 P1.1/TA0/A0/A1 XOUT/P2.7 TEST/SBWTCK P1.2/TA1/A2 P1.3/ADC10CLK/A3/VREF-/VEREFNMI/RST/SBWTDIO P1.4/SMCLK/A4/VREF+/VEREF+/TCK P1.7/A7/SDI/SDA/TDO/TDI P1.5/TA0/A5/SCLK/TMS P1.6/TA/A6/SDD/SCL/TDI/TCLK MSP430F2012IPW MSP430F2012IPW
R25
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
VSSA
22pF
47uF 6V3
GND
10K-1%-0603
2
J1
BAS516
+3.3V
NEEDLE
47uF 6V3
2 3 4
7 6 5
8
GND
R33
TP1
K1
2
1 X1
1
1
1
C12
1 2 HEATER 3 J5 4 NTC
EH4
100nF-50V-0603
GND
2
R22
GND
U4
TP3 TP5 TP4 TP6 TEST TP_SMD
TEST TP_SMD
TEST TP_SMD
TEST TP_SMD
EN
GND 3
4
IN2 6
IN1 5
10uF
TPS77301DGK TPS77301DGK
FB
RES
OUT2
OUT1
C14
10K-1%-0603
+3.3V
1
2
8
7
V+ 4
LM2767M5 LM2767M5
GND
3 CAP-
2
1 VOUT CAP+ 5
D1 2 U1
EH4 TO MAIN BOARD 1 +5V 2 3 J4 TEMP_FIG +24V 4 HEAT_CDE
2
+3.3V
1 C28
+5V
47 kohm
47K-1%-0603
R27
3.3 kohm
R28
2
2
3K3-1%-0603
6.8kohm
+3.3V
GND
6K8-1%-0603
R29
1uF-16V-0603
C24 2 1
10uF
GND
GND
TESTPOINT S1751-46
CM415-32.768KHz
TESTPOINT S1751-46
1
GND
14 13 12 11 10 9 8
2
1 C21
TP2
R30
GND
1 20 kohm
2 1
1 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 20K-1%-0603
2
22pF-50V-0603
DGND SHIELDEN C B A LEVEL LPCAP ROSC VDDCAP VPWR VCCCAP 100R-1%-0603
U2
1nF-16V-0603
2 100 ohm
1
22pF 50V
2
1 10 kohm
2
E7 E6 E5 E4 E3 E2 E1 TEST GND SHIELD AGND
2K2-1%-0603
C18
2
GND
Q4 BC817
R18
100nF-16V-0603
1 C20
47uF 6V3
GND
GND
Q2 BC817
GND
+
1 2.2kohm
22pF-50V-0603 C29
23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13
1
2.2kohm
2
2
R21
GND
R19
R32 GND 4K7-1%-0603 1 4.7kohm 2
GND
4.7kohm
4K7-1%-0603
R31
Q3 BC817
1 2K2-1%-0603 2K2-1%-0603
2 1
2.2kohm
2
1 2.2kohm
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN 2
BAS516
GND
+5V
PH5 TO MAIN BOARD 1 +5V 2 NC 3 J2 START SCAN 4 LEVEL DETECT 5 GND
Electric and electronic principles Level detection
2K2-1%-0603
Electric and electronic principles Level detection
Voltage measurements on the reagent level detection board To check the needle excitation frequency: ■ Disconnect
the reagent needle (J1). [The position of the reagent arm and needle is unimportant.]
■ Use
a multimeter (frequency measurement function) and plug it in between J1 and ground (TP2): - put the multimeter in frequency position and check the frequency: it must be about 240 KHz (±10%). - put the multimeter in alternating voltage position and check the voltage: it must be about 100 mV (±10%).
To check the detection functioning (voltage at U2 output and U3 input): ■ Disconnect
the reagent needle (J1). [The position of the reagent arm and needle is unimportant.]
■ Use
a multimeter (direct voltage position) and plug it in between TP1 and TP2. - The voltage must be about 2.8 V (±10%).
■ Reconnect
the reagent needle (J1) and check the voltage again [The position of the reagent arm and needle is unimportant.]: - The voltage must be about 0 V (< 0.5 V).
■ Disconnect
the heating needle connector (J5).
On air: ■ Place
the reagent arm in "Wash tower position" (above the wash tower).
■ Plug
a multimeter in between TP1 and TP2 then check the voltage: - The voltage must be about 1.9 V (±10%).
On water: ■ Place
the reagent arm in "Low Position in Wash" (in the reagent wash tower).
■ Plug
a multimeter in between TP1 and TP2 then check the voltage: - The voltage must be about 1.7 V (±10%).
■
4 - 24
Make sure that the difference between the measurement on air and the measurement on water is higher than 0.1 V.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Electric and electronic principles Sample relay board XAA491CS (1209109491)
4. Sample relay board XAA491CS (1209109491) The sample relay board is located on the sample tray.
To Tube Detector
To Sample Barcode
To J36 on Mother Board
The sample relay board supplies and transmits information from tube detector (J3), barcode reader (J5), tube height (not connected J4) and cover LED supply (J2) sensors. Reflexion sensor Supply and
J3 info transmission Tube presence
J4 Supply and
info transmission Tube height detection Supply and info transmission
J1 sensors to instrument mother board
LED J2
Supply Cover LED
Supply and
J5 info transmission Barcode reader 51123
Barcode reader SAMPLE RELAY BOARD
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
4 - 25
Electric and electronic principles Sample relay board XAA491CS (1209109491)
FACTORY CONFIGURATION:
4 - 26
Jumper E1 E1 (Default)
Pin 2 J3 = 0 Pin 2 J3 = 1
Jumper setting Short 1 - 2 Open
Jumper E2 (Default) E2
Pin 2 J4 = 0 Pin 2 J4 = 1
Jumper setting Short 1 - 2 Open
WL 160
WL 150
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Electric and electronic principles Pressure board (kit ref. 1300015280)
5. Pressure board (kit ref. 1300015280) The pressure board is located behind the syringe block. To Sample pressure sensor
TP6 (ground)
To Reagent pressure sensor
To J67 on Mother Board
TP3
R16 3.8 V
The pressure board detects fibrin presence or blockage on the sample needle and blockage on the reagent needle. After a gain and an offset calibration, the board, according to the pressure on the sensor, digitizes the analogic signal and sends the digitized information to the instrument mother board.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
4 - 27
Electric and electronic principles Pressure board (kit ref. 1300015280)
Amplification and gain adjustment Pressure sensor Sample needle To ADC µP AN1
P
J1
Offset adjustment with EEPOT Microprocessor 16F873
Amplification and gain adjustment
SPI link to mother board
J3
Pressure sensor Reagent needle To ADC µP AN0
P
J2
Offset adjustment with EEPOT
Pressure board
4 - 28
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Electric and electronic principles Internal computer 1300013734
6. Internal computer 1300013734
MOTHER BOARD
To servo-controls
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
4 - 29
Electric and electronic principles Power supply
7. Power supply
Two power supply references are available depending on the instrument you have: ■ DBN007E (1202165007) for ABX Pentra 400 with an instrument serial number below 4000 and Pentra C400 with an instrument serial number below 112 ■ DBN007F (1202166007) for ABX Pentra 400 since instrument serial number 4000 and Pentra C400 since instrument serial number 112 The instrument power supply is an AC/DC converter, extensive range input, 8 outputs with power of 450 W maximum. It provides electrical requirements to the entire instrument except for the cooling unit (independently connected to the receptacle). All cables are provided with power supply except the TTL flat cable. MOTHER BOARD J53 + 24 V
POWER SUPPLY FAN
VCC +5V
10
-5V
J1
2
TB1
+ 5 V, + 12 V, GND
GND
+ 24 V
V2
DAC011A (OR DAC012A)
V5-V6: 5/- 5 V 0.5 A V7: 0/5.1/5.6 V 6.6 A V8: 12 V 1.5 A
N=2
DZZ039A
Heat Room_Cde
FUSES
V4: 0/5 V 7.2 A
J54
PC_On/Off
FILTER
ON/OFF
V3: 5 V 2 A 24
MAIN SUPPLY 50-60 Hz 100-240 Vac 450 VA
TB4
V1
J2 CONTROLE
10 DAD091B
Lamp_On/Off Lamp_Stand by Power Sup_Status
To servo-controls
This table lists the differences between both power supply references. Mark on diagram V1 V2 FUSES
7.1.
DBN007F 24 V 6.25 A 0/24 V 6.25 A T 6.3 A H 250 V
Protection ■ Input: ■ Input
inrush current limitation (≤ 30 A)
fuses: T 6.3 A H 250 V
■ Outputs:
4 - 30
DBN007E 24 V 7 A 0/24 V 6.3 A F 6.3 A 250 V
electronic protection against short circuits
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Electric and electronic principles Power supply
7.2.
Inputs/Outputs connectors
7.2.1. Power outputs Outputs are done via two connectors embedded on the power supply board: ■a
connector with 2 points for the ISE module (CN2)
■a
connector with 24 points for other resources (CN3)
24-point connector (CN3) Output Pin out Function V11 V2
7 and 19 Analyzer 6 and 18 Reaction tray heater Numerical: 3 - analyzer 1 and 13 Computer Analogical: - optical acquisition module 16 - level detection - fibrin detection Analogical: - optical acquisition module 15 - level detection - fibrin detection
V3 V4 V5
V6
V72
2 and 14 Optical bench lamp
V8
4 Backlight LCD 5 - Sense V7 17 + Sense V7 8, 9, 10, 11, 12, 20, 21, 22, 23 and 24
Vnominal
Tolerance Imini Inom
+ 24 V
± 6%
M35 P33 - - - -> C33 P44 - - - -> M44 P52 - - - -> V52
J46
P46 - - - -> B46
J50
P50 - - - -> V50 a...h
J43
P43 - - - -> CTN
J66 J16 J14 J57
P66 - - - -> V66 P16 - - - -> M16 P14 - - - -> CH14 P57 - - - -> M57
J39
P39 - - - -> C39
J27 J25 J21 J60
P27 - - - -> E27 P25 - - - -> M25 P21 - - - -> C21 P60 - - - -> M60
J41
P41 - - - -> C41
J51 J29 J49
P51 - - - -> V51 P29 - - - -> C29 P49 - - - -> SW1
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Mixer assy motor DAL029A (1201961029) XY mixer motor home sensor XBA518A (1209111518) Mixing paddle motor assy XBA561D (1209114561) Reaction tray fan XBA533B (1209112533) Reaction tray temperature sensor XBA535BS (1209119535) Reagent tray fans XBA587B (1209111587) Reagent tray temperature sensor XBA535BS (1209119535) Reagent tray fan XBA587B (1209111587) Reagent tray motor XDA820D (1209134820) Reagent tray home sensor XEC186AS (1209179186) Reagent arm rotation motor Reagent arm rotation home sensor XBA518A (1209111518) Optical encoder Sample tray motor XDA871B (1209132871) Sample tray home sensor XBA518A (1209111518) Sample arm rotation motor Sample arm rotation home sensor XBA518A (1209111518) Not used Reagent tray door sensor XBA573A (1209111573) Cover solenoid
4 - 45
4 - 46
CCA071A HRP-4 (JST) Terminals SHR-001T-P0.6 CCA073A
CCA070A HRP-2 (JST) Terminals SHR-001T-P0.6 CCA073A
CCA018A PHR-4 (JST) Terminals AWG 30-24 SPH-002T-P0.5s CCA020A
CCA017A PHR-3 (JST) Terminals AWG 30-24 SPH-002T-P0.5s CCA020A
CCA046A PHR-2 (JST) Terminals AWG 30-24 SPH-002T-P0.5s CCA020A
C21-C29-C33-M35 P35-C39-C41-P57 P60-CH14
M44-B46-V50a-V50b-V50c V50d-V50e-V50f-V50g-V50h V51-V64-V66-V66
P14-P21-P27-P29 P33-P39-P41
P50-P51-P52-P66
P43-P44-P46-P49
CAK029A 5102-8 terminals 5103 CAK008A
CCA060A 6471-5 terminals 4161 CAK061A
CCA072A HRP-8 (JST) terminals SHR-001T-P0.6 CCA073A
CCA044A EHR-6 (JST) Terminals SEH-001T-P0.6 CCA045A
P16-P25
E27
M16-M25
M57-M60
Electric and electronic principles Connectors
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
8.12. XBA513C (1209113513): CABLE, RIGHT CABLE ASSY P400 V1
4-47
8.13. XBA513E (1209115513): CABLE, RIGHT CABLE ASSY
4-48
Electric and electronic principles Connectors
8.14.
XBA514B (1209112514): CABLE, ELECTRO-VALVES
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
4 - 49
Electric and electronic principles Connectors
8.15.
XBA517D (1209114517): CABLE, DET. BOARD CABLE P400
If the arm cable needs to be replaced on an ABX Pentra 400 V1, please order the KIT, STRAND TRANSF.ARM & GUIDES XEC166AS (1209179166). Once you have installed the kit ref. XEC166AS (1209179166) on your instrument, it is not necessary anymore to order the whole kit to replace the arm cable. Please directly order the arm cable ref. XBA517D (1209114517).
4 - 50
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Electric and electronic principles Connectors
8.16.
XBA518A (1209111518): SENSOR, LB TRAY/ARM/MIX/ HANDLER
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
4 - 51
Electric and electronic principles Connectors
8.17.
4 - 52
XBA519A (1209111519): SENSOR, LB+MOT.CABLE ARM/ HANDL.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Electric and electronic principles Connectors
8.18.
XBA520A (1209111520): CABLE, ARMS/HANDLER CABLE
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
4 - 53
Electric and electronic principles Connectors
8.19.
4 - 54
XBA531B (1209112531): PCB, SAMPLE TRAY TUBE DETECTOR
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Electric and electronic principles Connectors
8.20.
XBA532DS (1209119532): SENSOR, RACK LOAD/UNLOAD
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
4 - 55
Electric and electronic principles Connectors
8.21.
4 - 56
XBA533B (1209112533): FAN, REACTION TRAY FAN
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Electric and electronic principles Connectors
8.22.
XBA534C (1209113534): HEATER, REACTION TRAY
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
4 - 57
Electric and electronic principles Connectors
8.23.
4 - 58
XBA535BS (1209119535): SENSOR, REAGENT & REACTION TEMP.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Electric and electronic principles Connectors
8.24.
XBA536A (1209111536): SENSOR, REACT.TRAY HOME SENSOR
When the reaction tray is in home position: ■ the voltage between Pin 1 and 3 should be 5 V ■ the voltage between Pin 2 and 4 should be 1.27 V
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
4 - 59
Electric and electronic principles Connectors
8.25.
4 - 60
XBA543A (3012277056): CABLE, PREAMP.TO MAIN BOARD ISE
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Electric and electronic principles Connectors
8.26.
XBA544C (1209113544): VALVE, ISE VALVE ASSY
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
4 - 61
Electric and electronic principles Connectors
8.27.
4 - 62
XBA545B (1209112545): CABLE, ISE SYR. LB CABLE
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Electric and electronic principles Connectors
8.28.
XBA551A (1209111551): PCB, SAMPLE TRAY LED
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
4 - 63
Electric and electronic principles Connectors
8.29.
4 - 64
XBA561D (1209114561): MIXER, MIXING PADDLE MOTOR ASSY
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Electric and electronic principles Connectors
8.30.
XBA563ET (1209119563): NEEDLE, SAMPLE P400 W FERRITE
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
4 - 65
Electric and electronic principles Connectors
8.31.
4 - 66
XBA564DT (1209119564): NEEDLE, REAGENT NEEDLE
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Electric and electronic principles Connectors
8.32.
XBA571A (1209111571): CABLE, LEVEL DETECT TANKS
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
4 - 67
Electric and electronic principles Connectors
8.33.
4 - 68
XBA572A (1209111572): SENSOR, ROOM TEMP.SENSOR
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Electric and electronic principles Connectors
8.34.
XBA573A (1209111573): SENSOR, REAG.TRAY DOOR SENSOR
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
4 - 69
Electric and electronic principles Connectors
8.35.
4 - 70
XBA587B (1209111587): FAN, REAGENT TRAY FAN L=400
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Electric and electronic principles Connectors
8.36.
XBA588A (1209111588): CABLE, NEEDLE PRESS.CABLE
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
4 - 71
Electric and electronic principles Connectors
8.37.
4 - 72
XBA601BS (1209119601): PCB, PC WAKE UP BUTTON
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Electric and electronic principles Connectors
8.38.
XBA732AS (1209119732): CABLE, WASTE PUMP ADAPTOR/V1
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
4 - 73
Electric and electronic principles Connectors
8.39.
XBA734AS (1209119734): CABLE, ADAP NEW RACK SENSOR /V1
8.40.
XBA756AS (1209119756): CABLE, ADAP OLD RACK SENSOR
4 - 74
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Electric and electronic principles Connectors
8.41.
XBA814A (1209111814): CABLE, INNER ARM CABLE
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
4 - 75
Electric and electronic principles Connectors
8.42.
4 - 76
XBA815A (1209111815): CABLE, REAG MOTOR ADAPTOR CABLE
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Electric and electronic principles Connectors
8.43.
XBA847AT (1209119847): NEEDLE, SAMPLE PC400
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
4 - 77
Electric and electronic principles Connectors
8.44.
4 - 78
XDA820D (1209134820): MOTOR, REAGENT TRAY MOTOR
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Electric and electronic principles Connectors
8.45.
XDA871B (1209132871): MOTOR, SAMPLE TRAY MOTOR ASSY
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
4 - 79
Electric and electronic principles Connectors
8.46.
4 - 80
XEC186AS (1209179186): SENSOR, REAG. TRAY HOME SENSOR
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Electric and electronic principles Connectors
8.47.
XEC202AS (1209179202): PUMP, WATER ASSY + METAL SHEET
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
4 - 81
Electric and electronic principles Instrument synoptic
9. Instrument synoptic See synoptic diagrams at the end of this section.
4 - 82
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Section 5: Software description
1. Services menu overview............................................................................... 5 - 2 2. Software architecture................................................................................... 5 - 3 2.1. C:\ drive ..................................................................................................................................... 5 - 3 2.2. D:\ drive ..................................................................................................................................... 5 - 5
3. Diagnostics menu description ..................................................................... 5 - 7 3.1. System Parameters ................................................................................................................... 5 - 8 3.2. Tray .......................................................................................................................................... 5 - 10 3.3. Arms......................................................................................................................................... 5 - 12 3.4. Syringe ..................................................................................................................................... 5 - 16 3.5. Cuvette Changer...................................................................................................................... 5 - 17 3.6. Barcode Test ........................................................................................................................... 5 - 19 3.7. Spectro .................................................................................................................................... 5 - 19 3.8. Heating..................................................................................................................................... 5 - 20 3.9. Sensors .................................................................................................................................... 5 - 20 3.10. Pressure................................................................................................................................. 5 - 21 3.11. ISE.......................................................................................................................................... 5 - 21 3.12. Repeatability .......................................................................................................................... 5 - 22
4. Initialization phases .................................................................................... 5 - 25
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
5-1
Software description Services menu overview
1. Services menu overview Main menu
Worklist menu*
Calibration/Control menu*
Result Validation menu*
Services menu*
Archives menu*
Quality control menu*
Services menu Logs menu* Calibration Applications Reagent Sequencing Error Maintenance System configuration
Application Configuration menu* Applications Ratio Profiles Incompatibility Reagents (only for Sales and Manufacturer)
Customer Services menu* Cycles ISE Analyser Barcode Test Counter (available on request)
System Configuration menu* Analyser Audible alarm Local Settings Maintenance Host Connection Users Printer Channel configuration (only for Sales) Results validation
Diagnostics menu** System Parameters Spectro Tray Heating Arms Sensors Syringe Pressure Cuvette Changer ISE Repeatability Barcode Test
* Please refer to your user manual for more detailed information. ** See 3. Diagnostics menu description, page 5-7 for more detailed information.
5-2
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Software description Software architecture
2. Software architecture The instrument hard drive contains two partitions: the C:\ drive and the D:\ drive.
2.1.
C:\ drive
Windows and the instrument software are installed on the C:\ drive. During the software version installation, the instrument software is installed on C:\Program Files\P400 Software.
The following table describes the most important files of the P400 Software folder. Folder
File
Exe
ComProcess.exe
Exe
ComSil.exe
Exe
Manitou.exe
Exe
Asp400.ini
Exe
Ihm.exe
Purpose Management of communication between the computer software and the embedded software. Launched during instrument start up. Management of communication with the Host. Launched during instrument start up. Main process. Launched during instrument start up. Main parameters. Launched during instrument start up. Management of user interface. Launched during instrument start up.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
5-3
Software description Software architecture
Folder Exe Exe Exe Exe Exe Exe Exe Exe Exe Exe Exe Exe Exe Exe data data
File
Purpose Available language dictionary. Pentra400.mld Launched during instrument start up. Management of printout. Printer.exe Launched during instrument start up. Sil.ini Configuration of communication with the Host (speed, parity, ...). GridParams.ini Column configuration (column order and size). Embedded software update. BinLoader.exe Only used during the software version update. Database update. MajP400.exe Only used during the software version update. traceCom.log Host communication log file. Error.log Process log file. Spectrophotometer initialization log file (light stability check, black Spectro.log intensity measurement, ...). Log file of cuvette absorbance measurements, cuvette cleanness ReacTray.log check, loading/unloading of cuvette segments. Barcode readings log file (racks and tubes). Barcod.log Only for the sample tray. ISEState.log ISE module status log file (not initialized, sleeping, ...). ActionUtilisateur.log User action log file. Patient data pass through this folder during the communication with Rs_Data the Host. Asp400bd.mdb Database. HORIBA Medical applications database. methodes.mdb User channels are saved in the database. Updated during the Reagent applications installation.
The following folders are also present in the P400 Software folder.
5-4
- Help
Help files (user manual and reagent notices/MSDS).
- Images
Software pictures.
- Son
Sound files of the sound alarms.
- Tasks
Empty folder.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Software description Software architecture
2.2.
D:\ drive
During the software version installation, the Backup folder is created on the D:\ drive.
The following table describes the files of the Backup folder. Folder -
-
-
-
User
File
Purpose Results archive file. Archive_N°.mdb Created at the instrument start up every six months or when at least 100000 results are saved in the database. Database backup copy. Backup_N°_Version_ Saved at each creation of a new worklist. Asp400bd.mdb Up to eight databases are saved and numbered from the most recent to the oldest. Beyond this number, the oldest is suppressed. Backup copy of the instrument parameters (motor adjustments, ...). When you close the Diagnostics menu, the instrument will ask you: Backup_Date_Time_ "Do you want to save parameters?" If you press OK, the backup copy ParamOS9_Version.bin is created (not necessary if you did not modify the instrument parameters). Last backup copy of the instrument parameters (motor adjustments, ParamOS9.bin ...). Backup_Date_Time_ Database backup copy. Asp400bd.mdb Saved at each software version update. Backup copy of the client parameters (database, system configuration, column configuration, ...). Created using the Save client parameters function from the System Date_Time_Serial # Configuration menu (Services > System Configuration > Local Settings).
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
5-5
Software description Software architecture
Folder Restore
File
Purpose Empty folder. Temporary folder necessary for using the Restore database and Restore client parameters functions from the System Configuration menu (Services > System Configuration > Local Settings).
You can also find a Bugs folder on the D:\ drive. This folder contains backup copies of the database and the Error.log file, created when a "GeneralException" error appears. When the Bugs folder contains a lot of files, software slowness can appear. It is therefore advisable to suppress these files.
5-6
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Software description Diagnostics menu description
3. Diagnostics menu description Go to Services > Diagnostics.
The Diagnostics menu is divided into 12 tabs: ■ 3.1.
System Parameters, page 5-8
■ 3.2.
Tray, page 5-10
■ 3.3.
Arms, page 5-12
■ 3.4.
Syringe, page 5-16
■ 3.5.
Cuvette Changer, page 5-17
■ 3.6.
Barcode Test, page 5-19
■ 3.7.
Spectro, page 5-19
■ 3.8.
Heating, page 5-20
■ 3.9.
Sensors, page 5-20
■ 3.10.
Pressure, page 5-21
■ 3.11.
ISE, page 5-21
■ 3.12.
Repeatability, page 5-22.
Press one of the tabs to access the various functions.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
5-7
Software description Diagnostics menu description
■ Closing
the Diagnostics menu, the instrument turns to "Emergency Stop" status. Then, you have to press Startup to reinitialize the instrument. ■ When you run a cycle from the Diagnostics menu, you must always wait for the end of the cycle before running another cycle or pressing a new tab. Recommendations for use: adjust a position by changing the number of steps for this position: - enter the number of steps in the Target field and press Check Position OR - use the + and - buttons. ■ To validate and save the new adjustment value for this position, press Check Home then check the position again (press Check Position). ■ To
3.1.
System Parameters
The System Parameters tab summarizes the instrument parameters (motor adjustments, ...) modifiable by the technician. This tab allows you to print, modify, save and restore these instrument parameters. Moreover, this first tab gives access to the Windows Explorer.
3.1.1. Instrument parameters The following instrument parameters are displayed: ■ Motor
adjustments modifiable by the technician
■ Calibration ■ NTC
factors A and B of the sample and reagent pressure sensors
value for the reaction tray chamber.
Use the slider to display all data.
Print the instrument parameters
Press Data Print/Send to Host from the generic toolbar to print the list of instrument parameters displayed in the System Parameters tab.
Modify the instrument parameters The System Parameters tab opens in Display mode. In this mode, the instrument parameters are not modifiable. Press Edit to access modification function. After modification of one or several parameters, press OK to validate. ■ Only
the motor adjustments are modifiable from the System Parameters tab. calibration factors A and B of the sample and reagent pressure sensors and the NTC value for the reaction tray chamber are not modifiable from this tab; they are respectively modifiable from the Pressure and Heating tabs.
■ The
5-8
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Software description Diagnostics menu description
Save the instrument parameters
Press Export to save the instrument parameters.
■ The
following window is displayed:
The instrument parameters are saved: - on hard disk, by default - on USB flash drive, if selected. Press OK. ■ When
the message "Export successfully completed" is displayed, press OK.
Restore the instrument parameters
Press Import to restore a backup copy of the instrument parameters.
The backup copies of the instrument parameters are created when you close the Diagnostics menu and answer OK at the question: "Do you want to save parameters?" (not necessary if you did not modify the instrument parameters).
■ The
following window is displayed:
The last backup copy of the instrument parameters (D:\Backup\ParamOS9.bin) is submitted by default. If necessary, press Restore File to choose another backup copy of the instrument parameters. Then, press OK. ■ When
the message "Restore successful" is displayed, press OK.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
5-9
Software description Diagnostics menu description
3.1.2. Windows Explorer
■ Press
the Windows Explorer button to open the Windows Explorer. Diagnostics menu.
■ The Windows Explorer is automatically closed when you close the
3.2.
Tray
The Tray tab groups the functions concerning the three trays of the instrument: - Reagent tray - Sample tray - Reaction tray.
For each tray (reagent, sample and reaction), the following functions are available: Heading
Home
Offset
Sector/Position
5 - 10
Format
Description If the tray is at its home position, the light is green. - Reagent tray: sector 36 in front of the yellow arrow. Colored - Reaction tray: sector 1, cuvette segment position 1 in front of the square light beam. If not, the light is red. The light is gray when the tray position is unknown. Offset value (in number of steps). Field See Ranges of adjustment values for the tray positions, page 5-11. - Reagent tray: Tray sector (1 to 52) + Rack type. - Sample tray: Tray sector (1 to 6) / Rack position (1 to 10). Scrolling lists - Reaction tray: Tray sector (1 to 6) / Cuvette segment position (1 to 12).
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Software description Diagnostics menu description
Heading Reagent Position Target Target Check Home Check Position
+/Motor Off
Format
Description Only for the reagent tray. Scrolling lists Reagent rack or calibrator/control reagent rack position. Scrolling list List of the tray positions. Adjustment value (in number of steps) for the selected position. Field See Ranges of adjustment values for the tray positions, page 5-11. Button Moves the selected tray to its home position. Moves the selected tray to the position chosen in the Target Button scrolling list. Increase/Decrease the adjustment value for the position chosen in the Target scrolling list. Buttons - If you click once, the selected tray moves 1/4 of a step. - If you hold the button down, the selected tray moves step by step. Button The selected tray motor is turned off.
Other functionalities: ■
The CAB auto reader adjustment function is used to automatically adjust the reagent tray for the Reagent Bar Code Reader Position position. To use this function, please refer to the Reagent tray procedure. See RAS380: Reagent tray, page 1.
■ The
Segment function is used to load/unload cuvette segments into the reaction tray: - automatically using the Load and Unload buttons - manually using the Forward button.
Ranges of adjustment values for the tray positions Reagent tray Position Offset (not modifiable) Reagent Bar Code Reader Position Central Loading Reagent Position R1 Pos.- Reagent Rack for Sample Arm R2 Pos.- Reagent Rack for Sample Arm R3 Pos.- Reagent Rack for Sample Arm R1 Pos.- Cal/Ctrl Rack for Sample Arm R2 Pos.- Cal/Ctrl Rack for Sample Arm R3 Pos.- Cal/Ctrl Rack for Sample Arm R1 Pos.- Cassette for Sample Arm R2 Pos.- Cassette for Sample Arm R1 Pos.- Reagent Rack for Reagent Arm R2 Pos.- Reagent Rack for Reagent Arm R3 Pos.- Reagent Rack for Reagent Arm R1 Pos.- Cassette for Reagent Arm R2 Pos.- Cassette for Reagent Arm
Default value 160 11711 25870 35360 35358 35436 35492 35469 35520 35496 35576 36336 36778 37479 36361 37824
Min. value 160 10000 23200 33000 33000 33000 33000 33000 33000 33000 33000 34000 34000 35000 34000 35000
Max. value 160 14000 26500 38000 38000 38000 38000 38000 38000 38000 38000 39000 39000 40000 39000 41000
Default value 80 316 3859 18568 40
Min. value 80 0 3400 18100 0
Max. value 80 5000 4400 19000 19200
Sample tray Position Offset (not modifiable) Sample Bar code reader Position Sample Tube Detector Position External Sampling Pos. Internal Sampling Pos.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
5 - 11
Software description Diagnostics menu description
Reaction tray Position Offset Mixing Position Reagent Arm Position Sample Arm Position (not modifiable) Automatic Loading Handling Position
3.3.
Default value 150 4755 948 0 8900 19002
Min. value 50 4000 500 0 8500 18500
Max. value 200 5000 1300 0 9300 19900
Arms
The Arms tab groups the functions concerning the reagent and sample arms as the mixer.
5 - 12
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Software description Diagnostics menu description
3.3.1. Reagent and sample arms functions For the reagent and sample arms, the following functions are available: Heading
VERTICAL
Home
Offset Position Position Automatic adjustment
ROTATION
Home
Offset Position Position Level detection
Shock Detection Check Home Check Position
+/Motor Off
Format
Description If the arm is at its vertical home position (upper position), the light is Colored green. square If not, the light is red. The light is gray when the arm vertical position is unknown. Offset value (in number of steps). Field See Range of adjustment values for the arm positions, page 5-13. Scrolling list List of the arm vertical positions. Adjustment value (in number of steps) for the selected position. Field See Range of adjustment values for the arm positions, page 5-13. This function is used to automatically adjust the arm vertical Function positions. To use this function, please refer to the Arms procedure. See RAS385: Arms, page 1. If the arm is at its rotation home position (cuvette position), the light Colored is green. square If not, the light is red. The light is gray when the arm rotation position is unknown. Offset value (in number of steps). Field See Range of adjustment values for the arm positions, page 5-13. Scrolling list List of the arm rotation positions. Adjustment value (in number of steps) for the selected position. Field See Range of adjustment values for the arm positions, page 5-13. This function is used to check the level detection. To use this Colored function, please refer to the Arms procedure. See RAS385: Arms, square page 1. Only for the sample arm. Colored This function is used to check the shock detection. To use this square function, please refer to the Arms procedure. See RAS385: Arms, page 1. Button Moves the selected arm to its vertical/rotation home position. Moves the selected arm to the position chosen in the Position Button scrolling list. Increase/Decrease the adjustment value for the position chosen in the Position scrolling list. Buttons - If you click once, the selected arm moves 1/4 of a step. - If you hold the button down, the selected arm moves step by step. Button The selected arm motor is turned off.
Range of adjustment values for the arm positions Reagent arm - Vertical Position Offset (not modifiable) Low Position in Reaction Tray Low Position in Wash Tower Low Position in Reagent/Cal/Ctrl Rack Low Position in Cassette
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Default value 128 12070 12600 13383 14399
Min. value 128 11300 12000 11000 13500
Max. value 128 12700 12800 14800 14800
5 - 13
Software description Diagnostics menu description
Reagent arm - Rotation Position Offset (not modifiable) Cuvette Position (not modifiable) Wash Tower Position R1 Pos. - Reagent Rack R2 Pos. - Reagent Rack R3 Pos. - Reagent Rack R1 on Cassette R2 on Cassette
Default value 165 0 1270 2211 2600 2982 2068 3084
Min. value 165 0 500 1500 2000 2400 1500 2500
Max. value 165 0 2000 2700 3100 3500 2600 3600
Default value 128 15386 8300 6936 13912 16642 17608 4000 15010
Min. value 128 14500 8000 5500 13000 14700 16500 3000 14500
Max. value 128 15800 8700 7700 15000 17400 18000 6000 16000
Default value 150 0 521 1487 1711 1888 1425 1612 1825 1397 1927 2450 2708 4383
Min. value 150 0 200 1200 1500 1700 1200 1400 1600 1200 1700 2200 2500 4000
Max. value 150 0 800 1700 1900 2100 1600 1800 2000 1600 2100 2600 2900 4500
Sample arm - Vertical Position Offset (not modifiable) Low Position in Cuvette Low Position in Wash Tower Low Position in Sample Cup Low Position in Sample Tube Low Position in Reagent rack Low Position in Cassette Low Position in ISE Tower Low position CalCs on reagent tray Sample arm - Rotation Position Offset (not modifiable) Cuvette Position (not modifiable) Wash Tower Position R1 Pos. - Reagent Rack R2 Pos. - Reagent Rack R3 Pos. - Reagent Rack R1 Pos.- Cal/Ctrl Rack R2 Pos.- Cal/Ctrl Rack R3 Pos.- Cal/Ctrl Rack R1 on Cassette R2 on Cassette External Sample Internal Sample ISE Sample
5 - 14
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Software description Diagnostics menu description
3.3.2. Mixer functions For the mixer, the following functions are available: Heading Home
Offset Position Position Automatic adjustment Check Home Check Position +/Motor Off
Format
Description If the mixer is at its home position (wash tower position), the light is Colored green. square If not, the light is red. The light is gray when the mixer position is unknown. Offset value (in number of steps). Field See Range of adjustment values for the mixer positions, page 5-15. Scrolling list List of the mixer positions. Adjustment value (in number of steps) for the selected position. Field See Range of adjustment values for the mixer positions, page 5-15. This function is used to automatically adjust the mixer vertical Function positions. To use this function, please refer to the Mixer procedure. See RAS386: Mixer, page 1. Button Moves the mixer to its home position. Button Moves the mixer to the position chosen in the Position scrolling list. Increase/Decrease the adjustment value for the position chosen in the Position scrolling list. Buttons - If you click once, the selected arm moves 1/4 of a step. - If you hold the button down, the selected arm moves step by step. Button The mixer motor is turned off.
Range of adjustment values for the mixer positions Position Offset Above Reaction Tray Cuvette
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Default value 400 9656 13728
Min. value 400 8900 13200
Max. value 500 10200 14300
5 - 15
Software description Diagnostics menu description
3.4.
Syringe
The Syringe tab groups the functions concerning the instrument hydraulic circuit: reagent and sample syringes, waste and water pumps, valves.
For each syringe (reagent and sample), the following functions are available: Heading
Format
Home
Colored square
Offset
Field
Check Home
Button
Description If the syringe is at its home position (upper position), the light is green. If not, the light is red. The light is gray when the syringe position is unknown. Offset value (in number of steps). Not modifiable. Moves the selected syringe to its home position.
The waste and water pumps can be turned on and off by using the corresponding buttons. Moreover, the Water pump output function is used to check the water pump output. To use this function, please refer to the 6 month maintenance procedure. See RAS378: 6 month maintenance, 10. To check the sample needle throughput, page 8. The valves can be opened and closed using the corresponding buttons. Valve V0 V1 V2 V3 V4 V5 V6
5 - 16
Description Not used. Sample syringe valve. Reagent syringe valve. Mixer wash tower valve. Reagent wash tower valve. Sample wash tower valve. Not used.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Software description Diagnostics menu description
3.5.
Cuvette Changer
The Cuvette Changer tab groups the functions concerning the cuvette changer.
For each cuvette changer motor (vertical motor, horizontal motor, cuvette motion motor), the following functions are available: Heading
VERTICAL
Home
Offset Target Target
HORIZONTAL
Home
Offset Target Target
Format
Description If the grabber is at its vertical home position (upper position), the light is green. If not, the light is red. Colored NOTE: The grabber never stays at its vertical home position, so the square light always stays red. The light is gray if the grabber vertical position is unknown. Offset value (in number of steps). Field See Range of adjustment values for the cuvette changer motor positions, page 5-18. Scrolling list List of the grabber vertical positions. Adjustment value (in number of steps) for the selected position. Field See Range of adjustment values for the cuvette changer motor positions, page 5-18. If the grabber is at its horizontal home position (backward position), Colored the light is green. square If not, the light is red. The light is gray if the grabber horizontal position is unknown. Offset value (in number of steps). Field See Range of adjustment values for the cuvette changer motor positions, page 5-18. Scrolling list List of the grabber horizontal positions. Adjustment value (in number of steps) for the selected position. Field See Range of adjustment values for the cuvette changer motor positions, page 5-18.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
5 - 17
CUVETTE MOTION
Software description Diagnostics menu description
Heading
Format
Home
Colored square
Offset
Field
Check Home
Button
Check Position
Button
+/-
Buttons
Motor Off
Button
Description If the load rack rail is at its home position (lower position), the light is green. If not, the light is red. The light is gray if the load rack rail position is unknown. Offset value (in number of steps). See Range of adjustment values for the cuvette changer motor positions, page 5-18. Moves the grabber to its vertical/horizontal home position or the load rack rail to its home position. Moves the grabber to the position chosen in the Target scrolling list. Increase/Decrease the adjustment value for the position chosen in the Target scrolling list. - If you click once, the grabber moves 1/4 of a step. - If you hold the button down, the grabber moves step by step. The selected motor is turned off.
Other functionalities: ■ The
Segment function is used to load/unload cuvette segments into the reaction tray: - automatically using the Load and Unload buttons - manually using the Forward button.
Range of adjustment values for the cuvette changer motor positions Vertical Position Offset (not modifiable) Used Cuvette Holder Position New Cuvette Holder Position Pause Position Above Reaction Tray Low Position on Reaction Tray
Default value 512 463 44708 75757 102411
Min. value 512 0 40000 71000 98000
Max. value 512 2000 49000 80000 107000
Default value 128 2758 4263 2665 2940
Min. value 128 2300 3700 2000 2100
Max. value 128 3300 4800 3300 3800
Default value 40
Min. value 40
Max. value 40
Horizontal Position Offset (not modifiable) Backward Position in Reaction Tray Load in Reaction Tray Position Taking New Segment Pos Load Used Segment Position Cuvette motion Position Offset (not modifiable)
5 - 18
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Software description Diagnostics menu description
3.6.
Barcode Test
The Barcode Test tab is used to make sure that the reagent and sample barcode readers as well as the sample tube detector are working correctly. To use these functions, please refer to the Reagent tray procedure (see RAS380: Reagent tray, page 1) and the Sample tray procedure (see RAS381: Sample tray, page 1).
3.7.
Spectro
The Spectro tab groups the functions concerning the instrument optical bench and spectrophotometer.
This tab is divided into three subtabs: ■ Spectro
Measure Adjustment
■ Spectro
Settings
■ Spectro
Measurement. Press one of the tabs to access the various functions. The Spectro Measure Adjustment tab is used to adjust the reaction tray home position. To use this function, please refer to the Reaction tray procedure. See RAS382: Reaction tray, 4.3. Home position, page 21. The Spectro Settings and Spectro Measurement tabs are used to check the optical bench and the spectrophotometer. To use these functions, please refer to the Optical bench procedure. See RAS383: Optical bench, 4. Optical bench check, page 31.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
5 - 19
Software description Diagnostics menu description
3.8.
Heating
The Heating tab displays the temperature control values for the reagent needle, the reaction tray chamber and the cooled area of the reagent tray. These parameters are described in the Section 3: Technology, 3.1. PID control, page 3-12.
3.9.
Sensors
The Sensors tab is used to check the state of several instrument sensors.
From the Sensors tab, the following sensors can be checked: Heading Handling cover reagent closed Handling cover reagent locked Handling cover cuvette segment closed Rack used segment in position Rack used segment full New segment available
5 - 20
Description If the reagent cover is closed, the light is green. If not, the light is red. No check available. If the reaction tray door is closed, the light is green. If not, the light is red. If the unload rack of cuvette changer is in position, the light is green. If not, the light is red. If the unload rack of cuvette changer is full, the light is green. If not, the light is red. If a cuvette segment is on the load rack, in position to be loaded by the grabber, the light is green. If not, the light is red.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Software description Diagnostics menu description
Heading Water tank empty Waste tank full Lamp power standby Lamp power full Low liquid level (cooling unit) PC wake up Main cover closed Mixer present Power correct
Description If the water tank is empty, the light is green. If not, the light is red. If the waste tank is full, the light is green. If not, the light is red. No check available. If the lamp is running properly, the light is green. If not, the light is red. If the liquid level in the cooling unit is low, the light is green. If not, the light is red. If the computer wake up push-button is activated, the light is green. If not, the light is red. If the arms main cover is closed, the light is green. If not, the light is red. If the mixer assembly is in position, the light is green. If not, the light is red. If the power supply is running properly, the light is green. If not, the light is red.
To check the state of these sensors, please refer to the Sensors check and adjustment procedure. See RAS394: Sensors check and adjustment, page 1.
3.10.
Pressure
The Pressure tab is used to configure and calibrate the reagent and sample pressure sensors. To use these functions, please refer to the Pressure sensors procedure. See RAS442: Pressure sensors, page 1.
3.11.
ISE
The ISE tab groups the functions concerning the ISE module. This tab is described in the Section 7: ISE module, page 7-1.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
5 - 21
Software description Diagnostics menu description
3.12.
Repeatability
The Repeatability tab is used to perform repeatability cycles on the different instrument mechanical assemblies to verify that these mechanical assemblies are functioning properly. Repeatability cycles can be performed on the following mechanical assemblies: - Sample arm (vertical and rotation movements) - Reagent arm (vertical and rotation movements) - Mixer - Reagent syringe - Sample syringe - Reaction tray - Reagent tray - Sample tray - Cuvette changer (vertical and horizontal movements, cuvette motion movement). Each repeatability cycle performs a series of back and forth movements between the home position and several target positions of the mechanical assembly. Before performing a repeatability cycle, make sure that there is no mechanical assembly in the way of the mechanical assembly to be checked and move the mechanical assembly to be checked to its home position: ■ Place the reagent arm in low position in wash tower before moving the sample arm. ■ Move the sample arm to its upper position (vertical home position) before moving the reagent arm. ■ Move the sample and reagent arms to their upper positions (vertical home positions) before performing rotation movements. ■ Move the sample and reagent arms to their upper positions (vertical home positions) before moving any tray. ■ Make sure that the mixer paddle and the cuvette changer grabber are not in low position in the reaction tray before moving the reaction tray. ■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Arms.
■ Move the sample arm, then the reagent arm to its home ■ Move ■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Syringe.
■ Move ■ Go
the reagent and sample syringes to their home positions.
to Services > Diagnostics > Tray.
■ Move ■ Go
position (vertical and rotation home positions).
the mixer to its home position.
the reagent, sample and reaction trays to their home positions.
to Services > Diagnostics > Cuvette Changer.
■ Move
each cuvette changer motor (vertical motor, horizontal motor, cuvette motion motor) to its home position.
5 - 22
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Software description Diagnostics menu description
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Repeatability.
A B
E D
C
■ Select
the mechanical assembly in the Element scrolling list (A).
■ Enter
the number of repeatability cycles (from 2 to 50) in the Number of repetitions field (B).
■ Press
Start (C).
■ The
following message will appear: "This action can damage the mechanic. Could you confirm this action?"
■ Press
Yes.
During the repeatability cycle, the following information is displayed in the Statistics part (D): Heading Number of remaining cycles Number of results Standard Deviation
Description Number of remaining cycles. Number of rendered results. Standard deviation calculated for all the rendered results.
After the repeatability cycle, the results are displayed in the Statistics/Position table (E). Heading Position Number of results Standard deviation Coefficient of variation
Description Values in 1/16 of a step of the reached positions during the repeatability cycle. Number of rendered results per position. Standard deviation calculated for the rendered results per position. Coefficient of variation calculated for the rendered results per position.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
5 - 23
Software description Diagnostics menu description
Target positions per mechanical assembly Mechanical assembly Vertical sample arm
Rotation sample arm
Vertical reagent arm
Rotation reagent arm Mixer
Reagent syringe
Sample syringe
Reaction tray
Reagent tray
Sample tray
Up and down cuvettes
Translator cuvettes Lambada cuvettes
Target positions (functional position, volume or 16th of steps) - Low position in reaction tray - Low position in wash tower - Low position in cassette on reagent tray - Low position in ISE mix cup - Wash tower - R1 on cassette - Internal sample - ISE mix cup - Low position in reaction tray - Low position in wash tower - Low position in cassette on reagent tray - Wash tower - R1 on cassette - R2 on cassette - Above reaction tray - Cuvette - 150 µL - 300 µL - 450 µL - 600 µL - 25 µL - 50 µL - 75 µL - 95 µL - 10080 (1/4 of turn) - 20160 (1/2 of turn) - 30240 (3/4 of turn) - 40000 (~ 1 turn) - 10000 (1/4 of turn) - 20000 (1/2 of turn) - 30000 (3/4 of turn) - 39000 (~ 1 turn) - 4800 (1/4 of turn) - 9600 (1/2 of turn) - 14400 (3/4 of turn) - 19100 (~ 1 turn) - Used cuvette holder position - New cuvette holder position - Pause position above reaction tray - Low position on reaction tray - Backward position in reaction tray - Load in reaction tray position - 400 (1/4 of turn) - 800 (1/2 of turn) - 1200 (3/4 of turn)
You can save the number of repeatability cycles as follows: the number of repeatability cycles directly in the Number of repetitions field. ■ Press Back to exit from the Repeatability tab. ■ When the message "Exit without saving?" appears, press Cancel. ■ Type
5 - 24
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Software description Initialization phases
4. Initialization phases This section describes the different phases of the instrument initialization. If an error appears during these phases, a warning or an alarm is triggered. See Section 6: Troubleshooting, page 6-1. 1. Manual or automatic start up ■ Computer
power supply starting
■ Spectrophotometer ■ Heating
lamp starting
starting (reaction tray and reagent needle) and temperature regulation
2. ■ Boot
of the computer
■ Launch
of Windows
3. Launch of instrument software ■ Electronic
key check (standard instrument or extended configuration)
4. Computer maintenance ■ Version
check
■ Database
check
■ Language
database check
■ Check
for archive file creation
■ Result
storage capacity check
■ ABX ■ Log
cassette storage capacity check storage capacity check
■ Database
compacting
5. ISE module wake up 6. Synchronization Computer software/Embedded software. ■ Loading
of instrument software modules (COMPROCESS, PRINTER, COMSIL, IHM)
■ Coherence
control between Embedded software version and Computer software version
■ Coherence control between Embedded exchange table version and Computer exchange table version ■ Coherence
control with CPLD version
■ Coherence
control with ISE version
■ Coherence
control with peripherals (CPLD, ISE, barcodes, PIC version)
■ Mechanical
initialization
■ Barcode
configuration
■ Reagent
and sample barcodes reading
■ Spectrophotometer ■ Light ■ Black
gain adjustment and check
stability check (on air) intensity measurement
■ Cuvette
cleanness check
■ Reference ■ Reaction
light intensity measurement (on water-filled cuvette)
tray check (unload/load)
■ Temperature
regulation check
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
5 - 25
Software description Initialization phases
7. Login
5 - 26
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Section 6: Troubleshooting
1. Error messages ............................................................................................. 6 - 2 1.1. System warnings and alarms..................................................................................................... 6 - 2 1.2. Sampling alarms ...................................................................................................................... 6 - 38
2. Troubleshooting .......................................................................................... 6 - 42 2.1. Chemistry problem .................................................................................................................. 2.2. Windows and computer error .................................................................................................. 2.3. Cooling unit.............................................................................................................................. 2.4. What to do if you are having intermittent alarms #066 or 114?............................................... 2.5. Other ........................................................................................................................................
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
6 - 42 6 - 44 6 - 44 6 - 48 6 - 53
6-1
Troubleshooting Error messages
1. Error messages 1.1.
System warnings and alarms System warnings and alarms are listed in the following table. See 1.1.1. List of warnings and alarms, page 6-3. 1. Warnings Warnings are triggered to warn the user but are not blocking the instrument. They are displayed on the Warning tab of the System Warnings menu. When a warning is triggered, the instrument is not stopped but turns to "Ready" status. If a warning appears, follow the instructions given in the following table. See 1.1.1. List of warnings and alarms, page 6-3. 2. Alarms Alarms are blocking the instrument. They are displayed on the Alarm tab of the System Warnings menu.
The Alarm tab is re-set at each start. To access the previous alarms, press CTRL + F8.
When an alarm is triggered, the instrument is stopped and turns to "Emergency Stop" status. If an alarm appears, follow the instructions given in the following table. See 1.1.1. List of warnings and alarms, page 6-3.
6-2
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Code
001
002
003
004
005
006
007
008
009
010
011
012
013
014
015
Level
Warning
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
Reagent Syringe Motor Initialization Problem
Sample Syringe Motor Initialization Problem
Mixer Initialization Problem
Reaction Tray Motor Initialization Problem
Reagent Tray Motor Initialization Problem
Sample Tray Motor Initialization Problem
Reagent Rotation Motor Initialization Problem
Reagent Vertical Motor Initialization Problem
Sample Rotation Motor Initialization Problem
Sample Vertical Motor Initialization Problem
Measurement Module Initialization Problem
Temperature Regulation Initialization Problem
Reagent Barcode Reader Initialization Problem
Sample Barcode Reader Initialization Problem
ISE Module Initialization Problem
Message
1.1.1. List of warnings and alarms
Check the ISE module connections and fuse. Check the connector J5 on the sample relay board. Check the connector J4 on the mother board. Reload the embedded software version on the mother board. See RAS517: Software version installation, page 1. Replace the mother board. Check the connectors J1 and J2 on the acquisition board, and the bus.
Instrument/ISE module communication failed. Mother board/sample barcode reader communication failed. Mother board/reagent barcode reader communication failed. Communication failed on PIC of temperature regulation. Mother board/acquisition board communication failed.
Communication failed on PIC of reagent syringe motor.
Communication failed on PIC of sample syringe motor.
Communication failed on PIC of mixer XY motor.
Communication failed on PIC of reaction tray motor.
Communication failed on PIC of sample Reload the embedded software version on the tray motor. mother board. See RAS517: Software version Communication failed on PIC of reagent installation, page 1. Replace the mother board. tray motor.
Communication failed on PIC of reagent arm rotation motor.
Communication failed on PIC of reagent arm vertical motor.
Communication failed on PIC of sample arm rotation motor.
Communication failed on PIC of sample arm vertical motor.
Action
Error type / Description
Troubleshooting Error messages
6-3
6-4
021
Alarm
024
020
Alarm
Alarm
019
Alarm
023
018
Alarm
Alarm
017
Alarm
022
016
Alarm
Alarm
Code
Level
Action
Check the sample arm vertical motion, vertical motor connectors. Sample arm vertical home position is not Check the voltages on the mother board: TP28 reached on time during the initialization. (1 V ± 50 mV), home sensor on J59 Pin1-3 (home position 5 V, other 0 V).
motion motor.
Communication failed on PIC of cuvette changer vertical motor. Reload the embedded software version on the Communication failed on PIC of cuvette mother board. See RAS517: Software version installation, page 1. changer horizontal motor. Communication failed on PIC of cuvette Replace the mother board.
Error type / Description
Reagent Tray Motor Reference Position Error
Sample Tray Motor Reference Position Error
Check the reagent arm rotation motion, rotation motor connectors. Check the voltages on the mother board: TP27 (0.6 V ± 50 mV), home sensor on J39 Pin1-3 (home position 5 V, other 0 V).
Check the reagent tray motion, motor connectors, home flag adjustment. Reagent tray home position is not Check the voltages on the mother board: TP11 reached on time during the initialization. (1 V ± 50 mV), home sensor on J14 Pin1-4 (home position 0 V LED DS5 OFF, other 5 V).
Check the sample tray motion, motor connectors, optical encoder connectors. Sample tray home position is not reached Check the voltages on the mother board: TP14 on time during the initialization. (1 V ± 50 mV), home sensor on J21 Pin1-3 (home position 5 V, other 0 V).
Reagent arm rotation home position is Reagent Rotation Motor Reference Position Error not reached on time during the initialization.
Check the reagent arm vertical motion, vertical motor connectors. Reagent arm vertical home position is not Reagent Vertical Motor Reference Position Error Check the voltages on the mother board: TP29 reached on time during the initialization. (1 V ± 50 mV), home sensor on J58 Pin1-3 (home position 5 V, other 0 V).
Check the sample arm rotation motion, rotation motor connectors. Sample arm rotation home position is not Sample Rotation Motor Reference Position Error Check the voltages on the mother board: TP30 reached on time during the initialization. (0.6 V ± 50 mV), home sensor on J41 Pin1-3 (home position 5 V, other 0 V).
Sample Vertical Motor Reference Position Error
Cuvette Motion Initialization Problem
Cuvette Horizontal Motor Initialization Problem
Cuvette Vertical Motor Initialization Problem
Message
Troubleshooting Error messages
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Code
025
026
027
028
029
030
031
Level
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
Action
Mixer home position is not reached on time during the initialization.
Check the mixer XY motion, motor connectors, home flag adjustment. Check the voltages on the mother board: TP16 (0.8 V ± 50 mV), home sensor on J33 Pin1-3 (home position 5 V, other 0 V).
Check the reaction tray motion, motor connectors, home flag adjustment. Reaction tray home position is not Check the voltages on the mother board: TP1 reached on time during the initialization. (2 V ± 50 mV), home sensor on J12 Pin1-3 (home position 5 V, other 0 V).
Error type / Description
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Cuvette Motion Position Error
Cuvette Horizontal Motor Reference Position Error
Check the cuvette motion, cuvette motion motor connectors. Cuvette motion home position is not Check the voltages on the mother board: TP13 reached on time during the initialization. (0.6 V ± 50 mV), home sensor on J37 Pin1-3 (home position 5 V, other 0 V).
Check the cuvette changer horizontal motion, Cuvette changer horizontal home horizontal motor connectors. position is not reached on time during the Check the voltages on the mother board: TP9 initialization. (0.8 V ± 50 mV), home sensor on J20 Pin1-3 (home position 5 V, other 0 V).
Check the cuvette changer vertical motion, vertical motor connectors. Cuvette changer vertical home position is Check the voltages on the mother board: TP6 Cuvette Vertical Motor Reference Position Error not reached on time during the (1.2 V ± 50 mV), home sensor (top) on J17 Pin1-3 initialization. (home position 5 V, other 0 V), position detector (bottom) on J61 Pin1-3 (low position 5 V, other 0 V).
Reagent Syringe Reference Position Error
Check the reagent syringe, the reagent syringe Reagent syringe home position is not motion, motor connectors. reached on time during the initialization. Check the voltages on the mother board: TP2 (1.2 V ± 50 mV), home sensor switch on J2.
Check the sample syringe, the sample syringe Sample syringe home position is not motion, motor connectors. Sample Syringe Motor Reference Position Error reached on time during the initialization. Check the voltages on the mother board: TP7 (1 V ± 50 mV), home sensor switch on J9.
Mixer Initialization Problem
Reaction Tray Motor Reference Position Error
Message
Troubleshooting Error messages
6-5
6-6
038
Alarm
035
Alarm
037
034
Alarm
Alarm
033
Alarm
036
032
Alarm
Alarm
Code
Level
Reaction Tray Position Error
Reagent Tray Position Error
Sample Tray Position Error
Reagent Rotation Motor Position Error
Reagent Vertical Motor Position Error
Sample Rotation Position Error
Sample Vertical Position Error
Message
Action
Check the reaction tray motion, motor connectors, Reaction tray home position is not home flag adjustment. reached with the acceptable motor Check the voltages on the mother board: TP1 number of steps during the initialization. (2 V ± 50 mV), home sensor on J12 Pin1-3 (home position 5 V, other 0 V).
Check the reagent tray motion, motor connectors, Reagent tray home position is not home flag adjustment. reached with the acceptable motor Check the voltages on the mother board: TP11 number of steps during the initialization. (1 V ± 50 mV), home sensor on J14 Pin1-4 (home position 0 V LED DS5 OFF, other 5 V).
Check the sample tray motion, motor connectors, Sample tray home position is not reached optical encoder connectors. with the acceptable motor number of Check the voltages on the mother board: TP14 steps during the initialization. (1 V ± 50 mV), home sensor on J21 Pin1-3 (home position 5 V, other 0 V).
Check the reagent arm rotation motion, rotation Reagent arm rotation home position is motor connectors. not reached with the acceptable motor Check the voltages on the mother board: TP27 number of steps (error > 1/2 offset) during (0.6 V ± 50 mV), home sensor on J39 Pin1-3 (home the initialization. position 5 V, other 0 V).
Check the reagent arm vertical motion, vertical Reagent arm vertical home position is not motor connectors. reached with the acceptable motor Check the voltages on the mother board: TP29 number of steps (error > 1/2 offset) during (1 V ± 50 mV), home sensor on J58 Pin1-3 (home the initialization. position 5 V, other 0 V).
Check the sample arm rotation motion, rotation Sample arm rotation home position is not motor connectors. reached with the acceptable motor Check the voltages on the mother board: TP30 number of steps (error > 1/2 offset) during (0.6 V ± 50 mV), home sensor on J41 Pin1-3 (home the initialization. position 5 V, other 0 V).
Check the sample arm vertical motion, vertical Sample arm vertical home position is not motor connectors. reached with the acceptable motor Check the voltages on the mother board: TP28 number of steps (error > 1/2 offset) during (1 V ± 50 mV), home sensor on J59 Pin1-3 (home the initialization. position 5 V, other 0 V).
Error type / Description
Troubleshooting Error messages
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Code
039
040
041
042
043
044
045
Level
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Alarm
Alarm
Shock Detection Stop
Cuvette Changer Problem: Moving Forward
Cuvette Horizontal Motor Position Error
Cuvette Vertical Motor Position Error
Reagent Syringe Position Error
Sample Syringe Position Error
Mixer Position Error
Message
Action
Check the sample needle alignment, the sample arm cover. Shock detection switch (SW1) of sample Check the voltage on the sample level detection arm is ON during the initialization. board: shock detection switch on J2 Pin2-5 (ON 0 V, OFF 5 V).
Check the cuvette motion, cuvette motion motor Cuvette motion home position is not connectors. reached with the acceptable motor Check the voltages on the mother board: TP13 number of steps during the initialization. (0.6 V ± 50 mV), home sensor on J37 Pin1-3 (home position 5 V, other 0 V).
Check the cuvette changer horizontal motion, Cuvette changer horizontal home horizontal motor connectors. position is not reached with the Check the voltages on the mother board: TP9 acceptable motor number of steps during (0.8 V ± 50 mV), home sensor on J20 Pin1-3 (home the initialization. position 5 V, other 0 V).
Check the cuvette changer vertical motion, vertical motor connectors. Cuvette changer vertical home position is Check the voltages on the mother board: TP6 not reached with the acceptable motor (1.2 V ± 50 mV), home sensor (top) on J17 Pin1-3 number of steps during the initialization. (home position 5 V, other 0 V), position detector (bottom) on J61 Pin1-3 (low position 5 V, other 0 V).
Check the reagent syringe, the reagent syringe Reagent syringe home position is not motion, motor connectors. reached with the acceptable motor Check the voltages on the mother board: TP2 number of steps during the initialization. (1.2 V ± 50 mV), home sensor switch on J2.
Check the sample syringe, the sample syringe Sample syringe home position is not motion, motor connectors. reached with the acceptable motor Check the voltages on the mother board: TP7 number of steps during the initialization. (1 V ± 50 mV), home sensor switch on J9.
Check the mixer XY motion, motor connectors, Mixer home position is not reached with home flag adjustment. the acceptable motor number of steps Check the voltages on the mother board: TP16 (0.8 V ± 50 mV), home sensor on J33 Pin1-3 (home during the initialization. position 5 V, other 0 V).
Error type / Description
Troubleshooting Error messages
6-7
6-8
053
Alarm
055
048
Alarm
Alarm
047
Alarm
054
046
Alarm
Alarm
Code
Level
Action
Check the reagent needle wires, check the connectors J5 and J4 on the reagent level detection board. Check the detection board cable (XBA517 or XBA814) and its conductivity from the reagent level detection board (J4) to the mother board (J47). Change the reagent needle. Run an initialization and restart the cooling unit. Check the glycol level and circulation. Check the fans inside the reagent tray and the cooling unit fan. Change the glycol.
Temperature of reagent needle, measured by the temperature sensor, is not in the acceptable range: - after 10 min. during the initialization (37°C ±1.5). - after the initialization (37°C ±3). Temperature of reagent tray, measured by the temperature sensor, is not in the acceptable range: - after 4 hours during the initialization (6°C, 4-10°C). - after the initialization (6°C, 2-12°C).
Heating Needle Temperature regulation failed
Refrigerated Compartment Temperature regulation failed
Reaction Tray Temperature regulation failed
Check the reaction tray fan is running (airflow from top to bottom), powered on 24 V on the mother board: J52, LED DS16. Check the heater resistance, check the voltage on the heater: J2 Pin1-2 (24 V TTL). Check the temperature sensor voltage on the mother board: J46 (37°C 1.95 V, 30°C 2.3 V). Check the cooling unit is running.
Reagent needle does not detect liquid, with the capacitive level detection, during Check the level of the concerned reagent. pipetting in reagent tray. Triggered during the shutdown.
Sample needle does not detect liquid, with the capacitive level detection, during Check the level of the concerned reagent. pipetting in reagent tray. Triggered during the shutdown.
Check the sample needle alignment, the sample Shock detection switch (SW1) of sample arm cover. arm is ON during the initialization, and the Check the voltage on the sample level detection sample arm is at its vertical home board: shock detection switch on J2 Pin2-5 position. (ON 0 V, OFF 5 V).
Error type / Description
Temperature of reaction tray, measured by the temperature sensor, is not in the acceptable range: - after 15 min. during the initialization (37°C ±0.25) - after the initialization (37°C ±0.5).
Reagent Level Detection Error
Sample Level Detection Error
Shock Detection Out of Service
Message
Troubleshooting Error messages
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Code
056
057
058
059
060
061
062
063
Level
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
Warning
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Warning
Alarm
Alarm
Action
Reagent Door Open
Main Cover Open
ISE command invalid
Detected by the reagent door magnetic switch.
Close the reagent door. Check the reagent door switch, connector J29 Pin1-2 on the mother board. To avoid reagent tray cover alarms when disconnecting connector J29, make a short circuit between the black and white wires on the connector right below the reagent tray.
Close the main cover. Check the main cover switch, connector J30 on Detected by the main cover mechanical the mother board. switch during the initialization. Connector J30 can be disconnected without triggering any alarm on the instrument.
Shut down and switch the instrument off and on. Change the ISE mother board.
Reload the barcode reader configuration (shut down and restart the instrument). Change the barcode reader. Change the mother board.
Incorrect communication frame with reagent barcode reader.
The used ISE function cannot be performed. Triggered by the ISE mother board.
Reload the barcode reader configuration (shut down and restart the instrument). Change the barcode reader. Change the mother board.
Incorrect communication frame with sample barcode reader.
Shut down and switch the instrument off and on. Change the ISE mother board.
Check the connectors J1 and J2 on the acquisition board, and the bus. Check the connector J1 on the mother board.
Mother board/acquisition board communication failed. Triggered during absorbance measurements.
Mother board/acquisition board Check the connectors J1 and J2 on the acquisition communication failed. board, and the bus. Triggered during the spectrophotometer Check the connector J1 on the mother board. initialization.
Error type / Description
Non recoverable material error on the ISE module Triggered by the ISE mother board.
Reagent Tray Identification Failure
Sample Tray Identification Failure
Measurement Module Out of Service
Measurement Module Out of Service
Message
Troubleshooting Error messages
6-9
6 - 10
102
103
Alarm
067
Alarm
Alarm
066
Alarm
101
065
Alarm
Alarm
Code
Level
Reagent Vertical Position Error
Sample Rotation Position Error
Sample Vertical Position Error
No Clean Cuvettes Present
Low pressure on the Sample or Reagent hydraulic system
Check the reagent arm vertical motion, vertical motor connectors. Reagent arm vertical home position is not Check the voltages on the mother board: TP29 reached on time during a run. (1 V ± 50 mV), home sensor on J58 Pin1-3 (home position 5 V, other 0 V).
Check the sample arm rotation motion, rotation motor connectors. Sample arm rotation home position is not Check the voltages on the mother board: TP30 reached on time during a run. (0.6 V ± 50 mV), home sensor on J41 Pin1-3 (home position 5 V, other 0 V).
Check the sample arm vertical motion, vertical motor connectors. Sample arm vertical home position is not Check the voltages on the mother board: TP28 reached on time during a run. (1 V ± 50 mV), home sensor on J59 Pin1-3 (home position 5 V, other 0 V).
Add new cuvette segments. Detected by the cuvette segment sensor, Check the cuvette segment sensor adjustment. located on the load rack, during the Check the voltages on the mother board: J38 initialization. Pin2-3 (24 V), Pin1-2 (without cuvette segment 5 V, with cuvette segment 0 V).
Check the low pressure threshold = 300 in the Pressure menu. Check the water tank and hydraulic circuit (leaks, unplug tubing, ...). Detected by the sample or reagent Check the voltage on the pressure board: TP3 pressure sensor (< 300 mbar) during the (3.8 V ± 50 mV), and readjust it if necessary with initialization. R16. Change the sample or reagent pressure sensor. See 2.4. What to do if you are having intermittent alarms #066 or 114?, page 6-48.
Action
Mixer not Positioned
Error type / Description Manually push the mixer down. Check the "mixer present switch", connector J28 Detected by the "mixer present switch". on the mother board. Connector J28 can be disconnected without triggering any alarm on the instrument.
Message
Troubleshooting Error messages
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Code
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
Level
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
Reagent Syringe Position Error
Sample Syringe Position Error
Mixer Position Error
Reaction Tray Position Error
Reagent Tray Position Error
Sample Tray Position Error
Reagent Rotation Position Error
Message Check the reagent arm rotation motion, rotation motor connectors. Check the voltages on the mother board: TP27 (0.6 V ± 50 mV), home sensor on J39 Pin1-3 (home position 5 V, other 0 V).
Reagent arm rotation home position is not reached on time during a run.
Check the reagent tray motion, motor connectors, home flag adjustment. Check the voltages on the mother board: TP11 (1 V ± 50 mV), home sensor on J14 Pin1-4 (home position 0 V LED DS5 OFF, other 5 V). Check the reaction tray motion, motor connectors, home flag adjustment. Check the voltages on the mother board: TP1 (2 V ± 50 mV), home sensor on J12 Pin1-3 (home position 5 V, other 0 V). Check the mixer XY motion, motor connectors, home flag adjustment. Check the voltages on the mother board: TP16 (0.8 V ± 50 mV), home sensor on J33 Pin1-3 (home position 5 V, other 0 V). Check the sample syringe, the sample syringe motion, motor connectors. Check the voltages on the mother board: TP7 (1 V ± 50 mV), home sensor switch on J9. Check the reagent syringe, the reagent syringe motion, motor connectors. Check the voltages on the mother board: TP2 (1.2 V ± 50 mV), home sensor switch on J2.
Reagent tray home position is not reached on time during a run.
Reaction tray home position is not reached on time during a run.
Mixer home position is not reached on time during a run.
Sample syringe home position is not reached on time during a run.
Reagent syringe home position is not reached on time during a run.
Check the sample tray motion, motor connectors, Sample tray home position is not reached optical encoder connectors. on time during a run or the optical Check the voltages on the mother board: TP14 encoder detects a wrong position. (1 V ± 50 mV), home sensor on J21 Pin1-3 (home position 5 V, other 0 V).
Action
Error type / Description
Troubleshooting Error messages
6 - 11
6 - 12
115
116
117
Alarm
Alarm
113
Alarm
Alarm
112
Alarm
114
111
Alarm
Alarm
Code
Level
Used Cuvette Holder Missing
Manual Cuvette Loading Door Open
Main Cover Open
Low pressure on the Sample or Reagent hydraulic system
Cuvette Changer Problem: Moving Forward
Cuvette Horizontal Motor Position Error
Cuvette Vertical Motor Position Error
Message
Action
Check the low pressure threshold = 300 in the Pressure menu. Check the water tank and hydraulic circuit (leaks, unplug tubing, ...). Check the voltage on the pressure board: TP3 (3.8 V ± 50 mV), and readjust it if necessary with R16. Change the sample or reagent pressure sensor. See 2.4. What to do if you are having intermittent alarms #066 or 114?, page 6-48.
Cuvette motion home position is not reached on time during a run.
Detected by the sample or reagent pressure sensor (< 300 mbar) during a run.
Unload rack is not detected by the mechanical switch during the initialization or a run.
Reinstall the unload rack. Check the "rack used segment in position" sensor, connector J26 on the mother board.
Reaction tray flap door open, detected by Close the reaction tray flap door. the switch located on the reaction tray Check the flap door switch, connector J10 on the upper case during a run. mother board.
Close the main cover. Check the main cover switch, connector J30 on Detected by the main cover mechanical the mother board. switch during a run. Connector J30 can be disconnected without triggering any alarm on the instrument.
Check the cuvette motion, cuvette motion motor connectors. Check the voltages on the mother board: TP13 (0.6 V ± 50 mV), home sensor on J37 Pin1-3 (home position 5 V, other 0 V).
Check the cuvette changer horizontal motion, Cuvette changer horizontal home horizontal motor connectors. position is not reached on time during a Check the voltages on the mother board: TP9 run. (0.8 V ± 50 mV), home sensor on J20 Pin1-3 (home position 5 V, other 0 V).
Check the cuvette changer vertical motion, vertical motor connectors. Check the voltages on the mother board: TP6 Cuvette changer vertical home position is (1.2 V ± 50 mV), home sensor (top) on J17 Pin1-3 not reached on time during a run. (home position 5 V, other 0 V), position detector (bottom) on J61 Pin1-3 (low position 5 V, other 0 V).
Error type / Description
Troubleshooting Error messages
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Code
118
119
122
123
124
125
126
Level
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
Warning
Warning
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Alarm
Alarm
Sample Level Detection Out of Service
Shock Detection Out of Service
Heating needle temperature exceeds limits
Reaction tray temperature exceeds limits
Measurement Module Out of Service
Reagent Identification Failure
Sample Identification Failure
Message
Check the connectors J1 and J2 on the acquisition board, and the bus. Check the connector J1 on the mother board. Change the acquisition board. Check the reaction tray fan is running (airflow from top to bottom), powered on 24 V on the mother board: J52, LED DS16. Check the heater resistance, check the voltage on the heater: J2 Pin1-2 (24 V TTL). Check the temperature sensor voltage on the mother board: J46 (37°C 1.95 V, 30°C 2.3 V). Check the cooling unit is running. Check the reagent needle wires, check the connectors J5 and J4 on the reagent level detection board. Check the detection board cable (XBA517 or XBA814) and its conductivity from the reagent level detection board (J4) to the mother board (J47). Change the reagent needle.
Mother board/acquisition board communication failed.
Temperature of reaction tray, measured by the temperature sensor, is not in the acceptable range after the initialization: - after 2 min. (37°C ±0.25).
Temperature of reagent needle, measured by the temperature sensor, is not in the acceptable range after the initialization: - after 24 sec. (37°C ±1.5).
Sample needle does not detect liquid, with the capacitive level detection, 3 consecutive times during pipetting in sample or reagent tray.
Check the level of the concerned sample or reagent. Check the sample arm wires, connections and board. Check the frequency on the sample level detection board: U2 Pin1-5 (on air 47 kHz, with J1 disconnected > 100 kHz). Change the sample needle, sample level detection board.
Check the sample needle alignment, the sample arm cover. Shock detection switch (SW1) of sample Check the voltage on the sample level detection arm is ON during a run. board: shock detection switch on J2 Pin2-5 (ON 0 V, OFF 5 V).
Physically check the cassettes and racks.
Physically check the sample tubes and sample racks.
Action
Reagent identification failed.
Sample identification failed.
Error type / Description
Troubleshooting Error messages
6 - 13
6 - 14
130
Alarm
128
Alarm
129
127
Alarm
Alarm
Code
Level
Over pressure on the sample hydraulic system
Reagent Level Detection Out of Service
Reagent Level Detection Out of Service
Sample Level Detection Out of Service
Message
Action
High pressure on the sample hydraulic circuit (> 2500 mbar), detected by the sample pressure sensor during a run.
Check the high pressure threshold = 2500 in the Pressure menu. Check the sample needle is not clogged. Change the sample needle, sample pressure sensor, pressure board, water pump.
Check the reagent syringe has no bubble. Check there is no leaks. Check the concerned reagent (level, foam, bubbles). Air detection 2 consecutive times during Check the low pressure threshold = 300 and factor sampling, the pressure measured by the KA = 0.700 in the Pressure menu. reagent pressure sensor is lower than the Check the voltage on the pressure board: TP3 low limit of acceptable range (3.8 V ± 50 mV), and readjust it if necessary with (= KA * (A * pipetted volume + B)). R16. Calibrate the reagent pressure sensor. Change the reagent needle, reagent pressure sensor, pressure board.
Reagent needle does not detect liquid, with the capacitive level detection, 3 consecutive times during pipetting in reagent tray.
Check the level of the concerned reagent. Check the reagent arm wires, connections and board. Check the voltage on the reagent level detection board at U2 output and U3 input: between TP1 and TP2 (J1 disconnected 2.8 V ±10%, J1 connected 0 V < 0.5 V, J5 disconnected on air 1.9 V ±10%, J5 disconnected on water 1.7 V ±10%). Change the reagent needle, reagent level detection board.
Check the sample syringe has no bubble. Check there is no leaks. Air detection 2 consecutive times during Check the concerned sample or reagent (level, sampling, the pressure measured by the foam, bubbles). sample pressure sensor is lower than the Check the low pressure threshold = 300 and factor low limit of acceptable range KA = 0.050 in the Pressure menu. (= KA * (A * pipetted volume + B)). Calibrate the sample pressure sensor. Change the sample needle, sample pressure sensor, pressure board.
Error type / Description
Troubleshooting Error messages
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Code
131
132
133
134
135
Level
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Alarm
Alarm
Maximum quantity of cycles exceeded
Shock Detection Out of Service
Reagent Needle Clogged
Sample Needle Clogged
Over pressure on the reagent hydraulic system
Message Check the high pressure threshold = 2500 in the Pressure menu. Check the reagent needle is not clogged. Check the voltage on the pressure board: TP3 (3.8 V ± 50 mV), and readjust it if necessary with R16. Change the reagent needle, reagent pressure sensor, pressure board, water pump. Check the concerned sample or reagent. Check the sample needle is not clogged. Check the factor KB = 3.700 in the Pressure menu. Calibrate the sample pressure sensor. Change the sample needle, sample pressure sensor, pressure board.
High pressure on the reagent hydraulic circuit (> 2500 mbar), detected by the reagent pressure sensor during a run.
Clog detection 2 consecutive times during sampling, the pressure measured by the sample pressure sensor is higher than the high limit of acceptable range (= KB * (A * pipetted volume + B)).
Reload the embedded software version on the Number of cycles incompatible with the mother board. See RAS517: Software version embedded software version. installation, page 1. Replace the mother board.
Check the sample needle alignment, the sample Shock detection switch (SW1) of sample arm cover. arm is ON during a run, and the sample Check the voltage on the sample level detection arm is at its vertical home position. board: shock detection switch on J2 Pin2-5 (ON 0 V, OFF 5 V).
Check the concerned reagent. Check the reagent needle is not clogged. Check the factor KB = 1.800 in the Pressure Clog detection 2 consecutive times menu. during sampling, the pressure measured Check the voltage on the pressure board: TP3 by the reagent pressure sensor is higher (3.8 V ± 50 mV), and readjust it if necessary with than the high limit of acceptable range R16. (= KB * (A * pipetted volume + B)). Calibrate the reagent pressure sensor. Change the reagent needle, reagent pressure sensor, pressure board.
Action
Error type / Description
Troubleshooting Error messages
6 - 15
6 - 16
145
140
Alarm
Alarm
139
Alarm
142
138
Alarm
Alarm
137
Alarm
141
136
Alarm
Alarm
Code
Level
Reagent Tray Temperature Sensor Out of Order
Reagent Needle Temperature Sensor Out of Order
Action
Remove used cuvette segments. Check the "rack used segment full" sensor. Check the voltage on the mother board: J19 Pin12 (with cuvette segment 5 V, without cuvette segment 0 V). Check there is no light interference above the instrument.
Detected by the photoelectric beam sensor, located on the load rack.
The temperature sensor, located in the reagent tray, has no resistance (open circuit).
Check the temperature sensor and its wires, connector J43 on the mother board. Change the temperature sensor.
Check the reagent needle wires, check the connectors J5 and J4 on the reagent level detection board. The temperature sensor, located in the Check the detection board cable (XBA517 or reagent needle, has no resistance (open XBA814) and its conductivity from the reagent circuit). level detection board (J4) to the mother board (J47). Change the reagent needle.
Check the temperature sensor and its wires, connector J46 on the mother board. Change the temperature sensor.
Reinstall the unload rack. Check the "rack used segment in position" sensor, connector J26 on the mother board.
Unload rack is not detected by the mechanical switch, located on the cuvette changer.
Reaction tray flap door open, detected by Close the reaction tray flap door. the switch located on the reaction tray Check the flap door switch, connector J10 on the upper case during a run and a reaction mother board. tray motion.
The requested cycle does not exist.
Reload the embedded software version on the mother board. See RAS517: Software version installation, page 1. Replace the mother board.
See Alarm #136 "Peripheral busy", page 6-34 to know which motor is concerned by the message. Incompatible cycle, time out on a motor. Check the concerned motor. Send to HORIBA Medical the files Asp400bd.mdb and Error.log for analysis.
Error type / Description
The temperature sensor, located in the Reaction Tray Temperature Sensor Out of Order reaction tray, has no resistance (open circuit).
Used Cuvette Holder Full
Used Cuvette Holder Missing
Manual Cuvette Loading Cover Open
Unknown Cycle
Peripheral busy [%s]
Message
Troubleshooting Error messages
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Code
146
147
148
149
150
151
Level
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Alarm
Check the high pressure threshold = 2500 in the Pressure menu. Check the sample needle is not clogged. Change the sample needle, sample pressure sensor, pressure board, water pump. Check the high pressure threshold = 2500 in the Pressure menu. Check the reagent needle is not clogged. Check the voltage on the pressure board: TP3 (3.8 V ± 50 mV), and readjust it if necessary with R16. Change the reagent needle, reagent pressure sensor, pressure board, water pump.
Detected by the reagent door magnetic switch during pipetting.
High pressure on the sample hydraulic circuit (> 2500 mbar), detected by the sample pressure sensor during the initialization.
High pressure on the reagent hydraulic circuit (> 2500 mbar), detected by the reagent pressure sensor during the initialization.
Pressure controller initilization error
Over pressure on the reagent hydraulic system
Over pressure on the sample hydraulic system
Reload the embedded software version on the Communication failed on PIC of pressure mother board. See RAS517: Software version board. installation, page 1. Replace the mother board.
Close the reagent door. Check the reagent door switch, connector J29 Pin1-2 on the mother board. To avoid reagent tray cover alarms when disconnecting connector J29, make a short circuit between the black and white wires on the connector right below the reagent tray.
Compressor overload: Refrigeration has been stopped.
Reagent Door Open
Check the cooling unit is switched ON. Check the cooling unit condenser (dirty), fan (damaged), filter, control cable (disconnected). Check the room temperature is not excessive. See Compressor overload alarm, page 6-35.
Instrument received 5 V = compressor overload (instead of 0 V = compressor OK) through the cooling unit control cable on instrument connector Pin6 or the cooling unit is switched OFF.
Action
Shock Detection on dispensing
Error type / Description Check the sample needle alignment, the sample arm cover. Shock detection switch (SW1) of sample Check the voltage on the sample level detection arm is ON during dispensing. board: shock detection switch on J2 Pin2-5 (ON 0 V, OFF 5 V).
Message
Troubleshooting Error messages
6 - 17
Code
152
153
154
156
157
301
Level
Alarm
6 - 18
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
Warning
Cuvette Holder Empty
Error card reagent detection [error %s1: %s2]
Mixer not Positioned
Pressure controller of reagent arm out of order
Pressure controller of sample arm out of order
Water Tank Low Level
Message Fill the water tank. Check the voltage of the water tank empty sensor on the mother board: J31 Pin3-4 (water 0 V, no water 5 V). To avoid water level detection alarms when disconnecting connector J31, make a short circuit between Pin 3 and 4. WARNING: This will disabled the waste tank level detection.
Detected by the level switch, located in the water tank.
See Error on the reagent level detection board, page 6-37.
Detected by the mechanical switch, located under the mixer assembly.
Error on the reagent level detection board. [%s1]: error code. [%s2]: error message.
Add new cuvette segments. Check the cuvette segment sensor adjustment. Detected by the cuvette segment sensor, Check the voltages on the mother board: J38 located on the load rack, during a run. Pin2-3 (24 V), Pin1-2 (without cuvette segment 5 V, with cuvette segment 0 V). Check the cuvette motion, clean the load rack rail.
Manually push the mixer down. Check the voltage of the "mixer present switch" on the mother board: J28 Pin2-4 (mixer present 5 V, mixer not present 0 V). Connector J28 can be disconnected without triggering any alarm on the instrument.
Air detection 2 consecutive times during sampling, the pressure measured by the Check the reagent pressure sensor, pressure reagent pressure sensor is lower than the board. low limit of acceptable range (= KA * (A * pipetted volume + B)).
Air detection 2 consecutive times during sampling, the pressure measured by the Check the sample pressure sensor, pressure sample pressure sensor is lower than the board. low limit of acceptable range (= KA * (A * pipetted volume + B)).
Action
Error type / Description
Troubleshooting Error messages
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Code
302
303
304
305
307
308
Level
Warning
Warning
Warning
Warning
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Warning
Warning
Power supply problem
Water level of the cold group is insufficient
Reagent tray temperature exceeds limits
Waste Tank Full
Water Tank Low Level
Used Cuvette Holder Full
Message
Action
Run an initialization and restart the cooling unit. Check the glycol level and circulation. Check the fans inside the reagent tray and the cooling unit fan. Change the glycol.
Temperature of reagent tray, measured by the temperature sensor, is not in the acceptable range after the initialization: - after 30 min. (6°C, 4-10°C).
A default has been detected in the power supply. Change the power supply. Information from the power supply received on the mother board J54 Pin9.
Glycol level in the cooling unit insufficient, detected by the mechanical switch in the cooling unit. Check the glycol level. Instrument received 5 V = low level Check the cooling unit mechanical switch. (instead of 0 V = OK) through the cooling unit control cable on instrument connector Pin4.
Empty the waste tank. Check the voltage of the waste tank full sensor on the mother board: J31 Pin1-2 (empty 0 V, full 5 V).
Detected by the level switch, located in the waste tank.
Fill the water tank. Check the voltage of the water tank empty sensor on the mother board: J31 Pin3-4 (water 0 V, no Detected by the level switch, located in water 5 V). the water tank, during all phases except To avoid water level detection alarms when pipetting. disconnecting connector J31, make a short circuit between Pin 3 and 4. WARNING: This will disabled the waste tank level detection.
Remove used cuvette segments. Check the "rack used segment full" sensor. Detected by the photoelectric beam Check the voltage on the mother board: J19 Pin1sensor, located on the load rack, during a 2 (with cuvette segment 5 V, without cuvette run. segment 0 V). Check there is no light interference above the instrument.
Error type / Description
Troubleshooting Error messages
6 - 19
6 - 20
312
Warning
314
311
Warning
Warning
310
Warning
313
309
Warning
Warning
Code
Level
SOLUTION_CLOGGING/RN on liquid [%s]
SOLUTION_CLOGGING/SN on liquid [%s]
SOLUTION_FOAM/RN on liquid [%s]
SOLUTION_FOAM/SN on liquid [%s]
SOLUTION_EMPTY/RN on liquid [%s]
SOLUTION_EMPTY/SN on liquid [%s]
Message
Action Check the reagent and replace it if necessary. Activate the reagent in the Reagent Configuration menu. Rerun the shutdown. Check the reagent and replace it if necessary. Activate the reagent in the Reagent Configuration menu. Rerun the shutdown. Check the reagent and replace it if necessary. Activate the reagent in the Reagent Configuration menu. Rerun the shutdown. Check the reagent and replace it if necessary. Activate the reagent in the Reagent Configuration menu. Rerun the shutdown. Check the sample needle and tubing. Run a sample pressure calibration. Check the reagent and replace it if necessary. Activate the reagent in the Reagent Configuration menu. Rerun the shutdown. Check the reagent needle and tubing. Run a reagent pressure calibration. Check the reagent and replace it if necessary. Activate the reagent in the Reagent Configuration menu. Rerun the shutdown.
Error type / Description The sampling alarm SOLUTION_EMPTY/ SN has been triggered, by the sample needle, on the solution [%s] during the shutdown. [%s] = solution short name. The sampling alarm SOLUTION_EMPTY/ RN has been triggered, by the reagent needle, on the solution [%s] during the shutdown. [%s] = solution short name. The sampling alarm SOLUTION_FOAM/ SN has been triggered, by the sample pressure sensor, on the solution [%s] during the shutdown. [%s] = solution short name. The sampling alarm SOLUTION_FOAM/ RN has been triggered, by the reagent pressure sensor, on the solution [%s] during the shutdown. [%s] = solution short name. The sampling alarm SOLUTION_CLOGGING/SN has been triggered, by the sample pressure sensor, on the solution [%s] during the shutdown. The sample needle may be clogged. [%s] = solution short name. The sampling alarm SOLUTION_CLOGGING/RN has been triggered, by the reagent pressure sensor, on the solution [%s] during the shutdown. The reagent needle may be clogged. [%s] = solution short name.
Troubleshooting Error messages
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Code
315
316
317
318
319
320
321
Level
Warning
Warning
Warning
Warning
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Warning
Warning
Warning
Position error on ISE syringe 2 (error code 12)
Timeout error on ISE syringe 2 (error code 11)
Position error on ISE syringe 1 (error code 2)
Timeout error on ISE syringe 1 (error code 1)
INC_SOLUTION_PIPET/RN on liquid [%s]
INC_SOLUTION_PIPET/SN on liquid [%s]
SOLUTION_SHOCK on liquid [%s]
Message
Action
Check the reagent and replace it if necessary. Activate the reagent in the Reagent Configuration menu. Rerun the shutdown.
Check the reagent and replace it if necessary. Activate the reagent in the Reagent Configuration menu. Rerun the shutdown. Check the ISE syringe 1 assy motion. Check the voltage of the home sensor on the ISE mother board: CN6 Pin2-3 (home position 0 V, other 5 V). Check the ISE syringe 1 assy motion. Check the voltage of the home sensor on the ISE mother board: CN6 Pin2-3 (home position 0 V, other 5 V). Check the ISE syringe 2 assy motion. Check the voltage of the home sensor on the ISE mother board: CN4 Pin2-3 (home position 0 V, other 5 V). Check the ISE syringe 2 assy motion. Check the voltage of the home sensor on the ISE mother board: CN4 Pin2-3 (home position 0 V, other 5 V).
The sampling alarm INC_SOLUTION_PIPET/SN has been triggered, by the sample pressure sensor, on the solution [%s] during the shutdown. [%s] = solution short name. The sampling alarm INC_SOLUTION_PIPET/RN has been triggered, by the reagent pressure sensor, on the solution [%s] during the shutdown. [%s] = solution short name. ISE syringe 1 assy (Standard 1/waste) home position is not reached on time. ISE module status is 2 = module configured. ISE syringe 1 assy (Standard 1/waste) home position is not reached. ISE module status is 2 = module configured. ISE syringe 2 assy (Reference/Standard 2) home position is not reached on time. ISE module status is 2 = module configured. ISE syringe 2 assy (Reference/Standard 2) home position is not reached. ISE module status is 2 = module configured.
The sampling alarm SOLUTION_SHOCK Check the reagent, remove the caps. Activate the has been triggered, by the sample or reagent in the Reagent Configuration menu. reagent needle, on the solution [%s] Rerun the shutdown. during the shutdown. [%s] = solution short name.
Error type / Description
Troubleshooting Error messages
6 - 21
6 - 22
325
Warning
327
324
Warning
Warning
323
Warning
326
322
Warning
Warning
Code
Level
Action
ISE module reagent/fluidic error. LB sensor cannot detect Standard 1. The LB Check the ISE Standard 1 bottle, hydraulic circuit. sensor measurement is > 4.5 V (air). Check the valve V4 and readjust the LB sensor. ISE module status is 4 = module Run an ISE Global Initialization. sleeping.
Error type / Description
ISE low solution inlet excess on start of measuring (error code 25)
Can’t detect ISE high solution (error code 31)
ISE module reagent/fluidic error. LB sensor detects Standard 1 at the beginning of measurement. The LB sensor measurement is < 1 V (liquid). ISE module status is 4 = module sleeping.
ISE low solution inlet excess on timeout (error code 24)
ISE module reagent/fluidic error. LB sensor cannot detect Standard 2. The LB Check the ISE Standard 2 bottle, hydraulic circuit. Check the valve V4 and readjust the LB sensor. sensor measurement is > 4.5 V (air). Run an ISE Global Initialization. ISE module status is 4 = module sleeping.
Check the ISE Standard 1 bottle, hydraulic circuit. Check the valve V4 and readjust the LB sensor. Run an ISE Global Initialization.
ISE module reagent/fluidic error. LB sensor still detects Standard 1 flow after Check the ISE Standard 1 bottle, hydraulic circuit. the aspiration specified time. The LB Check the valve V4 and readjust the LB sensor. sensor measurement is < 1 V (liquid). Run an ISE Global Initialization. ISE module status is 4 = module sleeping.
Too much ISE low solution inlet (error code 23)
Check the ISE Standard 1 bottle, hydraulic circuit. Check the valve V4 and readjust the LB sensor. Run an ISE Global Initialization
ISE module reagent/fluidic error. LB sensor detects Standard 1. The LB sensor measurement is < 1 V (liquid). ISE module status is 4 = module sleeping.
ISE module reagent/fluidic error. LB sensor cannot detect the arriving of Check the ISE Standard 1 bottle, hydraulic circuit. Standard 1. The LB sensor measurement Can’t detect ISE low solution inlet (error code 22) Check the valve V4 and readjust the LB sensor. is > 4.5 V (air). Run an ISE Global Initialization. ISE module status is 4 = module sleeping.
Can’t detect ISE low solution (error code 21)
Message
Troubleshooting Error messages
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Code
328
329
330
331
332
333
334
Level
Warning
Warning
Warning
Warning
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Warning
Warning
Warning
Check the sample for fibrin, clog. Check the sample needle and tubing. Readjust the LB sensor. Check the sample for fibrin, clog. Check the sample needle and tubing. Readjust the LB sensor. Check the hydraulic circuit. Check the valve V4 and readjust the LB sensor. Run an ISE Global Initialization.
ISE module reagent/fluidic error. LB sensor cannot detect the arriving of sample. The LB sensor measurement is > 4.5 V (air). ISE module reagent/fluidic error. LB sensor detects sample. The LB sensor measurement is < 1 V (liquid). ISE module status is 4 = module sleeping.
ISE module reagent/fluidic error. LB sensor still detects sample flow after the Check the hydraulic circuit. aspiration specified time. The LB sensor Check the valve V4 and readjust the LB sensor. measurement is < 1 V (liquid). Run an ISE Global Initialization. ISE module status is 4 = module sleeping.
Too much ISE sample inlet (error code 43)
ISE sample inlet excess on timeout (error code 44)
Can’t detect ISE sample inlet (error code 42)
Can’t detect ISE sample (error code 41)
ISE module reagent/fluidic error. LB sensor cannot detect sample. The LB sensor measurement is > 4.5 V (air).
ISE high solution inlet excess on timeout (error code 34)
ISE module reagent/fluidic error. LB sensor still detects Standard 2 flow after Check the ISE Standard 2 bottle, hydraulic circuit. the aspiration specified time. The LB Check the valve V4 and readjust the LB sensor. sensor measurement is < 1 V (liquid). Run an ISE Global Initialization. ISE module status is 4 = module sleeping.
Check the ISE Standard 2 bottle, hydraulic circuit. Check the valve V4 and readjust the LB sensor. Run an ISE Global Initialization.
Can’t detect ISE high solution inlet (error code 32)
ISE module reagent/fluidic error. LB sensor detects Standard 2. The LB Too much ISE high solution inlet (error code 33) sensor measurement is < 1 V (liquid). ISE module status is 4 = module sleeping.
ISE module reagent/fluidic error. LB sensor cannot detect the arriving of Check the ISE Standard 2 bottle, hydraulic circuit. Standard 2. The LB sensor measurement Check the valve V4 and readjust the LB sensor. is > 4.5 V (air). Run an ISE Global Initialization. ISE module status is 4 = module sleeping.
Action
Error type / Description
Message
Troubleshooting Error messages
6 - 23
6 - 24
339
340
501
502
Warning
Alarm
Alarm
337
Warning
Warning
336
Warning
338
335
Warning
Warning
Code
Level Run a 2-point calibration. Perform the ISE module maintenance (etching, cleaning). Change the corresponding electrode. Run a 2-point calibration. Perform the ISE module maintenance (etching, cleaning). Change the corresponding electrode.
The difference between the low and high standard values is out of the sensitivity normal range for the electrode in brackets. [%s1] = electrode name. [%s2] = low/high point of the calibration. The low or high standard value is out of the acceptable range for the electrode in brackets. [%s1] = electrode name. [%s2] = low/high point of the calibration.
ISE electrode [%s1] sensibility error for [%s2] point (error code 50)
ISE electrode [%s1] offset error for [%s2] point (error code 51)
Compressor overload: Refrigeration is stopped temporarily for 10 minutes.
Compacting database Not OK
Database compacting failed.
Reload a previous database.
Bad database version. Reload a compatible database version. Database version [%s] Not OK, version required [%s] = database version number. Reinstall the software version. See RAS517: The software detected an incompatible [%s] Software version installation, page 1. database version during the initialization.
Check the cooling unit is switched ON. The cooling unit is stopped for ten Check the cooling unit condenser (dirty), fan minutes and automatically restarted after (damaged), filter, control cable (disconnected). ten minutes stopping. Check the room temperature is not excessive. See Compressor overload alarm, page 6-35.
Change the ISE preampli board.
ISE module mechanical error.
ISE LB check response error (error code 91)
ISE electrode [%s1] response error for [%s2] point (error code 55)
Check the ISE Standard 1 or 2 bottle has no bubble. The potential difference during the three Change the ISE Standard 1 or 2 bottle. last seconds of a measurement is Perform the ISE module maintenance (etching, ≥ 0.40 mV for the electrode in brackets. cleaning). [%s1] = electrode name. Change the corresponding electrode. [%s2] = low/high point of the calibration. Check the spring contact of the corresponding electrode.
Check the ISE Standard 1 bottle has no bubble. Change the ISE Standard 1 bottle. Repeatability error on the low standard Perform the ISE module maintenance (etching, ISE electrode [%s1] repeatability error for [%s2] value for the electrode in brackets. cleaning). point (error code 52) [%s1] = electrode name. Change the corresponding electrode. [%s2] = low/high point of the calibration. Check the spring contact of the corresponding electrode.
Action
Error type / Description
Message
Troubleshooting Error messages
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Code
503
504
505
506
507
508
509
510
511
Level
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
Alarm
Error type / Description
Check the lamp and replace it if necessary. Check the gain values. Clean the lamp side of the condensing lens. See RAS656: Partial condensing lens cleaning, page 1. Clean the mirror and all the lens of the optical bench. See RAS383: Optical bench, page 1.
The lamp stability is not reached after 10 min. during the initialization (the difference between 2 consecutive absorbances is > 0.00022).
Bad embedded exchange table version. [%s] = embedded exchange table Reinstall the software version. See RAS517: version number. Software version installation, page 1. The software detected an incompatible Replace the mother board. exchange table version on the mother board during the initialization.
Light stability Not OK
Bad Embedded exchange table: Version Required [%s], Current [%s]
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Unable to found empty cuvette on a reaction tray No new cuvette on the reaction tray.
Add new cuvette segments. Check the cuvette segment sensor adjustment. Check the voltages on the mother board: J38 Pin2-3 (24 V), Pin1-2 (without cuvette segment 5 V, with cuvette segment 0 V).
Run an initialization. Perform a Checkdisk. Reinstall the software version. See RAS517: Software version installation, page 1.
Module loading failed. [%s] = module name (COMPROCESS, IHM).
Loading Module [%s]: Not OK
-
Bad computer exchange table size. [%s] = computer exchange table size.
Bad PC exchange table size: Version Required [%s], Current [%s]
-
Bad embedded exchange table size. [%s] = embedded exchange table size.
Bad Embedded exchange table size: Version Required [%s], Current [%s]
Bad computer exchange table version. Bad PC exchange table: Version Required [%s], Reinstall the software version. See RAS517: [%s] = computer exchange table version Current [%s] Software version installation, page 1. number.
Bad CPLD version Required [%s], Current [%s]
Reinstall the software version. See RAS517: Software version installation, page 1. Replace the mother board.
Reinstall the software version. See RAS517: Software version installation, page 1.
Action
Bad CPLD version. [%s] = CPLD version number.
Bad embedded software version. [%s] = embedded software version Bad Embedded Software Version Required [%s], number. Current [%s] The embedded software version on the mother board is incompatible with the current software version.
Message
Troubleshooting Error messages
6 - 25
6 - 26
601
Warning
518
Alarm
600
517
Alarm
Warning
516
Alarm
520
515
Alarm
Alarm
514
Alarm
519
513
Alarm
Alarm
Code
Level
Reinstall the software version. See RAS517: Software version installation, page 1. Reinstall the ISE version on the ISE module. See RAS540: ISE module software version installation, page 1.
Replace the lamp.
Check the module connections. Run an initialization.
Bad ISE module version. [%s] = ISE version number. Detected during the initialization. Spectrophotometer gain check failed. [%s1] = wavelength. [%s2] = gain. The gain is out of the acceptable range (between 1 and 98%) during the initialization. Module loading failed. [%s] = module name (PRINTER, COMSIL).
Motor [%s1], function position [%s2], value [%s3] has changed
Bad ISE version Required [%s], Current [%s]
The lamp has failed the gain check. [%s1 nm / %s2 Gain]. Please change the lamp.
Bad language database version. Language database version [%s] Not OK, version [%s] = language database version required [%s] number.
-
-
Motor offset value out of range. [%s1] = motor name. [%s2] = position name. [%s3] = old value, new value.
Light intensity out of range
Loading Module [%s]: Not OK
The light intensity on air, measured in the position 1 of an empty sector of the Check the optical bench, reaction tray adjustment reaction tray, is out of the acceptable and clean the reaction tray. range (between 57200 and 65535) during the initialization.
Shut down and switch the instrument off and on.
Problem when configuring the Reagent Barcode Reagent barcode reader configuration Reader failed.
Check the barcode labels on cassettes and reagent racks.
Check the cable from the computer to the mother board. Check the power supply on the mother board.
Action
Shut down and switch the instrument off and on.
At least two identical reagent barcodes.
Internal communication failed.
Error type / Description
Problem when configuring the Sample Barcode Sample barcode reader configuration Reader failed.
At least 2 identical Barcodes detected
Communication Problem
Message
Troubleshooting Error messages
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Code
602
603
604
605
606
607
608
609
Level
Warning
Warning
Warning
Warning
Warning
Warning
Warning
Warning
Error type / Description
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Used Cuvette Holder Missing
Manual Cuvette Loading Door Open
Reagent Door Open
Main Cover Open
This Patient ID [%s] is a reserved code
This Sample ID [%s] is a reserved code
No Ordered Sample on Sample Tray
Position sample tubes on the sample tray.
Add new cuvette segments. Check the cuvette segment sensor adjustment. Check the voltages on the mother board: J38 Pin2-3 (24 V), Pin1-2 (without cuvette segment 5 V, with cuvette segment 0 V). Check the cleanness of the optical bench lenses.
Action
Unload rack is not detected by the mechanical switch, located on the cuvette changer.
Reinstall the unload rack. Check the "rack used segment in position" sensor, connector J26 on the mother board.
Reaction tray flap door open, detected by Close the reaction tray flap door. the switch located on the reaction tray Check the flap door switch, connector J10 on the upper case. mother board.
Detected by the reagent door magnetic switch.
Close the reagent door. Check the reagent door switch, connector J29 Pin1-2 on the mother board. To avoid reagent tray cover alarms when disconnecting connector J29, make a short circuit between the black and white wires on the connector right below the reagent tray.
Close the main cover. Check the main cover switch, connector J30 on Detected by the main cover mechanical the mother board. switch. Connector J30 can be disconnected without triggering any alarm on the instrument.
The patient ID in brackets, programmed from the Host, contains the "AUTO_SID" Modify the Patient ID from the Host. prefix. [%s] = Patient ID.
The sample ID in brackets, programmed from the Host, contains the "AUTO_SID" Modify the Sample ID from the Host. prefix. [%s] = Sample ID.
No ordered sample tube on the sample tray.
Not Enough Clean Cuvettes on Reaction Tray to Less than four new cuvettes on the Start Analysis reaction tray.
Message
Troubleshooting Error messages
6 - 27
Code
610
611
612
613
614
616
617
618
619
620
621
622
623
Level
Warning
6 - 28
Warning
Warning
Warning
Warning
Warning
Warning
Warning
Warning
Warning
Warning
Warning
Warning
Fill the water tank. Check the voltage of the water tank empty sensor on the mother board: J31 Pin3-4 (water 0 V, no water 5 V). To avoid water level detection alarms when disconnecting connector J31, make a short circuit between Pin 3 and 4. WARNING: This will disabled the waste tank level detection. Empty the waste tank. Check the voltage of the waste tank full sensor on the mother board: J31 Pin1-2 (empty 0 V, full 5 V).
Detected by the level switch, located in the water tank.
Detected by the level switch, located in the waste tank.
-
Make sure that the cleaning solution is positioned on the reagent tray.
Make sure that the cleaning solution is positioned on the reagent tray.
Access to electronic key is impossible
Instrument/key communication failed.
Serial number on the instrument is different from serial number on the electronic key.
Serial ## on the electronic key is incompatible with serial ## on memory
-
Check the serial number entered in the System Configuration menu.
Serial number recording on the electronic key has failed.
Write error on the electronic key
A request, programmed from the Host, does not comply with the ASTM format. Check and modify the request from the Host. The fields sample ID, action code or sample type contain an incorrect value.
L.I.S. order can't be performed for SID [sample ID]: incorrect value [value] in field [field]
-
At least two sample racks with the same Check the ID of sample racks. barcode.
Database save failed.
At least two sample racks with the same Check the ID of sample racks. barcode.
Stabilization or calibration in progress.
ISE module cleaning failed.
Needles cleaning failed.
Manually push the mixer down. Check the "mixer present switch", connector J28 Detected by the "mixer present switch". on the mother board. Connector J28 can be disconnected without triggering any alarm on the instrument.
Action
Error type / Description
Sample Rack Duplicate Detected
Database save not OK
Sample Rack Duplicate Detected
ISE Module busy
ISE cleaning failed
System cleaning failed
Mixer missing
Waste Tank Full
Water Tank Empty
Message
Troubleshooting Error messages
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Code
624
625
626
627
628
629
630
631
632
Level
Warning
Warning
Warning
Warning
Warning
Warning
Warning
Warning
Warning
Error type / Description
Check the reagent needle and clean it if necessary. Check the reagent syringe and hydraulic circuit. Recalibrate the reagent pressure sensor. -
The calibration of the reagent pressure sensor has failed. The database saved on [%s1] has been restored by [%s2]. [%s1] = date and time. [%s2] = user name.
Spectrophotometer gain reaches limit. [%s1] = wavelength. [%s2] = gain. The lamp will need to be replaced soon. The gain reaches the limit of the acceptable range (between 95 and 98%) during the initialization.
Restore database saved on [%s1] by [%s2]
The lamp is dying, it is still operational but you will need to change it soon. [%s1 nm / %s2 Gain].
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN Replace the sample tube to its previous position.
Check the barcode label on the sample rack.
The sample rack barcode is not read. [%s1] = position number on the sample tray. [%s2] = Sample ID.
Rack label not read on sector [%s1] for SID: [%s2]
The sample tube has been removed during the analysis. SID [%s1] on position [%s2] no longer displayed [%s1] = Sample ID. [%s2] = rack position.
Check the barcode label on the sample rack.
The sample rack barcode is not read. [%s] = position number on the sample tray.
Rack label not read on sector [%s]
Pressure Reagent calibration failed
Pressure Sample calibration failed
Check the sample needle and clean it if necessary. Check the sample syringe and hydraulic circuit. Recalibrate the sample pressure sensor.
The sample tube has been moved (for a sample that is for validation or validated). Replace the sample tube to its previous position. [%s] = rack position or Sample ID.
See 1.2. Sampling alarms, page 6-38.
Action
The calibration of the sample pressure sensor has failed.
Completed Sample [%s] is now detected on Rack.Pos [%s]
One of the following sampling alarms is triggered: - MISMATCH [%s1]: Sample [%s2] has been detected instead - POS_CHANGE of ordered sample [%s2] - BARCODE_DUPLICATE. [%s1] = sampling alarm. [%s2] = rack position or Sample ID.
Message
Troubleshooting Error messages
6 - 29
6 - 30
640
641
642
644
Warning
Warning
Warning
637
Warning
Warning
636
Warning
639
635
Warning
Warning
634
Warning
638
633
Warning
Warning
Code
Level
-
Check the USB flash drive.
The sample rack has been moved during the analysis. Replace the sample rack to its previous position. [%s1] = rack number. [%s2] = Sample ID.
The sample rack has been moved during the analysis. Replace the sample rack to its previous position. [%s] = rack number.
Archive database save failed.
Results save on the USB flash drive failed.
Check the reagent and replace it if necessary. Not enough solution to perform a Activate the reagent in the Reagent cleaning required from the Customer Configuration menu. Services menu or during the shutdown. Rerun the cleaning from the Customer Services [%s] = solution short name. menu or rerun the shutdown.
Configure the sample rack in the System Configuration menu.
LIS order cannot be performed. No order information available for PID [patient ID].
There is no O frame (Order) for the P frame (Patient).
Ask the IT Services Company to check the LIS configuration.
The analyses have been performed Worklist performed with reagent tray temperature though the temperature in the Rerun the analyses after performing the [temperature] out of the range (acceptable range) refrigerated area of reagent tray was out appropriate controls. of range.
Rack position modified [%s1] for SID: [%s2]
Rack position modified [%s]
Saving archive database failed
Unable to save results onto USB stick
Not enough cleaner solution [%s]
Rack [%s1] on sector [%s2] not configured
The sample rack is not configured. [%s1] = rack number. [%s2] = position number on the sample tray.
-
The column configuration has been restored the [%s1] by [%s2]. Restore column configuration the [%s1] by [%s2] [%s1] = date and time. [%s2] = user name.
Check the sample barcode label.
The sample barcode is not read. [%s1] = Sample ID. [%s2] = rack position. -
Action
Error type / Description
The system configuration has been restored the [%s1] by [%s2]. Restore system configuration the [%s1] by [%s2] [%s1] = date and time. [%s2] = user name.
SID [%s1] on position [%s2] not read
Message
Troubleshooting Error messages
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Code
645
646
647
648
649
650
654
Level
Warning
Warning
Warning
Warning
Warning
Warning
Warning
Ask the IT Services Company to check the LIS configuration. Ask the IT Services Company to check the LIS configuration. Ask the IT Services Company to check the LIS configuration.
Ask the IT Services Company to check the LIS configuration.
LIS order cannot be performed: communication/ There is no O frame (Order) for the P protocol error. Patient information for PID [patient frame (Patient). ID] could not be processed. Interrupted communication.
LIS order cannot be performed: communication/ protocol error. Information for PID [patient ID] and There is no L frame (Terminator) before related orders SID(s): [sample ID] could not be (End of Transmission). processed. There is no P frame (Patient) or O frame (Order) for the C frame (Comment). The Q frame (Query) comes with a P frame (Patient) or a O frame (Order) although only the H frame (Header) and the L frame (Terminator) are authorized with the Q frame. At least two Q frames comes together although only one Q frame is authorized.
A request, programmed from the Host, has one or several rejected tests. Each rejected test contains one of the following errors. - "Channel error": The test field does not contain a channel number. - "Disabled": The test is disabled on the Check and modify the request from the Host. instrument. - "Not configured": The test is not configured on the instrument. - "Sample type incompatible": The sample type of the test does not match the sample. The sample tube has been moved during Replace the sample tube to its previous position. the analysis.
LIS communication/protocol error. Comment information could not be processed.
LIS communication/protocol error. Query information could not be processed.
L.I.S. order with SID [sample ID] error. The following tests are rejected: [test no.1 (reason no.1), test no.2 (reason no.2), etc].
Position change: Sample [read barcode] was detected in [rack position of the sample tube], but it is expected to be in [rack position of the sample tube]
Action Ask the IT Services Company to check the LIS configuration.
Error type / Description
LIS order cannot be performed: communication/ There is no P frame (Patient) for the O protocol error. Order information for SID [sample frame (Order). ID] could not be processed.
Message
Troubleshooting Error messages
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
6 - 31
Code
655
Level
Warning
Error type / Description
Action
Mismatch: Sample [read barcode] was detected For a rack position, the sample ID in the Check the sample. in [rack position of the sample tube] instead of worklist is different from the read Modify the sample ID in the worklist or move the expected sample [expected barcode] barcode. sample tube to its correct position.
Message
Troubleshooting Error messages
6 - 32
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Troubleshooting Error messages
1.1.2. Additional information Special message during the instrument initialization ■ During
the database check/compacting, the following message can be displayed: "Unable to connect to database. Unable to compress or repair database. Do you really want to restore the database?".
■ Press
OK, then the following window is displayed:
This window lists the saved databases (the backup database name and date are displayed).
Each time a new worklist is created, the current database is saved on the instrument. Up to eight databases are saved and numbered from the most recent to the oldest.
■ Choose ■ Then,
a database by clicking the corresponding item.
press OK.
■ The
database is then restored and the following warning is triggered: #628 "Restore database saved on [%s1] by [%s2]".
Modifications carried out after this database backup are lost (calibrations, controls, patient results, reagent consumption, etc.)
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
6 - 33
Troubleshooting Error messages
Alarm #136 "Peripheral busy" With this alarm, you have a number corresponding to each peripheral. Please refer to the following table to see which peripheral is in trouble. #
Peripheral
1
Sample arm rotation motion
2
Reagent arm rotation motion
3
Sample arm vertical motion
4
Reagent arm vertical motion
5
Sample syringe motion
6
Reagent syringe motion
7
Sample tray rotation
8
Reagent tray rotation
9
Reaction tray rotation
10
Mixer XY motion
11
Cuvette changer vertical motion
12
Cuvette changer horizontal motion
13
Cuvette motion
14
Temperature regulation
15
Spectrophotometer
16
Pressure sensors
17
ISE module
18
Sample barcode reader
19
Reagent barcode reader
20
Reaction tray temperature
21
Reagent tray temperature
22
Reagent needle temperature
Management of temperature warnings and alarms This table will help you to understand how the temperature warnings and alarms are triggered. Code Type
Acceptable range
Time of stabilization
Reaction Tray Temperature regulation failed
37°C (+/- 0.25°C)
< 15 min.
37°C (+/- 1.5°C)
< 10 min.***
4-10°C
< 4 hours*
Message
The stability was not reached during the instrument initialization.
053
ALARM
054
ALARM
Heating Needle Temperature regulation failed
ALARM
Refrigerated Compartment Temperature regulation failed
055
The stability was reached during the instrument initialization but the temperature is now out of range.
123
WARNING Reaction tray temperature exceeds limits
37°C (+/- 0.25°C)
< 2 min.
053
ALARM
Reaction Tray Temperature regulation failed
37°C (+/- 0.5°C)
None
124
WARNING Heating needle temperature exceeds limits
37°C (+/- 1.5°C)
< 24 sec.
054
ALARM
37°C (+/- 3°C)
None
305
WARNING Reagent tray temperature exceeds limits**
4-10°C
< 30 min.
2-12°C
None
055
6 - 34
ALARM
Heating Needle Temperature regulation failed Refrigerated Compartment Temperature regulation failed
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Troubleshooting Error messages
* Every hour from the start of the cooling unit, the temperature in the refrigerated area of the reagent tray (if it is still out of the acceptable range) is checked to ensure that it is decreasing by at least two degrees per hour. If not, the alarm #055 "Refrigerated Compartment Temperature regulation failed" is triggered. ** Before performing the analyses, the reagent tray temperature is checked and if it is out of range, a dialog box is displayed: "The current reagent tray temperature [temperature] is out of the range (acceptable range). The results can be affected by this malfunction. We recommend you to perform controls. Do you still want to run analysis?". *** On each start of the heating needle temperature regulation, a test period of 5 seconds is performed. This test period consists in heating at its maximum power within 5 seconds, then checking that the temperature has increased by at least 1.5°C. If the temperature has increased of 1.5°C or more, then the heating needle temperature regulation works properly. If not, the alarm #142 "Reagent Needle Temperature Sensor Out of Order" is triggered and the heating needle temperature regulation is stopped.
Compressor overload alarm If the "Compressor overload" alarm is triggered for the first time, the warning #340 "Compressor overload: Refrigeration is stopped temporarily for 10 minutes" is triggered. This means that the cooling unit has stopped for ten minutes and automatically restarted afterwards. Once the cooling unit has automatically been restarted: ■ If a second "Compressor overload" alarm is triggered within five minutes, the alarm #147 "Compressor
overload: Refrigeration has been stopped" is triggered. This means that the cooling unit has stopped.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
6 - 35
Troubleshooting Error messages
■ After
five minutes, the cooling unit operation is back to normal. If a new "Compressor overload" alarm is triggered, it is considered as the first one.
6 - 36
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Check the LEDs state (DS2 and DS3) on the reagent level detection board. See Section 4: Electric and electronic The reagent level detection principles, 3.3. Reagent level detection board, page 4-20. board or the embedded Reinstall the software version. software version is defective. Replace the reagent level detection board. Run a calibration of the reagent level detection from Services > Customer Services > Cycles (please refer to the instrument user manual). Check the reagent arm wires, connections and board. Disconnect and reconnect J2 connector on the reagent level detection board. Check the LEDs state (DS2 and DS3) on the reagent level detection board. See Section 4: Electric and electronic principles, 3.3. Reagent level detection board, page 4-20. Replace the reagent level detection board.
Defective card (Autotest)
Defective card (Category)
Calibration not performed
Reference error
Calibration failed
001
002
004
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
005
007
008
009
Rerun a calibration of the reagent level detection from Services > Customer Services > Cycles (please refer to the instrument user manual). Replace the reagent needle, the reagent level detection board. Check the reagent arm wires, connections and board. Replace the reagent level detection board. Check the reagent arm wires, connections and board. Replace the reagent level detection board.
The calibration has failed.
The reagent level detection board is busy.
The reagent level detection board is absent or incompatible.
Card busy
Absent or incompatible card
Rerun a calibration of the reagent level detection from Services > Customer Services > Cycles (please refer to the instrument user manual). Reference measurement on air Check the LEDs state (DS2 and DS3) on the reagent level detection board. See Section 4: Electric and electronic out of range. principles, 3.3. Reagent level detection board, page 4-20. Replace the reagent needle, the reagent level detection board.
No valid calibration of the reagent level detection.
Action Check the reagent arm wires, connections and board. Check the LEDs state (DS2 and DS3) on the reagent level detection board. See Section 4: Electric and electronic principles, 3.3. Reagent level detection board, page 4-20. Replace the reagent level detection board.
Error type
The reagent level detection board is defective (detected during instrument initialization).
Code Message
This table lists the different errors that can appear on the reagent level detection board and trigger the system alarm #157 "Error card reagent detection [error %s1: %s2]".
Error on the reagent level detection board
Troubleshooting Error messages
6 - 37
Troubleshooting Error messages
1.2.
Sampling alarms Sampling alarms are displayed on the Sampling Exception tab of the Test Review menu.
If a sampling alarm is triggered, follow the instructions given in the following table.
6 - 38
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Action Check the sample. Check the reagent and replace it if necessary. Activate the reagent in the Reagent Configuration menu. Check the reagent and replace it if necessary. Activate the reagent in the Reagent Configuration menu.
Insufficient volume (detected by the reagent needle). The reagent is then inactivated. Tests in progress for this reagent are interrupted.
Air bubbles or insufficient volume (detected by the reagent pressure sensor). Check the reagent and replace it if necessary. Activate The reagent is then inactivated. the reagent in the Reagent Configuration menu. Tests in progress for this reagent are interrupted.
Check the sample. The sample needle may be clogged (detected by the sample pressure sensor). Make sure that the sample needle is not clogged and Tests in progress for this sample are interrupted. clean it if necessary. Run a sample pressure calibration.
Check the sample needle and tubing. The sample needle may be clogged (detected by the sample pressure sensor). Run a sample pressure calibration. The reagent is then inactivated. Check the reagent and replace it if necessary. Activate Tests in progress for this reagent are interrupted. the reagent in the Reagent Configuration menu.
Check the reagent. Activate the reagent in the Reagent Configuration menu.
Insufficient volume (detected by the sample needle). The reagent is then inactivated. Tests in progress for this reagent are interrupted.
Air bubbles or insufficient volume (detected by the sample pressure sensor). Check the reagent and replace it if necessary. Activate The reagent is then inactivated. the reagent in the Reagent Configuration menu. Tests in progress for this reagent are interrupted.
Check the sample.
Insufficient volume (detected by the sample needle). Tests in progress for this sample are interrupted.
Air bubbles or insufficient volume (detected by the sample pressure sensor). Check the sample. Tests in progress for this sample are interrupted.
Check the reagent needle and tubing. Run a reagent pressure calibration. Check the reagent and replace it if necessary. Activate the reagent in the Reagent Configuration menu.
Error type
The reagent needle may be clogged (detected by the reagent pressure sensor). The reagent is then inactivated. Tests in progress for this reagent are interrupted.
The sample may be capped. Tests in progress for this sample are interrupted.
The reagent may be capped. The reagent is then inactivated. Tests in progress for this reagent are interrupted.
Message
SPLE_EMPTY
SOLUTION_EMPTY/SN
SOLUTION_EMPTY/RN
SAMPLE_FOAM
SOLUTION_FOAM/SN
SOLUTION_FOAM/RN
SAMPLE_FIBRIN
SOLUTION_CLOGGING/SN
SOLUTION_CLOGGING/RN
SAMPLE_SHOCK
SOLUTION_SHOCK
Troubleshooting Error messages
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
6 - 39
6 - 40 Check the sample. Modify the sample ID in the worklist or move the sample tube to its correct position.
For a rack position, the sample ID in the worklist is different from the read barcode (Sampling status).
Air bubbles or insufficient volume (detected by the sample pressure sensor). Check the sample. Tests in progress for this sample are interrupted.
Air bubbles or insufficient volume (detected by the sample pressure sensor). Check the reagent and replace it if necessary. Activate The reagent is then inactivated. the reagent in the Reagent Configuration menu. Tests in progress for this reagent are interrupted.
Air bubbles or insufficient volume (detected by the reagent pressure sensor). Check the reagent and replace it if necessary. Activate The reagent is then inactivated. the reagent in the Reagent Configuration menu. Tests in progress for this reagent are interrupted.
The reagent is missing.
MISMATCH
INC_SAMPLE_PIPET
INC_SOLUTION_PIPET/SN
INC_SOLUTION_PIPET/RN
REAG_MISSING
The calibrator position is not configured.
Not enough reagent for the pending analyses.
Not enough cuvette segments in the load rack.
Calibrator Exp.
Pos. not set
NOT_ENOUGH_REAG
NOT_ENOUGH_CUV
The control has expired.
The calibrator has expired.
CLEANER_EXPIRED
CTRL_EXPIRED
Replace the cleaner.
The cleaner has expired. It then cannot be used for the pending analyses.
DIL_EXPIRED
No current valid calibration for this test (Control).
Replace the diluent.
The diluent has expired. It then cannot be used for the pending analyses.
REAG_EXPIRED
The calibrator is missing.
Replace the reagent.
The reagent has expired. It then cannot be used for the pending analyses.
CLEANER_LOCKED
Calibrator Miss
Activate the cleaner in the Reagent Configuration menu.
The cleaner is inactivated. It then cannot be used for the pending analyses.
DIL_LOCKED
No Cal. in Memory
Activate the diluent in the Reagent Configuration menu.
The diluent is inactivated. It then cannot be used for the pending analyses.
REAG_LOCKED
Replace the control.
Place the calibrator.
Run a calibration for this test.
Add new cuvette segments in the load rack.
Replace the reagent.
Configure the calibrator position in the Calibration/ Control menu.
Replace the calibrator.
Activate the reagent in the Reagent Configuration menu.
The reagent is inactivated. It then cannot be used for the pending analyses.
CLEANER_MISSING
Place the diluent on reagent tray. Place the cleaner on reagent tray.
The diluent is missing.
The cleaner is missing.
DIL_MISSING
Place the reagent on reagent tray.
Action
Error type
Message
Troubleshooting Error messages
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Check the sample. Modify the sample ID in the worklist or move the sample tube to its correct position.
For a rack position, the sample ID in the worklist is different from the read barcode (All status, Identification mode).
The sample tube has been moved during the analysis.
A sampling alarm has interrupted the tests in progress.
Two sample tubes having the same barcode are placed on the sample tray.
MISMATCH
POS_CHANGE
INTERRUPT
Barcode Dup.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN Check the barcode label. Replace the sample tube to its previous position.
No active cassette for this reagent.
The electrode is inactivated.
No active cassette for this cleaner.
No active cassette for this diluent.
The barcode label of the sample rack is not read.
The sample tube has been removed whereas all the tests of the sample are not finished.
The barcode label of the sample tube is not read.
The sample tube has been removed during the analysis.
The sample rack has been moved during the analysis.
ACTIVE_REAGENT_ ABX_CASSETTE_MISSING
Electrode disabled
ACTIVE_CLEANER_ ABX_CASSETTE_MISSING
ACTIVE_DILUANT_ ABX_CASSETTE_MISSING
RACK_NOT_READ
TUBE_NOT_PRESENT
TUBE_LABEL_NOT_READ
TUBE_DISAPPEAR
POSCHANGE_RACK
Replace the diluent.
Insuf. Cleaner
Replace the sample rack to its previous position.
Replace the sample tube to its previous position.
Check the barcode label.
Activate the cassette in the Reagent Configuration menu.
Activate the cassette in the Reagent Configuration menu.
Activate the electrode in the Customer Services menu.
Activate the cassette in the Reagent Configuration menu.
Replace the cleaner.
Not enough diluent for the pending analyses.
Not enough cleaner for the pending analyses.
Insuf. Diluent
Check and remove one of them if necessary.
The tests not completed will be performed at the next start.
Replace the sample tube to its previous position.
Check the sample. Modify the sample ID in the worklist or move the sample tube to its correct position.
For a rack position, the sample ID in the worklist is different from the read barcode (All status, Position mode).
MISMATCH
Run a calibration for this test. Run a control for this test.
No current valid calibration for this test (Patient sample).
Place the control.
No current valid control for this test (Patient sample).
The control is missing.
CTRL_MISSING
Configure the control position in the Calibration/ Control menu.
No Ctrl in Memory
The control position is not configured.
Pos. not set
Action
No Cal. in Memory
Error type
Message
Troubleshooting Error messages
6 - 41
Troubleshooting Troubleshooting
2. Troubleshooting This guide is intended to provide help in solving problem situations that may appear when using the instrument. The actions described in this troubleshooting chapter must be undertaken if all the user troubleshooting steps, described in your user manual (refer to the "Maintenance and Troubleshooting" chapter), have been performed. For any situations that cannot be resolved by using this guide, please contact the International Technical Support department (ITS).
Services and repairs of the instrument should only be carried out by a fully trained technician.
2.1.
Chemistry problem In all cases, first perform the "Precision test" procedure. See RAS393: Check up after intervention, page 1.
2.1.1. Repeatability 1. Test T1 or P1 with CV > 1% Cause
Action
Worn syringe plunger tips.
Change the syringe plunger tips.
Improper mixing.
Check the mixer paddle rotation, coupling, position. Check the mixer XY motion.
Defective manifold, valves V1 or V2.
Clean the hydraulic system with bleach solution. Change the manifold block.
Bubbles in the pipetting system.
Check the straw position into the water tank. Check the airtightness of the hydraulic system. Change the manifold block, water pump.
Bubbles clung to the syringe plunger tips. Change the syringe plunger tips. Clogged sample needle.
6 - 42
Prime the hydraulic system. Change the sample needle.
Bubbles on the top of sample.
Remove the bubbles.
Lamp instability.
Change the lamp.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Troubleshooting Troubleshooting
2. Test T1 or P1 with CV ≤ 1% but absorbance values out of the acceptable range Cause
Action
Contaminated or expired solution.
Use new ABX Pentra Qualitest Solution or ABX Pentra Precitest Solution, use fresh distilled water on the rack.
Defect on the spectrophotometer or pipetting.
Manually dilute the control solution and measure the absorbance value in the Spectro menu. - Test T1: 2.5 µL of ABX Pentra Qualitest Solution + 587.5 µL of distilled water - Test P1: 3 µL of ABX Pentra Precitest Solution + 292 µL of distilled water If the absorbance value x 1000 is in the acceptable range, then there is a defect on the pipetting. Otherwise, check the spectrophotometer.
2.1.2. Blank out of range Cause
Action
Contaminated distilled water and tubing.
Check the distilled water integrity, resistivity > 5 Mohm.cm Perform the decontamination procedure.
Contaminated or expired reagent.
Use fresh reagent.
Use of cuvette segments non-approved by HORIBA Medical.
Use HORIBA Medical approved cuvette segments.
Re-used cuvette segments.
Cuvette segments are designed for single use only.
2.1.3. Calibration factor out of range Cause
Action
Contaminated distilled water and tubing.
Check the distilled water integrity, resistivity > 5 Mohm.cm Perform the decontamination procedure.
Contaminated or expired calibrator, reagent.
Use fresh calibrator, reagent.
Bubbles/foam on the top of reagent (on cassette or reagent rack).
Remove the bubbles/foam.
For kinetic tests, temperature regulation problem.
Check the reaction tray temperature regulation. Change the reaction tray temperature sensor.
For user channels, not suitable calibration factor limits in the application Redefine the calibration factor limits. configuration.
2.1.4. Control out of range Cause
Action
Error in the confidence range configuration.
Check the configured values with the corresponding annex.
Expired calibration, reagent.
Recalibrate with fresh calibrator. Replace the reagent and recalibrate.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
6 - 43
Troubleshooting Troubleshooting
2.2.
2.3.
Windows and computer error
Error
Action
General exception
Shut down and restart the computer. Perform a Checkdisk. Purge the Rs_Data and Bugs folders. If the error continues to appear, reinstall the software version.
Boot disk failure
Reinstall the Windows master and the software version.
Cooling unit 2.3.1. Primary checking ■
The warning #340 is not necessarily a cooling unit defect. You should wait 10 minutes to let the compressor cool down the temperature.
■
Check the compatibility of the voltage and frequency with the main power supply (see Section 8: Exploded views, 24. Cooling unit, page 8-40).
■ Make
sure that the laboratory temperature is between +15°C and +32°C.
■ Check ■ Make
the fuses (see Section 8: Exploded views, 24. Cooling unit, page 8-40).
sure that the temperature target is +6°C (Services > Diagnostics > Heating).
■ The
minimum software version required for ABX Pentra 400 is 5.0.6. No minimum software version required for Pentra C400.
■ The
cooling unit maintenances have been performed: RAS378: 6 month maintenance, 4. Cooling unit, page 3 RAS379: Yearly maintenance, 2. Cooling unit, page 7
6 - 44
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Troubleshooting Troubleshooting
2.3.2. Diagnostic sequence (warning #305, alarms #055 and #147)
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
6 - 45
Troubleshooting Troubleshooting
CU401 fan is running?
■ Check
if there is air flow at the back of the CU401.
AIR FLOW
Regulation is functioning well?
"CLAC" ■ From
the Heating menu (Services > Diagnostics > Heating), press Start and check by ear if the solenoid valve has switched ("CLAC").
Cable defective? ■ Check
the cable conductivity with an ohmmeter (see Section 4: Electric and electronic principles, 8.2. DAC034A (1201891034): CABLE, CHILLER CABLE, page 4-37).
Control board defective? ■
6 - 46
Check the voltage on the control board (see Section 3: Technology, 3.2.3. Cooling unit electric diagram, page 3-18).
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Troubleshooting Troubleshooting
5 V on PIN 3 of CU401 connector?
■ From
the Heating menu (Services > Diagnostics > Heating), press Stop and then Start.
■ Check
the voltage of the PIN 3 of the CU401 connector (see Section 4: Electric and electronic principles, 8.2. DAC034A (1201891034): CABLE, CHILLER CABLE, page 4-37).
Pump is running?
■ Check
if the pump is running: the liquid is moving in the tank.
Liquid throughput OK?
■ Disconnect
the IN tubing from the CU401 and put it above the tank in order to make sure that the liquid throughput is correct.
Tubing pinched or clogged? ■
Check if the cooling liquid tubing is pinched or unclog the circuit (see Section 3: Technology, 2.3. Cooling system diagram, page 3-11).
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
6 - 47
Troubleshooting Troubleshooting
Temperature sensor and fans?
■ Check
if the reagent tray fans are working.
■ Check
with an external temperature probe if the temperature inside the reagent tray is the same than the temperature displayed in the Heating menu (Services > Diagnostics > Heating).
2.4.
What to do if you are having intermittent alarms #066 or 114? This troubleshooting guide is intended to help you in solving problems of intermittent alarms #66 or #114: "Low pressure on the Sample or Reagent hydraulic system". We recommend performing the following steps in the indicated sequence: ■ 2.4.1.
Pressure sensors activation, configuration, calibration, page 6-48
■ 2.4.2.
Improving the hydraulic system airtightness, page 6-50
■ 2.4.3.
Checking the sample needle throughput, page 6-52
■ 2.4.4.
Checking the water pump pressure, page 6-52
■ 2.4.5.
Replacing the pressure sensors and the pressure board, page 6-52
2.4.1. Pressure sensors activation, configuration, calibration 2.4.1.1. To activate the pressure sensors 1. Go to Services > System Configuration > Analyser. 2. Make sure that the reagent and sample pressure sensors are activated.
6 - 48
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Troubleshooting Troubleshooting
Both pressure sensors must be activated. Otherwise, erroneous test results could occur.
2.4.1.2. To configure the pressure sensors 1. Go to Services > Diagnostics > Pressure. 2. Check the values KA, KB, Low Pressure and High Pressure for the sample pressure sensor and modify them if necessary. 3. Check the values KA, KB, Low Pressure and High Pressure for the reagent pressure sensor and modify them if necessary.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
6 - 49
Troubleshooting Troubleshooting
2.4.1.3. To calibrate the pressure sensors 1. Go to Services > Customer Services > Cycles. 2. Press Reagent pressure calibration and wait until the calibration is finished. 3. Press Sample pressure calibration and wait until the calibration is finished.
2.4.2. Improving the hydraulic system airtightness
A
1. Remove the heat shrink tape (A). Disconnect the tubing from the water straw. Cut the tubing and reconnect it. Instead of doing that, you can replace the water straw assy ref. XBA568F (1209114568).
6 - 50
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Troubleshooting Troubleshooting
2. Check the inner water connection on the water / waste connection assembly (B).
B D 3. Disconnect the tubing from the water pump inlet (C). Cut the tubing, add a tube clamp ref. 3027030 (1223027030), reconnect the tubing and tighten the tube clamp. 4. Make sure that the tube clamp at the water pump outlet (D) is well-tightened.
C
5. Remove the collar ref. EAJ003A (1202261003) and disconnect the tubing from the internal water tank inlet (E). Cut the tubing, add a tube clamp ref. 3027030 (1223027030), reconnect the tubing and tighten the tube clamp.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
E
6 - 51
Troubleshooting Troubleshooting
6- If necessary, replace the filter located on the right-hand side, at the back of the instrument. Observe the fitting direction indicated by the arrow. Make sure that both tube clamps are well-tightened.
7. Make sure that no air bubbles are visible in the syringes and check for leaks. In case of problem, check the syringe plunger tips, the syringes and the manifold assembly (V1-V2).
If you are still having intermittent alarms #66 or #114, go to 2.4.3. Checking the sample needle throughput, page 6-52.
2.4.3. Checking the sample needle throughput Refer to the "RAS378: 6 month maintenance" procedure to check the sample needle throughput. In case of problem, check the sample needle (clogged, bent) and the manifold assembly (V1-V2).
If you are still having intermittent alarms #66 or #114, go to 2.4.4. Checking the water pump pressure, page 6-52.
2.4.4. Checking the water pump pressure Refer to the "RAS389: Waste and water pumps replacement" procedure to check the water pump pressure (2.1 bars +/- 0.1). In case of problem, check the filter and the water pump.
If you are still having intermittent alarms #66 or #114, go to 2.4.5. Replacing the pressure sensors and the pressure board, page 6-52.
2.4.5. Replacing the pressure sensors and the pressure board Refer to the "RAS442: Pressure sensors" procedure to replace the pressure sensors and the pressure board, adjust the pressure board voltage, and then, activate, configure and calibrate the pressure sensors.
6 - 52
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Troubleshooting Troubleshooting
2.5.
Other 2.5.1. Rejected cuvette segments Cause
Action
Use of cuvette segments non-approved by HORIBA Medical.
Use HORIBA Medical approved cuvette segments.
Re-used cuvette segments.
Cuvette segments are designed for single use only.
Lamp instability.
Check the lamp voltage (5.6 V). Change the lamp.
Dirty optical bench lenses.
Clean the optical bench lenses.
2.5.2. Not read or misread barcode Cause
Action
Bad adjustment of the barcode reader.
Readjust the barcode reader.
Bad barcode label.
Check the barcode label with the supplier.
2.5.3. No sound Cause
Action
Incompatible software version.
Install the latest higher software version.
Incompatible hardware.
Install the KIT, SOUND+USB UPDATE KIT P400.
Defective loudspeaker.
Check the loudspeaker connectors. Change the loudspeaker.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
6 - 53
Troubleshooting Troubleshooting
6 - 54
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Section 7: ISE module
1. ISE module description ................................................................................ 7 - 2 1.1. Measuring principle ...................................................................................................................7 - 2 1.2. Cycles description .....................................................................................................................7 - 6 1.3. ISE module status description .................................................................................................7 - 21 1.4. ISE module hydraulic diagram .................................................................................................7 - 22 1.5. Electric and electronic principles .............................................................................................7 - 24 1.6. ISE software description ..........................................................................................................7 - 28 1.7. Additional information ..............................................................................................................7 - 36
2. Error messages ........................................................................................... 7 - 38 3. Procedures .................................................................................................. 7 - 42 3.1. Maintenance by customers .....................................................................................................7 - 42 3.2. ISE 6 month maintenance ........................................................................................................7 - 42 3.3. ISE yearly maintenance ...........................................................................................................7 - 42 3.4. ISE procedure list ....................................................................................................................7 - 43 3.5. ISE maintenance check up summary ......................................................................................7 - 43 RAS441: ISE module installation RAS388: ISE module maintenance RAS537: ISE module check up after intervention RAS538: ISE module spare part replacement RAS539: Dummy PENTRA software use RAS540: ISE module software version installation
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
7-1
ISE module ISE module description
1. ISE module description 1.1.
Measuring principle
1.1.1. Measurement description The ISE module is designed to determine sodium, potassium and chloride concentrations in serum, plasma or urine samples. It uses three Ion Selective Electrodes (ISE) for the measurement of sodium, potassium and chloride concentrations and one reference electrode. The measurement principle is based on the interaction between moveable free ions in a sample solution and an active sensing unit (ion selective sensing electrode). An ion-selective membrane separates the sample solution, where the electrolyte concentration is unknown, from the electrode electrolyte, where the concentration is known. Potentiometry principle
Voltage measurement
Reference Electrode
Selective electrode (for the ion measured)
Electrolyte (known concentration)
Selective membrane
-
+
+
-
-
+
+
+
-
+
-
+
+
+
+
-
+
The membrane itself consists of a specific type of material which can react with one type of ions. Each ion selective electrode is equipped with a different type of membrane: ■ Sodium
electrode: a glass membrane selective to Na+ ions.
■ Potassium ■ Chloride
electrode: a PVC crown ether membrane which is selective to K+ ions.
electrode: a plastic membrane electrode selective to Cl- ions.
The four electrodes are compact and located in a Faraday cage to minimize the influence of electromagnetic fields. This electrode layout allows a simultaneous measurement of the Na+, K+ and Cl- concentration. The electrodes are supplied ready for use and no assembly is required.
7-2
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
ISE module ISE module description
Reference electrode
Sodium electrode
Sealing plug O-ring Electrode
Sealing plug O-ring Electrode
Electrolyte
Electrolyte
Electrode body
Electrode body
Reference tube Na tube with glass membrane
Waste tube O-ring
Sealing-ring
Potassium electrode
Chloride electrode
Sealing plug
Sealing plug
O-ring
O-ring
Electrode
Electrode
Electrolyte Electrolyte Electrode body Electrode body PVC crown ether membrane
Plastic membrane
O-ring
O-ring
The electrode membrane can bind a selective type of ions whereby a potential change appears at the membrane/sample boundary.
Membrane
Ion selective membrane
+
+ + +
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
+
+
+
+
+
Δ mV
+ +
+ + +
Sample
+
+ + +
7-3
ISE module ISE module description
In order to measure this potential change, a reference electrode with a fixed potential is immersed in the same solution. The potential of the reference electrode is kept fixed and constant, by filling it with an electrolyte that has a constant concentration. Sodium, potassium and chloride are measured on: ■ undiluted
serum and plasma samples: 60 µL of sample is pipetted by the sample needle and 50 µL is dispensed into the ISE module sample cup.
■ diluted
urine samples: 20 µL of sample is pipetted by the sample needle and 10 µL is dispensed and diluted with 60 µL of low standard directly into the ISE module sample cup.
A syringe is used to transport the required solution through the electrodes. The sample flows through the air sensor to reach the ISE block. The air detection by air sensor indicates the end of sample transfer from the sample cup to the ISE block. The reference solution flows through the reference electrode and merges with the sample downstream of the ISE block. The electrical potential is measured between each ion selective electrode and the reference electrode. This measured potential is proportional to the ion concentration. STD1 STD2 Low Waste
Syringe 1
Ref.
High
Syringe 2
REF
Ref Na
Cl
K
Air sensor
VOLTMETER
Cup
The potential values ascertained are amplified, digitized and finally sent via the RS232C serial interface to the instrument.
7-4
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
ISE module ISE module description
1.1.2. Calibration The calculation of the ion concentration in a sample solution is derivated from a calibration curve. When carrying out a calibration, the ion selective electrodes and the reference electrode are brought in contact with a series of solutions (standards) with known concentration. The voltages are recorded. The concentration of each standard is plotted against the measured voltage (in millivolts) on semi-logarithmic paper. The straight line drawn through these points is called a calibration curve.
mV
K+ = 37 to 67 mv/dec K+ ClNa = 38 to 65 mv/dec
Na
Cl- = -53 to -28 mv/dec
CONCENTRATION Std1 Std1 Std1
Std2
Std2 Std2
The electrical potential measured between these electrodes is proportional to the concentration of the specific ion, and can be described by the Nernst equation: E = E0 + S * log ai where: E: Measured potential between ion selective electrode and reference electrode E0: Standard potential of electrode assembly S: Electrode slope (Nernst factor) ai: Activity of measured ion The S slopes of the three electrodes are determined with two standard solutions of known concentration. The values are stored by the on board microprocessor system.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
7-5
ISE module ISE module description
1.2.
Cycles description
This chapter describes the ISE module cycles: ■ Global
initialization, page 7-7
■ Initialization
of the flow system, page 7-7
■ Two
point calibration, page 7-8
■ One
point calibration, page 7-10
■ Serum ■ Urine
measurement, page 7-11
measurement, page 7-13
■ Priming
of the flow system, page 7-14
■ Stabilization
of flow system, page 7-15
■ Draining,
page 7-16
■ Cleaning,
page 7-16
■ Wake
up, page 7-17
■ Keep
ready, page 7-17
■ Ready,
page 7-18
■ Activation, ■ Shut
page 7-18
down, page 7-19
■ Electrode
replacement, page 7-19
■ Standard
1 reagent check, page 7-19
■ Standard
2 reagent check, page 7-20
■ Reference ■ LB
reagent check, page 7-20
sensor check, page 7-21
The cycles described on the following pages correspond to the ISE software version V1.53 for the ABX Pentra 400 or V2.00 for the Pentra C400.
Caption Item Std1 Std2 R S1Mx S2Mx RM CSx SM UM S:x W:x
7-6
Definition ABX Pentra Standard 1, ref. A11A01717 ABX Pentra Standard 2, ref. A11A01718 ABX Pentra Reference 280 mL, ref. A11A01901 Measured potential of Standard 1 Measured potential of Standard 2 Measured potential of Reference solution Known concentration of Standard Measured concentration of sample (serum, plasma) Measured concentration of diluted sample (urine + Standard 1) ISE module status at the beginning and at the end of the cycle Warning
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
ISE module ISE module description
Global initialization
mV Initialization of flow system
Two point calibration
Std1/Std2/R
Std1/Std2
1
2
t S:6
S:0,1,2,3,4,5,6
1. The ISE module initializes the flow system (see Initialization of the flow system, page 7-7). 2. A two point calibration is run (see Two point calibration, page 7-8).
Initialization of the flow system
mV
Reagent detection
Rinsing (x4)
Rinsing (x4)
Rinsing
Std2
Std2
R Reagent detection + Keep condition in electrode
1
2
Rinsing (x6)
Rinsing
Rinsing
Std1
Std1
Std1
5
6
3
4
S:3,4,5,6
t S:5
1. Rinsing with Reference (4 times): Reference solution passes through the reference electrode then goes to waste. 2. Rinsing with Standard 2 (4 times): Standard 2 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, passes through the electrode then goes to waste. 3. Rinsing with Standard 1 (6 times): Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, passes through the electrode then goes to waste.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
7-7
ISE module ISE module description
4. Rinsing with Standard 2: Standard 2 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, detected by the LB sensor then goes to waste. During liquid check by the LB sensor, if Standard 2 is too much or not enough, warning #327 or #330 is triggered. The cycle is stopped. 5. Rinsing with Standard 1: Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, passes through the electrode then goes to waste. 6. Rinsing with Standard 1: Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, then aspirated in the electrode (keep condition). The end of the aliquot is detected by the LB sensor. During liquid check by the LB sensor, if Standard 1 is too much or not enough, warning #322 or #325 is triggered. The cycle is stopped.
Two point calibration A two point calibration determines a slope and an offset from a high and low solution with known concentrations. See Standards concentration, page 7-37. The slope and the offset are used to determine the patient sample concentration. Frequency: every 2 hours.
mV W:338 S2M1 W:335
W:338
W:337
W:337
S1M2 S1M1
S1M2
X6 max. Rinsing S1M3 Std1
1 S:4,5,6
2
3
4 3 sec.
5 3 sec.
S1M3
S1M3
X6 max. Rinsing Rinsing
X6 max.
Std1
Std1
6
7
8
S:6 or 4 (if 4 at the beginning)
1. First measurement of Standard 1 (S1M1): - Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, then aspirated in the electrode. The end of the aliquot is detected by the LB sensor. During liquid check by the LB sensor, if Standard 1 is too much or not enough, warning #322 or #325 is triggered. The cycle is stopped. - The potential of Standard 1 is measured. If the potential of S1M1 is out of range (see Range of normal values (Standard 1) triggering warning #336, page 7-37), warning #336 is triggered and the cycle is stopped. - Standard 1 goes to waste.
7-8
t
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
ISE module ISE module description
2. Second measurement of Standard 1 (S1M2): - Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, then aspirated in the electrode. The end of the aliquot is detected by the LB sensor. During liquid check by the LB sensor, if Standard 1 is too much or not enough, warning #322 or #325 is triggered. The cycle is stopped. - A second measurement of Standard 1 potential is run and compared with the first measurement (S1M1). If the difference in potential between S1M1 and S1M2 is out of range (see Repeatability normal range (Standard 1) triggering warning #337, page 7-37), S1M2 is rerun and the updated S1M2 is compared with S1M1 again. S1M2 is rerun maximum 6 times. If it is more than 6 times, warning #337 is triggered and the cycle is stopped. - Standard 1 goes to waste. 3. First measurement of Standard 2 (S2M1): - Standard 2 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, then aspirated in the electrode. The end of the aliquot is detected by the LB sensor. During liquid check by the LB sensor, if Standard 2 is too much or not enough, warning #327 or #330 is triggered. The cycle is skipped to the rescue cycle (see Two point calibration rescue cycle, page 7-10). - The potential of Standard 2 is measured. If the difference in potential during the last 3 seconds of measurement is ≥ 0.40 mV, warning #338 ("Calibration Error #1") is triggered. - Standard 2 goes to waste. 4. Rinsing with Standard 1: Standard 1 is dispensed into the sample cup, passes through the electrode then goes to waste. 5. Third measurement of Standard 1 (S1M3): - Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, then aspirated in the electrode. The end of the aliquot is detected by the LB sensor. During liquid check by the LB sensor, if Standard 1 is too much or not enough, warning #322 or #325 is triggered. The cycle is stopped. - A third measurement of Standard 1 potential is run and compared with the Standard 2 measurement (S2M1). If the difference in potential between S2M1 and S1M3 is out of range (see Sensitivity normal range (difference between Standard 1 and Standard 2) triggering warning #335, page 7-37), warning #335 is triggered and the rescue cycle is run (see Two point calibration rescue cycle, page 7-10). Then, the cycle is stopped. If the difference in potential during the last 3 seconds of measurement is ≥ 0.40 mV, warning #338 ("Calibration Error #1") is triggered. If the difference in potential between S1M2 and S1M3 is ≥ 0.40 mV, S1M3 is rerun and the updated S1M3 is compared with S1M2 again. S1M3 is rerun maximum 6 times. If it is more than 6 times, warning #337 is triggered. The slope in sensitive electrode is calculated from the values of the Standard 2 measurement (S2M1) and the third measurement of Standard 1 (S1M3): Slope = (S2M1-S1M3)/log ( CS2 ) CS1 Where: - S2M1 is the measured potential of Standard 2 - S1M3 is the measured potential of Standard 1 - CS2 is the known concentration of Standard 2 - CS1 is the known concentration of Standard 1 - Standard 1 goes to waste. 6. Rinsing with Standard 1: Standard 1 is dispensed into the sample cup, passes through the electrode then goes to waste.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
7-9
ISE module ISE module description
7. Rinsing with Standard 1: Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, then aspirated in the electrode. Standard 1 stays in the electrode (keep condition). 8. Third measurement of Standard 1 (S1M3): this measurement is rerun to check the correct functioning of the valves. The S1M3 is rerun maximum 6 times.
Two point calibration rescue cycle
mV Reagent detection Keep condition in electrode
Rinsing
Rinsing
Rinsing
Std1
Std1
Std1
1
2
3
t
1. Rinsing with Standard 1: Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, passes through the electrode then goes to waste. 2. Rinsing with Standard 1: Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, then aspirated in the electrode. The end of the aliquot is detected by the LB sensor. Standard 1 goes to waste. During liquid check by the LB sensor, if Standard 1 is too much or not enough, warning #322 or #325 is triggered. The cycle is stopped. 3. Rinsing with Standard 1: Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, then aspirated in the electrode. Standard 1 stays in the electrode (keep condition).
One point calibration A one point calibration monitors the electrodes stability by passing Standard 1 through the electrode. Frequency: every 15 minutes except when patient or control samples have to be run.
mV W:338
Reagent detection
W:337
Keep condition in electrode
S1M2
S1M
X6 max. Rinsing Std1
1 S:4,5,6
S1M1
Rinsing Std1
2
3 3 sec.
t
S:identical to the initial status
1. Rinsing with Standard 1: Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, passes through the electrode then goes to waste.
7 - 10
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
ISE module ISE module description
2. First measurement of Standard 1 (S1M1): - Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, then aspirated in the electrode. The end of the aliquot is detected by the LB sensor. During liquid check by the LB sensor, if Standard 1 is too much or not enough, warning #322 or #325 is triggered. The cycle is stopped. - The potential of Standard 1 is measured. If the difference in potential between S1M1 and the previous S1M is out of range (see Repeatability normal range (Standard 1) triggering warning #337, page 7-37), a second measurement of Standard 1 is run (S1M2) and the updated S1M2 is compared with S1M1. S1M2 is run maximum 6 times. If it is more than 6 times, warning #337 is triggered. The cycle is stopped. If the difference in potential during the last 3 seconds of measurement is ≥ 0.40 mV, warning #338 ("Calibration Error #1") is triggered. - Standard 1 goes to waste. 3. Rinsing with Standard 1: Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, then aspirated in the electrode. Standard 1 stays in the electrode (keep condition).
Serum measurement
mV
W:338
SM Serum/Plasma (50 µL) Reagent detection + Keep condition in electrode
W:338
Rinsing S1M1
1 S:6
Std1
Std1
2
3
3 sec.
t 3 sec. S:6
1. Sample measurement: - 60 µL of sample (serum, plasma) is pipetted by the sample needle and 50 µL is dispensed into the ISE sample cup. - The sample is aspirated in the electrode. The end of the aliquot is detected by the LB sensor. During liquid check by the LB sensor, if sample is too much or not enough, warning #331 or #334 is triggered. The cycle is skipped to the rescue cycle (see Serum measurement rescue cycle, page 7-12). - The sample concentration is measured. If the difference in potential during the last 3 seconds of measurement is ≥ 0.40 mV, warning #338 ("ISE Error") is triggered. - Sample goes to waste.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
7 - 11
ISE module ISE module description
2. Rinsing with Standard 1: Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, passes through the electrode then goes to waste. 3. Measurement of Standard 1 (S1M1): - Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, then aspirated in the electrode. The end of the aliquot is detected by the LB sensor. During liquid check by the LB sensor, if Standard 1 is too much or not enough, warning #322 or #325 is triggered. The cycle is stopped. - The potential of Standard 1 is measured. If the difference in potential during the last 3 seconds of measurement is ≥ 0.40 mV, warning #338 ("ISE Error") is triggered. The sample concentration is calculated from the values of the measured concentration of sample (SM), the measured potential of Standard 1 (S1M) and the slope obtained in the two point calibration. Dilution concentration = CS1 x 10^((SM-S1M)/Slope) Where: - SM is the measured concentration of sample - S1M is the measured potential of Standard 1 - Slope comes from the two point calibration - CS1 is the known concentration of Standard 1 - Standard 1 stays in the electrode (keep condition).
Serum measurement rescue cycle
mV
Reagent detection + Keep condition in electrode
S1M
W:337 S1M2 X6 max.
S1M
1
t
1. Measurement of Standard 1 (S1M): - Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, then aspirated in the electrode. The end of the aliquot is detected by the LB sensor. During liquid check by the LB sensor, if Standard 1 is too much or not enough, warning #322 or #325 is triggered. The cycle is stopped. - The potential of Standard 1 is measured. If the difference in potential between the current S1M and the previous S1M is ≥ 0.40 mV, the rescue cycle is rerun (max. 6 times) after updating the previous S1M to the current S1M. If it is more than 6 times, warning #337 is triggered. The cycle is stopped. - Standard 1 stays in the electrode (keep condition).
7 - 12
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
ISE module ISE module description
Urine measurement
mV
W:338
UM Urine (10 µL)
+ Std1 (60 µL) Reagent detection + Keep condition in electrode
W:338 Rinsing
Rinsing
Std1
Std1
1 S:6
3
2 3 sec.
Rinsing Rinsing S1M1 Std1 Std1
4
5
6
t 3 sec. S:6
1. Rinsing with Standard 1: Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, passes through the electrode then goes to waste. 2. Sample measurement: - 60 µL of Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup. An air bubble is created (LV6 commutation and small aspiration by syringe 1). Then, LV6 commutes and Standard 1 is dispensed (through the top connector) into the ISE sample cup. This cycle will avoid contamination between Standard 1 and mixing solution. - 20 µL of sample (urine) is pipetted by the sample needle. 10 µL is dispensed into the ISE sample cup and diluted with Standard 1. - The sample is aspirated in the electrode. The end of the aliquot is detected by the LB sensor. During liquid check by the LB sensor, if sample is too much or not enough, warning #331 or #334 is triggered. The cycle is skipped to the rescue cycle (see Urine measurement rescue cycle, page 7-14). - The sample concentration is measured. If the difference in potential during the last 3 seconds of measurement is ≥ 0.40 mV, warning #338 ("ISE Error") is triggered. - Sample goes to waste. 3. Rinsing with Standard 1: Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup (from the LV6- inlet 3 to the middle inlet of the ISE sample cup), passes through the electrode then goes to waste. 4. Rinsing with Standard 1: Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup (from the LV6- inlet 1 to the upper inlet at the back of the ISE sample cup), passes through the electrode then goes to waste. 5. Rinsing with Standard 1: Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup (from the LV6- inlet 3 to the middle inlet of the ISE sample cup), passes through the electrode then goes to waste.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
7 - 13
ISE module ISE module description
6. Measurement of Standard 1 (S1M1): - Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, then aspirated in the electrode. The end of the aliquot is detected by the LB sensor. - The potential of Standard 1 is measured. If the difference in potential during the last 3 seconds of measurement is ≥ 0.40 mV, warning #338 ("ISE Error") is triggered. The sample concentration is calculated from the values of the measured concentration of diluted sample (UM), the measured potential of Standard 1 (S1M) and the slope obtained in the two point calibration. Dilution concentration = CS1 x 10^((UM-S1M)/Slope) then, Concentration = 7 x Dilution concentration - 6 x S1M Where: - UM is the measured concentration of the diluted sample - S1M is the measured potential of Standard 1 - Slope obtained from the two point calibration - CS1 is the known concentration of Standard 1 - Standard 1 stays in the electrode (keep condition).
Urine measurement rescue cycle
mV
Reagent detection + Keep condition in electrode
S1M
W:337 S1M2 X6 max.
S1M
1
t
1. Measurement of Standard 1 (S1M): - Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, then aspirated in the electrode. The end of the aliquot is detected by the LB sensor. During liquid check by the LB sensor, if Standard 1 is too much or not enough, warning #322 or #325 is triggered. The cycle is stopped. - The potential of Standard 1 is measured. If the difference in potential between the current S1M and the previous S1M is ≥ 0.40 mV, the rescue cycle is rerun (max. 6 times) after updating the previous S1M to the current S1M. If it is more than 6 times, warning #337 is triggered. The cycle is stopped. - Standard 1 stays in the electrode (keep condition).
Priming of the flow system The priming of the flow system cycle is the same as the initialization of the flow system (see Initialization of the flow system, page 7-7). The only difference is that the ISE module status is at the beginning 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 6 and at the end identical to the initial status.
7 - 14
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
ISE module ISE module description
Stabilization of flow system
mV Rinsing
Rinsing
R
Std2 Reagent detection
Rinsing
Rinsing Rinsing
Std1
1
2
3
Reagent detection + Keep condition in electrode
Rinsing Rinsing
Std1
Std1
Std1
Std1
4
5
6
7
S:4,5,6
t S:5
1. Rinsing with Reference: Reference solution passes through the reference electrode then goes to waste. 2. Rinsing with Standard 1: Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, passes through the electrode then goes to waste. 3. Rinsing with Standard 2: Standard 2 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, passes through the electrode then goes to waste. 4. Rinsing with Standard 1: Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, passes through the electrode then goes to waste. 5. Rinsing with Standard 1: Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, then aspirated in the electrode. The end of the aliquot is detected by the LB sensor. Standard 1 goes to waste. 6. Rinsing with Standard 1: Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, passes through the electrode then goes to waste. 7. Rinsing with Standard 1: Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, then aspirated in the electrode (keep condition). The end of the aliquot is detected by the LB sensor. During liquid check by the LB sensor, if Standard 1 is too much or not enough, warning #322 or #325 is triggered. The cycle is stopped.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
7 - 15
ISE module ISE module description
Draining
mV Rinsing (x6) Rinsing (x4)
Std2
R
Rinsing (x6) Std1
1
3
2
S:3,4,5,6
t S:3
1. Rinsing Reference (4 times): Reference solution passes through the reference electrode then goes to waste. 2. Rinsing with Standard 2 (6 times): Standard 2 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, passes through the electrode then goes to waste. 3. Rinsing wih Standard 1 (6 times): Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, passes through the electrode then goes to waste.
Cleaning
mV Cleaning Cleaning solution
Reagent detection twice + Waste Rinsing Std2
(80 µL)
Reagent detection + Keep condition in electrode 4 times Rinsing Std1
1 S:4,5,6
2
3
t S:identical to the initial status
1. Cleaning with cleaning solution: 80 µL of cleaning solution is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, then aspirated in the electrode for cleaning. The end of the aliquot is detected by the LB sensor. Then, it goes to waste. During liquid check by the LB sensor, if the cleaning solution is too much or not enough, warning #331 or #334 is triggered. The cycle is skipped to step 2.
7 - 16
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
ISE module ISE module description
2. Standard 2 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, then aspirated in the electrode (keep condition). The end of the aliquot is detected by the LB sensor. Then, it goes to waste. (twice) During liquid check by the LB sensor, if Standard 2 is too much or not enough, warning #327 or #330 is triggered. The cycle is stopped. 3. Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, then aspirated in the electrode (keep condition). The end of the aliquot is detected by the LB sensor. (4 times) During liquid check by the LB sensor, if Standard 1 is too much or not enough, warning #322 or #325 is triggered. The cycle is stopped.
Wake up
mV Stabilization of flow system
Two point calibration
R/Std2/Std1
Std1/Std2
1
2
t S:6
S:4,5,6
1. The ISE module stabilizes the flow system (see Stabilization of flow system, page 7-15). 2. A two point calibration is run (see Two point calibration, page 7-8).
Keep ready When the instrument is shut down and to keep the electrodes stability, the ISE module runs the "Keep ready" cycle to ensure reagent transfer at electrodes level. Frequency: every 15 minutes (can be modified by the user, see ISE calibration setting, page 7-30).
mV Reagent detection Keep condition in electrode
Rinsing
Rinsing
Std1
Std1
1
2
S:4,5,6
t S:4
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
7 - 17
ISE module ISE module description
1. Rinsing with Standard 1: Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, then aspirated in the electrode. The end of the aliquot is detected by the LB sensor. Standard 1 goes to waste. During liquid check by the LB sensor, if Standard 1 is too much or not enough, warning #322 or #325 is triggered. The cycle is stopped. 2. Rinsing with Standard 1: Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, then aspirated in the electrode. Standard 1 stays in the electrode (keep condition).
Ready When the instrument is in operation and to keep the electrodes stability, the ISE module runs the "Ready" cycle to ensure reagent transfer at electrodes level. Frequency: every 5 minutes (can be modified by the user, see ISE calibration setting, page 7-30).
mV Reagent detection Keep condition in electrode
Rinsing
Rinsing
Std1
Std1
1
2
S:6
t S:6
1. Rinsing with Standard 1: Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, then aspirated in the electrode. The end of the aliquot is detected by the LB sensor. Standard 1 goes to waste. During liquid check by the LB sensor, if Standard 1 is too much or not enough, warning #322 or #325 is triggered. The cycle is stopped. 2. Rinsing with Standard 1: Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, then aspirated in the electrode. Standard 1 stays in the electrode (keep condition).
Activation The activation cycle consists in running one serum or plasma sample to condition electrodes.
mV Detection + Keep condition in electrode + Waste Sample
Reagent detection Keep condition in electrode
(50 µL)
Rinsing Rinsing Rinsing Std1 Std1 Std1
1 S:4,5,6
7 - 18
2
3
4
t S:identical to initial status
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
ISE module ISE module description
1. 60 µL of sample (serum, plasma) is pipetted by the sample needle and 50 µL of serum or plasma sample is dispensed into the ISE sample cup. Sample is detected by the LB sensor, stays in the electrode (keep condition) then goes to waste. During liquid check by the LB sensor, if sample is too much or not enough, warning #331 or #334 is triggered. The cycle is skipped to step 2. 2. Rinsing with Standard 1: Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, passes through the electrode then goes to waste. 3. Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, then aspirated in the electrode. The end of the aliquot is detected by the LB sensor. Standard 1 goes to waste. During liquid check by the LB sensor, if Standard 1 is too much or not enough, warning #322 or #325 is triggered. The cycle is stopped. 4. Rinsing with Standard 1: Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, then aspirated in the electrode. Standard 1 stays in the electrode (keep condition).
Shut down
mV
Keep condition in electrode Rinsing R
Rinsing Std1
1 S:3,4,5,6
2
t S:3
1. Rinsing with Reference: Reference solution passes through Reference electrode then goes to waste. 2. Rinsing with Standard 1: Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, then aspirated in the electrode. Standard 1 stays in the electrode (keep condition).
Electrode replacement
mV Waste Std1
1
t
S:3,4,5,6 S:Not applicable 1. Standard 1, present in electrode, goes to waste.
Standard 1 reagent check
mV S1M 1
t
S:3,4,5,6 S:3 or 4
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
7 - 19
ISE module ISE module description
1. Measurement of Standard 1 (S1M): - Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, then aspirated in the electrode. The end of the aliquot is detected by the LB sensor. During liquid check by the LB sensor, if Standard 1 is too much or not enough, warning #322 or #325 is triggered. The cycle is stopped. - The potential of Standard 1 is measured.
Standard 2 reagent check
mV S2M
1
t
S:3,4,5,6 S:3 or 4 1. Measurement of Standard 2 (S2M): - Standard 2 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, then aspirated in the electrode. The end of the aliquot is detected by the LB sensor. During liquid check by the LB sensor, if Standard 2 is too much or not enough, warning #327 or #330 is triggered. The cycle is stopped. - The potential of Standard 2 is measured.
Reference reagent check
mV RM
1
t
S:3,4,5,6 S:3 or 4 1. Measurement of Reference (RM): - Reference solution is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, then aspirated into the reference electrode. The end of the aliquot is detected by the LB sensor. During liquid check by the LB sensor, if Reference is too much or not enough, warning #331 or #334 is triggered. The cycle is stopped. - The potential of Reference solution is measured.
7 - 20
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
ISE module ISE module description
LB sensor check
mV
LB sensor detection + Keep condition in electrode Std1
1
t
S:3,4,5,6 S:3 or 4 1. Standard 1 is dispensed into the ISE sample cup, then aspirated in the electrode. The end of the aliquot is detected by the LB sensor. If the LB Sensor cannot detect "ON" or "OFF", warning #322 or #325 is triggered.
1.3.
ISE module status description
The ISE module exists in seven different statuses. While the instrument is running, the status of the ISE module is displayed in the ISE tab. Go to Services > Customer Services > ISE. The status from 0 to 6 of the ISE module are described in the following table: Code 0 1 2 3 4 5 6
Description Module not initialized Module initialized Module configured Mechanical part initialized Module sleeping Fluidic part initialized Module calibrated
In correct working order, the ISE module evolves sequentially from status 0 to 6, thus from the instrument start up (Power ON) to the calibrated module achievement, ready for the analyses.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
7 - 21
ISE module ISE module description
1.4.
ISE module hydraulic diagram
This diagram is available in the form of a sticker to be stuck on the inside of the ISE cover: STICKER, ISE HYDRAULIC HAX0271 (1207230271).
Mark on diagram 0.76-xxx 1.52-xxx 1.5/2.5 ISOLATOR
7 - 22
P/n EAE003A* EAE007A* EAB015A (1202211015) XCA167A (1209121167)
Designation TUBING, TYGON 0.762 (0.030) TUBING, TYGON 1.52 (0.060) FITTING, STRAIGHT 2.5/1.5 CHAMBER, ISOLATOR (SMALL)
Sales unit * * Pack of 5 1
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
ISE module ISE module description
Mark on diagram Air sensor Na+ ClK+ Ref LV1, LV2, LV3, LV4 LV5, LV6 E1
P/n GBM0746 (3014029452) A11A01738 A11A01739 A11A01740 A11A01741 XBA635AS (1209119635) XBA544C (1209113544) EBA018A (1202351018) EBA017A (1202351017) XBA733AS (1209119733) EAB013A (1202211013) GBM1266 (1203601266) GBM0751 (1203600751) GBM0750 (1203600750)
Designation FLUID, ISE AIR DETECT.ELECTRODE ABX PENTRA SODIUM-E ABX PENTRA CHLORIDE-E ABX PENTRA POTASSIUM-E ABX PENTRA REFERENCE-E VALVE, ISE VALVE VALVE, ISE VALVE ASSY VALVE, LV5 VALVE ISE VALVE, LV6 VALVE ISE VALVE, ISE MIXCUP VALVE ASSY FITTING, STRAIGHT 3.1/2.3 CLEAR FLUID, ISE REF.BLUE STRAW 300 ML FLUID, ISE 300 ML BOTTLE STRAW FLUID, ISE 100 ML BOTTLE STRAW
Sales unit 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
* Possible to order under the following references: - EAE003AS (1202249003) (2 metres) - EAE007AS (1202249007) (2 metres)
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
7 - 23
ISE module ISE module description
1.5.
Electric and electronic principles
1.5.1. ISE mother board XAA492CS (1209109492) To ISE syringe motor 1/150 sensor To ISE syringe motor 1/75 sensor To ISE preampli board To Valve block
To ISE syringe motor 1/75
To ISE syringe motor 1/150
Fuse
To power supply
To the analyzer
To ISE software board
1.5.2. ISE preampli board XAA496C (3200092606)
To Reference electrode TP3 To Reference electrode
To Na electrode
To Cl electrode
To ISE mother board
TP2
To K electrode
7 - 24
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
ISE module ISE module description
1.5.3. ISE software board ISE software board CPU-03N XAA497E (3200448459) for ABX Pentra 400 only
ISE software board CPU-07N XAA646A (3200375620) for Pentra C400 only
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
7 - 25
ISE module ISE module description
1.5.4. Electric circuit configuration ISE preampli board
ISE mother board ISE software board
LP-PRE-01
LP-CNT-03
CPU-03N (P400) / CPU-07N (PC400)
Reference electrode
Amplifier
Na electrode
Amplifier
Peripheral control circuit
RS-232C-2 MPX AD converter
Cl electrode
K electrode
LB sensor
RS232
Signal isolator
Amplifier Liquid Valve bulb unit drive circuit
Liquid Valve bulb unit
Syringe-1 drive circuit
Syringe-1
Syringe-2 drive circuit
Syringe-2
Amplifier
Amplifier
(DC 5 V)
(DC 5 V)
DC/DC converter Power supply (DC24V) DC/DC converter
7 - 26
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Electrodes
Valves
ISE preampli board
Valves
ISE syringe motor 1/75 sensor
ISE syringe motor 1/75
ISE syringe motor 1/150 sensor
ISE syringe motor 1/150
ISE mother board
ISE software board
To power supply
To the analyzer
ISE module ISE module description
1.5.5. ISE module wiring diagram
7 - 27
ISE module ISE module description
1.6.
ISE software description
To minimize environmental interferences, the ISE module cover must always be closed during ISE module operation.
1.6.1. ISE module status presentation The ISE Module Status button, located on the main menu, allows the user to check the ISE module status.
ABX Pentra 400
ISE Module Status button
Pentra C400
ISE Module Status button
7 - 28
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
ISE module ISE module description
This button aspect changes according to the ISE module status:
ISE module is available and calibrations are finished.
ISE module is busy (calibration, cleaning, measurement, etc.).
Error on calibrations. A calibration needs to be ordered. See ISE calibration screens, page 7-29.
Error on ISE module (mechanical, fluidic, etc.). A global initialization needs to be ordered. See ISE customer services screen, page 7-30.
ISE module not initialized. ISE module needs to be activated. See ISE customer services screen, page 7-30.
1.6.2. ISE customer screens ISE calibration screens ■ ISE calibration Press the ISE Module Status button to open the ISE module status screen. The ISE module status screen displays the last results of chloride, potassium and sodium calibrations. The Calibrate button allows the user to perform a 2-point calibration. To know the expected values of the slope and the sensitivity for each electrode, refer to 1.7.2. NA, K, CL normal range, page 7-37.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
7 - 29
ISE module ISE module description
■ ISE calibration setting The ISE Calibration tab allows the user to configure the 2-point and 1-point calibrations frequency as well as the Keep ready and Ready functions. Go to Calibration > Control > ISE Calibration. For more detailed information, refer to the "Calibration and Control Configuration" chapter of your user manual.
ISE customer services screen The ISE tab allows the user to activate electrodes, stop ISE cycle, change electrodes, run a fluidic initialization, stabilize fluidic system, prime the flow system, drain the reagents, run a global initalization, run a mechanical initialization, shut down the ISE module, run cleaning cycles (etching, cleaning) and ISE module activation. Moreover, the ISE tab allows the user to perform ISE automatic maintenance. Go to Services > Customer Services > ISE.
A
B
C
D
E
Fig.7-1: ISE tab 7 - 30
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
ISE module ISE module description
■ Activated electrode (Fig.7-1-A): Activates/inactivates the three electrodes: Chloride, Potassium, Sodium. If the check box is selected, the electrode is activated.
An electrode cannot be inactivated if there are ISE tests for this electrode in the worklist or for validation.
■ Stop ISE cycle: Stops the ISE module immediately (without user confirmation). Then, the user must initialize the ISE module by pressing the Global Initialization key. The Stop ISE cycle key is enabled only if the ISE module is occupied.
■ Change electrode: Helps the user to replace an electrode. The ISE module drains the reagents from the electrodes to allow the user to replace the electrode. The ISE module will be stabilized in status 4. The Change electrode key is enabled only if the ISE module is not occupied and its status ≥ 3. ■ Fluidic
Initialization: Primes the reagents into the fluidic system. This function should be used after the ISE reagents replacement or an ISE shutdown (complete stop of the ISE module) exceeding three days. The Fluidic Initialization key is enabled only if the ISE module is not occupied and its status ≥ 3.
■ Stabilization of Fluidic system: Rinses the fluidic system out. This function should be used to rinse the fluidic system out or eliminate air bubbles in the fluidic system. The Stabilization of Fluidic system key is enabled only if the ISE module is not occupied and its status ≥ 4. ■ Prime flow system: Primes the reagents into the fluidic system. This function should be used to prime the reagents into the fluidic system at the ISE module installation. The Prime flow system key is enabled only if the ISE module is not occupied and its status ≥ 5. ■ Drain: Drains the reagents from the fluidic system. This function should be used for an ISE shutdown (complete stop of the ISE module) exceeding three days or the system transportation. The Drain key is enabled only if the ISE module is not occupied and its status ≥ 3. ■ Global
Initialization: Initializes the ISE module. The Global Initialization key is enabled only if the ISE module is not occupied.
■ Mechanical Initialization: Checks the syringe movement and sets the syringes to their initial position. The Mechanical Initialization key is enabled only if the ISE module is not occupied and its status ≥ 2.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
7 - 31
ISE module ISE module description
■ Shutdown:
ISE shutdown (complete stop of the ISE module) exceeding three days. See 1.6.3. ISE module shutdown, page 7-32. Fills the electrodes with low standard and air to prevent the contamination of the reference solution. The Shutdown key is enabled only if the ISE module is not occupied and its status ≥ 3. ■ ISE cleaning Solution (Fig.7-1-B): Allows the user to perform etching and cleaning of the ISE module.
■ ISE
activation (Fig.7-1-C): Runs one serum or plasma sample to condition the electrodes. This function should be used after the ISE module cleaning and/or etching. This function is disabled if the ISE module is occupied.
■ ISE
automatic maintenance (Fig.7-1-D): Helps the user to perform the ISE module weekly maintenance (cleaning, etching, activation and 2-point calibration). For more detailed information, please refer to the instrument user manual.
■ ISE Status window (Fig.7-1-E): Displays the ISE status. See 1.3. ISE module status description, page 7-21.
1.6.3. ISE module shutdown Shutdown within 3 days
ISE reagents running dry can damage the electrodes. Ensure that there is always enough ISE reagents to perform the ISE module calibrations.
■ Go
to Services > Customer Services > ISE.
■ First,
make sure that the ISE module status is ≥ 3 (A). If not, press Global Initialization (B).
■ Press
Shutdown (C).
■ Switch
the instrument off. B C
7 - 32
A
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
ISE module ISE module description
Shutdown over 3 days ■ Go
to Services > Customer Services > ISE.
■ First,
make sure that the ISE module status is ≥ 3 (A). If not, press Global Initialization (B).
■ Remove the straws from the reagent bottles
and wrap them in absorbent paper. ■ Close
the reagent bottles with caps.
B A
After opening, ISE reagents are stable for one month if stored at 5-30°C and protected from light.
■ Press
Drain (C).
■ Plunge
the straws into a distilled water bottle and press Fluidic Initialization (D).
■ Remove
the straws from the distilled water bottle and wrap them in absorbent paper.
■ Press
Drain (C).
■ Switch
D C
the instrument off.
■ Remove
the electrodes and the air sensor from the cage. - For the sodium, chloride and potassium electrodes as well as for the air sensor, ensure there is no liquid in the inner tube. - For the reference electrode, connect a tubing filled with reference solution between the two connectors and seal the inner tube with a cellophane tape.
Store the electrodes in a dry and clean area in their original packaging.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
7 - 33
ISE module ISE module description
Electrodes reinstallation after a shutdown over 3 days ■ Reinstall
the electrodes and the air sensor into the cage. - For the reference electrode, disconnect the tubing between the two connectors and remove the cellophane tape from the inner tube. - For all electrodes, make sure that the O-ring is well-positioned on one side of the electrode and make sure that the electrode is clean. - Install the electrodes.
■ Close
the ISE door and tighten the screw.
■ Plunge
the straws into the reagent bottles.
■ Switch
the instrument on.
1.6.4. Diagnostics screen The ISE diagnostics screen allows you to: ■ Run
a global check, a global initialization, a data initialization, a mechanical initialization.
■ Calibrate ■ Check ■ Clean ■ Keep
electrodes low and high levels.
the sample detection, the syringes 1 and 2, the valves, the LB sensor.
the ISE module. ready.
■ Prime
the flow system.
■ Purge
the ISE module.
Go to Services > Diagnostics > ISE.
To use those functions, select the corresponding option and press Check. If the function is correct, the corresponding light becomes green. ■ Global Check: Checks all the elements of the ISE module for example the mechanical movement of the syringes and valves. This command is a batch of "Standard 1", "Standard 2", "Sample Detection", "Needle 1 Liquid Aspiration", "Needle 2 Liquid Aspiration", "Valve Check", "LB Sensor", "Cleaning", and "Keep ready" functions.
7 - 34
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
ISE module ISE module description
■ Standard 1 and Standard 2: Performs a measurement of each electrode using the Standard 1 or the Standard 2 solution.
■ Sample
Detection: Checks the correct functioning of the sample detection.
■ Needle 1 Liquid Aspiration: Checks the syringe 1 (Std 1 + Waste) complete movement.
■ Needle 2 Liquid Aspiration: Checks the syringe 2 (Std 2 + Reference) complete movement.
■ Valve
Check: Checks the liquid valves movement (open then close the four valves).
■ LB Sensor: Checks the correct detection between air and liquid.
■ Cleaning: Commands ISE module cleaning.
■ Keep ready: Maintains liquid (Standard 1) in the fluidic system during the shutdown.
■ Global
Initialization: Initialization of the system, which is a batch of "Request status" (sets status, the instrument obtains the current status), "Request Data" (sets data, the instrument obtains the current data), "Mechanical System Initialization", "Prime flow system" (primes the reagent into the fluidic system; rinses the distilled/ deionized water into the fluidic system) and "Two point calibration" functions. ■ Data
Initilization: Initialization of the ISE module data.
■ Mechanical
System Initialization: Checks the syringe movements and sets the syringes to their initial position.
■ Prime flow system: Primes the reagent into the fluidic system.
■ Purge
ISE Module: Purges the fluidic system. Prepares the ISE module for transportation.
If a function is used (except Cleaning cycle), you must run a Global Initialization before leaving this menu.
■ Messages:
Displays the ISE error messages of previous tests (see 2. Error messages, page 7-38).
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
7 - 35
ISE module ISE module description
1.7.
Additional information
1.7.1. ISE module reagents consumption The reagents consumption calculation is based on a basic ISE module working day (24 hours) which includes: - 1 ISE module wake up - 90 measurements on serum - 10 measurements on urine - 12 x 2 point calibrations (every 2 hours) - 16 x 1 point calibrations (every 15 minutes in 4 hours, instrument working) - 32 x Ready cycles (every 5 minutes in 4 hours, instrument working) - 80 x Keep ready cycles (every 15 minutes in 20 hours, instrument sleeping) - 2 cleaning cycles (at the beginning and the end of the day) - 0.1 x prime flow system cycle (reagents exchange)
Reagent consumption at each cycle (mL) Cycle Wake up Measure serum Measure urine Two point calibration One point calibration Keep ready Ready Cleaning Prime flow system
Standard 1 1.12 0.14 0.32 0.41 0.21 0.15 0.15 0.29 2.79
Standard 2 0.48 0.00 0.00 0.05 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.26 2.23
Reference 0.75 0.08 0.10 0.19 0.05 0.05 0.05 0.32 1.92
Total consumption
Daily consumption (mL/day) Weekly consumption (mL/week) Bottle volume (mL)
7 - 36
Standard 1 42.6 297.9 280.0
Standard 2 1.9 13.4 100.0
Reference 18.4 129.1 100.0
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
ISE module ISE module description
1.7.2. NA, K, CL normal range Range of normal values (Standard 1) triggering warning #336 NA: -100 to 100 mv K: -100 to 100 mv CL: -50 to 150 mv
Sensitivity normal range (difference between Standard 1 and Standard 2) triggering warning #335 NA: 8.5 to 14.4 mv K: 9 to 16.3 mv CL: 5 to 9.4 mv
Repeatability normal range (Standard 1) triggering warning #337 NA: 0.2 mv K: 0.3 mv CL: 0.2 mv
Slope normal range (for ISE V2) NA: 38 to 65 mv K: 37 to 67 mv CL: -53 to -28 mv
Standards concentration
NA: K: CL:
Standard 1 120 meq 4 meq 100 meq
Standard 2 200 meq 7 meq 150 meq
1.7.3. Automatic cycle frequency Cycle Two point calibration One point calibration Ready Keep ready
Condition Executed every 2 hours (except when the instrument is shut down) Executed every 15 minutes (except when the instrument is shut down) Executed every 5 minutes (only when the instrument is running) Executed every 15 minutes (only when the instrument is shut down)
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
7 - 37
ISE module Error messages
2. Error messages System warnings and alarms are listed in the table on the following pages. 1. Warnings Warnings are triggered to warn the user but are not blocking the instrument. They are displayed on the Warning tab of the System Warnings menu. When a warning is triggered, the instrument is not stopped but turns to "Ready" status. If a warning appears, follow the instructions given in the table on the following pages. 2. Alarms Alarms are blocking the instrument. They are displayed on the Alarm tab of the System Warnings menu.
The Alarm tab is re-set at each start. To access the previous alarms, press CTRL + F8.
When an alarm is triggered, the instrument is stopped and turns to "Emergency Stop" status. If an alarm appears, follow the instructions given in the table on the following pages.
7 - 38
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Code 001
060
061
318
319
320
321
322
323
324
Level Warning
Warning
Warning
Warning
Warning
Warning
Warning
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Warning
Warning
Warning
Too much ISE low solution inlet (error code 23)
Can’t detect ISE low solution inlet (error code 22)
Can’t detect ISE low solution (error code 21)
Position error on ISE syringe 2 (error code 12)
Timeout error on ISE syringe 2 (error code 11)
Position error on ISE syringe 1 (error code 2)
Timeout error on ISE syringe 1 (error code 1)
Action Check the ISE module connections and fuse. Shut down and switch the instrument off and on. Change the ISE mother board. Shut down and switch the instrument off and on. Change the ISE mother board. Check the ISE syringe 1 assy motion. ISE syringe 1 assy (Standard 1/waste) home Check the voltage of the home sensor on the ISE position is not reached on time. mother board: CN6 Pin2-3 (home position 0 V, other ISE module status is 2 = module configured. 5 V). Check the ISE syringe 1 assy motion. ISE syringe 1 assy (Standard 1/waste) home Check the voltage of the home sensor on the ISE position is not reached. mother board: CN6 Pin2-3 (home position 0 V, other ISE module status is 2 = module configured. 5 V). Check the ISE syringe 2 assy motion. ISE syringe 2 assy (Reference/Standard 2) home Check the voltage of the home sensor on the ISE position is not reached on time. mother board: CN4 Pin2-3 (home position 0 V, other ISE module status is 2 = module configured. 5 V). Check the ISE syringe 2 assy motion. ISE syringe 2 assy (Reference/Standard 2) home Check the voltage of the home sensor on the ISE position is not reached. mother board: CN4 Pin2-3 (home position 0 V, other ISE module status is 2 = module configured. 5 V). ISE module reagent/fluidic error. LB sensor Check the ISE Standard 1 bottle, hydraulic circuit. cannot detect Standard 1. The LB sensor Check the valve V4 and readjust the LB sensor. measurement is > 4.5 V (air). Run an ISE Global Initialization. ISE module status is 4 = module sleeping. ISE module reagent/fluidic error. LB sensor Check the ISE Standard 1 bottle, hydraulic circuit. cannot detect the arriving of Standard 1. The LB Check the valve V4 and readjust the LB sensor. sensor measurement is > 4.5 V (air). Run an ISE Global Initialization. ISE module status is 4 = module sleeping. ISE module reagent/fluidic error. LB sensor Check the ISE Standard 1 bottle, hydraulic circuit. detects Standard 1. The LB sensor measurement Check the valve V4 and readjust the LB sensor. is < 1 V (liquid). Run an ISE Global Initialization. ISE module status is 4 = module sleeping.
Message Error type ISE Module Initialization Problem Instrument/ISE module communication failed. Non recoverable material error on the Triggered by the ISE mother board. ISE module The used ISE function cannot be performed. ISE command invalid Triggered by the ISE mother board.
ISE module Error messages
7 - 39
7 - 40
332
333
Warning
329
Warning
Warning
328
Warning
331
327
Warning
Warning
326
Warning
330
325
Warning
Warning
Code
Level
Error type ISE module reagent/fluidic error. LB sensor still detects Standard 1 flow after the aspiration ISE low solution inlet excess on specified time. The LB sensor measurement is timeout (error code 24) < 1 V (liquid). ISE module status is 4 = module sleeping. ISE module reagent/fluidic error. LB sensor detects Standard 1 at the beginning of ISE low solution inlet excess on start measurement. The LB sensor measurement is of measuring (error code 25) < 1 V (liquid). ISE module status is 4 = module sleeping. ISE module reagent/fluidic error. LB sensor Can’t detect ISE high solution (error cannot detect Standard 2. The LB sensor code 31) measurement is > 4.5 V (air). ISE module status is 4 = module sleeping. ISE module reagent/fluidic error. LB sensor Can’t detect ISE high solution inlet cannot detect the arriving of Standard 2. The LB (error code 32) sensor measurement is > 4.5 V (air). ISE module status is 4 = module sleeping. ISE module reagent/fluidic error. LB sensor Too much ISE high solution inlet detects Standard 2. The LB sensor measurement (error code 33) is < 1 V (liquid). ISE module status is 4 = module sleeping. ISE module reagent/fluidic error. LB sensor still detects Standard 2 flow after the aspiration ISE high solution inlet excess on specified time. The LB sensor measurement is timeout (error code 34) < 1 V (liquid). ISE module status is 4 = module sleeping. ISE module reagent/fluidic error. LB sensor Can’t detect ISE sample (error code cannot detect sample. The LB sensor 41) measurement is > 4.5 V (air). ISE module reagent/fluidic error. LB sensor Can’t detect ISE sample inlet (error cannot detect the arriving of sample. The LB code 42) sensor measurement is > 4.5 V (air). ISE module reagent/fluidic error. LB sensor Too much ISE sample inlet (error detects sample. The LB sensor measurement is code 43) < 1 V (liquid). ISE module status is 4 = module sleeping.
Message
Check the hydraulic circuit. Check the valve V4 and readjust the LB sensor. Run an ISE Global Initialization.
Check the sample for fibrin, clog. Check the sample needle and tubing. Readjust the LB sensor. Check the sample for fibrin, clog. Check the sample needle and tubing. Readjust the LB sensor.
Check the ISE Standard 2 bottle, hydraulic circuit. Check the valve V4 and readjust the LB sensor. Run an ISE Global Initialization.
Check the ISE Standard 2 bottle, hydraulic circuit. Check the valve V4 and readjust the LB sensor. Run an ISE Global Initialization.
Check the ISE Standard 2 bottle, hydraulic circuit. Check the valve V4 and readjust the LB sensor. Run an ISE Global Initialization.
Check the ISE Standard 2 bottle, hydraulic circuit. Check the valve V4 and readjust the LB sensor. Run an ISE Global Initialization.
Check the ISE Standard 1 bottle, hydraulic circuit. Check the valve V4 and readjust the LB sensor. Run an ISE Global Initialization.
Check the ISE Standard 1 bottle, hydraulic circuit. Check the valve V4 and readjust the LB sensor. Run an ISE Global Initialization.
Action
ISE module Error messages
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Code
334
335
336
337
338
339
519
614
616
Level
Warning
Warning
Warning
Warning
Warning
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Warning
Alarm
Warning
Warning
Bad ISE module version. [%s] = ISE version number. Detected during the initialization.
Bad ISE version Required [%s], Current [%s]
ISE Module busy
Stabilization or calibration in progress.
ISE module cleaning failed.
ISE module mechanical error.
ISE cleaning failed
Run a 2-point calibration. Perform the ISE module maintenance (etching, cleaning). Change the corresponding electrode.
Check the hydraulic circuit. Check the valve V4 and readjust the LB sensor. Run an ISE Global Initialization.
Action
Reinstall the software version. See RAS517: Software version installation, page 1. Reinstall the ISE version on the ISE module. See RAS540: ISE module software version installation, page 1. Make sure that the cleaning solution is positioned on the reagent tray. -
Change the ISE preampli board.
Run a 2-point calibration. Perform the ISE module maintenance (etching, cleaning). Change the corresponding electrode. Check the ISE Standard 1 bottle has no bubble. Change the ISE Standard 1 bottle. Repeatability error on the low standard value for Perform the ISE module maintenance (etching, the electrode in brackets. cleaning). [%s1] = electrode name. Change the corresponding electrode. [%s2] = low/high point of the calibration. Check the spring contact of the corresponding electrode. Check the ISE Standard 1 or 2 bottle has no bubble. The potential difference during the three last Change the ISE Standard 1 or 2 bottle. seconds of a measurement is ≥ 0.40 mV for the Perform the ISE module maintenance (etching, electrode in brackets. cleaning). [%s1] = electrode name. Change the corresponding electrode. [%s2] = low/high point of the calibration. Check the spring contact of the corresponding electrode.
Error type ISE module reagent/fluidic error. LB sensor still detects sample flow after the aspiration specified time. The LB sensor measurement is < 1 V (liquid). ISE module status is 4 = module sleeping. The difference between the low and high standard values is out of the sensitivity normal range for the electrode in brackets. [%s1] = electrode name. [%s2] = low/high point of the calibration. The low or high standard value is out of the acceptable range for the electrode in brackets. [%s1] = electrode name. [%s2] = low/high point of the calibration.
ISE LB check response error (error code 91)
ISE electrode [%s1] response error for [%s2] point (error code 55)
ISE electrode [%s1] repeatability error for [%s2] point (error code 52)
ISE electrode [%s1] offset error for [%s2] point (error code 51)
ISE electrode [%s1] sensibility error for [%s2] point (error code 50)
ISE sample inlet excess on timeout (error code 44)
Message
ISE module Error messages
7 - 41
ISE module Procedures
3. Procedures
Maintenance and adjustments required for the ISE module are divided into procedures according to the concerned assemblies. This should make any update easier as all interventions can be done with the corresponding procedure on its own.
1 - Procedures must be performed on a clean instrument. If the instrument is suspected not to be perfectly clean, perform a cleaning procedure. 2 - Disposable gloves, eye protections and a lab coat must be worn by the operator. 3 - When the Diagnostics menu is used, the security switches are disabled and it is therefore recommended to be extremely cautious.
3.1.
Maintenance by customers
The table below lists the ISE maintenance procedures and their frequencies. For more detailed information, please refer to the instrument user manual. Maintenance ISE module etching ISE module cleaning ISE reagents replacement Electrodes replacement
3.2.
Frequency Daily if more than 20 samples are run daily Weekly As needed As needed
ISE 6 month maintenance
See RAS388: ISE module maintenance, 1. 6 month maintenance, page 2.
3.3.
ISE yearly maintenance
See RAS388: ISE module maintenance, 2. Yearly maintenance, page 3.
7 - 42
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
ISE module Procedures
3.4.
ISE procedure list
The procedures are sorted by theme. Theme
P/n and designation
Installation
RAS441: ISE module installation RAS388: ISE module maintenance RAS537: ISE module check up after intervention
Maintenance
RAS538: ISE module spare part replacement RAS539: Dummy PENTRA software use
Software
3.5.
RAS540: ISE module software version installation
Concerns Physical installation - Mechanical adjustments Electrode and reagent installation - Start and use - Check up 6 month maintenance - Yearly maintenance Check up of the ISE module on serum and urine mode Dismantling - Boards, valves, syringes and motors replacement - Mechanical adjustments - LB sensor adjustment Connection - Command description - Software use ISE preparation - ISE version loading
ISE maintenance check up summary
An ISE maintenance check up summary is provided in this manual (see on next page) to ensure the maintenance follow-up. This document can be used as reference to create a maintenance schedule for customer archives.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
7 - 43
ISE module Procedures
7 - 44
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
HORIBA ABX SAS Parc Euromédecine - Rue du Caducée B.P. 7290 34184 Montpellier Cedex 4 - FRANCE Phone: + 33 (0)4 67 14 15 16 Fax: + 33 (0)4 67 14 15 17
ABX Pentra 400 / Pentra C400 ISE module Check-up maintenance 6 month maintenance Rinsing and draining
Yearly maintenance
Rinsing with distilled water and draining. See RAS388: ISE module maintenance, 3.1. Rinsing with distilled water and draining, page 4. Syringes O-rings replacement and greasing. See RAS388: ISE module maintenance, 3.2. Syringes Orings replacement and greasing, page 5.
X
X
Syringes Syringes pistons and O-rings replacement See RAS388: ISE module maintenance, 3.3. Syringes pistons and O-rings replacement, page 7.
Valves
X
Electrovalve no. 4 cleaning. See RAS388: ISE module maintenance, 3.4. Electrovalve no. 4 cleaning, page 9.
X
X
Tubing "reference electrode to electrovalve no. 4" replacement. See RAS388: ISE module maintenance, 3.5. Tubing "reference electrode to electrovalve no. 4" replacement, page 10.
X
X
ISE mix cup cleaning with bleach and rinsing with distilled water. See RAS388: ISE module maintenance, 3.6. ISE mix cup cleaning, page 10.
X
X
Tubing "air sensor to ISE mix cup" replacement. See RAS388: ISE module maintenance, 3.7. Tubing "air sensor to ISE mix cup" replacement, page 11.
X
X
Mix cup
All tubings and fittings replacement. See RAS388: ISE module maintenance, 3.8. All tubings and fittings replacement, page 11.
X
Tubings
Adjustment
Check up after intervention
Isolator and ISE waste tubing replacement. See RAS388: ISE module maintenance, 3.9. Isolator and ISE waste tubing replacement, page 11.
X
X
ISE mix cup adjustment. See RAS388: ISE module maintenance, 3.10. ISE mix cup adjustment, page 12.
X
X
Check up on serum mode. See RAS537: ISE module check up after intervention, 1. Check up on serum mode, page 2: Calibration (x5): difference < 0.2 mV, Control N, P (x10): CV < 1% Na, Cl and K.
X
X
Check up on urine mode. See RAS537: ISE module check up after intervention, 2. Check up on urine mode, page 7: Control Standard 2 (x10): CV < 2% Na, Cl and < 1.5% K.
X
X
This document can be used as reference to create a maintenance schedule for customer archives.
RAS441E
ISE module installation In this procedure, specific instructions are given for previous ABX Pentra 400 hardware versions: ■ V1 corresponds to instruments with serial numbers below 2000.
RAS441: ISE module installation
■For
a full installation on an instrument without ISE module, perform the procedure entirely. ■For an ISE module startup, perform only the ISE module startup part.
Concerns ISE module physical installation ISE module startup
Required tools Hexagonal keys Phillips screwdriver
Required products Distilled water
Intervention time 1 h 00
Frequency On request
Specific kit or consumables ■ ISE
module electrodes: ABX Pentra Sodium-E A11A01738 ABX Pentra Chloride-E A11A01739 ABX Pentra Potassium-E A11A01740 ABX Pentra Reference-E A11A01741
■ ISE
module reagents: ABX Pentra Standard 1 A11A01717 ABX Pentra Standard 2 A11A01718 ABX Pentra Reference 280 ML A11A01901
Disposable gloves, eye protections and a lab coat must be worn by the operator. Local or national regulations must be applied in all the operations.
ISE module installation
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
1. ISE module physical installation 1.1.
Unpacking
Unpack the ISE module carefully and make sure that all the parts from the package list are present.
Package list Part number
Qty
Designation
1
ISE module
1
ISE packaging
1
KIT, ISE INSTALLATION KIT P400
KIT, ISE INSTALLATION KIT P400 Part number
Qty
Designation
DAC028A (1201891028) 1
CABLE, PC/MAIN BOARD P80
EAE028AS (1202249028) 2 metres
TUBING, CRYSTAL 4X6 L=2M
EAB013A (1202211013)
1
FITTING, STRAIGHT 3.1/2.3 CLEAR
KAA013A (1207401013)
6
CHC SCREW M4X6 FITTING, STRAIGHT 2.5/1.5
EAB015A (1202211015)
2
EAE003A*
0.5 metres TUBING, TYGON 0.762 (0.030)
EAE007A*
0.5 metres TUBING, TYGON 1.52 (0.060)
EAC015A (1202221015)
1
KAU007A (1207571007) 2
FITTING, LUER MALE FITTING PLASTIC WASHER
* Possible to order under the following references: - EAE003AS (1202249003) (2 metres) - EAE007AS (1202249007) (2 metres)
RAS441E - 2
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
1.2.
ISE module installation
Instrument setting ■ Switch ■ Open
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
the arms main cover and the ISE cover.
■ Remove
the ISE plate and the mother board cover. See RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1.
D ■ Remove
the rear plate (A), the luer connector plate (B), the middle plate (C) and the ISE rear plate (D) at the back of the instrument.
A
C
B
Specific ABX Pentra 400 V1 ■ Remove
the rear plate (A), the luer connector plate (B) and the middle plate (C) at the back of the instrument.
A
C
B
Null modem cable connection: J3
■ Connect
the null modem cable (included in the kit) in position J3 of the mother board.
■ Guide the cable down to the passage designed for the wires (follow the black "Barcode Reader" wire)
to achieve the correct position. ■ Put
the mother board cover back in position.
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS441E - 3
ISE module installation
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
B
A
■ Prepare
the null modem cable linked to the mother board (A), the crystal tubing linked to the luer link plate (B) and the power supply cable coming from the power supply block (C).
C
1.3.
ISE module positioning
Tygon tubing
■ Use
the straight fitting 3.1/2.3 (included in the kit) to connect the 1.52 mm Tygon tubing to the crystal tubing 4x6 linked to the ISE waste assy.
Straight fitting
Crystal tubing
Tygon tubing
Specific ABX Pentra 400 V1 ■ Use
the straight fitting 3.1/2.3 (included in the kit) to connect the 1.52 mm Tygon tubing to the crystal tubing 4x6 linked to the ISE waste assy. Straight fitting
Crystal tubing
RAS441E - 4
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
ISE module installation
Power supply cable
Null modem cable
■ Connect the power supply cable on the ISE
module mother board as well as the null modem cable. Make sure that the wires are not in a stressed position.
B
A
■ Slightly loosen the 2 CHC screws (A) to free
the left gusset plate. ■ Place
the ISE module and tighten the 2 CHC screws (one with the braided ground wire) on the left of the module (C), the 2 CHC screws and plastic washers (provided in the kit) on the right of the module (B) and the 2 CHC screws of the left gusset plate (A).
C
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS441E - 5
ISE module installation
■ Put
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
the covers and plates back.
■ Connect
the ISE waste tubing to the external central luer connector plate.
ISE module waste
■ Guide
with the shortest distance from the instrument to the waste detection assy and cut to the correct length.
■ Then,
connect it to the small connector of the waste detection assy.
RAS441E - 6
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
1.4.
ISE module installation
ISE module mechanical adjustments ■ Connect
the power supply cable and switch the instrument on.
1.4.1. ISE mix cup adjustment ■ Remove ■ Make
■ Go
the ISE cup cover. See RAS377: Covers dismantling, 9. Reagent plate, page 6.
sure that the reagent arm is in its wash tower and the sample arm is at its vertical home position.
to Services > Diagnostics > Arms.
■ Select
the sample arm Rotation radio button (A), then press Motor Off (B).
■ Manually
turn the sample arm over the ISE A
mix cup. B
■ Loosen
the 2 CHC screws and washers.
■ Move
the ISE mix cup to have the sample needle centered (left/right).
■ Screw
Technical Manual RAA023
the ISE mix cup support.
RAS441E - 7
ISE module installation
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Check
the position with the sample arm in the ISE mix cup: - Select the sample arm Vertical radio button (A), support the arm by hand, then press Motor Off (B). - Slowly move the arm down and check the position.
A
■ Press Check Home (C) to move the arm up. ■ Put
the ISE cup cover back.
C
B
1.4.2. Sample arm "ISE Sample" position adjustment Adjust the sample arm in the ISE mix cup by following the sample arm adjustment procedure. - ISE Sample (rotation) to center the sample needle in the ISE mix cup. See RAS385: Arms, 6.3.5. ISE Position, page 42. - Low Position in ISE Tower (vertical) to adjust the sample needle height in the ISE mix cup. See RAS385: Arms, 6.4.5. "Low Position in ISE Tower", page 53.
RAS441E - 8
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
ISE module installation
2. ISE module startup 2.1.
Electrode and reagent installation
After opening, the electrodes are stable for: - ABX Pentra Reference-E: 12 months - ABX Pentra Sodium-E: 12 months - ABX Pentra Chloride-E: 4 months - ABX Pentra Potassium-E: 6 months For the reference electrode, remove the protection from one side of the electrode and disconnect the tubing between the two connectors. For all electrodes, make sure that the O-ring is well-positioned on one side of the electrode and make sure that the electrode is clean.
O-ring ■ Install
the electrodes (after removing the foam supporting the air detector):
Reference
Sodium (Na)
Technical Manual RAA023
Chlore (Cl)
Potassium (K)
RAS441E - 9
ISE module installation
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Connect
the tubing from LV3- inlet 1 to the upper inlet of the Reference electrode.
■ Connect
the tubing from LV4- inlet 1 to the lower inlet of the Reference electrode.
■ Close
and fasten the ISE door.
■ Install
the Standard 1, the Standard 2 and the Reference solutions. LV4
LV3
Standard 1
Standard 2
Reference
RAS441E - 10
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
ISE module installation
ISE module hydraulic diagram
This diagram is available in the form of a sticker to be stuck on the inside of the ISE cover: STICKER, ISE HYDRAULIC HAX0271 (1207230271).
Mark on diagram 0.76-xxx 1.52-xxx 1.5/2.5 ISOLATOR Air sensor Na+
Technical Manual RAA023
P/n EAE003A* EAE007A* EAB015A (1202211015) XCA167A (1209121167) GBM0746 (3014029452) A11A01738
Designation TUBING, TYGON 0.762 (0.030) TUBING, TYGON 1.52 (0.060) FITTING, STRAIGHT 2.5/1.5 CHAMBER, ISOLATOR (SMALL) FLUID, ISE AIR DETECT.ELECTRODE ABX PENTRA SODIUM-E
Sales unit * * Pack of 5 1 1 1
RAS441E - 11
ISE module installation
Mark on diagram ClK+ Ref LV1, LV2, LV3, LV4 LV5, LV6 E1
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
P/n A11A01739 A11A01740 A11A01741 XBA635AS (1209119635) XBA544C (1209113544) EBA018A (1202351018) EBA017A (1202351017) XBA733AS (1209119733) EAB013A (1202211013) GBM1266 (1203601266) GBM0751 (1203600751) GBM0750 (1203600750)
Designation ABX PENTRA CHLORIDE-E ABX PENTRA POTASSIUM-E ABX PENTRA REFERENCE-E VALVE, ISE VALVE VALVE, ISE VALVE ASSY VALVE, LV5 VALVE ISE VALVE, LV6 VALVE ISE VALVE, ISE MIXCUP VALVE ASSY FITTING, STRAIGHT 3.1/2.3 CLEAR FLUID, ISE REF.BLUE STRAW 300 ML FLUID, ISE 300 ML BOTTLE STRAW FLUID, ISE 100 ML BOTTLE STRAW
Sales unit 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
* Possible to order under the following references: - EAE003AS (1202249003) (2 metres) - EAE007AS (1202249007) (2 metres)
2.2.
Start and use of ISE option
To minimize environmental interferences, the ISE module cover must always be closed during ISE module operation.
■ Go
to Services > System Configuration > Analyser > ISE Module.
■ Activate
the ISE module: - Press Edit (A). - Select the Activate ISE Module check box (B). - Press OK (C).
B
A
RAS441E - 12
C
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
ISE module installation
■ Go
to Services > Customer Services > ISE.
■ Activate
the electrodes: - Press Edit (D). - In the Activated electrode area, select the Chloride, Potassium and/or Sodium check boxes (E). - Press OK (F).
E
D
F
G
I
■ Go
to Calibration/Control > ISE Calibration.
■ Make
sure that the Keep ready and Ready functions are activated as well as the ISE calibrations, if not:
■ Press
Edit (G).
H
■ Select
the 1 point Calibration Frequency, 2 point Calibration Frequency, Keep ready and/or Ready check boxes (H) and enter the frequency values.
■ Press
OK (I).
■ Go
to Services > Customer Services > ISE.
■ Run
2.3.
a Global Initialization.
ISE module check up
Follow the "ISE module check up after intervention" procedure. See RAS537: ISE module check up after intervention, page 1.
To know the slope and offset range, see Section 7: ISE module, 1.7.2. NA, K, CL normal range, page 7-37.
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS441E - 13
ISE module installation
RAS441E - 14
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS388J
ISE module maintenance
RAS388: ISE module maintenance
Concerns 6 month maintenance Yearly maintenance Procedures Rinsing with distilled water and draining Syringes O-rings replacement and greasing Syringes pistons and O-rings replacement Electrovalve no. 4 cleaning Tubing "reference electrode to electrovalve no. 4" replacement ISE mix cup cleaning Tubing "air sensor to ISE mix cup" replacement All tubings and fittings replacement Isolator and ISE waste tubing replacement ISE mix cup adjustment
Required tools Hexagonal keys Phillips screwdriver
Required products Distilled water Bleach
Intervention time 1 h 00
Frequency On request
Specific kit or consumables KIT, ISE 6 MONTH MAINTENANCE XEC273AS (1209171273) KIT, ISE 1 YEAR MAINTENANCE KIT XEA794ES (1209155794) Disposable gloves, eye protections and a lab coat must be worn by the operator. Local or national regulations must be applied in all the operations.
ISE module maintenance
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
1. 6 month maintenance 1.1.
Maintenance kit
KIT, ISE 6 MONTH MAINTENANCE XEC273AS (1209171273)
1.2.
P/n
Designation
Qty
XEA019A (1209151019)
TOOL, GREASE SILICON CONTAINER
1
FAA073A (1202401073)
O'RING, ISE SYRINGE O'RING
8
EAE028AS (1202249028)
TUBING, CRYSTAL 4X6 L=2M
2 metres
EAE003AS (1202249003)
TUBING, TYGON 0.762 (0.030) L=2M
2 metres
XCA167A (1209121167)
CHAMBER, ISOLATOR (SMALL)
1
What to do?
Here are listed and organized the tasks to be performed during the ISE 6 month maintenance. For each task, the steps to follow are detailed in chapter 3. No.
RAS388J - 2
Task
Link
1
Syringes O-rings replacement and greasing
3.2. Syringes O-rings replacement and greasing, page 5
2
Electrovalve no. 4 cleaning
3.4. Electrovalve no. 4 cleaning, page 9
3
Tubing "reference electrode to electrovalve no. 4" replacement
3.5. Tubing "reference electrode to electrovalve no. 4" replacement, page 10
4
ISE mix cup cleaning
3.6. ISE mix cup cleaning, page 10
5
Tubing "air sensor to ISE mix cup" replacement
3.7. Tubing "air sensor to ISE mix cup" replacement, page 11
6
Isolator and ISE waste tubing replacement
3.9. Isolator and ISE waste tubing replacement, page 11
7
ISE mix cup adjustment
3.10. ISE mix cup adjustment, page 12
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
ISE module maintenance
2. Yearly maintenance 2.1.
Maintenance kit
KIT, ISE 1 YEAR MAINTENANCE KIT XEA794ES (1209155794) P/n
Designation
Qty
EAE007A*
TUBING, TYGON 1.52 (0.060)
3 metres
EAB015A (1202211015)
FITTING, STRAIGHT 2.5/1.5
11
GBM0891 (1203600891)
SYRINGE, ISE SYR. PISTON
4
XEC273AS (1209171273)
KIT, ISE 6 MONTH MAINTENANCE
XEA019A (1209151019)
TOOL, GREASE SILICON CONTAINER
FAA073A (1202401073)
O'RING, ISE SYRINGE O'RING
8
EAE028AS (1202249028)
TUBING, CRYSTAL 4X6 L=2M
2 metres
EAE003AS (1202249003)
TUBING, TYGON 0.762 (0.030) L=2M
2 metres
XCA167A (1209121167)
CHAMBER, ISOLATOR (SMALL)
1
1
* Possible to order under the following reference: - EAE007AS (1202249007) (2 metres)
2.2.
What to do?
Here are listed and organized the tasks to be performed during the ISE yearly maintenance. For each task, the steps to follow are detailed in chapter 3. No.
Task
Link
1
Rinsing with distilled water and draining
3.1. Rinsing with distilled water and draining, page 4
2
Syringes pistons and O-rings replacement
3.3. Syringes pistons and O-rings replacement, page 7
3
Electrovalve no. 4 cleaning
3.4. Electrovalve no. 4 cleaning, page 9
4
Tubing "reference electrode to electrovalve no. 4" replacement
3.5. Tubing "reference electrode to electrovalve no. 4" replacement, page 10
5
ISE mix cup cleaning
3.6. ISE mix cup cleaning, page 10
6
Tubing "air sensor to ISE mix cup" replacement
3.7. Tubing "air sensor to ISE mix cup" replacement, page 11
7
All tubings and fittings replacement
3.8. All tubings and fittings replacement, page 11
8
Isolator and ISE waste tubing replacement
3.9. Isolator and ISE waste tubing replacement, page 11
9
ISE mix cup adjustment
3.10. ISE mix cup adjustment, page 12
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS388J - 3
ISE module maintenance
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
3. Procedures 3.1.
Rinsing with distilled water and draining
In order not to damage the pistons, it is advisable to drain the syringes, then rinse them as quickly as possible to avoid the crystallization of reagents.
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > ISE.
■ Remove
the straws from the reagent bottles and wrap them in absorbent paper.
■ Run
a Purge ISE Module cycle (A) to drain the circuit.
■ Dry
the straws using absorbent paper.
■ Plunge
the straws into a distilled water bottle, then run a Prime flow system cycle (B).
■ Remove
the straws from the distilled water bottle and wrap them in absorbent paper.
B A
■ Run
a Purge ISE Module cycle (A) to drain the circuit.
RAS388J - 4
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
3.2.
ISE module maintenance
Syringes O-rings replacement and greasing
■ Go
to Services > Customer Services > ISE and press Change electrode. A
■ Disconnect
the 2 tubings from the syringe
(A). ■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws (B) of the syringe body, then remove it. B
■ On a piece of absorbent paper, unscrew the
CHC screws and the Torx screws to open the syringe body. ■ Remove
the pistons and gently clean them with distilled water.
■ Replace
the 4 O-rings with new ones.
■ Take
the first syringe block cover and put 2 O-rings in it. Do not grease these O-rings. Install the first cover on the syringe body (O-ring side facing up).
■ Grease
2 O-rings and put them in the second syringe block cover. Install the second cover on the syringe body (O-ring side facing up).
O-rings without grease
■ Screw
both covers on the syringe body without tightening the screws. O-rings with grease
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS388J - 5
ISE module maintenance
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Both covers must be well-aligned with the syringe body.
■ Put
the pistons in the syringe body.
■ Maintain
the covers and the syringe body well-aligned and tighten the screws.
To avoid risk of instability or impossibility to calibrate, be very careful not to inverse the pistons when reassembling the syringe.
■ Reinstall
the syringe body on the ISE syringes assy without tightening the screws.
■ Perform
the same operation with the second syringe.
■ Press
Mechanical Initialization.
■ When
the pistons are in the highest position, press Stop ISE cycle.
■ Tighten ■ Press
RAS388J - 6
the syringe body screws.
Mechanical Initialization.
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
3.3.
ISE module maintenance
Syringes pistons and O-rings replacement
■ Go
to Services > Customer Services > ISE and press Change electrode. A
■ Disconnect
the 2 tubings from the syringe
(A). ■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws (B) of the syringe body, then remove it. B
■ On a piece of absorbent paper, unscrew the
CHC screws and the Torx screws to open the syringe body. ■ Replace
both pistons with new ones.
■ Replace
the 4 O-rings with new ones.
■ Take
the first syringe block cover and put 2 O-rings in it. Do not grease these O-rings. Install the first cover on the syringe body (O-ring side facing up).
■ Grease
2 O-rings and put them in the second syringe block cover. Install the second cover on the syringe body (O-ring side facing up).
O-rings without grease
■ Screw
both covers on the syringe body without tightening the screws. O-rings with grease
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS388J - 7
ISE module maintenance
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Both covers must be well-aligned with the syringe body.
■ Put
the pistons in the syringe body.
■ Maintain
the covers and the syringe body well-aligned and tighten the screws.
To avoid risk of instability or impossibility to calibrate, be very careful not to inverse the pistons when reassembling the syringe.
■ Reinstall
the syringe body on the ISE syringes assy without tightening the screws.
■ Perform
the same operation with the second syringe.
■ Press
Mechanical Initialization.
■ When
the pistons are in the highest position, press Stop ISE cycle.
■ Tighten ■ Press
RAS388J - 8
the syringe body screws.
Mechanical Initialization.
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
3.4.
ISE module maintenance
Electrovalve no. 4 cleaning
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws of the right syringe body ("Syringe 1"), then remove it.
■ Disconnect
the tubing from the lower inlet of the reference electrode. See ISE module hydraulic diagram, page 13.
B
■ Plunge this tubing into bleach (diluted 1/10)
(A).
A
■ Press on the electrovalve with a screwdriver
(B) and push the syringe piston (C) to make the bleach pass through the electrovalve. C
■ Leave
the bleach to act for a few seconds.
■ Perform
this operation 4 times.
■ Remove
the tubing from the bleach.
■ Plunge
it into distilled water and rinse the electrovalve in the same way as described above.
■ Perform
Technical Manual RAA023
this operation 10 times.
RAS388J - 9
ISE module maintenance
■ Remove
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
the dried up residue of the saline
solution.
■ Reinstall
the syringe body on the ISE syringes assy without tightening the screws.
■ Press
Mechanical Initialization.
■ When
the pistons are in the highest position, press Stop ISE cycle.
■ Tighten ■ Press
3.5.
the syringe body screws.
Mechanical Initialization.
Tubing "reference electrode to electrovalve no. 4" replacement ■ Replace
the tubing from the lower inlet of the reference electrode to the electrovalve no. 4, inlet 1 (cut 0.170 m of the 0.76 mm Tygon tubing). See ISE module hydraulic diagram, page 13.
3.6.
ISE mix cup cleaning ■ Remove
the ISE cup cover. See RAS377: Covers dismantling, 9. Reagent plate, page 6.
■ Disconnect ■ Remove ■ Clean
RAS388J - 10
the 4 tubings from the ISE mix cup.
the ISE mix cup.
it with bleach (diluted 1/10) and rinse it with distilled water.
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
3.7.
ISE module maintenance
Tubing "air sensor to ISE mix cup" replacement ■ Replace the tubing from the air sensor inlet to the electrovalve no. 5 (cut 0.085 m of the 0.76 mm Tygon
tubing) and the tubing from the electrovalve no. 5 to the lower inlet of the ISE mix cup (cut 0.103 m of the 0.76 mm Tygon tubing). See ISE module hydraulic diagram, page 13. ■ Reconnect
3.8.
the 3 other tubings on the ISE mix cup.
■ Put
the ISE mix cup back.
■ Put
the ISE cup cover back.
All tubings and fittings replacement
Replace all the ISE module tubings and fittings by following the hydraulic diagram. See ISE module hydraulic diagram, page 13.
3.9.
Isolator and ISE waste tubing replacement ■ Replace
the isolator with a new one.
Be very careful to respect the isolator orientation.
To LV4 valve
To waste
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS388J - 11
ISE module maintenance
■
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Cut 750 mm of crystal tubing 4x6 and replace the ISE waste tubing located inside the instrument between the straight fitting 3.1/2.3 of the ISE module (E1) and the internal central luer connector.
E1
luer connector
■ Use
the remaining crystal tubing 4x6 to replace the ISE waste tubing located outside the instrument between the external central luer connector and the waste tank. luer connector
■ Guide
with the shortest distance from the instrument to the waste detection assy and cut to the correct length.
■ Then,
connect it to the small connector of the waste detection assy.
3.10.
ISE mix cup adjustment
Perform an ISE mix cup adjustment (see RAS441: ISE module installation, 1.4.1. ISE mix cup adjustment, page 7).
RAS388J - 12
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
ISE module maintenance
ISE module hydraulic diagram
This diagram is available in the form of a sticker to be stuck on the inside of the ISE cover: STICKER, ISE HYDRAULIC HAX0271 (1207230271).
Mark on diagram 0.76-xxx 1.52-xxx 1.5/2.5 ISOLATOR Air sensor Na+
Technical Manual RAA023
P/n EAE003A* EAE007A* EAB015A (1202211015) XCA167A (1209121167) GBM0746 (3014029452) A11A01738
Designation TUBING, TYGON 0.762 (0.030) TUBING, TYGON 1.52 (0.060) FITTING, STRAIGHT 2.5/1.5 CHAMBER, ISOLATOR (SMALL) FLUID, ISE AIR DETECT.ELECTRODE ABX PENTRA SODIUM-E
Sales unit * * Pack of 5 1 1 1
RAS388J - 13
ISE module maintenance
Mark on diagram ClK+ Ref LV1, LV2, LV3, LV4 LV5, LV6 E1
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
P/n A11A01739 A11A01740 A11A01741 XBA635AS (1209119635) XBA544C (1209113544) EBA018A (1202351018) EBA017A (1202351017) XBA733AS (1209119733) EAB013A (1202211013) GBM1266 (1203601266) GBM0751 (1203600751) GBM0750 (1203600750)
Designation ABX PENTRA CHLORIDE-E ABX PENTRA POTASSIUM-E ABX PENTRA REFERENCE-E VALVE, ISE VALVE VALVE, ISE VALVE ASSY VALVE, LV5 VALVE ISE VALVE, LV6 VALVE ISE VALVE, ISE MIXCUP VALVE ASSY FITTING, STRAIGHT 3.1/2.3 CLEAR FLUID, ISE REF.BLUE STRAW 300 ML FLUID, ISE 300 ML BOTTLE STRAW FLUID, ISE 100 ML BOTTLE STRAW
Sales unit 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
* Possible to order under the following references: - EAE003AS (1202249003) (2 metres) - EAE007AS (1202249007) (2 metres)
RAS388J - 14
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS537D
ISE module check up after intervention
RAS537: ISE module check up after intervention
Concerns Check up on serum mode Preliminary operations Calibration ISE activation Control Check results Check up on urine mode Results validation configuration Procedure
Required tools None
Required products Distilled water
Intervention time 0 h 30
Frequency On request
Specific kit or consumables ABX Pentra N Control A11A01653 ABX Pentra P Control A11A01654 ABX Pentra Standard 2 A11A01718
Disposable gloves, eye protections and a lab coat must be worn by the operator. Local or national regulations must be applied in all the operations.
ISE module check up after intervention
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
The "ISE module check up after intervention" procedure should be performed after an intervention to verify that the ISE module is functioning properly.
To minimize environmental interferences, the ISE module cover must always be closed during ISE module operation.
1. Check up on serum mode 1.1.
Preliminary operations
1.1.1. Results validation configuration ■ Go
to Services > System Configuration > Results validation.
■ Write
down the customer configuration.
It is necessary to write down the customer configuration to reconfigure the control results validation, with the customer configuration, at the end of the procedure.
■ Press
Edit (A).
■ Configure ■ Press
B
the control results validation (B).
OK to validate (C).
A
RAS537D - 2
C
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
ISE module check up after intervention
1.1.2. Application check ■ Go
to Services > Application Configuration > Applications.
■ Select
the application "K_S" in the Applications list and press Details.
■ In
the Result area, the Decimal Position field must be set at least to 1.
■ If
not, press Edit to modify the value, then press OK.
1.1.3. Control configuration ■ Go
to Calibration/Control > Control and refer to your user manual to configure the N Control and the P Control for the tests Cl, K and Na on serum. ■ Refer
to the N Control and the P Control vials to specify the control characteristics. To use the same configuration later, enter a longer expiration date. ■ Refer to the N Control and the P Control vials to specify the Target value, Min. value and Max. value for the tests Cl, K and Na. ■ Fill
one sample tube with 2 mL of N Control and another one with 2 mL of P Control.
■ Physically ■ Then,
Technical Manual RAA023
position the N Control and the P Control on the programmed rack positions.
load the rack on the sample tray.
RAS537D - 3
ISE module check up after intervention
1.2.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Calibration
This part of the procedure has to be done only after the first installation of the ISE module or after the installation of new electrodes.
■ From
the main menu, press the ISE Module Status button.
■ Press
Calibrate to perform a 2-point calibration.
■ Note the results (low and high values) of the
2-point calibration for each electrode. ■ Perform
this operation 5 times.
■ Calculate
the difference between the low and high values for each result.
Low value (mV)
High value (mV)
Difference
1
52.0
44.1
7.9
2
51.9
44.7
7.2
3
52.0
44.7
7.3
4
52.1
44.8
7.3
5
52.0
44.8
7.2
For the three last calibrations, the gap between the calculated differences must be 0.2 mV maximum. For this example: - 7.3 - 7.3 - 7.2 The gap is 0.1 mV. It might be possible, during the first hour after the electrode installation, that the gap exceeds 0.2 mV. It is due to the electrode stabilization. In this case, wait for one hour before repeating this part of the procedure.
RAS537D - 4
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
1.3.
ISE module check up after intervention
ISE activation ■ Go
to Services > Customer Services > ISE.
■ Put
a sample tube on a rack.
■ Select
the rack position of the sample tube used for the ISE activation by using the corresponding scrolling lists.
■ Press
ISE activation key and follow the instructions given by the instrument.
■ Repeat
this operation a second time.
■ From the main menu, press the ISE Module
Status button and then press Calibrate button.
1.4.
Control
Once the calibration is validated, perform the control as explained below. ■ Go
to Worklist > Control and refer to your user manual to create the control request (10 replicates) for the tests Cl, K and Na on serum.
■ Run the analyses by pressing Start from the
generic toolbar. The 10 replicates for the tests Cl, K and Na on the N Control and the P Control will be performed.
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS537D - 5
ISE module check up after intervention
1.5.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Check results
Once the instrument is Ready, check results of the tests Cl, K and Na. ■ Go
to Quality Control > Control. A C
■ Select
the N Control using the Control scrolling list (A).
■ In
the Session Mean area, drag the slider (B) to display the CV (C).
■ Make
B
sure that the CV are lower than those below: Test
CV Max.
CL_S
1.0
K_S
1.0
NA_S
1.0
■ Follow
the same procedure for the P Control.
If you have to run the 10 replicates again, ask for a New Worklist from the Start up window (use the Change User option from the Shutdown window) so that only the 10 new replicates are taken into account in the CV calculation.
RAS537D - 6
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
ISE module check up after intervention
2. Check up on urine mode First, perform check up on serum mode (See 1. Check up on serum mode, page 2).
2.1.
Results validation configuration
See 1.1.1. Results validation configuration, page 2.
2.2.
Procedure
Check the ISE results in urine mode as follows.
2.2.1. Application check ■ Go
to Services > Application Configuration > Applications.
■ For
the applications "K_U" and "NA_U", make sure that the Decimal Position field is set at least to 1.
2.2.2. Control configuration ■ Go
to Calibration/Control > Control and refer to your user manual to configure the Standard 2 as a control for the tests Cl, K and Na on urine.
Please refer to the Standard 2 bottle to specify the control characteristics (name, lot, expiration date) and to the following table to specify the Target value, Min. value and Max. value for the tests "CL_U", "K_U" and "NA_U".
Target values
■
Test
Target value
Min. value
Max. value
CL_U
150
143
157
K_U
7
6.7
7.3
NA_U
200
187.8
212.2
Fill one sample cup with 500 µL of Standard 2 and physically position this sample cup on the programmed rack position.
■ Then,
Technical Manual RAA023
load the rack on the sample tray. RAS537D - 7
ISE module check up after intervention
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
2.2.3. Control ■ Go
to Worklist > Control and refer to your user manual to create the control request (5 replicates) for the tests Cl, K and Na on urine.
■ Run the analyses by pressing Start from the
generic toolbar. The 5 replicates for the tests Cl, K and Na on the Standard 2 will be performed. ■ Perform
this operation twice.
2.2.4. Check results Once the instrument is Ready, check results of the tests Cl, K and Na. ■ Go
to Quality Control > Control.
■ Select
the Standard 2 control and make sure that: - the results are included between the Min. and Max. values. See Target values, page 7. - the CV are lower than those below: Test
CV Max.
CL_U
2.0
K_U
1.5
NA_U
2.0
If you have to run the 10 replicates again, ask for a New Worklist from the Start up window (use the Change User option from the Shutdown window) so that only the 10 new replicates are taken into account in the CV calculation.
■ Go
to Services > System Configuration > Results validation.
■ Press
Edit.
■ Reconfigure ■ Press
RAS537D - 8
the control results validation with the customer configuration previously written down.
OK to validate.
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS538F
ISE module spare part replacement In this procedure, specific instructions are given for previous ABX Pentra 400 hardware versions: ■ V1 corresponds to instruments with serial numbers below 2000.
RAS538: ISE module spare part replacement
Concerns ISE module dismantling ISE module spare parts replacement Boards replacement ISE valves replacement ISE syringes and motors replacement ISE module mechanical adjustments ISE mix cup adjustment Sample arm "ISE Sample" position adjustment LB sensor adjustment
Required tools Hexagonal keys Phillips screwdriver Voltmeter Syringe KIT, ANTISTATIC KIT MZZ015A (1207921015)
Required products Distilled water
Intervention time N/A
Frequency On request
Specific kit or consumables None Disposable gloves, eye protections and a lab coat must be worn by the operator. Local or national regulations must be applied in all the operations.
ISE module spare part replacement
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
1. ISE module dismantling ■ Open ■ Go
the arms main cover and the ISE cover.
to Services > Diagnostics > ISE.
■ Rinse
and purge the ISE module: - Remove the straws from the reagent bottles and wrap them in absorbent paper. - Run a Purge ISE Module cycle (A) to drain the circuit. - Dry the straws using absorbent paper. - Plunge the straws into a distilled water bottle, then run a Prime flow system cycle (B). - Remove the straws from the distilled water bottle and wrap them in absorbent paper. - Run a Purge ISE Module cycle (A) to drain the circuit.
■ Switch
B A
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
From the instrument rear: Specific ABX Pentra 400 V1 Connections are accessible from the instrument front on ABX Pentra 400 V1. Move directly to the next chapter.
■ Remove
the ISE rear plate by unscrewing the 12 CHC screws.
RAS538F - 2
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Unplug
ISE module spare part replacement
the waste tubing (A).
■ Disconnect
the power supply cable (B) and the null modem cable (C). B C
A
From the instrument front:
B
A
■ Slightly loosen the 2 CHC screws (A) to free
the left gusset plate. ■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws and plastic washers (B) on the right-hand side of the module.
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws (C) on the lefthand side of the module.
C Now, it is possible to move the ISE module, but if necessary, remove the power supply cover, the external and internal sample covers. See RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1.
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS538F - 3
ISE module spare part replacement
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Specific ABX Pentra 400 V1 ■ Slowly
pull the ISE module to access the connections.
■ Unplug
the waste tubing (A).
■ Disconnect
the power supply cable (B) and the null modem cable (C). B C
A ■ Remove
the ISE module.
■ Reassemble
in reverse order.
2. ISE module spare parts replacement At the end of each replacement, proceed to a mechanical adjustment (see 3. ISE module mechanical adjustments, page 20), run a Global Initialization cycle in Services > Diagnostics > ISE and follow the "ISE module check up after intervention" procedure (see RAS537: ISE module check up after intervention, page 1). ■ Switch ■ Open ■
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
the arms main cover and the ISE cover.
Dismantle the ISE module until you have access to its connections (See 1. ISE module dismantling, page 2).
RAS538F - 4
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
2.1.
ISE module spare part replacement
Boards replacement
As the electronic devices are very sensitive to electrostatic discharges (ESD), the use of an antistatic kit is mandatory during boards handling/dismantling.
2.1.1. ISE software board
CPU-03N
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws and washers.
■ Slowly
pull the ISE software board to remove it from the ISE mother board.
■ Reassemble
in reverse order.
CPU-07N
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS538F - 5
ISE module spare part replacement
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
2.1.2. ISE mother board
■ Carefully
disconnect: - the "preampli to main board ISE" cable (A) - the valves cable (B) - the 2 syringe home sensor cables: one of them from the ISE syringe motor 1/75 (C) and the other one from the ISE syringe motor 1/150 (D) - the 2 syringe motor cables: one of them from the ISE syringe motor 1/75 (E) and the other one from the ISE syringe motor 1/150 (F)
■ Remove
A B C E D F
the ISE software board. See 2.1.1. ISE software board, page 5.
■ Unscrew
the 5 CHC screws and washers (one with a ground wire) to remove the ISE mother board from its plate.
■ Reassemble
RAS538F - 6
in reverse order.
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
ISE module spare part replacement
2.1.3. ISE preampli board assy ■ Open
the ISE cage door and remove the electrodes.
■ Remove
the ISE V2 mix cup valve assy as follows: - Unscrew the 2 CHC screws and washers maintaining the ISE V2 mix cup valve assy.
- Disconnect all the tubings from the ISE V2 mix cup valve assy. - Remove the ISE V2 mix cup valve assy.
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS538F - 7
ISE module spare part replacement
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Unscrew
the 8 CHC screws (one with a braided ground wire) supporting the ISE preampli board assy to access the board.
■ Slowly
pull the ISE preampli board assy.
A B ■ Disconnect
the "preampli to main board ISE" cable (A) from the ISE preampli board.
■ Unscrew
the screw supporting the ground
wire (B). ■ Remove
the preampli board assy.
■ Reassemble
in reverse order. To reconnect all the tubings correctly: see ISE module hydraulic diagram, page 18.
RAS538F - 8
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
2.2.
ISE module spare part replacement
ISE valves replacement
2.2.1. ISE valve (LV1, LV2, LV3, LV4)
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws supporting the ISE valve assy and pull it toward the rear of the ISE module.
■ Disconnect all the tubings from the valve to
be replaced. ■ Unscrew
the 2 screws located under the valve to be replaced.
■ Cut
the Ty-Raps™ maintaining the black and red cables.
■ Disconnect
the valve connector from the connector located on the ISE mother board.
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS538F - 9
ISE module spare part replacement
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Disconnect
the black and red cables of the concerned valve from the valve connector. For this, push the cables using a thin screwdriver.
■ Connect
the new valve cables on the valve connector. Be careful of the polarity when connecting cables. Place the black cable on position "A" and the red cable on position "B".
A
B
■ Reassemble
in reverse order. To reconnect all the tubings correctly: see ISE module hydraulic diagram, page 18.
■ Run
a Valve Check cycle in Services > Diagnostics > ISE.
2.2.2. ISE valve assy (LV1, LV2, LV3, LV4)
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws supporting the ISE valve assy and pull it toward the rear of the ISE module.
■ Disconnect
RAS538F - 10
all the tubings from the valves.
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
ISE module spare part replacement
■ Disconnect
the valve connector from the connector located on the ISE mother board.
■ Reassemble
in reverse order. To reconnect all the tubings correctly: see ISE module hydraulic diagram, page 18.
■ Run
a Valve Check cycle in Services > Diagnostics > ISE.
2.2.3. ISE LV5 valve
■ Disconnect
the LV5 cable connector located at the back of the ISE module electrode holder.
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws supporting the LV5 valve.
■ Replace
the valve.
■ Reassemble
Technical Manual RAA023
in reverse order.
RAS538F - 11
ISE module spare part replacement
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
2.2.4. ISE LV6 valve
■ Disconnect
the LV6 cable connector located at the back of the ISE module electrode holder.
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws and washers supporting the ISE V2 mix cup valve assy.
■ Remove
the ISE V2 mix cup valve assy.
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws supporting the LV6 valve.
■ Replace
the valve.
■ Reassemble
in reverse order. To reconnect all the tubings correctly: see ISE module hydraulic diagram, page 18.
RAS538F - 12
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
ISE module spare part replacement
2.2.5. ISE V2 mix cup valve assy
■ Disconnect
the LV5 and LV6 cable connectors located at the back of the ISE module electrode holder.
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws and washers supporting the ISE V2 mix cup valve assy.
■ Disconnect
all the tubings from the ISE V2 mix cup valve assy.
■ Remove
the ISE V2 mix cup valve assy.
■ Reassemble
in reverse order. To reconnect all the tubings correctly: see ISE module hydraulic diagram, page 18.
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS538F - 13
ISE module spare part replacement
2.3.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
ISE syringes and motors replacement
2.3.1. ISE syringe + motor assy
■ Cut
the Ty-Raps™ maintaining the syringe home sensor and syringe motor cables.
■ Disconnect
from the ISE mother board: - the 2 syringe home sensor cables: one of them from the ISE syringe motor 1/75 (A) and the other one from the ISE syringe motor 1/150 (B) - the 2 syringe motor cables: one of them from the ISE syringe motor 1/75 (C) and the other one from the ISE syringe motor 1/150 (D)
■ Disconnect
A C B D
the 4 tubings on the syringe
blocks.
RAS538F - 14
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
ISE module spare part replacement
■ Remove
the ISE reagent bottles from the ISE bottle support.
■ Unscrew
the 3 screws supporting the ISE bottle support and remove it.
■ Unscrew
the 8 CHC screws supporting the ISE syringe + motor assy.
■ Reassemble
in reverse order. To reconnect all the tubings correctly: see ISE module hydraulic diagram, page 18.
■ Run
a Needle 1 Liquid Aspiration cycle and a Needle 2 Liquid Aspiration cycle in Services > Diagnostics > ISE.
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS538F - 15
ISE module spare part replacement
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
2.3.2. ISE syringe block assy
■ Disconnect
the 2 tubings from the syringe block to be replaced.
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws of the syringe block to be replaced, then remove the syringe body.
■ Reinstall
the syringe body on the ISE syringes assy without tightening the screws.
■ Go
to Services > Customer Services > ISE and press Mechanical Initialization.
■ When
the pistons are in the highest position, press Stop ISE cycle.
■ Tighten ■ Press
■ To
the syringe body screws.
Mechanical Initialization.
reconnect all the tubings correctly: see ISE module hydraulic diagram, page 18.
■ Run
a Needle 1 Liquid Aspiration cycle and a Needle 2 Liquid Aspiration cycle in Services > Diagnostics > ISE.
RAS538F - 16
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
ISE module spare part replacement
2.3.3. ISE syringe motor 1/150, 1/75
■ Cut
the Ty-Raps™ maintaining the syringe home sensor and syringe motor cables.
■ Disconnect
from the ISE mother board the syringe motor cable of the motor to be replaced: - for ISE syringe motor 1/75 (A) - for ISE syringe motor 1/150 (B)
A B
■ Unscrew
the 4 CHC screws supporting the ISE syringe motor to be replaced and remove the motor spring (if present).
spring ■ Reassemble
spring
in reverse order.
■ Run
a Needle 1 Liquid Aspiration cycle and a Needle 2 Liquid Aspiration cycle in Services > Diagnostics > ISE.
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS538F - 17
ISE module spare part replacement
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
ISE module hydraulic diagram
This diagram is available in the form of a sticker to be stuck on the inside of the ISE cover: STICKER, ISE HYDRAULIC HAX0271 (1207230271).
Mark on diagram 0.76-xxx 1.52-xxx 1.5/2.5 ISOLATOR Air sensor Na+
RAS538F - 18
P/n EAE003A* EAE007A* EAB015A (1202211015) XCA167A (1209121167) GBM0746 (3014029452) A11A01738
Designation TUBING, TYGON 0.762 (0.030) TUBING, TYGON 1.52 (0.060) FITTING, STRAIGHT 2.5/1.5 CHAMBER, ISOLATOR (SMALL) FLUID, ISE AIR DETECT.ELECTRODE ABX PENTRA SODIUM-E
Sales unit * * Pack of 5 1 1 1
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Mark on diagram ClK+ Ref LV1, LV2, LV3, LV4 LV5, LV6 E1
ISE module spare part replacement
P/n A11A01739 A11A01740 A11A01741 XBA635AS (1209119635) XBA544C (1209113544) EBA018A (1202351018) EBA017A (1202351017) XBA733AS (1209119733) EAB013A (1202211013) GBM1266 (1203601266) GBM0751 (1203600751) GBM0750 (1203600750)
Designation ABX PENTRA CHLORIDE-E ABX PENTRA POTASSIUM-E ABX PENTRA REFERENCE-E VALVE, ISE VALVE VALVE, ISE VALVE ASSY VALVE, LV5 VALVE ISE VALVE, LV6 VALVE ISE VALVE, ISE MIXCUP VALVE ASSY FITTING, STRAIGHT 3.1/2.3 CLEAR FLUID, ISE REF.BLUE STRAW 300 ML FLUID, ISE 300 ML BOTTLE STRAW FLUID, ISE 100 ML BOTTLE STRAW
Sales unit 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
* Possible to order under the following references: - EAE003AS (1202249003) (2 metres) - EAE007AS (1202249007) (2 metres)
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS538F - 19
ISE module spare part replacement
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
3. ISE module mechanical adjustments ■ Connect
3.1.
the power supply cable and switch the instrument on.
ISE mix cup adjustment
Follow the ISE mix cup adjustment procedure (see RAS441: ISE module installation, 1.4.1. ISE mix cup adjustment, page 7).
3.2.
Sample arm "ISE Sample" position adjustment
Adjust the sample arm in the ISE mix cup by following the sample arm adjustment procedure. - ISE Sample (rotation) to center the sample needle in the ISE mix cup. See RAS385: Arms, 6.3.5. ISE Position, page 42. - Low Position in ISE Tower (vertical) to adjust the sample needle height in the ISE mix cup. See RAS385: Arms, 6.4.5. "Low Position in ISE Tower", page 53.
RAS538F - 20
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
ISE module spare part replacement
4. LB sensor adjustment ■ Remove
the ISE V2 mix cup valve assy (See 2.1.3. ISE preampli board assy, page 7).
■ Unscrew
the 8 CHC screws (one with a braided ground wire) supporting the ISE preampli board assy to access the board.
■ Slowly
pull the ISE preampli board assy. The connectors and tubings must stay connected.
■ Connect a
voltmeter between TP2 and TP3.
VR1
TP2
TP3
■ Remove
the ISE cup cover (See RAS377: Covers dismantling, 9. Reagent plate, page 6).
■ Remove
the ISE mix cup.
■ Disconnect
Technical Manual RAA023
the tubing from the ISE mix cup to the air sensor.
RAS538F - 21
ISE module spare part replacement
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Measure
the voltage between TP2 and TP3. The voltage must be > 4 V with air in the sensor. If not, loosen the 4 CHC screws supporting the board, then move the board to adjust the voltage. If the voltage is still < 4 V, adjust it with the trimmer VR1.
■ Fill
a syringe with distilled water then connect it to the air sensor.
■ Use
the syringe to push the liquid in the air sensor.
■ Measure
the voltage between TP2 and TP3. The voltage must be < 1 V with liquid in the sensor. If not, loosen the 4 CHC screws supporting the board, then move the board to adjust the voltage. If the voltage is still > 1 V, adjust it with the trimmer VR1.
■ Check
if the adjustment with air in the sensor is still correct. If not readjust it.
■ Check
and readjust until both adjustments are correct.
■ When
the adjustment is correct, tighten the screws.
■ Reassemble ■
in reverse order.
Perform an ISE mix cup adjustment (see RAS441: ISE module installation, 1.4.1. ISE mix cup adjustment, page 7).
RAS538F - 22
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS539C
Dummy PENTRA software use In this procedure, specific instructions are given for previous ABX Pentra 400 hardware versions: ■ V1 corresponds to instruments with serial numbers below 2000.
RAS539: Dummy PENTRA software use
Concerns Introduction Connection of the ISE module with the laptop Reminder on the different ISE module status Communication between instrument and ISE module Command access in the Dummy PENTRA software Command validity according to the ISE module status Dummy PENTRA software use Command sequence to complete the diagnostic Explanation of the main error messages End of operation
Required tools Hexagonal keys Phillips screwdriver
Required products Distilled water
Intervention time N/A
Frequency On request
Specific kit or consumables None
Disposable gloves, eye protections and a lab coat must be worn by the operator. Local or national regulations must be applied in all the operations.
Dummy PENTRA software use
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
1. Introduction The Dummy PENTRA software makes the breakdown diagnostic relative to the ISE module easier. According to the result of the performed tests, the failure can be attributed to the ISE module in itself or to the instrument. ■ This
software stems from the HORIBA Medical production. certain software functions are available. ■ This software is designed for diagnostic help. ■ No upgrade/improvement of the software is expected at that time. ■ No specific aid concerning the use of this software will be provided. ■ The instrument can continue to run even if the ISE module is dismantled. ■ Only
2. Connection of the ISE module with the laptop ■ Switch ■ Open
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
the arms main cover and the ISE cover.
Two solutions are possible to connect to the ISE module.
2.1.
First case (easy one): use of a new connection cable ■ Obtain ■
a null modem cable DB9F/DB9F, ref. DAC028A (1201891028).
Dismantle the ISE module until you have access to its connections (See RAS538: ISE module spare part replacement, 1. ISE module dismantling, page 2).
■ Disconnect
RAS539C - 2
the null modem cable of the ISE module.
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Dummy PENTRA software use
ISE module mother board ■ Connect
the cable, ref. DAC028A (1201891028), to the ISE module (in CN2 position) and to the laptop. CN2
Connector + Null modem cable
2.2. Second case (if no cable at your disposal): use of the ISE/ instrument null modem cable
■ Dismantle
the ISE module until you have access to its connections (see RAS538: ISE module spare part replacement, 1. ISE module dismantling, page 2).
■ Remove
the mixer cover. See RAS377: Covers dismantling, 15. Mixer cover, page 9.
■ Remove the mother board cover. See RAS377: Covers dismantling, 16. Mother board cover, page
10.
Null modem cable in J3 position
■ When
the mother board is visible, disconnect the null modem cable from J3 position.
■
2 cutting wheels
Slowly guide the null modem cable down to the passage designed for the wires (follow the black "Barcode Reader" wire) to reach the ISE module back.
■ Connect
Technical Manual RAA023
the cable to the laptop.
RAS539C - 3
Dummy PENTRA software use
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
3. Reminder on the different ISE module status The ISE module exists in seven different statuses. While the instrument is running, the status of the ISE module is displayed in the ISE tab. Go to Services > Customer Services > ISE. The status from 0 to 6 of the ISE module are described in the following table: Code 0 1 2 3 4 5 6
Description Module not initialized Module initialized Module configured Mechanical part initialized Module sleeping Fluidic part initialized Module calibrated
In correct working order, the ISE module evolves sequentially from status 0 to 6, thus from the instrument start up (Power ON) to the calibrated module achievement, ready for the analyses.
RAS539C - 4
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Dummy PENTRA software use
4. Communication between instrument and ISE module The change from status to status depends on the instrument which activates specific commands (see Status transition diagram, page 5). In addition to these commands which allow the ISE module to reach the status 6, the instrument can communicate with the ISE through several other commands to provide the global functioning of the ISE module. These commands can vary from a serum measurement to a cleaning command, and include an activation command. These commands are accessible from the Dummy PENTRA software. They are defined by a number and the expected action heading.
Status transition diagram Commands of the analyzer allowing the transition from status to status
Description of the status Power ON
This status doesn’t require any command from the analyzer
Status 0 "Request status", "Request data" "Request system configuration"
Status 1
Ready to communicate with the analyzer
Status 2
Complete initialization (configuration checking, emptying of the RAM memory...)
"Set system configuration"
"Initialization of mechanical system"
Status 3
Initialization of the mechanical system
"Initialization of flow system" Status 4
Waking status
"Stabilization of flow system" Status 5
Complete initialization of the fluidic system
Status 6
Two point calibration ended
"Two point calibration"
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS539C - 5
Dummy PENTRA software use
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
5. Command access in the Dummy PENTRA software ■ Connect ■ Open
the power supply cable and switch the instrument on.
the Dummy PENTRA software by double-clicking.
If a USB/series adapter is used, configure under Windows the selected USB port in COM1.
The Dummy PENTRA screen opens.
B A
The commands are located in the middle of the window (A). They go sequentially from number 001 to 300. The second part of the commands are accessible by using the scroll bar (B).
Some numbers are missing from the sequence. They correspond to commands carried out by the instrument, but which have no sense to exist in this test software (example of unlisted command: 100- "Emergency stop").
RAS539C - 6
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Dummy PENTRA software use
6. Command validity according to the ISE module status The commands present in this software are either valid or not according to the ISE module status. The table below is a summary of the accessible commands (number and designation) according to the ISE module status: Command Command designation number
Status of the ISE Status 0 Status 1 Status 2 Status 3 Status 4 Status 5 Status 6 module after the command
001 002 003 051 052 053 054
Request status Request data Request system configuration Global initialization Set system configuration Initialization of mechanical system Initialization of flow system
OK OK OK OK OK -
OK OK OK OK OK -
OK OK OK OK OK OK -
OK OK OK OK OK OK OK
OK OK OK OK OK OK OK
OK OK OK OK OK OK OK
OK OK OK OK OK OK OK
055
Two point calibration
-
-
-
-
OK
OK
OK
056 057 058 060 061 062 063 064 065 066 067 068 069 070 101 103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110 200 300
One point calibration Measure serum Measure urine Keep ready Shut down Cleaning Prime flow system Stabilization of flow system Activation Drain Wake up Exchange electrode Ready Measure urine (2) Global check Check L solution Check H solution Check sample Check dispenser 1 Check dispenser 2 Check liquid valves Check LB sensor Position for transport IPL mode Wait
OK OK
OK OK
OK OK
OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK
OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK
OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK
OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK OK
ID ID ID 6 2 3 5 6 or 4 (if status 4 at the beginning) ID 6 6 4 3 ID ID 5 ID 3 6 NA 6 6 3 or 4 3 or 4 3 or 4 3 or 4 3 or 4 3 or 4 3 or 4 3 or 4 NU NU NU
OK: Accessible command -: Unaccessible command ID: Status identical to the initial command status NA: Not applicable NU: Not used
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS539C - 7
Dummy PENTRA software use
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
7. Dummy PENTRA software use The Dummy PENTRA software put together all the actions in relation with the ISE module, accessible in the Customer Services menu and in the Diagnostics menu.
The Dummy PENTRA software V1.32 is compatible with both ABX Pentra 400 and Pentra C400.
7.1.
Software description
The Dummy PENTRA screen contains four parts:
3 2
1
4
7.2.
Part 1: Command access
In the case of a breakdown diagnostic, one or several commands can be selected successively. ■ Double-click
the command to select it. A message is displayed. It allows you:
■ To
launch directly the command: click Run
(A). ■ To validate the command without launching
it: click OK (B). This function is used to create a sequence of commands. ■ To
RAS539C - 8
A
B
C
cancel the command: click Cancel (C).
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
7.3.
Dummy PENTRA software use
Part 2: selected commands ■ If
you click OK, the selected command is displayed in part 2 (A) of the window:
A
■
7.4.
To cancel a pre-selected command, click the command in part 2 and cancel it (with delete keyboard key).
Part 3: selected command(s) launching ■ Enter
the number of times the command(s) will be launched in the Repeat times field (B). By default, the command will be carried out only once.
■ To
launch the command without a limit notion: select the Infinity times check box (C).
■ Click
START (D) to launch the command.
■ Click
STOP (E) to stop the command. D E
B C
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS539C - 9
Dummy PENTRA software use
7.5.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Part 4: summary of information linked to the commands ■
When the command is launched, a message is displayed, informing that the selected command is running. The command can be stopped by clicking on the STOP button:
■ When
the command is finished, some information is displayed in part 4.
The information present in each column is explained in the following table: Designation of the column
Corresponding information
"Command"
Command number
"Date"
Date and hour of the test
"Status"
Status of the command (OK, ERR...)
"Initi.Lv"
0 to 6: Status of the ISE module after the command
"Na" "K"
Last values in memory*
"Cl" "SEQ. Time"
Cycle length (in seconds)
"ID#"
Number of the selected command
"Config1"
Value from 0 to 7 according to the selected electrode(s)**
"Config2"
Not used
"Config3"
Not used
"Config4"
Not used
"Config5"
Not used
"Config6"
Not used
* Data can be displayed in these three columns while no analysis have been ordered.
RAS539C - 10
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Dummy PENTRA software use
Example: without any value in memory, the following default values will be displayed: NA
K
Cl
999.9
999.9
999.9
** The table below summarizes the relation between the indicated value and the selected electrode(s):
Electrode use setup Na+
K+
Cl-
0
-
-
-
1
Yes
-
-
2
-
Yes
-
3
Yes
Yes
-
4
-
-
Yes
5
Yes
6 7
Yes
-
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
Yes
The command 052 "Set system configuration" allows you to set the use of one, two or three electrodes according to the binary weight (0=none and 7=all) assigned to the field "Config 1". To check the change of configuration, launch the command 003.
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS539C - 11
Dummy PENTRA software use
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
8. Command sequence to complete the diagnostic 8.1.
Communication test between the ISE module and the laptop ■ Command
002: "Request data" If the status is "OK" (A), the communication between the ISE module and the laptop is established.
A
8.2.
ISE module initialization to perform measurements ■ Command
052: "Set system configuration" According to the electrode number present in the ISE module, mention the corresponding value in the field 1 by referring to the information given in the table Electrode use setup, page 11. The command 052 (B) allows: - to initialize the ISE data table - the transition from status 1 to status 2. The status 2 allows you to launch the mechanical initialization of the module.
■ Command
053: "Initialization of mechanical system" If the mechanical initialization is "OK" (C), the system is then in status 3.
■ Command
054: "Initialization of flow system" If the flow system initialization is "OK" (D), the system evolves from status 3 to status 5. In status 5, the flow system is initialized.
The status 4 is a "waking" status. See Status transition diagram, page 5. The status 6 can be reached by using directly the command 067 "Waking up".
RAS539C - 12
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Dummy PENTRA software use
■ Command
055: "Two point calibration" This command makes the system available to perform measurements. If the status is "OK" (E), the status 6 is reached. ■ If
there is a problem during the calibration, an error 03 appears and the system stays in status 5. ■ If there is no value in memory, the value 999.9 is displayed for each physically present electrode. ■ All these sequences can be connected to reach directly the status 6 by using the command 051 "Global initialization".
B C D E
8.3.
Measurement sequences
To perform a measurement command, 50 µL of sample must be poured into the ISE mix cup right before launching the command. ■ Command
057: "Measure serum" The figure below is an example of repeatability performed with the Standard 1 which allows you to compare directly the obtained values with the reference values on Cl, K and Na.
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS539C - 13
Dummy PENTRA software use
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
9. Explanation of the main error messages ■ ERROR
02: communication problem between the ISE module and the instrument.
Reset the Dummy PENTRA software and switch the ISE module off and on. ■ ERROR
03: this error message exists in different cases:
If the sample is missing or if it has been poured too late: Make sure that the sample is definitely present before lauching the command. The system stays in status 6. If the system is in "Keep ready": Wait for the end of the "Keep ready" cycle and launch again the command. The system stays in status 6. If there is a problem with the air sensor: Make sure that the air sensor is not obstructed. Readjust the air sensor sensitivity. See RAS538: ISE module spare part replacement, 4. LB sensor adjustment, page 21 The sytem goes to status 4. If there is a problem during the calibration: Order a new calibration. The system goes to status 5. ■ ERROR
RAS539C - 14
06: command not available in view of the ISE module status.
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Dummy PENTRA software use
10. End of operation ■ When
the diagnostic is done, switch the Dummy PENTRA software off.
■ Switch
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
■ Disconnect
your laptop from the ISE module.
■ Reconnect
the null modem cable.
■ Reassemble ■ Connect
the ISE module in reverse order.
the power supply cable and switch the instrument on.
Specific ABX Pentra 400 V1 ■ Adjust the sample arm in the ISE mix cup. See RAS385: Arms, 6.3.5. ISE Position, page
42 and 6.4.5.
"Low Position in ISE Tower", page 53. ■ Perform
the "ISE module check up after intervention" procedure. See RAS537: ISE module check up after intervention, page 1.
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS539C - 15
Dummy PENTRA software use
RAS539C - 16
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS540C
ISE module software version installation In this procedure, specific instructions are given for previous ABX Pentra 400 hardware versions: ■ V1 corresponds to instruments with serial numbers below 2000.
RAS540: ISE module software version installation
Concerns ISE module preparation ISE software version loading End of operation
Required tools Hexagonal keys Phillips screwdriver Flat screwdriver
Required products None
Intervention time 1 h 00
Frequency On request
Specific kit or consumables Instrument software version CABLE, PC/RS L=1000 5-09 P80 DAD124A (1201921124)
Disposable gloves, eye protections and a lab coat must be worn by the operator. Local or national regulations must be applied in all the operations.
ISE module software version installation
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
1. ISE module preparation
■ Deselect
the Activate ISE Module check box in Services > System Configuration > Analyser.
■ Install
the instrument software version corresponding to the ISE software version you need. See RAS517: Software version installation, page 1.
■ For
precautionary reasons, save the client parameters (including database, system configuration, parameters of the Customer Services menu and column configuration) by using the Save button in Services > System Configuration > Local Settings.
■ Log ■ Go
in to the instrument software as technician with tech/abxtech as login/password.
to Services > Diagnostics and open the Windows Explorer.
■ Press ■ Log
the Windows Start button, press Log Off abx... and then press Log Off.
in to Windows as administrator with administrator/admin as login/password.
■ From
the Windows Explorer, go to C:\Program Files and modify the name of the P400 Software folder so that at the next instrument start, the instrument software is not launched and you are directly logged in to Windows.
■ Switch ■ Open
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
the arms main cover and the ISE cover.
■ Remove
the mother board cover. See RAS377: Covers dismantling, 16. Mother board cover, page 10.
■ Dismantle
the ISE module until you reach the ISE software board (see RAS538: ISE module spare part replacement, 1. ISE module dismantling, page 2).
RAS540C - 2
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
ISE module software version installation
CPU-03N (for ABX Pentra 400 only) Rotary selector
■ If
your ISE module is equipped with the ISE software board CPU-03N, use a flat screwdriver to turn the rotary selector from 0 to F (located on the ISE software board).
Position F
Position 0
CPU-07N (for Pentra C400 only)
SW1 switch ■ If
your ISE module is equipped with the ISE software board CPU-07N, use a flat screwdriver to change the SW1 switch position from E to W (located on the ISE mother board).
Position W ■ Disconnect
Technical Manual RAA023
the null modem cable from the ISE module.
RAS540C - 3
ISE module software version installation
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
J5
■ On the instrument mother board, unplug the
RS232 cable from position J5.
■ Plug
the RS232 cable into the ISE module.
If needed, use the CABLE, PC/RS L=1000 5-09 P80, ref. DAD124A (1201921124) to simplify the connection between the RS232 cable and the ISE module.
■ Connect
RAS540C - 4
the power supply cable and switch the instrument on.
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
ISE module software version installation
2. ISE software version loading
The following procedure is a generic procedure for the installation of ISE software versions. The version numbers mentioned are shown as an example only.
The ISE software version installation procedure lightly differs depending on the ISE software board you have on your ISE module: CPU-03N or CPU-07N. Make sure to install the ISE software version compatible with your ISE software board.
2.1.
ISE software board CPU-03N (for ABX Pentra 400 only) ■
From the Windows Explorer, go to C:\Program Files\P400 Software\Exe\Tools\ISE\CPU03N and launch the Ipl_load.exe file. The IPL Loader window is displayed.
■ Press
Rom Info.
■ In
the Information Address field, enter "00010000" instead of "00000000".
■ Press
OK. Wait while the message "Just a second..." is displayed.
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS540C - 5
ISE module software version installation
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Make
sure that the indicated ISE version number corresponds to the latest software version installed. For example 1.52.
■ Then,
■ Back
press OK.
to the IPL Loader window, press
Load.
■ Select
the ISE software version to install. For example 1.53.
■ Then,
RAS540C - 6
press Open.
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
ISE module software version installation
■ From
the IPL Loader window, press RomWrite.
■ The
following window is displayed.
■ Once
the data transfer is finished, press Rom Info and make sure that the indicated ISE version number corresponds to the version to install. For example 1.53.
■ Press
OK, then Cancel to close the IPL Loader window.
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS540C - 7
ISE module software version installation
2.2.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
ISE software board CPU-07N (for Pentra C400 only) ■ From
the Windows Explorer, go to C:\Program Files\PC400 Software\Exe\Tools\ISE\CPU07N and launch the IplActiveXClient.exe file. The IPL ActiveXClient window is displayed.
■ Select
the ISE software version to be installed, located in Tools\ISE\CPU07N (A). For example: lp207iplv200.mot.
■ Press
Initialize (B). B
A
■ Once the data transfer is finished, press Get
Info.
RAS540C - 8
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
ISE module software version installation
Version currently installed
Version to be installed
■ In
the Status window, make sure that the indicated ISE version number corresponds to the version to install. For example 2.00.
■ Press
OK to close the Status window.
■ Press
Start.
■ When
"Write completed" is displayed, press OK to close IPL ActiveXClient window.
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS540C - 9
ISE module software version installation
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
3. End of operation ■ From
the Windows Explorer, go to C:\Program Files and rename the P400 Software folder so that at the next instrument start, the instrument software is launched.
■ Press
the Windows Start button, press Shutdown and then Shutdown.
■
When getting the message "It is now safe to turn off your computer", switch the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
■
If your ISE module is equipped with the ISE software board CPU-03N, use a flat screwdriver to turn the rotary selector from F to 0 (located on the ISE software board).
Position F
Position 0
■ If
your ISE module is equipped with the ISE software board CPU-07N, use a flat screwdriver to change the SW1 switch position from W to E (located on the ISE mother board).
Position E
■ Unplug
the RS232 cable from the ISE module and plug it into the instrument mother board (J5). Then, plug the null modem cable into the ISE module.
■ Reassemble ■ Connect
the ISE module in reverse order.
the power supply cable and switch the instrument on.
Specific ABX Pentra 400 V1 ■ Adjust
the sample arm in the ISE mix cup. See RAS385: Arms, 6.4.5. "Low Position in ISE Tower", page 53.
■
Enable the ISE module by selecting the Activate ISE Module check box in Services > System Configuration > Analyser.
■ Run
RAS540C - 10
a Global Initialization cycle in Services > Customer Services > ISE.
Technical Manual RAA023
Section 8: Exploded views
1. Reagent tray .................................................................................................. 8 - 3 2. Reagent tray closing assy ............................................................................ 8 - 6 3. Sample tray.................................................................................................... 8 - 7 4. Optical bench ................................................................................................ 8 - 8 5. Reaction tray ................................................................................................. 8 - 9 6. Cuvette changer.......................................................................................... 8 - 11 7. Cuvette changer carriage assembly ......................................................... 8 - 15 8. Cuvette changer load rack......................................................................... 8 - 16 9. Cuvette changer unload rack .................................................................... 8 - 17 10. Ventilation .................................................................................................. 8 - 18 11. Arms assembly.......................................................................................... 8 - 19 12. Sample arm................................................................................................ 8 - 23 13. Reagent arm .............................................................................................. 8 - 24 14. Arms assembly kits................................................................................... 8 - 25 15. Mixer assembly ......................................................................................... 8 - 26 16. Syringe assy .............................................................................................. 8 - 28 17. Wash cup assy .......................................................................................... 8 - 29 18. Fluid part .................................................................................................... 8 - 30 19. Covering..................................................................................................... 8 - 32 20. ISE module................................................................................................. 8 - 34 21. ISE module electrode holder ................................................................... 8 - 36
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
8-1
Exploded views
22. ISE module syringes ................................................................................. 8 - 37 23. Computer ................................................................................................... 8 - 38 24. Cooling unit ............................................................................................... 8 - 40
8-2
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Exploded views Reagent tray
1. Reagent tray Reagent tray - ABX Pentra 400 V2, V3 and Pentra C400
1
2 2 3
4 8
5
9
6
10
11
7
12 13 14 15 16
Mark 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
P/n GBM1354 (1203601354) XBA587B (1209111587) CBC010A (1201681010) 1300019579 XBA535BS (1209119535) XDA820D (1209134820) XEA809CS (1209159809) GBM0940 (1203600940) XDA891AS (1209139891)
Designation COVER, REAG. INSULATED COVER FAN, REAGENT TRAY FAN L=400 PCB, REAG. TRAY BARCODE READER ROLLER, REAGENT TRAY SUPPORT SENSOR, REAGENT & REACTION TEMP. MOTOR, REAGENT TRAY MOTOR KIT, REAG TRAY TENSIONER ROLLER HOLDER, REAG TRAY FAN HOLDER HEATER, REAG. TRAY COOLING ASSY
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Qty 1 9 1 3 1 1 1 8 1
Sales unit 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Compatibility ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL
8-3
Exploded views Reagent tray
Mark 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
8-4
P/n GBM0945 (1203600945) FAA071A (1202401071) 1300019590 XEC186AS (1209179186) XBA573A (1209111573) XDA889AS (1209139889) DAM010A (1201971010)
Designation PCB, ANTI-STATIC BRUSH O'RING, REAG.TRAY COOLING ASSY ROLLER,REAG.TRAY MOTOR ROLLER SENSOR, REAG. TRAY HOME SENSOR SENSOR, REAG.TRAY DOOR SENSOR ASSY, REAG.TRAY CLOSING ASSY PCB, REAG.TRAY CLOSING SOLENOID
Qty 1 4 2 1 1 1 1
Sales unit 1 Pack of 10 1 1 1 1 1
Compatibility ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Exploded views Reagent tray
Reagent tray - Specific ABX Pentra 400 V1
6
1 7
2 8 9
3
10 4
11
5
12 13
14
15
6
Mark 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
P/n CBC010A (1201681010) 1300019590 XBA535BS (1209119535) GBM0544 (1203600544) XDA820D (1209134820) XBA587B (1209111587) GBM0945 (1203600945) XEC186AS (1209179186) FAA071A (1202401071) 1300019579 XEA809CS (1209159809) XBA573A (1209111573) EAA015A (1202201015) XDA889AS (1209139889) DAM010A (1201971010)
Designation PCB, REAG. TRAY BARCODE READER ROLLER, REAG.TRAY MOTOR ROLLER SENSOR, REAGENT & REACTION TEMP. O'RING, PEELABLE SPACER R.TRAY MOTOR, REAGENT TRAY MOTOR FAN, REAGENT TRAY FAN L=400 PCB, ANTI-STATIC BRUSH SENSOR, REAG. TRAY HOME SENSOR O'RING, REAG.TRAY COOLING ASSY ROLLER, REAGENT TRAY SUPPORT KIT, REAG TRAY TENSIONER ROLLER SENSOR, REAG.TRAY DOOR SENSOR FITTING, ANGLE D=6 ASSY, REAG.TRAY CLOSING ASSY PCB, REAG.TRAY CLOSING SOLENOID
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Qty 1 2 1 1 1 8 1 1 4 3 1 1 5 1 1
Sales unit 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Pack of 10 1 1 1 Pack of 5 1 1
Compatibility ALL ALL ALL P400 V1 ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL
8-5
Exploded views Reagent tray closing assy
2. Reagent tray closing assy
1
2
Mark P/n 1 XDA889AS (1209139889) 2 DAM010A (1201971010)
8-6
Designation ASSY, REAG.TRAY CLOSING ASSY PCB, REAG.TRAY CLOSING SOLENOID
Qty Sales unit Compatibility 1 1 ALL 1 1 ALL
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Exploded views Sample tray
3. Sample tray
1
2
3 9 4 5
6
7
8
Mark 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
P/n XBA551A (1209111551) XDA888AS (1209139888) XEC019AS (1209179019) CBC011A (1201681011) GBM0945 (1203600945) XBA518A (1209111518) FBR023A (1202621023) XDA871B (1209132871) XBA531B (1209112531)
Designation PCB, SAMPLE TRAY LED COVER, SAMPLE TRAY BLACK COVER KIT, TUBE DETECTOR UPDATE KIT PCB, SAMP.TRAY BARCODE READER PCB, ANTI-STATIC BRUSH SENSOR, LB TRAY/ARM/MIX/HANDLER BELT, SAMPLE TRAY MOTOR BELT MOTOR, SAMPLE TRAY MOTOR ASSY PCB, SAMPLE TRAY TUBE DETECTOR
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Qty 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Sales unit 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Compatibility ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL
8-7
Exploded views Optical bench
4. Optical bench
1
6
2
7 3
8
4
9 10
5
+
Mark P/n 1 XDA838B (1209132838) 2 FCA026A (1202631026) 1300028830 3 GBM1326 (1203601326) 4 XDA858AS (1209139858) 5 XDA857BS (1209139857) 6 XEC106AS (1209179106) 7 XDA854D (1209134854) 8 XAA483CS (1209109483) 9 XAA457BS (1209109457) 10 XDB114A (1209141114)
Designation OPTICAL, OPT. BENCH LAMP LOCK OPTICAL, OPTIC BENCH MIRROR OPTICAL, LAMP P400 OPTICAL, LAMP PC400 OPTICAL, CUV. EMISSION GUN+LENS OPTICAL, LAMP EMISSION GUN+LENS KIT, OPTICAL BENCH+COVERS OPTICAL, SPECTRO P400 >V5.06 PCB, ACQU. BOARD P400 >V5.06 PCB, PREAMPLIFIER BOARD P400 OPTICAL, SPEC.EMISSION GUN+LENS
Qty Sales unit Compatibility 1 1 ALL 1 1 ALL P400 1 1 PC400 1 1 ALL 1 1 ALL 1 1 ALL 1 1 ALL* 1 1 ALL* 1 1 ALL 1 1 ALL
* For the ABX Pentra 400, the acquisition board ref. XAA483CS (1209109483) and the spectrophotometer ref. XDA854D (1209134854) are compatible only if the instrument is equipped with the software version V5.0.6 or higher. The spectrophotometer ref. XDA854D (1209134854) is delivered with the acquisition board cable ref. DAD134C (1201923134). This cable is not compatible with the ABX Pentra 400 V1, the acquisition board cable ref. DAD134B (1201922134) must be used instead.
8-8
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Exploded views Reaction tray
5. Reaction tray
12
11
13
14 1 15 16 6
2 3 4
17
5
18 19 24
7
20
21
8 9
22 10
Mark 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
23
P/n XDA855AS (1209139855) 1300019574 FAC027A (1202421027) GBM1246 (1203601246) XDA856CS (1209139856) XEA833AS (1209159833) 1300019592 1300019591 1300019577
Designation MOTOR, REACTION TRAY MOTOR ROLLER, REACT TRAY BRACKET ASSY ROLLER, TENSION. ROLLER SPRING HOLDER, REAC.TRAY ADJUST PLATE ROLLER, REAC.TRAY ADJUSTABLE KIT, GROUND FITTING REAC. TRAY ROLLER, REACT.TRAY UPPER ROLLER ROLLER, REACTION TRAY LATERAL ROLLER, REACT.TRAY DOWN ROLLER
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Qty 1 1 1 1 1 1 3 2 3
Sales unit 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Compatibility ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL
8-9
Exploded views Reaction tray
Mark P/n XEC080AS (1209179080) 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
8 - 10
GBM0945 (1203600945) XDB038BS (1209149038) XDA917AS (1209139917) GBM0975 (1203600975) XBA535BS (1209119535) XDB066A (1209141066) XDA853B (1209132853) XBA536A (1209111536) FAL009A (1202491009) XDB130B (1209142130) XBA533B (1209112533) XBA534C (1209113534) XEC028AS (1209179028) FAL005A (1202491005) GBM1203 (1203601203)
Designation KIT, REACTION TRAY ROLLERS KIT Contains: 1 x XDA856CS (1209139856), 3 x 1300019592, 3 x 1300019577, 2 x 1300019591 PCB, ANTI-STATIC BRUSH COVER, TOP COVER+HATCH NEW BO ASSY, CUV. AUTO LOADING HATCH SPRING, CUV. AUTO LOADING HATCH SENSOR, REAGENT & REACTION TEMP. ASSY, CUVETTE HOLDER DISK ASSY, REACTION CROWN GEAR SENSOR, REACT.TRAY HOME SENSOR SILENT BLOCK, FOR SUB ASSEMBL. KIT, LOWCASE+FAN+HEAT FAN, REACTION TRAY FAN HEATER, REACTION TRAY KIT, LOWER CASE ASSEMBLY SILENT BLOCK, FOR LOWER CASE FILTER, LOWER CASE FOAM GRID
Qty Sales unit Compatibility 1
1
ALL
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 4 1 1 1 1 4 1
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Pack of 12 1 1 1 1 1 1
ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Exploded views Cuvette changer
6. Cuvette changer Cuvette changer - ABX Pentra 400 V2, V3 and Pentra C400
7
1 8 2
3
2
4
9
5 10
6 11
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
8 - 11
Exploded views Cuvette changer
Mark 1 2 3 4 5
P/n XBA554A (1209111554) CAE023A (1201531023) FBR021A (1202621021) XBA519A (1209111519) KAP040A (1207551040)
Designation MOTOR, TRANSLATOR MOTOR SWITCH, UNLOAD RACK SWITCH BELT, CUV.TRANSLATOR MOTOR BELT SENSOR, LB+MOT.CABLE ARM/HANDL. CLIP, CUVETTE GRABBER CLIP
Qty 1 2 1 1 1
6
XEC034AS (1209179034)
MOTOR, UP/DOWN HANDLER MOTOR
1
7
XDB111CS (1209149111)
ASSY, CUV.CHANGER W/O FRAMES
1
8
XBA518A (1209111518)
SENSOR, LB TRAY/ARM/MIX/HANDLER
2
9
FBM008A (1202601008)
CARRIAGE, CUV.HANDLER RAIL
1
10 11
FAC031A (1202421031) FAL009A (1202491009)
SPRING, HANDLER FINGER SPRING SILENT BLOCK, FOR SUB ASSEMBL.
1 4
8 - 12
Sales unit 1 1 1 1 Pack of 10
Compatibility ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL P400 V2, V3 1 PC400 P400 V2, V3 1 PC400 1 ALL P400 V2, V3 1 PC400 1 ALL Pack of 12 ALL
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Exploded views Cuvette changer
Cuvette changer - Specific ABX Pentra 400 V1
1
8
2 9
3 4 5 6
1
7 10
Mark 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
P/n CAE023A (1201531023) FBR021A (1202621021) KAP040A (1207551040) FAC031A (1202421031) XDA887AS (1209139887) XBA519A (1209111519) FAL009A (1202491009) XBA518A (1209111518) XBA554A (1209111554) XBA555A (1209111555)
Designation SWITCH, UNLOAD RACK SWITCH BELT, CUV.TRANSLATOR MOTOR BELT CLIP, CUVETTE GRABBER CLIP SPRING, HANDLER FINGER SPRING ASSY, CUVETTE HANDLER FINGER V1 SENSOR, LB+MOT.CABLE ARM/HANDL. SILENT BLOCK, FOR SUB ASSEMBL. SENSOR, LB TRAY/ARM/MIX/HANDLER MOTOR, TRANSLATOR MOTOR MOTOR, UP/DOWN HANDLER MOTOR V1
Qty 2 1 1 1 1 1 4 2 1 1
Sales unit 1 1 Pack of 10 1 1 1 Pack of 12 1 1 1
Compatibility ALL ALL ALL ALL P400 V1 ALL ALL ALL ALL V1
If the cuvette changer ABX Pentra 400 V1 needs to be replaced, order the cuvette changer update kit ref. XEC033AS (1209179033). See Cuvette changer update kit, page 8-14.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
8 - 13
Exploded views Cuvette changer
Cuvette changer update kit 1
Mark P/n 1 XEC033AS (1209179033)
8 - 14
Designation KIT, CUV. CHANGER V1->V2 UPDATE
Qty Sales unit Compatibility 1 1 V1
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Exploded views Cuvette changer carriage assembly
7. Cuvette changer carriage assembly
4 1
5
2
6
7
3
Mark P/n
Designation
1
XEC205AS (1209179205)
KIT, SILENT BLOCK CARRIAGE ASSY
2 3
XBA554A (1209111554) XBA519A (1209111519)
MOTOR, TRANSLATOR MOTOR SENSOR, LB+MOT.CABLE ARM/HANDL.
4
FBM008A (1202601008)
CARRIAGE, CUV.HANDLER RAIL
5 6 7
FBR021A (1202621021) KAP040A (1207551040) FAC031A (1202421031)
BELT, CUV.TRANSLATOR MOTOR BELT CLIP, CUVETTE GRABBER CLIP SPRING, HANDLER FINGER SPRING
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Qty Sales unit Compatibility P400 V2, V3 1 1 PC400 1 1 ALL 1 1 ALL P400 V2, V3 1 1 PC400 1 1 ALL 1 Pack of 10 ALL 1 1 ALL
8 - 15
Exploded views Cuvette changer load rack
8. Cuvette changer load rack
1 2
9
8
7
3
4
6
5
Mark 1 2 3
P/n XDA863DS (1209139863) HAX0112 (1207230112) HAX0040 (1207230040)
Designation ASSY, LOAD RACK ASSY STICKER, RACK SENSOR WIRE COVER STICKER, LOAD RACK STICKER
Qty 1 1 4
Sales unit 1 Pack of 10 Pack of 10
4
XBA560BS (1209119560)
ASSY, CUV. MOTION MOTOR
1
1
5
DAL021A (1201961021)
MOTOR, LOAD RACK MOTOR
1
1
6 7 8 9
XBA518A (1209111518) XEA997AS (1209159997) XBA532DS (1209119532) GBM0669 (1203600669)
SENSOR, LB TRAY/ARM/MIX/HANDLER KIT, LOAD RACK SUPPORT SENSOR, RACK LOAD/UNLOAD STICKER, NON SKID FOR CUV. RACK
1 1 1 2
1 1 1 1
8 - 16
Compatibility ALL ALL ALL P400 V2, V3 PC400 P400 V2, V3 PC400 ALL ALL ALL ALL
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Exploded views Cuvette changer unload rack
9. Cuvette changer unload rack
1
2
Mark P/n 1 XDA864BS (1209139864) 2 GBM0905 (1203600905)
Designation ASSY, UNLOAD RACK ASSY ASSY, UNLOADING RACK RAILS
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Qty Sales unit Compatibility 1 1 ALL 2 1 ALL
8 - 17
Exploded views Ventilation
10. Ventilation
1
2
Mark P/n 1 XBA393A (1209111393) 2 XBA634A (1209111634)
Designation FAN, MAIN FAN 24 V P60/P80 FAN, PC/LAMP 24 V FAN
Qty Sales unit Compatibility 1 1 ALL 1 1 ALL
The FAN, MAIN FAN 24 V P60/P80 ref. XBA393A (1209111393) is located at the rear of the instrument, right below the mother board.
8 - 18
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Exploded views Arms assembly
11. Arms assembly Arms assembly - ABX Pentra 400 V2, V3 and Pentra C400
1
2 3
5
6
4 7
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
8 - 19
Exploded views Arms assembly
Mark P/n 1
GBM1113 (1203601113)
2
GBM1112 (1203601112)
3 4 5 6 7
FBR022A (1202621022) XBA541A (1209111541) XBA518A (1209111518) XBA542B (1209112542) XBA519A (1209111519)
8 - 20
Designation
Qty Sales unit Compatibility P400 V2, V3 COVER, LEFT ARM COVER 1 1 PC400 P400 V2, V3 COVER, RIGHT ARM COVER 1 1 PC400 BELT, ARM ROTATION MOVEMENT 2 1 ALL MOTOR, UP/DOWN SAMPLE ARM MOTOR 1 1 ALL SENSOR, LB TRAY/ARM/MIX/HANDLER 2 1 ALL MOTOR, ROTATION ARM MOTOR 2 1 ALL SENSOR, LB+MOT.CABLE ARM/HANDL. 2 1 ALL
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Exploded views Arms assembly
Arms assembly - Specific ABX Pentra 400 V1
1
2
3
5
4
6
7
8
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
8 - 21
Exploded views Arms assembly
Mark 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
P/n GBM0924 GBM0654 FBR022A (1202621022) XBA541A (1209111541) XBA518A (1209111518) XBA542B (1209112542) XBA540C* (1209113540) XBA519A (1209111519)
Designation COVER, LEFT ARM COVER P400 V1 COVER, RIGHT ARM COVER P400 V1 BELT, ARM ROTATION MOVEMENT MOTOR, UP/DOWN SAMPLE ARM MOTOR SENSOR, LB TRAY/ARM/MIX/HANDLER MOTOR, ROTATION ARM MOTOR MOTOR, UP/DOWN REAG.ARM MOTOR SENSOR, LB+MOT.CABLE ARM/HANDL.
Qty 1 1 2 1 2 2 1 2
Sales unit 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Compatibility P400 V1 P400 V1 ALL ALL ALL ALL P400 V1 ALL
* The part number XBA540C (1209113540) is obsolete and replaced by the kit ASSY, REAGENT ARM ASSY W/O JIB ref. XDA861CS (1209139861).
8 - 22
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Exploded views Sample arm
12. Sample arm
1
4
5 6
2
7
3
Mark 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
P/n DBJ025A (1202131025) GBM0675 (1203600675) GBM1204 (1203601204) XEA827AS (1209159827) XBA563ET (1209119563) XBA847AT (1209119847) GBM0612 (1203600612) XAA486AS (1209108486)
Designation CLIPS, PLASTIC D=6.4 MM TUBING, SAMPLE PIPE GUIDING TUBING, ARM PIPE HOLDER COVER, SAMPLE ARM JIB COVER NEEDLE, SAMPLE P400 W FERRITE NEEDLE, SAMPLE PC400 NEEDLE, SHOCK DETECTION SPRING PCB, SAMPLE ARM DETECTION BOARD
Qty 2 1 1 1
Sales unit Pack of 2 1 1 1
1
1
1 1
1 1
Compatibility ALL ALL ALL ALL P400 PC400 ALL ALL
To position the teflon tubing of the sample needle in the correct way on the mother board cover, use the CLIPS, PLASTIC D=6.4 MM ref. DBJ025A (1202131025).
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
8 - 23
Exploded views Reagent arm
13. Reagent arm
1 4
5 2
3
Mark 1 2 3 4 5 6
P/n DBJ025A (1202131025) GBM0621 (1203600621) GBM1204 (1203601204) XEA826AS (1209159826) XBA564DT (1209119564) XAA500FS (1209109500)
6
Designation CLIPS, PLASTIC D=6.4 MM TUBING, REAGENT PIPE GUIDING TUBING, ARM PIPE HOLDER KIT, KIT REAG. ARM COVER NEEDLE, REAGENT NEEDLE PCB, REAG.LEVEL DETECTION BOARD
Qty 2 1 1 1 1 1
Sales unit Pack of 2 1 1 1 1 1
Compatibility ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL
To position the teflon tubing of the reagent needle in the correct way on the mother board cover, use the CLIPS, PLASTIC D=6.4 MM ref. DBJ025A (1202131025).
8 - 24
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Exploded views Arms assembly kits
14. Arms assembly kits
2
1
Mark P/n 1
XDA823E (1209135823)
2 3
XDA862CS (1209139862) XDA861CS (1209139861)
Designation ASSY, SAMPLE AND REAGENT ARMS Includes: 1 x XBA520A (1209111520), 1 x XBA815A (1209111815), 1 x XBA814A (1209111814) ASSY, SAMPLE ARM ASSY W/O JIB ASSY, REAGENT ARM ASSY W/O JIB
3
Qty Sales unit Compatibility 1
1
P400 V2, V3 PC400
1 1
1 1
ALL ALL
For the ABX Pentra 400 V1 and V2: because the up/down reagent arm motor rotation way is inverted, it is mandatory to replace the reagent arm vertical motor cable by the new one (provided in the kit XDA861CS (1209139861)).
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
8 - 25
Exploded views Mixer assembly
15. Mixer assembly
1
9
10
2
11 3
12
4
13
5 14 6
15 16
7 8
8 - 26
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Exploded views Mixer assembly
Mark 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
P/n JAJ007AS (1207309007) XDA837C (1209133837) XDB299AS (1209149299) XBA518A (1209111518) XBA561D (1209114561) FAC030A (1202421030) EBD007A (1202381007) GBM0134 (1203600134) GBM0633 (1203600633) FZZ009A (1202651009) FAC023A (1202421023) DBD007A (1202091007) DAL029A (1201961029) XDA835B (1209132835) CAE006A (1201531006) XDA886AS (1209139886)
Designation ADHESIVE, TAPE FOR RACK L=1M ASSY, COMPLETE MIXER KIT, MIXER ARM ASSY SENSOR, LB TRAY/ARM/MIX/HANDLER MIXER, MIXING PADDLE MOTOR ASSY SPRING, MIXER SHAFT SPRING AIR CYLINDER, MIXER NEEDLE, MIXING PADDLE COVER, MIXER ASSY COVER CLIP, SMALL RUBBER BUMPER SPRING, MIXER ARM SPRING O'RING, MIX PADDLE MOTOR CABLE MOTOR, MIXER ASSY MOTOR CUP, MIXER WASH CUP SWITCH, MICROSWITCH XC5-81-82 CUP, MIXER WASH CUP SUPPORT
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Qty 1 1 1 1 1 2 1 1 1 5 1 1 1 1 1 1
Sales unit 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 Pack of 10 1 Pack of 10 1 1 Pack of 5 1
Compatibility ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL
8 - 27
Exploded views Syringe assy
16. Syringe assy
1 2 6
7
3
4
5
Mark 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
8 - 28
P/n XDA822C (1209133822) XBA546A (1209111546) GBM1211 (1203601211) CAE010A (1201531010) FAL009A (1202491009) B8078955 (1228078955) B8076812 (1228076812)
Designation SYRINGE, SYR. BLOCK ASSY MOTOR, SYRINGE MOTOR SPRING, SYRINGE BLOCK GND SWITCH, MICROSWITCH XC5-81 SILENT BLOCK, FOR SUB ASSEMBL. REAGENT SYRINGE (1000 µL) SAMPLE SYRINGE (100 µL)
Qty 1 2 1 2 8 1 1
Sales unit 1 1 1 Pack of 5 Pack of 12 1 1
Compatibility ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Exploded views Wash cup assy
17. Wash cup assy
1
2 5
3
4
Mark 1 2 3 4 5
P/n GBM0773 (1203600773) XDA836A (1209131836) GBM1198 (1203601198) FAL009A (1202491009) XDA879AS (1209139879)
Designation CUP, WASH CUP OVERFLOW CUP, NEEDLE WASH CUP CLIP, FOR REAGENT WASH CUP SILENT BLOCK, FOR SUB ASSEMBL. CUP, NEEDLE WASH CUP SUPPORT
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Qty 1 2 1 1 2
Sales unit 1 1 1 Pack of 12 1
Compatibility ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL
8 - 29
Exploded views Fluid part
18. Fluid part
1
13 14
2
16
12
3 4 17
2 3
14 5
6
9
7
18
4
13
13 15
2
19
8
20
9 10
21
11
24
23 22
+ EAC015A (x3)
8 - 30
+ EAC015A (x1)
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Exploded views Fluid part
Mark 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
P/n XCA197A (1209121197) EAA015A (1202201015) EAA017A (1202201017) EAC012A (1202221012) XCA198B (1209122198) EAA022A (1202201022) EAA023A (1202201023) 1300015267 EBA010A (1202351010) EAA006A (1202201006)
11
1300015280
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21
XCA193A (1209121193) EAC026A (1202221026) EAC025A (1202221025) FAA072A (1202401072) XCA194B (1209122194) EBA011A (1202351011) EZZ001A (1202391001) XEC202AS (1209179202) XCA216BS (1209129216) FAL008B (1202492008)
22
XBA574C (1209113574)
23
LBH004A (1207791004)
24
XBA568F (1209114568) EAC015A (1202221015)
Designation FLUID, CONDENSATION MANIFOLD V1 FITTING, ANGLE D=6 FITTING, STRAIGHT D=6 FITTING, STOPPER D=6 FLUID, OVERFLOW MANIFOLD FITTING, ANGLE 1/4" 1/8-27 FITTING, STRAIGHT 1/4"1/8-27 MANIFOLD, WITH VALVES V1 AND V2 VALVE, 2 WAYS ELECTROVALVE FITTING, STRAIGHT I=3X19.5 KIT, WIRED PRESSURE SENSORS WITH PCB FLUID, INTERNAL WATER TANK FITTING, FITTING S=20 FITTING, FITTING S=30 O'RING, INTERN.WATER TANK VALVE, 3 VALVES ASSY VALVE, 3 WAYS ELECTROVALVE FITTING, STOPPER D=4 PUMP, WATER ASSY + METAL SHEET PUMP, WASTE ASSY + METAL SHEET SILENT BLOCK, COMPR. ALL P120 FLUID, WASTE STRAW ASSY Includes: 3 x EAC015A (1202221015) FLUID, 10 L CONTAINER FLUID, WATER STRAW ASSY Includes: 1 x EAC015A (1202221015) FITTING, LUER MALE FITTING
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Qty 1 5 3 2 1 2 2 1 3 1
Sales unit 1 Pack of 5 Pack of 5 Pack of 5 1 Pack of 5 Pack of 5 1 1 Pack of 5
Compatibility P400 V1 ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL
1
1
ALL
1 7 2 1 1 2 1 1 1 4
1 Pack of 5 Pack of 5 1 1 1 Pack of 5 1 1 Pack of 4
ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL
1
1
ALL
1
1
ALL
1
1
ALL
4
Pack of 5
ALL
8 - 31
Exploded views Covering
19. Covering
13 1
14
2
15
3 16
4
17
5
18
6
19
7 8
20
9
21 22
10
23 11 12
26
25
24
27
8 - 32
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Exploded views Covering
Mark P/n 1 XDA872CS (1209139872) HAX0301 (1207230301) 2 HAX0327 (1207230327) 3 GBM0793 (1203600793) 4 GBM0418 (1203600418) 5 XEC099AS (1209179099) 6 GBM0883 (1203600883) 7 XDA932E (1209135932) 8 FAX009AS (1202529009) 9 FAX012AS HAX0300 (1207230300) 10 HAX0343 (1207230343) 11 JAJ015AS (1207309015) 12 GBM0901 (1203600901) 13 GBM0881 (1203600881) 14 EBD006A (1202381006) 15 GBM0886 (1203600886) 16 GBM0789 (1203600789) 17 GBM0791 (1203600791) 18 XDA874CS (1209137874) 19 GBM0790 (1203600790) 20 XDA877BS (1209139877) 21 CZZ030B (1201862030) XBA682CS (1209119682) 22 XBA735AS (1209119735) XDB112AS (1209149112) 23 XAA578A (1209101578) 24 XDA875BS (1209139875) 25 FZZ048A (1202651048) 26 GBM0882 (1203600882)
Designation COVER, TOP ISE COVER STICKER, ISE COVER LABEL P400 STICKER, ISE COVER LABEL PC400 COVER, BOTTOM ISE COVER COVER, SAMPLE TRAY LEFT SIDE COVER, SAMPLE TRAY RIGHT SIDE COVER, POWER SUPPLY COVER COVER, REAGENT TRAY FRONT COVER COVER, REAG. COVER FOAM EP=6 COVER, REAG. COVER FOAM EP=9 STICKER, REAG TRAY DOOR P400 STICKER, REAG TRAY DOOR PC400 COVER, REAG. COVER MAGNET. TAPE COVER, P400 ADJUSTABLE FOOT COVER, ARMS MAIN COVER ASSY AIR CYLINDER, COVER COVER, SEGMENT HANDLER COVER COVER, BACK REAGENT TRAY COVER COVER, MIXER COVER BACK SIDE COVER, LAMP HATCH COVER, REACTION TRAY LEFT SIDE COVER, MANUAL CUVETTE LOADING PCB, SPEAKER PCB, SPEAKER + HATCH USB PCB, CONNECTION HATCH+USB COVER, PC CONNECTION HATCH PCB, USB EXTENSION BOARD COVER, REACTION TRAY RIGHT SIDE COVER, WASH CUP HATCH PUSH-PUSH COVER, PC COVER
Qty Sales unit Compatibility 1 1 ALL P400 1 1 PC400 1 1 ALL 1 1 ALL 1 1 ALL 1 1 ALL 1 1 ALL 1 1 ALL 1 1 ALL P400 1 1 PC400 1 1 ALL 4 1 ALL 1 1 ALL 3 1 ALL 1 1 ALL 1 1 ALL 1 1 ALL 1 1 ALL 1 1 ALL 1 1 ALL 1 1 ALL
27
COVER, REAG. DOOR REPAIR HINGES
1300023001
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
1
1
ALL
1 1 1 1
1 1 1 1
1
1
ALL ALL ALL ALL P400 V2, V3 PC400
8 - 33
Exploded views ISE module
20. ISE module
1
2
3 3
5
4 6 7
9
8 10 20
11
19
12
18 13
21 17 14
15
8 - 34
16
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Exploded views ISE module
Mark P/n XDA843ES (1209139843) 1 XDB263AS (1209149263) 2 HAX0271 (1207230271) 3 GBM0753 (1203600753) 4 GBM0751 (1203600751) 5 GBM1266 (1203601266) 6 GBM0752 (1203600752) 7 GBM0750 (1203600750) 8 GBM1267 (1203601267) 9 XBA635AS (1209119635) 10 XBA544C (1209113544) 11 XDA921DS (1209136921) XAA497E (3200448459) 12 XAA646A (3200375620) 13 XAA492CS (1209109492) 14 EBA017A (1202351017) 15 EBA018A (1202351018) 16 XBA733AS (1209119733) 17 HAX0141 (1207230141) 18 XCA167A (1209121167) 19 XDA892B (1209132892) 20 GBM0870 (1203600870) 21 XBA543A (3012277056)
Designation ISE, MODULE ASSY V1.53 P400 ISE, MODULE ASSY V2.00 PC400 STICKER, ISE HYDRAULIC FLUID, ISE 280 ML BOTTLE CAP FLUID, ISE 300 ML BOTTLE STRAW FLUID, ISE REF.BLUE STRAW 300 ML FLUID, ISE 100 ML BOTTLE CAP FLUID, ISE 100 ML BOTTLE STRAW CUP, ISE BOTTLE SUPPORT VALVE, ISE VALVE VALVE, ISE VALVE ASSY ASSY, ISE SYRINGES + MOTORS PCB, ISE SOFTWARE V1.53 P400 PCB, ISE SOFTWARE V2.00 PC400 PCB, ISE MAIN BOARD VALVE, LV6 VALVE ISE VALVE, LV5 VALVE ISE VALVE, ISE MIXCUP VALVE ASSY STICKER, ISE ELECTRODE POSITION CHAMBER, ISOLATOR (SMALL) CUP, ISE MIX CUP COVER, ISE CUP COVER CABLE, PREAMP.TO MAIN BOARD ISE
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Qty Sales unit Compatibility P400 1 1 PC400 1 1 ALL 1 1 ALL 1 1 ALL 1 1 ALL 2 1 ALL 2 1 ALL 1 1 ALL 1 1 ALL 1 1 ALL 1 1 ALL P400 1 1 PC400 1 1 ALL 1 1 ALL 1 1 ALL 1 1 ALL 1 1 ALL 1 1 ALL 1 1 ALL 1 1 ALL 1 1 ALL
8 - 35
Exploded views ISE module electrode holder
21. ISE module electrode holder
1 2 3 4 5 6
7 8 9
10 Mark 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
8 - 36
P/n GBM0500 (1203600500) GBM0607 (1203600607) A11A01738 A11A01739 A11A01740 GBM0746 (3014029452) XEA795AS (1209159795) A11A01741 XDA923AS (1209139923) XBA603A (1209111603)
Designation PCB, ISE ELECTR. SPRING CONTACT DOOR, ISE ELECTRODE SUPPORT ABX PENTRA SODIUM-E ABX PENTRA CHLORIDE-E ABX PENTRA POTASSIUM-E FLUID, ISE AIR DETECT.ELECTRODE DOOR, ISE CAGE DOOR ABX PENTRA REFERENCE-E PCB, ISE PREAMPL. BOARD ASSY CABLE, ISE BOARDS GND WIRE
Qty 6 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Sales unit 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Compatibility ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Exploded views ISE module syringes
22. ISE module syringes
1
2
3
4
5
9 6
7
8
Mark 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
P/n XDA921DS (1209136921) XBA591A (1209111591) XBA592A (1209111592) XBA545B (1209112545) 3200261156 XDA922BS (1209138922) FAA073A (1202401073) GBM0891 (1203600891) GBM1372 (1203601372)
Designation ASSY, ISE SYRINGES + MOTORS MOTOR, ISE SYR.MOTOR 1/150 MOTOR, ISE SYR.MOTOR 1/75 CABLE, ISE SYR. LB CABLE SENSOR, OPTICAL CELL SYRINGE, ISE SYR. BLOCK ASSY O'RING, ISE SYRINGE O'RING SYRINGE, ISE SYR. PISTON SPRING, FOR ISE MOTOR SHAFT
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Qty 1 1 1 2 2 1 8 4 2
Sales unit 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Compatibility ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL ALL
8 - 37
Exploded views Computer
23. Computer Computer models from 1300013734 1
2
5 6
3
7 8 4
Mark 1 2 3
P/n 1300013893 GBM0882 (1203600882) XDB355A (1209141355)
4
1201772017
5 6 7
XBA507AS (1209119507) 1300018920 1300014030
8
1300023975
8 - 38
Designation PCB, PC ASSY FOR W7 TYPE 1300013734 COVER, PC COVER PCB, SCREEN COMPL. ASSY PCB, HDD SATA 250 GO (for computer models from "CCC014J") FAN, FOR COMPUTER P80 CABLE, WITH SOUND AMPLIFICATION PCB PCB, RAM 4GB DDR3 PCB, MOTHER BOARD CONFIGURED FOR PC
Qty 1 1 1
Sales unit 1 1 1
Compatibility ALL ALL ALL
1
1
ALL
1 1 1
1 1 1
ALL ALL ALL
1
1
ALL
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Exploded views Computer
Computer models < 1300013734
1
2
5
3 4
Mark P/n 1 GBM0882 (1203600882) 2 XAA511BS (1209109511) CBT018A 3
CBT021A (1201771021)
4
XEC074AS (1209179074) 1201772017
5
XBA507AS (1209119507)
Designation COVER, PC COVER PCB, TOUCH PANEL FUTJI P80 PCB, CD-ROM READER P80/P400 (for computer models < "CCC014L") PCB, DVDRW PC CCC005L/CCC014L (for computer models from "CCC014L") PCB, HDD FOR PC System Configuration > Analyser.
■ Identification ■
mode: select this mode if all sample tubes are identified with barcode labels.
Position mode: select this mode if sample tubes with and without barcode labels are used on the instrument.
IMPORTANT! To use the instrument in connected mode, it is mandatory to select the Identification mode.
Then, the connection is configured on the instrument in Services > System Configuration > Host connection.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
10 - 3
Host connection Connection configuration on the instrument
2.1.
RS232 Configuration
Heading Bauds Parity Stop bit Profile
2.2.
Description Speed selection: 1200, 2400, 4800, 9600, 19200, 38400, 57600, 115200 Parity selection: None, Odd, Even Stop bit selection: 1 Stop, 2 Stop Protocol selection: Xon/Xoff, None
Format
Default value
Radio button
9600
Radio button Radio button Radio button
None 1 Stop Xon/Xoff
Query Mode
This part is used to enable/disable the Query mode. The Query mode allows the instrument to ask the Host if there is a programmed request corresponding to the SID (Sample IDentification) read on the sample tray.
The Query mode is automatically disabled when the instrument operates in Position mode.
The Sending validated samples option is used to manually ask the Host for supplementary tests on validated patient samples by using the corresponding function in the Work Balance menu or the Patient Result list.
2.3.
Handling spaces
This part is used to authorize the character "Space" on the left side of the Sample ID field.
2.4.
■
If the check box is selected, then the character "Space" is allowed on the left side of the Sample ID field when manually captured from the instrument as when loaded from the Host. On prints, the character "Space" is indicated by a rectangle.
■
If the check box is deselected, then the character "Space" is not authorized on the left side of the Sample ID field and is systematically deleted.
Automatic Transmission to Host
This part is used to enable/disable the automatic transmission of patient and/or control results to the Host.
10 - 4
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Host connection Connection protocol
Three options of transmission are available: ■ Nothing: ■
no transmission.
Order: transmission request by request after manual or automatic validation of the results (only for patient results). The results of all the tests of a request must be validated in order to be transmitted.
■ Test:
transmission test by test after manual or automatic validation of the results. The results of each test are transmitted as soon as they are validated.
2.5.
Analyser Id
This field is used to enter the identification number of the instrument by the Host.
2.6.
Host Tools
This part is used to perform some operations regarding the Host connection. See Host Tools, page 10-17.
3. Connection protocol The ABX Pentra 400 / Pentra C400 connection protocol is both the language used for the transmission of data between the instrument and the LIS (Laboratory Information System) and the way the data is exchanged. For simplification, we will call protocol the way the data is exchanged and format the language used.
3.1.
Format type
The ASTM (American Society for Testing and Materials) format is the language used for the transmission of data on the ABX Pentra 400 / Pentra C400.
3.2.
Connection type
There are two analyzer operating modes: monodirectional (i.e. unidirectional) and bidirectional. This is inherent to the protocol. On the ABX Pentra 400 / Pentra C400, the bidirectional connection is used.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
10 - 5
Host connection ASTM format
4. ASTM format The ASTM format was developed several years ago to standardize the connection between analysis instruments and LIS. In fact, there were as many connection formats as companies providing instruments. Each company may use a different protocol for each instrument. The ASTM proposed one standard for the low level exchange protocol (E-1381) and another for the format used for the transmission of clinical data (E-1394).
For more information, please refer to the document "Output formats ABX Pentra 400 / Pentra C400" ref. RAA025, intended for IT Services Companies.
4.1.
Exchange structure
At the protocol level, the data exchange is based on the following model: - (ENQuiry) --> line pick-up request. - (ACKnowledge) --> correct acknowledgement, positive response to the line pick-up request. - ..data.. (Start of Text ..data.. End of Text) --> data transmission. - (ACKnowledge) --> acceptance of data receipt. - (End Of Transmission) --> end of message.
The characters (Carriage Return) and (Line Feed) are usually placed at the end of frame for a better organization and reading.
4.2.
The different ASTM frames
These different frames have an identifier that indicates the nature of transmitted data between and . From Host Header (grab)
Patient (patient data) Order (test request) Result (results) Query (Host interrogation)
10 - 6
H separator P patient demography O Q if no request entered
To Host H (full or shortened) separator + sender ID + date and time P patient demography O R Q simple or multiple
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Host connection ASTM format
Comment (comments, optional)
From Host C comments linked to patient / order
To Host C comments linked to patient / order / result
L
L
Terminator (give back, end of communication)
Three types of separators are used in these frames: - | separates the fields - ^ separates the parts of a field - \ separates the repetitive fields.
4.3.
The different record structures
4.3.1. Structure of Order transmission - H (Header) - ...P (Patient) - ...C (Patient Comments) optional - ......O (Order) - ......C (Order Comments) optional - L (Terminator)
The comment frames are optional.
Example Patient. If not, check the connection configuration on the instrument and make sure that the test corresponding to the channel #39 (used above) is enabled.
Check of instrument data transmission The purpose of this procedure is to make sure that a pending data transmission, created in the Rs_Data folder, is sent correctly by the instrument software, and so that the connection on the instrument is well-configured and the communication with the Host works properly.
■ Create
the following file with a text editor: H|\^&||||||||||P|E1394-97|20040226162323 P|1|||||||U O|1|20040216004||||20040216141034|20040216000000||||||||1||||||||||F R|1|^^^18^C_Chol|2.27|12||H||F|||20040216141911 L|1|N
■ Save
this file as follows: Astm260204162323245.trx
■ Put
this file in the Rs_Data folder.
If the connection is well-configured, the result should be sent correctly by the instrument software (the file disappears from the Rs_Data folder) and should be received by the Host. If not, test the physical connection (cable) and ask the IT Services Company to check the LIS configuration and that the test corresponding to the channel #18 (used above) is enabled.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
10 - 19
Host connection Connection test
■ The
Rs_Data folder contains temporary files, created during the communication with the Host. These temporary files are named as follows: AstmddMMyyhhmmsszzz (date, time, three-digit number) and the following file extensions are possible.
File extension .r* .rcv .rrr .rer .t* .trx .ter
Description Data receipt from Host to instrument. Pending data receipt. Data receipt with incorrect ASTM format. Data receipt with an error (see warning #620). Data transmission from instrument to Host. Pending data transmission. An error appears during the communication with the Host. Successful data transmission. Note: These files are quickly suppressed.
.tok
■A
file SEND_TO_SIL can appear in the Rs_Data folder, this file lists the status of data transmissions from instrument to Host in case of "GeneralException" error (for example). ■ During the instrument initialization, the following message can be displayed: "Transmission not successful, do you want to continue to process queued messages?". This message means that data transmissions are pending in the Rs_Data folder. Press Yes to send the pending data transmissions as soon as the communication with the Host is running. Press No to suppress the pending data transmissions.
7.2.2. Using the WinASTM software
The WinASTM software should be used only for connection tests on HORIBA Medical instruments.
■ The
purpose of this procedure is to simulate the Host, using the WinASTM software on a laptop, to send an order to the instrument and to receive a result from the instrument. ■ This procedure consists in simulating the transmission of a test T1 order to the instrument and checking the result receipt once the analysis has been performed.
Installation of the WinASTM software ■ Download
the WinASTM_x.x.x(x.x.x.x).exe file on a laptop (example: WinASTM_1.0.0(1.0.0.2).exe).
■ Double-click
10 - 20
the .exe file and follow the instructions displayed to install the WinASTM software.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Host connection Connection test
Connection configuration on the WinASTM software The connection on the WinASTM software must be configured according to the connection parameters configured on the instrument in Services > System Configuration > Host connection. ■
Note down the connection parameters configured on the instrument in Services > System Configuration > Host connection.
■
Enter these connection parameters on the WinASTM software in Configuration > RS and Sockets Settings.
■ Click
Save and quit to save the connection configuration.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
10 - 21
Host connection Connection test
Configuration of test T1 on the WinASTM software To simulate the transmission of a test T1 order, the test T1 must be previously configured on the WinASTM software. ■ Go
10 - 22
to Configuration > Other Settings.
■ Click
Add One Row.
■ Enter
the channel #600 corresponding to the test T1 in the available field.
■ Click
Save and quit to save the test T1 configuration.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Host connection Connection test
Creation of a test T1 order on the WinASTM software ■ Click
the Database Records tab.
■ Create
a test T1 order by filling the Patient and Order fields as follows:
2 2 4 3
5
5
1. Select the Modify check box to access modification function. 2. Use the Patient Index # displayed in the left window to fill the Patient Index field in the right window. 3. Use the current date to fill the Collection Date field with the following format: yyyyddMM.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
10 - 23
Host connection Connection test
4. Select the channel #600 corresponding to the test T1 in the Test scrolling list. Note: If the channel #600 does not appear in the scrolling list, close and reopen the WinASTM software. 5. Do not forget to click Modify Current Patient/Modify Current Order to save the Patient/Order fields.
For more information about the different fields, please refer to the document "Output formats ABX Pentra 400 / Pentra C400" ref. RAA025, intended for IT Services Companies.
Test of communication between the instrument and the WinASTM software ■ Go
to Services > System Configuration > Host connection.
■ Press
the Test communication button to test the communication with the WinASTM software.
■ Once
the test is done, make sure that the message displayed in the Received character field is ACK (ACKnowledge).
Simulate the transmission of a test T1 order to the instrument ■
Before simulating the transmission of a test T1 order to the instrument, check the status of the instrument. It must be Ready. The control solution for the test T1 must be configured and physically positioned on the sample tray (you can use distilled water in place of the control solution). Two vials of distilled water (15 mL and 10 mL) must be configured as a reagent for the test T1 and physically positioned on the reagent tray. The calibration for the test T1 must be performed.
■ Then,
check the status of the WinASTM software. The WinASTM software must be connected to the instrument i.e. the status buttons must be as follows:
If not and the status buttons are as follows:
1
2
Press (1), then (2) to connect the WinASTM software. If it does not work, check the connection configuration, test the physical connection (cable) and test the communication using the Host Tools in Services > System Configuration > Host connection. ■ Choose
the protocol: On the WinASTM software, there are two protocols "ASTM" and "LIS1/2A". The "LIS1/2A" protocol corresponds to the ASTM protocol with an extended transmission capacity (64 octets -> around 65000 octets). To switch between "ASTM" and "LIS1/2A" protocols, use the button below:
When "ASTM" is displayed, "LIS1/2A" protocol is selected. When "LIS1/2A" is displayed, "ASTM" protocol is selected.
10 - 24
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Host connection Connection test
■ Once
the test T1 order is created from the Database Records tab, click Send Current Patient With His Orders to send the test T1 order to the instrument.
■ Click
the Console tab to visualize the sent frame.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
10 - 25
Host connection Connection test
■ The order should be correctly integrated by the instrument software and created in Worklist > Patient.
If not, check on the instrument: the instrument status, the loading mode configuration and the connection configuration. Check on the WinASTM software: the status buttons, the connection configuration and make sure that the test T1 order is correctly created. ■
In Worklist > Patient, open the order and select the rack position of the control solution physically positioned on the sample tray. Press OK to validate. Then, press Start to run the analysis.
■ Once
10 - 26
the analysis has been performed, check the result receipt on the WinASTM software.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Host connection Troubleshooting
8. Troubleshooting 8.1.
List of warnings about the connection
Level
Code Message
Action
Warning
604
Modify the Sample ID from the Host.
Warning
605
Warning
620
Warning
644
Warning
645
Warning
646
Warning
647
Warning
648
Error type The sample ID in brackets, programmed from the Host, This Sample ID [%s] is a contains the "AUTO_SID" reserved code prefix. [%s] = Sample ID. The patient ID in brackets, programmed from the Host, This Patient ID [%s] is a contains the "AUTO_SID" reserved code prefix. [%s] = Patient ID. A request, programmed from L.I.S. order can't be the Host, does not comply performed for SID [sample with the ASTM format. The ID]: incorrect value [value] in fields sample ID, action code field [field] or sample type contain an incorrect value. LIS order cannot be There is no O frame (Order) performed. No order information available for PID for the P frame (Patient). [patient ID]. LIS order cannot be performed: communication/ There is no P frame (Patient) protocol error. Order for the O frame (Order). information for SID [sample ID] could not be processed. LIS order cannot be performed: communication/ There is no O frame (Order) for the P frame (Patient). protocol error. Patient information for PID [patient Interrupted communication. ID] could not be processed. LIS order cannot be performed: communication/ There is no L frame protocol error. Information for (Terminator) before PID [patient ID] and related (End of Transmission). orders SID(s): [sample ID] could not be processed. LIS communication/protocol There is no P frame (Patient) error. Comment information or O frame (Order) for the C could not be processed. frame (Comment).
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Modify the Patient ID from the Host.
Check and modify the request from the Host.
Ask the IT Services Company to check the LIS configuration.
Ask the IT Services Company to check the LIS configuration.
Ask the IT Services Company to check the LIS configuration.
Ask the IT Services Company to check the LIS configuration.
Ask the IT Services Company to check the LIS configuration.
10 - 27
Host connection Troubleshooting
Level
Code Message
Error type The Q frame (Query) comes with a P frame (Patient) or a O frame (Order) although only LIS communication/protocol the H frame (Header) and the error. Query information L frame (Terminator) are could not be processed. authorized with the Q frame. At least two Q frames comes together although only one Q frame is authorized. A request, programmed from the Host, has one or several rejected tests. Each rejected test contains one of the following errors. - "Channel error": The test L.I.S. order with SID [sample field does not contain a ID] error. The following tests channel number. are rejected: [test no.1 - "Disabled": The test is (reason no.1), test no.2 disabled on the instrument. (reason no.2), etc]. - "Not configured": The test is not configured on the instrument. - "Sample type incompatible": The sample type of the test does not match the sample.
Action
Warning
649
Ask the IT Services Company to check the LIS configuration.
Warning
650
8.2.
Troubleshooting help
Check and modify the request from the Host.
No order is integrated by the instrument software and created in Worklist > Patient. When the instrument is used in connected mode, it is mandatory to select the Identification mode even if the laboratory does not use barcodes. When the Position mode is selected, no order is integrated by the instrument software and created in Worklist > Patient whereas the connection on the instrument is well-configured. In this mode, the instrument can only send results to the Host.
It is impossible to add, from the Host, a supplementary test for a SID Check, from the Host, the value in the Action Code field (field 9.4.12, please refer to the document "Output formats ABX Pentra 400 / Pentra C400" ref. RAA025). For the first request, the Action Code field must be "N" (New request) and when a supplementary test is added from the Host, the Action Code field must be "A" (Add request). This setting must also be respected when using the WinASTM software.
Incorrect sample type An order is not integrated by the instrument software if the sample type specified in the order does not correspond to the requested test. It is mandatory to specify correctly the sample type in the Specimen Descriptor field (field 9.4.16, please refer to the document "Output formats ABX Pentra 400 / Pentra C400" ref. RAA025).
10 - 28
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Host connection Troubleshooting
Please refer to the document "Output formats ABX Pentra 400 / Pentra C400" ref. RAA025 for more information about the ASTM fields.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
10 - 29
Host connection Troubleshooting
10 - 30
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Section 11: Maintenance
1. Preventive maintenance ............................................................................. 11 - 2 1.1. Maintenance by customers .....................................................................................................11 - 2 1.2. 6 month maintenance ..............................................................................................................11 - 3 1.3. Yearly maintenance .................................................................................................................11 - 3
2. Prevention against the electrostatic discharges ..................................... 11 - 4 3. Procedures .................................................................................................. 11 - 7 3.1. Procedure list ...........................................................................................................................11 - 7 3.2. Maintenance check up summary .............................................................................................11 - 8 RAS376: Installation RAS378: 6 month maintenance RAS379: Yearly maintenance RAS393: Check up after intervention RAS377: Covers dismantling RAS380: Reagent tray RAS381: Sample tray RAS382: Reaction tray RAS548: Fan and heater replacement RAS383: Optical bench RAS656: Partial condensing lens cleaning RAS386: Mixer RAS385: Arms RAS384: Cuvette changer RAS392: Internal computer RAS390: Power supply replacement RAS391: Mother board replacement RAS394: Sensors check and adjustment RAS387: Syringe block assembly replacement RAS389: Waste and water pumps replacement RAS442: Pressure sensors RAS533: Windows master installation RAS517: Software version installation RAS518: Reagent applications installation RAS542: Printer installation RAS814: External barcode reader RAS624: Cooling unit
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
11 - 1
Maintenance Preventive maintenance
1. Preventive maintenance 1.1.
Maintenance by customers
Maintenance procedures have to be carried out according to the recommended frequency table and after having attended a HORIBA Medical approved customer training course. The system warranty may be affected if damage appears after a non trained technician intervenes or if replaced spare parts and consumables do not come from HORIBA Medical approved origin. 1. Daily maintenance procedures No special maintenance or adjustment has to be done on your instrument if the recommended start up and shutdown procedures are explicitly respected. Please refer to your user manual and daily guide. 2. Weekly maintenance procedures An overall check for cleanness of the instrument is recommended every week. Please refer to the instrument cleaning and decontamination procedure in your user manual. If the instrument is switched off for one week at least: the reagents from the tray, close them and place them in a refrigerated area, ■ then, switch the cooling unit off. If the instrument is equipped with ISE module, you have to shut down the ISE module first. See Section 7: ISE module, 1.6.3. ISE module shutdown, page 7-32. ■ remove
The table below lists the maintenance procedures and their frequencies. For more detailed information, please refer to your user manual and daily guide. Maintenance Needles cleaning with Deproteinizer Reagent needle cleaning (external part) Wash towers cleaning Syringe plunger tips replacement Precision test Cooling unit (CU400) filter cleaning Cooling unit (CU401) condenser cleaning Glycol level checking Filter replacement Syringes replacement Needles replacement Mixer paddle replacement Lamp replacement Instrument cleaning and decontamination Applications update Software update
11 - 2
Frequency Without mixer: Daily With mixer: Weekly Monthly Monthly Monthly Monthly Monthly Monthly Bimonthly Bimonthly As needed As needed As needed As needed As needed As needed As needed
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Maintenance Preventive maintenance
1.2.
6 month maintenance
See RAS378: 6 month maintenance, page 1.
KIT, 6 MONTH MAINTENANCE XEA766BS (1209159766) P/n 9001072 (1229001072) B8078955 (1228078955) B8076812 (1228076812) 3027030 (1223027030)
1.3.
Designation FILTER, FILTER LIQUID COMPLETE REAGENT SYRINGE (1000 µL) SAMPLE SYRINGE (100 µL) CLAMP, TUBE D7
Qty 1 1 1 2
Yearly maintenance
See RAS379: Yearly maintenance, page 1.
KIT, 1 YEAR MAINTENANCE XEA792GS (1209159792) P/n XEA768A (1209151768) LAM017A (1207681017) 1300024610 DZZ055A (1202191055) LBH003A (1207791003) HAX0239 (1207230239) JAB010A (1207251010) DBJ025A (1202131025) XEA766BS (1209159766)
Designation TOOL, MOLYKOTE GREASE 3.5 ML TOOL, CUV.CHANGER AXIS GREASE CHILLER, GLYCOL 1 L FILTER, COOLING UNIT FILTER REAGENT, 5 L KEG FOR RINSE SPS GLYCOL STICKER CASE USDD40 500x400x250 CLIPS, PLASTIC D=6.4 MM KIT, 6 MONTH MAINTENANCE
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Qty 1 1 2 1 1 1 1 4 1
11 - 3
Maintenance Prevention against the electrostatic discharges
2. Prevention against the electrostatic discharges ■ The
electronic boards are very sensitive to electrostatic discharges (ESD).
■ The
damages are not always immediately visible, but can be detected over the course of time.
In order to prevent those risks, the use of an antistatic kit is MANDATORY.
2.1.
The antistatic kit ref. MZZ015A (1207921015) ■
An antistatic ground mat is one of a number of antistatic devices designed to help eliminate static electricity. This mat has a conductive material embedded within, which collects the static. The mat would need to be grounded (earthed). This is usually accomplished by plugging it into the grounded line in an electrical outlet. It is important to discharge at a slow rate, therefore a resistor should be used in earthing the mat. This ground mat allows you to connect an antistatic wrist strap.
■ The
antistatic kit is composed of:
- An antistatic mat with 2 female snaps:
11 - 4
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Maintenance Prevention against the electrostatic discharges
- A wrist strap:
- A ground cord (for the wrist strap):
- A crocodile clip:
- A second ground cord (for the crocodile clip):
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
11 - 5
Maintenance Prevention against the electrostatic discharges
2.2.
How to use the antistatic kit
■ Connect
the second ground cord to a snap of the antistatic mat and install the crocodile clip on its other end.
■ Connect
the crocodile clip to the earth
outlet.
■ Install
the wrist strap on the first ground cord and connect the first ground cord to the second snap of the antistatic mat.
■ Put
the bracelet around your wrist.
■ The
antistatic kit is ready for use:
To ensure a good contact, ensure that the wrist strap is correctly tightened around your wrist.
11 - 6
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
Maintenance Procedures
3. Procedures
■ Maintenance
and adjustments required for the instrument are divided into procedures according to the concerned assemblies. This should make any update easier as all interventions can be done with the corresponding procedure on its own. ■ For ISE module procedures, please refer to the ISE module specific section (see Section 7: ISE module, 3. Procedures, page 7-42).
1 - Procedures must be performed on a clean instrument. If the instrument is suspected not to be perfectly clean, perform a cleaning procedure. 2 - Disposable gloves, eye protections and a lab coat must be worn by the operator. 3 - When the Diagnostics menu is used, the security switches are disabled and it is therefore recommended to be extremely cautious.
3.1.
Procedure list
The procedures are sorted by theme and instrument sub-assembly. Category Installation
Maintenance
Covers Reagent tray Sample tray
Reaction tray
Optical bench
Mixer
P/n and designation
Concerns Instrument and cooling unit installation - First start of the RAS376: Installation instrument - Mechanical check - Reagent application installation - Check up Decontamination - Filter and Syringes replacement Cooling unit maintenance - Mechanical adjustments RAS378: 6 month maintenance Photometer, temperature and pumps check up Pressure sensors calibration Greasing and cleaning - Cooling unit maintenance RAS379: Yearly maintenance 6 month maintenance Check up of the instrument pipetting accuracy and RAS393: Check up after intervention precision RAS377: Covers dismantling Dismantling of all the instrument covers Dismantling, parts replacement and adjustment of the RAS380: Reagent tray reagent tray Dismantling, parts replacement and adjustment of the RAS381: Sample tray sample tray Dismantling, parts replacement and adjustment of the RAS382: Reaction tray reaction tray Reaction tray lower box dismantling - Fan and Heater RAS548: Fan and heater replacement replacement - Temperature and Glycol circuit check Dismantling of the optical bench - Mirror and lenses RAS383: Optical bench cleaning and replacement - Check up RAS656: Partial condensing lens Condensing lens cleaning (lamp side) cleaning Mixer paddle replacement - Dismantling and RAS386: Mixer replacement of the mixer assembly - Parts replacement - Adjustment
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
11 - 7
Maintenance Procedures
Category
P/n and designation
Arms
RAS385: Arms
Cuvette changer RAS384: Cuvette changer Computer
Electricity
Hydraulics
RAS392: Internal computer RAS390: Power supply replacement RAS391: Mother board replacement RAS394: Sensors check and adjustment RAS387: Syringe block assembly replacement RAS389: Waste and water pumps replacement
Concerns Needles replacement - Dismantling and parts replacement of the arms assembly - Adjustment of the arms - Level and shock detection check Cuvette changer rack dismantling - Parts replacement Adjustment Computer dismantling and parts replacement Dismantling and replacement of the power supply Dismantling and replacement of the mother board Check and adjustment of all the instrument sensors Dismantling and mounting of the syringe block assembly Dismantling and replacement of the pumps
Pressure sensors and pressure board replacement Pressure board voltage adjustment - Pressure sensors activation, configuration and calibration RAS533: Windows master installation Windows master installation Software version downloading - Software version RAS517: Software version installation installation RAS518: Reagent applications Reagent applications downloading - Reagent installation applications installation RAS542: Printer installation Driver installation - Printer selection RAS814: External barcode reader Installation - Configuration - Barcode reading test Dismantling - Air fan, float switch, control board, RAS624: Cooling unit pressure sensor, pump replacement RAS442: Pressure sensors
Software
Cooling unit
3.2.
Maintenance check up summary
A maintenance check up summary is provided in this manual (see on next page) to ensure the maintenance follow-up. This document can be used as reference to create a maintenance schedule for customer archives.
11 - 8
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400: Technical Manual Ref: 1300021859 - Int. Ref. Doc.: RAA023JEN
HORIBA ABX SAS Parc Euromédecine - Rue du Caducée BP 7290 34184 Montpellier Cedex 4 - FRANCE Phone: + 33 (0)4 67 14 15 16 Fax: + 33 (0)4 67 14 15 17
ABX Pentra 400 / Pentra C400 Check-up maintenance 6 month maintenance - CU401: Condenser cleaning - CU400: Filter cleaning See RAS378: 6 month maintenance, 4. Cooling unit, page 3. Cooling unit
Reagent tray
Arms
X
- Cooling unit draining - Overflow jar cleaning - Filling with glycol and distilled water - Cooling unit grid cleaning - CU400: Filter replacement See RAS379: Yearly maintenance, 2. Cooling unit, page 7.
X
- Reagent tray cleaning - Reagent barcode reader cleaning See RAS379: Yearly maintenance, 1.1. Reagent tray cleaning, page 2.
X
Reagent barcode reader position See RAS380: Reagent tray, 4.4. Reagent barcode reader position, page 24.
X
X
Sample barcode reader position See RAS381: Sample tray, 4.3. Sample barcode reader position, page 17.
X
X
Sample arm all positions mechanical check See RAS385: Arms, 6. Sample arm adjustment, page 36
X
X
Reagent arm all positions mechanical check See RAS385: Arms, 5. Reagent arm adjustment, page 23
X
X
2 arms greasing (Molykote grease) See RAS379: Yearly maintenance, 1.2. Arms assembly greasing (for ABX Pentra 400 V1 only), page 3 Mixer
All positions mechanical check See RAS386: Mixer, 5. Adjustments, page 17.
Reaction tray
Reaction tray cleaning See RAS379: Yearly maintenance, 1.3. Reaction tray cleaning, page 5.
Optic
Yearly maintenance
X
X
X
X
Photometer check up. See RAS383: Optical bench, 4. Optical bench check, page 31: - Black measurement: between 1400 and 2000 - Gain measurement: between 3 and 242 - Dynamic Optical Reading: reference on Air ≅ 0 - Dynamic Optical Reading: Reference on Air with cuvette: WL =340 nm: between 0.06 and 0.12 WL=700 nm: between 0.05 and 0.09
X
X
Lamp replacement. Refer to the instrument user manual.
X
X
Dynamic cuvette changer functioning check See RAS384: Cuvette changer, 4. Adjustments, page 31. Cuvette changer
6 month maintenance
Yearly maintenance
X
X
Endless screw greasing See RAS379: Yearly maintenance, 1.4. Cuvette changer endless screw greasing, page 6.
X
Filter replacement. Refer to the instrument user manual.
X
X
Syringes replacement 100 µL and 1000 µL. Refer to the instrument user manual.
X
X
Pressure sensor calibration. See RAS442: Pressure sensors, 3.3. To calibrate the pressure sensors, page 7.
X
X
Water pump flow check See RAS378: 6 month maintenance, 10. To check the sample needle throughput, page 8.
X
X
Fluidic system decontamination See RAS378: 6 month maintenance, 1. To decontaminate the hydraulic system, page 2.
X
X
- Water tank decontamination - Waste tank decontamination See RAS378: 6 month maintenance, 1.2. To decontaminate the tanks, page 2.
X
X
Wash tower decontamination See RAS378: 6 month maintenance, 1.3. To decontaminate the wash towers, page 2.
X
X
Temperature
Temperature check. See RAS378: 6 month maintenance, 9. To check the temperature, page 7: - Reaction heating: 37°C (± 0.25°C) - Needle heating: 37°C (± 1.5°C) - Refrigerated area: 4-10°C
X
X
Check up after intervention
Run a test T1 or P1 (Precision test) x15, CV < 1%. See RAS393: Check up after intervention, page 1.
X
X
Hydraulic
= Specific ABX Pentra 400 V1
This document can be used as reference to create a maintenance schedule for customer archives.
Specific instructions are given for previous ABX Pentra 400 hardware versions: ■ V1 corresponds to instruments with serial numbers below 2000.
RAS376H
Installation
RAS376: Installation
Concerns Instrument installation Cooling unit installation ISE module preparation First start of the instrument ISE Mechanical alignments check Priming Pressure sensors calibration Reagent applications installation Racks Check up
Required tools Hexagonal keys Phillips screwdriver Graduated ruler
Required products Distilled water
Specific kit or consumables KIT, INSTALLATION P400 XEA759G (1209156759) KIT, INSTALLATION PC400 XEC139B (1209172139) If the instrument is equipped with ISE module option: ■ ISE
module electrodes: ABX Pentra Sodium-E A11A01738 ABX Pentra Chloride-E A11A01739 ABX Pentra Potassium-E A11A01740 ABX Pentra Reference-E A11A01741
■ ISE
module reagents: ABX Pentra Standard 1 A11A01717 ABX Pentra Standard 2 A11A01718 ABX Pentra Reference 280 ML A11A01901 Disposable gloves, eye protections and a lab coat must be worn by the operator. Local or national regulations must be applied in all the operations.
Installation
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
1. Instrument installation
Before unpacking, control the proper handling of the instrument package during transportation with the help of the shock indicator "Shockwatch" and the tipping indicator "Tiltwatch". Please refer to the Service Information Letter RAN357A to know the procedure to follow for instrument package reception.
1.1.
Unpacking
Unpack the instrument carefully, then make sure that all of the parts from the package list are present. You can print these following tables and tick off the corresponding check box when the part is present.
Package list Part number
Qty
Designation
1
Instrument with or without ISE module
XEA759G (1209156759) XEC139B (1209172139) XEA815E (1209155815) XEC114C (1209173114)
KIT, INSTALLATION P400 or KIT, INSTALLATION PC400 1
KIT, ACCESSORIES BOX P400 V4 or KIT, ACCESSORIES BOX PC400
DZZ045F (1202196045) 1300012509 DZZ047F (1202196047) DZZ048F (1202196048)
1
CHILLER, CU401 100 V 50-60 HZ or CHILLER, CU401 115 V 60 HZ or CHILLER, CU401 230 V 50 HZ or CHILLER, CU401 230 V 60 HZ
1300024610
2
CHILLER, GLYCOL 1 L
LBH004A (1207791004)
2
FLUID, 10 L CONTAINER
1
PCB, QWERTY KEYBOARD USB or PCB, USB AZERTY KEYBOARD
1
PRINTER (OPTIONAL)
DAC051A (1201891051)
1
CABLE, USB PC-FRONT USB L=1M
GBM0418 (1203600418)
1
COVER, SAMPLE TRAY LEFT SIDE
1300017778 CBK055A (1201721055)
RAL199B (1300025224) RAL156D (1300025223) DAC011A (1201891011) DAC012A (1201891012) JAM005A (1207321005)
SAFETY INFORMATION P400 or SAFETY INFORMATION PC400 2 1
CABLE, POWER EUROPE (+ 1 cable if printer) or CABLE, POWER USA (+ 1 cable if printer)
1
KIT, SOFTWARE VERSION P400 / PC400
1
5 OUTLET EXTENSION CORD
1
KIT, REAGENT APPLICATION P400 / PC400
1300030012 1300029998
1
P400 DOCUMENTATION USB FLASH DRIVE PC400 DOCUMENTATION USB FLASH DRIVE
GBD072A (1202901072)
4
COVER, HANDLER FOR P120 & P400 CUVETTE SEGMENTS (3x15)
RAS376H - 2
INSTALLATION
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Installation
KIT, INSTALLATION P400 XEA759G (1209156759) Part number
Qty
Designation
XDA806B (1209132806)
6
SAMPLE RACK
XDA968A (1209131968)
6
TUBE ADAPTORS (x5)
XDA805B (1209132805)
6
SAMPLE CUP RACK
8700205 (1228700205)
1
SAMPLE CUP BLUE (x100)
XDA849A (1209131849)
6
REAGENT RACK + ADAPTORS
8700596 (1228700596)
1
4 ML REAGENT CUP (x10)
8700713 (1228700713)
1
10 ML REAGENT CUP (x10)
B1037307 (1221037307)
0.10
15 ML REAGENT CUP (100/bag)
XDA850A (1209131850)
4
CAL/CTRL REAG. RACK GBM0749 (1203600749) + ADAPTORS GBM0794 (1203600794)
HAX0230 (1207230230)
1
STICKER, REAGENT RACK P400
XBA574C (1209113574)
1
FLUID, WASTE STRAW ASSY
XBA568F (1209114568)
1
FLUID, WATER STRAW ASSY
CBK048A (1201721048)
1
PCB, OPT. MOUSE 3 BUT. & WHEEL
GBM0843 (1203600843)
1
CHILLER, CHILLER TUBING SUPPORT
XDB254AS (1209149254) 1
CHILLER, CU400-401 OVERFLOW JAR (cooling unit overflow jar + magnetic ribbon)
EAE003A*
1 metre TUBING, TYGON 0.762 (0.030)
EAE007A*
1 metre TUBING, TYGON 1.52 (0.060)
3027030 (1223027030)
2
CLAMP, TUBE D7
FAX016AL0060 (1202522016)
2
FLUID, CHILLER CASING L=60CM
DBJ016A (1202131016)
2
COLLAR, COBRA METAL COLLAR D=12
FBA002A (1202551002)
2
ADHESIVE AUTO-GRIP STRIP (0.160)
DZZ039A (1202191039)
3
CABLE, FERRITE D=10 MM
A11A01922
3
KIT, CASSETTE 30/10+CAPS (x6)
* Possible to order under the following references: - EAE003AS (1202249003) (2 metres) - EAE007AS (1202249007) (2 metres)
KIT, ACCESSORIES BOX P400 V4 XEA815E (1209155815) Part number
Qty
Designation
1
Accessory case ABX Pentra 400
HAX0166 (1207230166)
1
SAMPLE RACK STICKERS 1-10
HAX0170 (1207230170)
1
SAMPLE CUP RACK STICKERS 41-50
HAX0173 (1207230173)
1
CAL SAMPLE RACK STICKERS 71-84
HAX0174 (1207230174)
1
CTRL SAMP. RACK STICKERS 85-99
XBA563ET (1209119563) 1
NEEDLE, SAMPLE P400 W FERRITE
HAX0175 (1207230175)
1
REAGENT RACK STICKERS 60-69
HAX0188 (1207230188)
1
CAL REAG. RACK STICKERS 01-15
Technical Manual RAA023
INSTALLATION
RAS376H - 3
Installation
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Part number
Qty
Designation
HAX0190 (1207230190)
1
CTRL REAG. RACK STICKERS 30-44
1300028830
1
OPTICAL, LAMP P400
MAB086A (1207821086)
1
TOOL, ALLEN SCREWDRIVER 2MM
B8076812 (1228076812)
1
SAMPLE SYRINGE (100 µL)
B8086648 (1228086648)
1
100 µL TEFLON SEAL (x10)
B8088454 (1228088454)
1
SEAL REPLACEMENT TOOL
B8078955 (1228078955)
1
REAGENT SYRINGE (1000 µL)
B8086605 (1228086605)
1
1000 µL TEFLON SEAL (x10)
B8086583 (1228086583)
1
1000 µL + 500 µL O'RINGS (x10)
9001072 (1229001072)
1
FILTER, FILTER LIQUID COMPLETE
1
Clips, Ø 12 mm
1
ISO sticker
1
Key screwdriver
1
Mouse pad
2
Touchscreen stylus
EAA021A (1202201021)
1
Straight link DI=4.25
EAB031A (1202211031)
1
Straight link DI=5 Polyprop.
EAC015A (1202221015)
1
FITTING, LUER MALE FITTING
DAR055A (1202001055)
2
FUSE, 5X20 T 6.3 A H
HAX0273 (1207230273)
1
NCD SAMPLE RACK STICKERS 1-10
HAX0277 (1207230277)
1
NCD SAMPLE CUP RACK ST. 41-50
HAX0280 (1207230280)
1
NCD CAL SAMPLE RACK ST. 71-84
HAX0281 (1207230281)
1
NCD CTRL SAMPLE RACK ST. 85-99
EAB015A (1202211015)
5
FITTING, STRAIGHT 2.5/1.5
1
Flat screwdriver 3.5x100
DBK009A (1202141009)
6
ADHESIVE, HOLDER TYRAP D=9 MM
MAB002A (1207821002)
1
TOOL, ALEN SCREWDRIVER 2.5 MM
HAX0334 (1207230334)
1
PC400/P400 OPEN CAS.STICKER SHEET1
HAX0335 (1207230335)
1
PC400/P400 OPEN CAS.STICKER SHEET2
KIT, INSTALLATION PC400 XEC139B (1209172139) Part number
Qty
Designation
XDA806B (1209132806)
6
SAMPLE RACK
XDA968A (1209131968)
6
TUBE ADAPTORS (x5)
XDA805B (1209132805)
6
SAMPLE CUP RACK
8700205 (1228700205)
1
SAMPLE CUP BLUE (x100)
XDA849A (1209131849)
6
REAGENT RACK + ADAPTORS
8700596 (1228700596)
1
4 ML REAGENT CUP (x10)
8700713 (1228700713)
1
10 ML REAGENT CUP (x10)
B1037307 (1221037307)
0.10
15 ML REAGENT CUP (100/bag)
RAS376H - 4
INSTALLATION
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Part number
Installation
Qty
Designation
XDA850A (1209131850)
4
CAL/CTRL REAG. RACK GBM0749 (1203600749) + ADAPTORS GBM0794 (1203600794)
HAX0230 (1207230230)
1
STICKER, REAGENT RACK P400
XBA574C (1209113574)
1
FLUID, WASTE STRAW ASSY
XBA568F (1209114568)
1
FLUID, WATER STRAW ASSY
CBK048A (1201721048)
1
PCB, OPT. MOUSE 3 BUT. & WHEEL
GBM0843 (1203600843)
1
CHILLER, CHILLER TUBING SUPPORT
XDB254AS (1209149254) 1
CHILLER, CU400-401 OVERFLOW JAR (cooling unit overflow jar + magnetic ribbon)
EAE003A*
1 metre TUBING, TYGON 0.762 (0.030)
EAE007A*
1 metre TUBING, TYGON 1.52 (0.060)
3027030 (1223027030)
2
CLAMP, TUBE D7
FAX016AL0060 (1202522016)
2
FLUID, CHILLER CASING L=60CM
DBJ016A (1202131016)
2
COLLAR, COBRA METAL COLLAR D=12
FBA002A (1202551002)
2
ADHESIVE AUTO-GRIP STRIP (0.160)
DZZ039A (1202191039)
3
CABLE, FERRITE D=10 MM
A11A01922
3
KIT, CASSETTE 30/10+CAPS (x6)
* Possible to order under the following references: - EAE003AS (1202249003) (2 metres) - EAE007AS (1202249007) (2 metres)
KIT, ACCESSORIES BOX PC400 XEC114C (1209173114) Part number
Qty
Designation
1
Accessory case Pentra C400
HAX0166 (1207230166)
1
SAMPLE RACK STICKERS 1-10
HAX0170 (1207230170)
1
SAMPLE CUP RACK STICKERS 41-50
HAX0173 (1207230173)
1
CAL SAMPLE RACK STICKERS 71-84
HAX0174 (1207230174)
1
CTRL SAMP. RACK STICKERS 85-99
XBA847AT (1209119847) 1
NEEDLE, SAMPLE PC400
HAX0175 (1207230175)
1
REAGENT RACK STICKERS 60-69
HAX0188 (1207230188)
1
CAL REAG. RACK STICKERS 01-15
HAX0190 (1207230190)
1
CTRL REAG. RACK STICKERS 30-44
GBM1326 (1203601326)
1
OPTICAL, LAMP PC400
MAB086A (1207821086)
1
TOOL, ALLEN SCREWDRIVER 2MM
B8076812 (1228076812)
1
SAMPLE SYRINGE (100 µL)
B8086648 (1228086648)
1
100 µL TEFLON SEAL (x10)
B8088454 (1228088454)
1
SEAL REPLACEMENT TOOL
B8078955 (1228078955)
1
REAGENT SYRINGE (1000 µL)
B8086605 (1228086605)
1
1000 µL TEFLON SEAL (x10)
B8086583 (1228086583)
1
1000 µL + 500 µL O'RINGS (x10)
9001072 (1229001072)
1
FILTER, FILTER LIQUID COMPLETE
Technical Manual RAA023
INSTALLATION
RAS376H - 5
Installation
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Part number
1.2.
Qty
Designation
1
Clips, Ø 12 mm
1
ISO sticker
1
Key screwdriver
1
Mouse pad
2
Touchscreen stylus
EAA021A (1202201021)
1
Straight link DI=4.25
EAB031A (1202211031)
1
Straight link DI=5 Polyprop.
EAC015A (1202221015)
1
FITTING, LUER MALE FITTING
DAR055A (1202001055)
2
FUSE, 5X20 T 6.3 A H
HAX0273 (1207230273)
1
NCD SAMPLE RACK STICKERS 1-10
HAX0277 (1207230277)
1
NCD SAMPLE CUP RACK ST. 41-50
HAX0280 (1207230280)
1
NCD CAL SAMPLE RACK ST. 71-84
HAX0281 (1207230281)
1
NCD CTRL SAMPLE RACK ST. 85-99
EAB015A (1202211015)
5
FITTING, STRAIGHT 2.5/1.5
1
Flat screwdriver 3.5x100
DBK009A (1202141009)
6
ADHESIVE, HOLDER TYRAP D=9 MM
MAB002A (1207821002)
1
TOOL, ALEN SCREWDRIVER 2.5 MM
HAX0334 (1207230334)
1
PC400/P400 OPEN CAS.STICKER SHEET1
HAX0335 (1207230335)
1
PC400/P400 OPEN CAS.STICKER SHEET2
Location
Keep in mind that the instrument weighs approximately 120 kg (265 lb). To move the instrument, four persons are required. The lifting handles provided in the installation kit must be used. ■ Place
your instrument on a clean and leveled table or workbench.
■ Avoid
exposure to sunlight.
■ Place
your instrument where it is not exposed to water or vapor.
■ Place
your instrument where it is not exposed to dust.
■ Avoid
direct exposure to air conditioner.
■ Place
your instrument where it is free from vibration or shock.
■ Place
your instrument where an independent power receptacle can be used.
■
Use a receptacle different from the one used by a device that easily generates noise such as a centrifuge, etc.
■ Provide
a space of at least 20 cm (7.9 in) at the back of the instrument for a proper ventilation.
■
Make sure to provide enough space to open the main cover easily. The instrument height is approximately 63 cm (24.8 in) closed cover and 105 cm (41.3 in) open cover.
■
Make sure to provide enough space on both sides of the instrument to access the computer connections and power supply connection.
RAS376H - 6
INSTALLATION
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Installation
The Power switch and Power supply connection should always be accessible. When positioning the system for operational use, leave the required amount of space for easy access to these items.
1.3.
Installation
Install the instrument lifting handles in their location, make sure that they are correctly secured, lift the instrument onto the workbench using the four handles.
Technical Manual RAA023
INSTALLATION
RAS376H - 7
Installation
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Open
the arms main cover and remove its protective foam.
■ Remove
the protective foams retaining the
arms.
■ Open
the reagent door and remove the
foam.
In order not to damage needles during installation, disable the arms (vertical and rotation movements), and put them on a sample cup rack over the reagent tray as shown on the following picture.
RAS376H - 8
INSTALLATION
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Installation
C ■ Open
the optic hatch (A).
■ Make
sure that the tubings on the reagent syringe and on the sample syringe are correctly fastened (B).
B
■ Remove
the mixer cover (C). See RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1. A
■ Unscrew
the CHC screw supporting the mixer in low position and remove it.
■ Lift
the mixer assembly up, then down by pressing the red button.
■ Put
1.4.
the mixer cover back.
Syringes
Required products: - Reagent syringe 1000 µL (provided in the accessories box) - Sample syringe 100 µL (provided in the accessories box) ■
Manually fill and empty several times the syringes using a container of distilled water to ensure that the barrel is filled with water and no air bubbles are visible in the syringes.
Technical Manual RAA023
INSTALLATION
RAS376H - 9
Installation
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
B
■ Push
the syringes support halfway down
(A). ■ Install
the syringes: carefully fasten the glass barrel (B), then the knurl (C). A
C
1.5.
Electrical and computer connections ■ Cut
the Ty-Rap™ maintaining the cooling unit tubing.
■ Make
sure that the power supply module voltage of the instrument (indicated at the instrument back) corresponds to the nominal supply voltage of the laboratory and the country.
■ Connect
the power supply cable.
■ Open the connection hatch (right-hand side
of the instrument). ■ Route
the cables under the frame of the instrument.
RAS376H - 10
INSTALLATION
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Installation
■ Place
a ferrite core on the keyboard cable as follows: - Open the plastic case of the ferrite core. - Place the keyboard cable into the case (at approx. 10 cm of the USB connection). - Make a loop with the keyboard cable, then close the case.
■ Connect
the keyboard to the computer.
■ Place
a ferrite core on the mouse cable as follows: - Open the plastic case of the ferrite core. - Place the mouse cable into the case (at approx. 10 cm of the USB connection). - Make a loop with the mouse cable, then close the case.
■ Connect
the mouse to the computer.
■ Connect
the printer into a free USB port.
■ Close
the connection hatch cautiously.
Make sure to inform the customer that: ■ the instrument is equipped with a ferrite core on the keyboard cable as well as on the mouse cable, ■ if he has to replace the keyboard or the mouse, he must keep the ferrite core and reinstall it on the new peripheral device.
1.6.
Distilled water and waste installation
Use the "Luer" connectors, straws and tubings provided in the installation kit and in the accessories box to connect distilled water and waste.
A - Evacuation of condensation water B - H2O C - ISE module waste D - Intrument waste B
C
D
A ■ Connect
Technical Manual RAA023
the instrument distilled water (B) and waste (D) tubings.
INSTALLATION
RAS376H - 11
Installation
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Place
a ferrite core on both level detection cables (distilled water and waste) as follows: - Mark the distilled water level detection cable and the waste level detection cable. - Open the plastic case of the ferrite core. - Place both level detection cables into the case. - Make a loop with each cable, then close the case.
F
E
■ Connect
the distilled water level detection cable (E) and the waste level detection cable (F) to the instrument.
■
Connect the 6x9 mm PVC tube to the twisted priming tube (evacuation of condensation water (A)). Guide with the shortest distance from the side of the instrument to the waste detection assy and cut to the correct length. Connect it to the big connector of the waste detection assy.
■ If
the instrument is equipped with the ISE module option, follow the same procedure for the ISE waste tubing (C), then connect it to the small connector of the waste detection assy. The evacuation of condensation water is done by gravity, it is very important to make sure that tubes do not bend or do not go up. Idem for ISE waste tubing. This tube must be guided between the cooling unit tubings by the "Chiller tubing support". See 2. Cooling unit installation, page 13.
Place the ISO sticker (provided in the accessories box) on the waste container.
RAS376H - 12
INSTALLATION
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Installation
2. Cooling unit installation ■
Before plugging the cooling unit tubings, install the connectors (provided with the cooling unit) as follows: screw nuts with caps
- Unscrew the screw nuts and caps from the cooling unit. - Remove the caps from the screw nuts. - Keep the caps for a possible transportation of the cooling unit. - Put the connectors in the screw nuts and screw them on the cooling unit. - Tighten the connectors with a pair of pliers.
screw nut with connector
casings
- Put the casings (provided in the installation kit) on the connectors.
Technical Manual RAA023
INSTALLATION
RAS376H - 13
Installation
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Plug
the cooling unit tubings as follows:
■ The
input tubing of the instrument into the output connector of the cooling unit. output tubing of the instrument into the input connector of the cooling unit. See picture below:
■ The
output tubing of instrument
input tubing of instrument
output tubing input tubing of cooling unit of cooling unit
- Compress the tubing cover to access the tubing and cut 10-15 cm of the tubing.
- Put the Cobra metal collar (provided in the installation kit) on the tubing and plug the tubing into the connector.
RAS376H - 14
INSTALLATION
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Installation
- Then, with a pair of pliers, tighten the collar to its maximum.
- Put the tubing cover in contact with the casing. Support the casing and the tubing cover with one auto-grip strip (provided in the installation kit). The rough and grip side of the auto-grip strip must be placed on the casing and the tubing cover.
- Put the slipcover on the tubing cover + casing + auto-grip strip.
To instrument
■ Install the chiller tubing support (included in
the installation kit) to support those tubings.
To cooling unit
Technical Manual RAA023
INSTALLATION
RAS376H - 15
Installation
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Plug
the cooling unit cable into the instrument connector and the cooling unit connector.
■ Install
the cooling unit drainage tubing (10-15 cm of the tubing previously cut) as follows:
- Pull the ventilation grid in the front of the cooling unit and remove it.
- Plug the drainage tubing into the connector next to the bleed screw.
RAS376H - 16
INSTALLATION
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Installation
- Put the ventilation grid back.
When you close the ventilation grid, take care to arrange the drainage tubing up as shown on the figure below.
■ Install the cooling unit overflow jar (included
in the installation kit) at the rear of the cooling unit.
■ Fill
the cooling unit with ethylene glycol and distilled water as follows:
- Slightly push to unlock and to open the lid of the filling opening.
Technical Manual RAA023
INSTALLATION
RAS376H - 17
Installation
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
- Fill the cooling unit with two liters of ethylene glycol and complete with distilled water up to the high mark.
Take care that no liquid enters the cooling unit.
- Close the lid.
Install the cooling unit under the instrument or at the same level but never on a higher position. Proper ventilation requires at least 10 cm (4 inches) space in the front and at the rear.
■ Connect ■ Switch
the cooling unit.
the cooling unit on.
3. ISE module preparation
■ If
the instrument is not equipped with the ISE module option and you have to install the ISE module, refer to RAS441: ISE module installation, page 1. ■ If the instrument is already equipped with the ISE module, refer directly to the ISE module startup procedure. See RAS441: ISE module installation, 2.1. Electrode and reagent installation, page 9.
RAS376H - 18
INSTALLATION
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Installation
4. First start of the instrument ■ Make ■ Put
sure that the arms main cover is open.
some cuvette segments in the cuvette segment loader.
■ Start
the instrument (ON/OFF switch is on the left-hand side of the instrument). The initialization will be "NOT OK" because of the open arms main cover.
■ When
initialization is ended, enter the name (tech) and the password (qbxtech for Azerty keyboard or abxtech for Qwerty keyboard), then press OK to access the main menu.
4.1.
Check online help language
■ Press Help and verify that the
online help is installed on the instrument in the software language.
■ If
not, use the Documentation media supplied within the instrument to install it.
4.2.
Check keyboard setup ■ Go
to Services > System Configuration > Local Settings.
■ Press
Change Configuration, select the country in the Default input language list, press Apply, then
OK.
Technical Manual RAA023
INSTALLATION
RAS376H - 19
Installation
4.3.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Check date and time
B
■ In
the Local Settings tab, press Edit (A) to access the System Date and Time scrolling lists (B).
■ Make
the modifications, then press OK (C) to confirm. A
C
If the date format or the time format is changed, the instrument will reboot automatically after confirmation.
4.4.
Check printer configuration
■ Go
to Services > System Configuration > Printer.
■ Press
Edit (D) to access the different scrolling lists.
■ Make
the modifications, then press OK (E) to confirm.
D
E
5. ISE
See RAS441: ISE module installation, 2.2. Start and use of ISE option, page 12 in Section 7: ISE module.
RAS376H - 20
INSTALLATION
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Installation
6. Mechanical alignments check
It is advisable to check the sample needle alignment in order not to damage it. Always move the sample arm to its upper position (vertical home) before moving the reagent arm. Always move the sample and reagent arms to their upper positions before moving a tray. Always move the reagent arm into its wash tower before moving the sample arm. ■
Check the adjustment of the reagent arm positions in the wash tower by following the reagent arm adjustment procedure: - Wash Tower Position (rotation): see RAS385: Arms, 5.3.2. Wash Tower Position, page 29 - Low Position in Wash Tower (vertical): see RAS385: Arms, 5.4.2. "Low Position in Wash Tower", page 32
■
Check the adjustment of the sample arm positions in the wash tower by following the sample arm adjustment procedure: - Wash Tower Position (rotation): see RAS385: Arms, 5.3.2. Wash Tower Position, page 29 - Low Position in Wash Tower (vertical): see RAS385: Arms, 5.4.2. "Low Position in Wash Tower", page 32
7. Priming ■ Push
the waste straw into the waste container.
■ Manually
fill the two wash towers with distilled water to avoid splashes, then put the optic hatch back.
■ Close
the arms main cover, then leave the Diagnostics menu (press Back) and press Startup. The instrument initializes its mechanical components, wait until the end of the initialization.
■ Go
to Services > Customer Services > Cycles\Priming.
■ Connect
the distilled water tubing to the distilled water container, then perform two Filling up cycles.
■ Perform
a Priming Cycle.
■ Make
sure that no air bubbles are visible in the syringes.
8. Pressure sensors calibration Perform the pressure sensors calibration by following the pressure sensors procedure. See RAS442: Pressure sensors, 3.3. To calibrate the pressure sensors, page 7.
Technical Manual RAA023
INSTALLATION
RAS376H - 21
Installation
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
9. Reagent applications installation Perform a full installation of the reagent applications (included in the reagent application kit). See RAS518: Reagent applications installation, page 1.
Before installation, ensure that the reagent application version is compatible with the software version installed on the instrument. Refer to the compatibility table in the technical note included in the reagent application kit.
To optimize the "software" support of your customers, this Reagent Application media must be kept close to the instrument.
10. Racks The instrument racks are identified by means of barcode and numbered labels. Place these labels on racks as shown on the stickers plate: ■ HAX0166
(1207230166) for sample rack 1-10
■ HAX0170
(1207230170) for sample cup rack 41-50
■ HAX0173
(1207230173) for calibrator sample rack 71-84
■ HAX0174
(1207230174) for control sample rack 85-99
■ HAX0175
(1207230175) for reagent rack 60-69
■ HAX0188
(1207230188) for calibrator reagent rack 01-15
■ HAX0190
(1207230190) for control reagent rack 30-44
To read barcode format "Interleaved 2 of 5 WITHOUT Check Digit", use the following stickers: - HAX0273 (1207230273): NCD SAMPLE RACK STICKERS 1-10 (included in the accessories box) - HAX0274 (1207230274): NCD SAMPLE RACK STICKERS 11-20 - HAX0277 (1207230277): NCD SAMPLE CUP RACK ST. 41-50 (included in the accessories box) - HAX0278 (1207230278): NCD SAMPLE CUP RACK ST. 51-60 - HAX0279 (1207230279): NCD SAMPLE CUP RACK ST. 61-70 - HAX0280 (1207230280): NCD CAL SAMPLE RACK ST. 71-84 (included in the accessories box) - HAX0281 (1207230281): NCD CTRL SAMPLE RACK ST. 85-99 (included in the accessories box) Go to Services > System Configuration > Local Settings. Press Edit and deselect the Check Digit option, then press OK.
RAS376H - 22
INSTALLATION
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Installation
Reagent and calibrator/control stickers (STICKER, REAGENT RACK P400 HAX0230 (1207230230)) are also available to identify solutions, calibrators and controls on the reagent racks, calibrator/control reagent racks and calibrator/control sample racks. Place these stickers as shown on the examples below:
11. Check up Follow the "Check up after intervention" procedure. See RAS393: Check up after intervention, page 1.
Technical Manual RAA023
INSTALLATION
RAS376H - 23
Installation
RAS376H - 24
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
INSTALLATION
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS378J
6 month maintenance
RAS378: 6 month maintenance
Concerns To decontaminate the hydraulic system To replace the filter To replace the syringes Cooling unit ISE module To check the mechanical adjustments To check the barcode readers To check the spectrophotometer To check the temperature To check the sample needle throughput To calibrate the pressure sensors To clean and defragment the C:\ and D:\ drives Check up after intervention
Required tools Flat screwdriver Phillips screwdriver Hexagonal keys
Required products Bleach
Intervention time 2 h 00
Frequency Every 6 months
Specific kit or consumables KIT, 6 MONTH MAINTENANCE XEA766BS (1209159766) If the instrument is equipped with ISE module option: KIT, ISE 6 MONTH MAINTENANCE XEC273AS (1209171273) Disposable gloves, eye protections and a lab coat must be worn by the operator. Local or national regulations must be applied in all the operations.
6 month maintenance
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
KIT, 6 MONTH MAINTENANCE XEA766BS (1209159766) P/n 9001072 (1229001072) B8078955 (1228078955) B8076812 (1228076812) 3027030 (1223027030)
Designation FILTER, FILTER LIQUID COMPLETE REAGENT SYRINGE (1000 µL) SAMPLE SYRINGE (100 µL) CLAMP, TUBE D7
Qty 1 1 1 2
1. To decontaminate the hydraulic system 1.1.
To decontaminate the hydraulic circuit
1. Prepair a bottle containing half a liter of bleach diluted to 1 part of bleach for 9 parts of distilled water (1/10). 2. Prepair a bottle containing half a liter of distilled water. 3. Replace the water tank with the diluted bleach bottle then run several Filling up cycles. 4. Remove the straw from the diluted bleach bottle and wrap it in absorbent paper. 5. Run several Priming Cycle to drain the circuit. 6. Dry the straw with absorbent paper. 7. Plunge the straw into the distilled water bottle then run several Priming Cycle. 8. Remove the straw from the distilled water bottle and wrap it in absorbent paper. 9. Run several Priming Cycle to drain the circuit. 10. Dry the straw well. 11. Decontaminate the water tank (see 1.2. To decontaminate the tanks, page 2). 12. Plunge the straw into the water tank filled with distilled water.
1.2.
To decontaminate the tanks
1. 2. 3. 4.
1.3.
Prepair 2 liters of bleach diluted to 1 part of bleach for 9 parts of distilled water (1/10). Pour this dilution into the water tank then shake it several times. Throw the dilution out in a waste container then rinse thoroughly with distilled water. Follow the same procedure to decontaminate the waste tank.
To decontaminate the wash towers
1. Prepair bleach diluted to 1 part of bleach for 9 parts of distilled water (1/10). 2. Fill the wash towers with this dilution then wait a few minutes. 3. Run a Draining cycle to drain the wash towers.
RAS378J - 2
MAINTENANCE
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
6 month maintenance
4. Fill and drain the wash towers several times with distilled water. 5. Manually clean the wash towers with absorbent paper.
2. To replace the filter The filter is located on the right-hand side, at the back of the instrument. Refer to your user manual to replace the filter.
3. To replace the syringes Refer to your user manual to replace the syringes.
4. Cooling unit 4.1.
To clean the cooling unit condenser (for cooling unit CU401)
1. Go to Services > System Configuration > Analyser and deselect the Activate Cold Area option. 2. Switch the cooling unit off and disconnect the power supply cable.
3. Pull the ventilation grid and remove it.
Technical Manual RAA023
MAINTENANCE
RAS378J - 3
6 month maintenance
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
4. Remove dust from the condenser with a vacuum cleaner.
5. Put the ventilation grid back.
When you close the ventilation grid, take care to arrange the drainage tubing up as shown below.
6. Connect the power supply cable and switch the cooling unit on.
Wait ten minutes minimum, between switching off and switching on the cooling unit.
7. Go to Services > System Configuration > Analyser and select the Activate Cold Area option.
RAS378J - 4
MAINTENANCE
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
4.2.
6 month maintenance
To clean the cooling unit filter (for cooling unit CU400)
If you have just replaced the filter, it is not necessary to clean it now.
1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
Remove the filter with its metallic support from the cooling unit grid. Remove the filter from its metallic support. Clean the filter with water and let it dry. Once dry, put the filter back in its metallic support. Put the filter with its metallic support back on the cooling unit grid by fitting the two metallic pieces in the grid holes.
5. ISE module Refer to the procedure RAS388: ISE module maintenance, 1. 6 month maintenance, page 2 in the section 7: ISE module.
6. To check the mechanical adjustments
Always move the reagent arm into its wash tower before moving the sample arm. Always move the sample arm to its vertical home position before moving the reagent arm.
Technical Manual RAA023
MAINTENANCE
RAS378J - 5
6 month maintenance
6.1.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
To check the sample arm positions
1. Check the adjustment of all the sample arm positions listed below. Refer to the procedure RAS385: Arms, 6. Sample arm adjustment, page 36. - Cuvette: Cuvette Position (rotation) and Low Position in Cuvette (vertical) - Wash tower: Wash Tower Position (rotation) and Low Position in Wash Tower (vertical) - Reagent rack (rotation): R1 Pos.-Reagent Rack, R2 Pos.-Reagent Rack, R3 Pos.-Reagent Rack - Calibrator/control reagent rack (rotation): R1 Pos.-Cal/Ctrl Rack, R2 Pos.-Cal/Ctrl Rack, R3 Pos.-Cal/Ctrl Rack - Cassette (rotation): R1 on Cassette and R2 on Cassette - Reagent rack, calibrator/control reagent rack and cassette (vertical): Low Position in Reagent rack, Low Position CalCs on reagent tray, Low Position in Cassette - Sample (rotation): External Sample and Internal Sample - Sample (vertical): Low Position in Sample Cup and Low Position in Sample Tube - ISE tower: ISE Sample (rotation) and Low Position in ISE Tower (vertical) 2. If necessary, readjust the positions.
6.2.
To check the reagent arm positions
1. Check the adjustment of all the reagent arm positions listed below. Refer to the procedure RAS385: Arms, 5. Reagent arm adjustment, page 23. - Cuvette: Cuvette Position (rotation) and Low Position in Reaction Tray (vertical) - Wash tower: Wash Tower Position (rotation) and Low Position in Wash Tower (vertical) - Reagent rack (rotation): R1 Pos.-Reagent Rack, R2 Pos.-Reagent Rack, R3 Pos.-Reagent Rack - Cassette (rotation): R1 on Cassette and R2 on Cassette - Reagent rack and cassette (vertical): Low Position in Reagent/Cal/Ctrl Rack and Low Position in Cassette 2. If necessary, readjust the positions.
6.3.
To check the mixer positions
1. Check the adjustment of all the mixer positions listed below. Refer to the procedure RAS386: Mixer, 5. Adjustments, page 17. - Home position - Above Reaction Tray position and Cuvette position 2. If necessary, readjust the positions.
6.4.
To check the cuvette changer
1. Refer to the procedure RAS384: Cuvette changer, 4.9. Adjustment check, page 47 to check the adjustment of the cuvette changer. 2. If necessary, readjust the cuvette changer. See RAS384: Cuvette changer, 4. Adjustments, page 31.
RAS378J - 6
MAINTENANCE
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
6 month maintenance
7. To check the barcode readers 1. Check the adjustment of the reagent barcode reader position. Refer to the procedure RAS380: Reagent tray, 4.4. Reagent barcode reader position, page 24. 2. If necessary, readjust the position. 3. Check the adjustment of the sample barcode reader position. Refer to the procedure RAS381: Sample tray, 4.3. Sample barcode reader position, page 17. 4. If necessary, readjust the position.
8. To check the spectrophotometer Refer to the procedure RAS383: Optical bench, 4. Optical bench check, page 31.
9. To check the temperature 1. Go to Services > Diagnostics > Heating. 2. Make sure that the assigned values for the following are correct. - Needle Heating: 37°C - Reaction Heating: 37°C - Refrigerated Area: 6°C
3. If necessary, change the assigned values as follows. - Select the Needle Heating, Reaction Heating or Refrigerated Area option (A). - Press Stop (B). - Change the assigned value. - Press Start (C) to save the modifications on the mother board.
A
C
B
4. Make sure that the current temperatures for the following are correct. - Needle Heating: 37°C +/- 1.5°C - Reaction Heating: 37°C +/- 0.25°C - Refrigerated Area: between 4 and 10°C The lights should be green.
Technical Manual RAA023
MAINTENANCE
RAS378J - 7
6 month maintenance
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
10. To check the sample needle throughput
This procedure allows you to check the sample needle and the water pump flow.
1. Go to Services > Customer Services > Cycles. 2. Run a Priming Cycle. 3. Make sure that the suction and the flow of the reagent and sample needles are correct.
A 4. Go to Services > Diagnostics > Tray. 5. Select the Reagent option (A) then press Motor Off (B). B
6. Place an empty 15 mL vial on the position "A1" of a reagent rack. 7. Manually load this rack on the reagent tray, in position "1".
8. Go to Services > Diagnostics > Syringe. 9. In the Pump area, select the Water Pump option (C) then press Water pump flow measurement (D). The cycle starts then the water volume that has flowed is displayed in the Measured volume field (E). The water volume is displayed in red if it is out of range or if an error appears during the cycle.
C
E D
11. To calibrate the pressure sensors Refer to the procedure RAS442: Pressure sensors, 3.3. To calibrate the pressure sensors, page 7.
RAS378J - 8
MAINTENANCE
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
6 month maintenance
12. To clean and defragment the C:\ and D:\ drives 12.1.
To log in to Windows
1. 2. 3. 4.
12.2.
Log in to the instrument software as technician with tech/abxtech as login/password. Go to Services > Diagnostics and open the Windows Explorer. Press the Windows Start button, press Log Off abx... and then press Log Off. Log in to Windows as administrator with administrator/admin as login/password.
To clean the C:\ and D:\ drives
1. Press the Windows Start button and go to Programs > Accessories > System Tools > Disk Cleanup.
2. Select the C:\ drive and press OK. 3. Add the Compress old files option and press OK.
4. Repeat the steps 1 to 3 for the D:\ drive.
Technical Manual RAA023
MAINTENANCE
RAS378J - 9
6 month maintenance
12.3.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
To defragment the C:\ and D:\ drives
1. Press the Windows Start button and go to Programs > Accessories > System Tools > Disk Defragmenter.
2. Select the C:\ drive and press Defragment. 3. Repeat the steps 1 and 2 for the D:\ drive.
12.4.
To clear the print spooler
1. Open the Windows Explorer and go to C:\WINDOWS\system32\spool\PRINTERS.
2. Delete all the files.
RAS378J - 10
MAINTENANCE
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
12.5.
6 month maintenance
To purge the Host orders
1. Go to C:\Program Files\P400 Software\Exe\Rs_Data. 2. Delete all the files.
12.6.
To empty the recycle bin
Right-click the Recycle Bin and then click Empty Recycle Bin.
13. Check up after intervention Refer to the procedure RAS393: Check up after intervention.
Technical Manual RAA023
MAINTENANCE
RAS378J - 11
6 month maintenance
RAS378J - 12
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
MAINTENANCE
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS379J
Yearly maintenance In this procedure, specific instructions are given for previous ABX Pentra 400 hardware versions: ■ V1 corresponds to instruments with serial numbers below 2000.
RAS379: Yearly maintenance
Concerns Instrument Reagent tray cleaning Arms assembly greasing (for ABX Pentra 400 V1 only) Reaction tray cleaning Cuvette changer endless screw greasing Cooling unit Cooling unit CU401 Cooling unit CU400 ISE module 6 month maintenance procedure
Required tools Flat screwdriver Phillips screwdriver Hexagonal keys Torx key
Required products Distilled water Bleach
Intervention time 3 h 30
Frequency Yearly
Specific kit or consumables KIT, 1 YEAR MAINTENANCE XEA792GS (1209159792) If the instrument is equipped with ISE module option: KIT, ISE 1 YEAR MAINTENANCE KIT XEA794ES (1209155794)
Disposable gloves, eye protections and a lab coat must be worn by the operator. Local or national regulations must be applied in all the operations.
Yearly maintenance
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
KIT, 1 YEAR MAINTENANCE XEA792GS (1209159792) P/n XEA768A (1209151768) LAM017A (1207681017) 1300024610 DZZ055A (1202191055) LBH003A (1207791003) HAX0239 (1207230239) JAB010A (1207251010) DBJ025A (1202131025) XEA766BS (1209159766) 9001072 (1229001072) B8078955 (1228078955) B8076812 (1228076812) 3027030 (1223027030)
Designation TOOL, MOLYKOTE GREASE 3.5 ML TOOL, CUV.CHANGER AXIS GREASE CHILLER, GLYCOL 1 L FILTER, COOLING UNIT FILTER REAGENT, 5 L KEG FOR RINSE SPS GLYCOL STICKER CASE USDD40 500x400x250 CLIPS, PLASTIC D=6.4 MM KIT, 6 MONTH MAINTENANCE FILTER, FILTER LIQUID COMPLETE REAGENT SYRINGE (1000 µL) SAMPLE SYRINGE (100 µL) CLAMP, TUBE D7
Qty 1 1 2 1 1 1 1 4 1 1 1 2
1. Instrument 1.1.
Reagent tray cleaning ■ Switch
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
■ Remove
the sample tray, the insulating cover and the reagent tray (see RAS380: Reagent tray, page 1) to access the reagent tray fans.
■ Connect ■ Make
the power supply cable and switch the instrument on.
sure that the reagent tray fans are working properly.
■ Switch
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
■ Use
a brush to remove dust from the reagent tray.
■ Use
absorbent paper to clean the reagent tray and the barcode reader window.
RAS379J - 2
MAINTENANCE
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Yearly maintenance
Specific ABX Pentra 400 V1 Follow the arms assembly greasing procedure before reassembling. See 1.2. Arms assembly greasing (for ABX Pentra 400 V1 only), page 3.
1.2.
Arms assembly greasing (for ABX Pentra 400 V1 only)
It is advisable to remove the needles before dismantling the arms assembly (in order not to damage them).
■ Fill
a syringe with MOLYKOTE grease.
■ Remove
the covers. See RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1. Open the arms main cover and the ISE cover. Remove the external and internal sample covers, the power supply cover, the optic hatch, the arms covers, the cuvettes tray plate, the reagent cover, the reagent plate, the loader cover, the mother board cover and the mixer plate.
■ Disconnect
the two connectors from the reagent arm board and the connector from the sample arm
board. ■ Disconnect
the reagent arm motor connector (J58) from the mother board.
■ Disconnect
the sample arm motor connector (J59) from the mother board. A
■ Cut
the Ty-Rap™, then unplug the connectors of the two rotation motors (A) and the connectors of the two home sensors (B).
B
A
Technical Manual RAA023
MAINTENANCE
RAS379J - 3
Yearly maintenance
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Remove
the arms assembly by unscrewing the four CHC screws.
Take care of the needles.
■ Turn
the arms to access the greasing holes.
■ Use
the syringe to grease the arms through the two holes on each arm body.
■ Reassemble
in reverse order.
After the arms assembly greasing procedure, it is advisable to check the mechanical adjustments of the sample and reagent arms. See RAS378: 6 month maintenance, 6. To check the mechanical adjustments, page 5.
RAS379J - 4
MAINTENANCE
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
1.3.
Yearly maintenance
Reaction tray cleaning ■ Follow
the reaction tray dismantling procedure. See RAS382: Reaction tray, page 1.
A ■ Unscrew the 7 CHC screws, disconnect the
flap door (A) switch and unscrew the NTC to remove the upper case.
■ Unscrew
the 6 CHC screws to remove the holder disk.
■ Remove
dust from the reaction tray using a brush and a vacuum cleaner.
■ Clean
the crown wheel using a brush and a vacuum cleaner.
■ Clean
the roller groove using absorbent paper.
■ Blow
dust off the spectrophometer lenses, using an aerosol duster.
■ Reassemble
Technical Manual RAA023
in reverse order.
MAINTENANCE
RAS379J - 5
Yearly maintenance
1.4.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Cuvette changer endless screw greasing
This procedure does not apply to the ABX Pentra 400 V1.
■ Open
the arms main cover.
■ Remove
the loader cover. See RAS377: Covers dismantling, 11. Loader cover, page 7.
■ Use
the syringe of "TOOL, CUV.CHANGER AXIS GREASE" (provided in the kit) to grease the endless screw:
- Put a drop of grease on the endless screw. - Manually move up and down the endless screw by turning it.
■ Put
RAS379J - 6
the loader cover back.
MAINTENANCE
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Yearly maintenance
2. Cooling unit Follow the procedure corresponding to the cooling unit model you have: - 2.1. Cooling unit CU401, page 7 - 2.2. Cooling unit CU400, page 9
2.1.
Cooling unit CU401 ■ Drain
the cooling unit as follows:
- Pull the ventilation grid and remove it.
- Put the glycol sticker on the tank (both provided in the kit).
- Put the drainage tubing in the tank to collect the used glycol and unscrew the bleed screw.
- Slightly tilt the cooling unit forwards to drain completely the cooling unit. - Then, screw the bleed screw and remove the drainage tubing from the tank.
Technical Manual RAA023
MAINTENANCE
RAS379J - 7
Yearly maintenance
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
- Put the ventilation grid back.
When you close the ventilation grid, take care to arrange the drainage tubing up as shown on the figure below.
■ Clean
the overflow jar at the rear of the cooling unit.
■ Fill
the cooling unit with ethylene glycol and distilled water as follows:
- Slightly push to unlock and to open the lid of filling opening.
RAS379J - 8
MAINTENANCE
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Yearly maintenance
- Fill the cooling unit with 2 liters of ethylene glycol and complete with distilled water up to the high mark.
Take care that no liquid enters the cooling unit.
- Close the lid. ■ Remove
2.2.
dust from the cooling unit grid (at the rear of the cooling unit).
Cooling unit CU400 ■ Raise
the cooling unit by approximately 40 cm.
■ Drain
the cooling unit as follows: - Put the glycol sticker on the tank (both provided in the kit).
- Place the tank under the cooling unit and put the tubing into the tank to collect the used glycol. - Turn the tap on. - Slightly tilt the cooling unit backwards to drain completely the cooling unit. - Then, turn the tap off and remove the tubing from the tank.
Technical Manual RAA023
MAINTENANCE
RAS379J - 9
Yearly maintenance
■ Clean ■ Fill
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
the overflow jar.
the cooling unit with 2 liters of ethylene glycol, then add one liter of distilled water.
The liquid level (glycol + distilled water) exceeds lightly the middle mark of the window.
■ Remove
dust from the cooling unit grid.
■ Replace
the filter (included in the kit).
3. ISE module See RAS388: ISE module maintenance, 2. Yearly maintenance, page 3 in Section 7: ISE module.
4. 6 month maintenance procedure See RAS378: 6 month maintenance, page 1.
It is not necessary to perform the cooling unit filter cleaning (for cooling unit CU400 only) because it has been replaced.
RAS379J - 10
MAINTENANCE
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS393E
Check up after intervention
RAS393: Check up after intervention
Concerns Preliminary operations Calibration Control Check results
Required tools None
Required products Distilled water
Intervention time 1 h 30
Frequency On request
Specific kit or consumables ABX Pentra Qualitest Solution A11A01758 or ABX Pentra Precitest Solution 1300017438
Disposable gloves, eye protections and a lab coat must be worn by the operator. Local or national regulations must be applied in all the operations.
Check up after intervention
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
The "Check up after intervention" procedure, also called "Precision test" procedure, should be performed after an intervention to verify that the instrument is functioning properly. This procedure consists in checking the pipetting precision with the ABX Pentra Qualitest Solution or the ABX Pentra Precitest Solution.
1. Preliminary operations 1.1.
Control configuration ■ Go
to Calibration/Control > Control and refer to your user manual to configure either the ABX Pentra Qualitest Solution as a control for the test T1 or the ABX Pentra Precitest Solution as a control for the test P1. ■ For
the test T1, refer to the control solution vial to specify the control characteristics as the Target Value, Min. Value and Max. Value. ■ For the test P1, specify the control characteristics as follows: - Target Value: 600 ΔA, - Min. Value: 500 ΔA, - Max. Value: 700 ΔA ■ Transfer
the control solution in a sample cup (200 µL minimum).
■ Physically ■ Then,
1.2.
position the sample cup on the programmed rack position.
load the rack on the sample tray.
Reagent configuration ■
Go to Reagent Configuration > Configuration and refer to your user manual to configure distilled water as a reagent for the test T1 or P1.
■ Physically
position either two vials of distilled water (15 mL and 10 mL) for the test T1 or a 15 mL vial of distilled water for the test P1 on the programmed rack position.
■ Then,
1.3.
load the rack on the reagent tray.
Results validation configuration ■ Go
to Services > System Configuration > Results validation.
■ Write
RAS393E - 2
the customer configuration down.
MAINTENANCE
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Check up after intervention
It is necessary to write down the customer configuration to reconfigure the results validation of calibrations and controls, with the customer configuration, at the end of procedure.
■ Press
Edit (A). B
■ Configure
the results validation of calibrations and controls (B).
■ Press
OK to validate (C). A
C
2. Calibration ■
Go to Worklist > Calibration and refer to your user manual to create the calibration request for the test T1 or P1.
■ Run
analyses by pressing Start from the generic toolbar.
The calibration for the test T1 or P1 will be performed.
3. Control Once the calibration is validated, perform the control as explained below. ■ Go
to Worklist > Control and refer to your user manual to create the control request (15 replicates) for the test T1 or P1.
■ Run
analyses by pressing Start from the generic toolbar.
The 15 replicates for the test T1 or P1 will be performed.
Technical Manual RAA023
MAINTENANCE
RAS393E - 3
Check up after intervention
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
4. Check results Once the instrument is Ready, check results of the test T1 or P1.
First, make sure that all the results (15 replicates) were validated automatically.
■ Go
to Quality Control > Control. A C
■ Select
the control solution using the Control scrolling list (A).
■ In
the Session Mean part, drag the slider (B) to display the CV (C). The expected coefficient of variation (CV) for the 15 replicates must be ≤ 1.0%.
■ If
B
the test results are bad, see Section 6: Troubleshooting, 2.1.1. Repeatability, page 6-42.
■ If you have to run the 15 replicates again, ask for a New Worklist from the Start up window
(use the Change User option from the Shutdown window) so that only the 15 new replicates are taken into account in the CV calculation. Use new control solution, use fresh distilled water on the rack.
■ Go
to Services > System Configuration > Results validation.
■ Press
Edit (A).
B
■ Reconfigure
the results validation of calibrations and controls with the customer configuration previously written down (B).
■ Press
RAS393E - 4
A
OK to validate (C).
MAINTENANCE
C
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS377E
Covers dismantling In this procedure, specific instructions are given for previous ABX Pentra 400 hardware versions: ■ V1 corresponds to instruments with serial numbers below 2000. ■ V2 corresponds to instruments with serial numbers between 2000 and 2999.
RAS377: Covers dismantling
Concerns Arms main cover and ISE cover Sample covers Power supply cover ISE plate Optic hatch Arms covers Cuvettes tray plate Reagent cover Reagent plate Recuperation jar Loader cover Cuvettes hatch Connection hatch Cuvettes cover Mixer cover Mother board cover Arm bracket covers Mixer plate
Required tools Hexagonal keys Flat screwdriver Phillips screwdriver
Required products None
Specific kit or consumables None Disposable gloves, eye protections and a lab coat must be worn by the operator. Local or national regulations must be applied in all the operations.
Covers dismantling
■ Switch
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
1. Arms main cover and ISE cover
B
■ Lift
the arms main cover up (A).
■ Lift
the ISE cover up (B).
A
2. Sample covers
■ Remove
the external sample cover.
■ Unscrew
the 3 cruciform screws and the FHC screw to remove the internal sample cover.
RAS377E - 2
COVERS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Covers dismantling
3. Power supply cover
■ Unscrew
the 7 cruciform screws to remove the power supply cover.
4. ISE plate
■ If
the instrument is not equipped with ISE module, follow the procedure below. the instrument is equipped with ISE module, see RAS538: ISE module spare part replacement, 1. ISE module dismantling, page 2.
■ If
■ Unscrew
the 4 cruciform screws to remove the ISE plate.
Technical Manual RAA023
COVERS
RAS377E - 3
Covers dismantling
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
5. Optic hatch
■ Press
the front of the optic hatch to open it.
Press
6. Arms covers
■ Unscrew
the 4 BHC screws to remove the left arm cover.
■ Unscrew
the 2 FHC screws to remove the right arm cover.
RAS377E - 4
COVERS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Covers dismantling
7. Cuvettes tray plate
■ Unscrew
the 2 cruciform screws to remove the cuvettes tray plate.
8. Reagent cover
■ Unscrew
the 3 cruciform screws to remove the reagent cover with the reagent hatch.
Technical Manual RAA023
COVERS
RAS377E - 5
Covers dismantling
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
9. Reagent plate
■ First,
remove the ISE cup cover by unscrewing the BHC screw.
■ Then,
unscrew the 5 cruciform screws to remove the reagent plate.
If the instrument is not equipped with ISE module, you have to remove the ISE plate instead of the ISE cup cover. See 4. ISE plate, page 3.
RAS377E - 6
COVERS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Covers dismantling
10. Recuperation jar
■ Disconnect
the tubings from the wash
towers. ■ Pull
the wash towers and disconnect the overflow tubings.
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws and washers and disconnect the tubing under the recuperation jar to remove the recuperation jar.
11. Loader cover
■ Remove the loader cover by unscrewing the
2 cruciform screws on the side and loosening the 3 CHC screws at the rear.
Technical Manual RAA023
COVERS
RAS377E - 7
Covers dismantling
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
12. Cuvettes hatch
■ Pull
the cuvettes hatch to remove it.
Pull
13. Connection hatch
■ Use
a flat screwdriver to turn the captive screw anti-clockwise.
■ Disconnect
the loudspeaker and the USB cables from the computer, then remove the connection hatch.
RAS377E - 8
COVERS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Covers dismantling
14. Cuvettes cover
■ Unscrew
the 6 cruciform screws to remove the cuvettes cover.
15. Mixer cover
■ Unscrew
the 3 BHC screws to remove the mixer cover.
Technical Manual RAA023
COVERS
RAS377E - 9
Covers dismantling
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
16. Mother board cover
■ Remove the needle tubings from the plastic
collars located on the mother board cover and unscrew the 4 CHC screws to remove the mother board cover.
Specific ABX Pentra 400 V1 and V2 ■ First,
remove the wire guide by unscrewing the CHC screw.
■ Then,
remove the needle tubings from the plastic collars located on the mother board cover and unscrew the 4 CHC screws to remove the mother board cover.
RAS377E - 10
COVERS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Covers dismantling
17. Arm bracket covers
Hold the arms in position when unscrewing in order not to damage the needles. The arm boards are sensible to electrostatic discharge. In order not to damage those boards, do not touch them.
■ Unscrew
the 2 BHC screws on the sample arm bracket and the 2 BHC screws on the reagent arm bracket to remove the plastic covers.
18. Mixer plate
■ Unscrew
the 3 cruciform screws to remove the mixer plate.
Technical Manual RAA023
COVERS
RAS377E - 11
Covers dismantling
RAS377E - 12
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
COVERS
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS380E
Reagent tray In this procedure, specific instructions are given for previous ABX Pentra 400 hardware versions: ■ V1 corresponds to instruments with serial numbers below 2000.
RAS380: Reagent tray
Concerns Reagent tray dismantling Reagent tray parts replacement Impacted adjustments Adjustments
Required tools Hexagonal keys Torx key Open-end wrench Phillips screwdriver TOOL, REAG TRAY ADJUSTING TOOL XDB097AS (1209149097) TOOL, DUMMY REAGENT NEEDLE GBM1124 (1203601124) TOOL, DUMMY SAMPLE NEEDLE GBM1125 (1203601125)
Required products None
Intervention time N/A
Frequency On request
Specific kit or consumables None
Disposable gloves, eye protections and a lab coat must be worn by the operator. Local or national regulations must be applied in all the operations.
Reagent tray
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
1. Reagent tray dismantling The reagent tray dismantling allows you to access the reagent tray parts that can be replaced: - barcode reader - rollers - home sensor - motor - fans - NTC - reagent tray closing assy - reagent tray door sensor. See 2. Reagent tray parts replacement, page 6
■ Switch
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
■ Remove
the covers (see RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1): Open the arms main cover and the ISE cover. Remove the external and internal sample covers, the power supply cover, the optic hatch, the left arm cover, the cuvettes tray plate, the reagent cover and the reagent plate.
■ Remove the left gusset plate by unscrewing
the 3 CHC screws on the side and loosening the 4 CHC screws at the rear of the instrument.
RAS380E - 2
REAGENT TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Reagent tray
■ If
the instrument is equipped with ISE module, you have to remove the ISE module. See RAS538: ISE module spare part replacement, 1. ISE module dismantling, page 2.
■ Remove
the ISE angle support plate by unscrewing the 2 CHC screws at the rear of the instrument.
Specific ABX Pentra 400 V1 For ABX Pentra 400 V1 only, you have to remove the sample tray as follows: ■ Remove
the barcode reader cover by unscrewing the 2 BHC screws and disconnecting the LED connector from the sample relay board (J2).
■ Loosen
the screw to turn the antistatic
brush.
Technical Manual RAA023
REAGENT TRAY
RAS380E - 3
Reagent tray
■ Remove the sample tray by
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
unscrewing the
5 low head CHC screws.
■ Disconnect
the fan from the right side of the tray, then remove the insulating cover by unscrewing the 13 Torx screws and the 2 Torx F screws.
Specific ABX Pentra 400 V1 For ABX Pentra 400 V1, disconnect the fan from the right side of the tray, then remove the insulating cover by unscrewing the 14 CHC screws and the 2 FHC screws.
RAS380E - 4
REAGENT TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Remove
Reagent tray
the reagent tray.
■ Reassemble
in reverse order except covers.
When reassembling the reagent tray, put the reagent tray into gear on the tensioner roller first. Then, pull on the reagent tray to put it into gear on the 2 centering rollers. Never dismantle the motor or the tensioner roller to put the reagent tray back in place.
Technical Manual RAA023
REAGENT TRAY
RAS380E - 5
Reagent tray
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
2. Reagent tray parts replacement 2.1.
Barcode reader replacement
To know which adjustments have to be performed after parts replacement: See 3. Impacted adjustments, page 19.
■ Follow
the reagent tray dismantling procedure (see 1. Reagent tray dismantling, page 2) to access the barcode reader.
■ Remove
the mother board cover. See RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1.
■ Mark
the position of the barcode reader support (to align it when reassembling), then unscrew the 4 Torx screws.
Marks
It is important to mark the position of the barcode reader support to keep the mechanical adjustment done in factory. The position of the barcode reader support is adjusted so that the barcode reader beam passes crosswise through a sector of the reagent tray. The angle formed from one reagent tray sector extremity to the other is 12°.
12°
■ Unplug
RAS380E - 6
the barcode reader connector from the mother board (J4), then remove the barcode reader.
REAGENT TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Reagent tray
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws under the barcode reader support to release the barcode reader from its support.
■ Replace
2.2.
the barcode reader and reassemble in reverse order.
Rollers replacement
To know which adjustments have to be performed after parts replacement: see 3. Impacted adjustments, page 19.
■ Follow
the reagent tray dismantling procedure (see 1. Reagent tray dismantling, page 2) to access the rollers.
■ Remove the 2 deflectors by unscrewing the
10 cruciform screws.
Technical Manual RAA023
REAGENT TRAY
RAS380E - 7
Reagent tray
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
B
This procedure describes how to replace the 2 centering rollers (A), the 3 supporting rollers (B) and the tensioner roller (C): - 2.2.1. Centering roller, page 8 - 2.2.2. Supporting roller, page 8 - 2.2.3. Tensioner roller, page 9.
A C
2.2.1. Centering roller
■ Loosen
the hexagonal screw to release the
roller. ■ Replace
the roller and tighten the hexagonal screw.
■ Reassemble
in reverse order.
2.2.2. Supporting roller
■ Unscrew
the 2 Torx screws to remove the roller with its support.
■ Replace
the roller with its support and reassemble in reverse order.
RAS380E - 8
REAGENT TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Reagent tray
2.2.3. Tensioner roller
CHC screw
■ Unscrew
the CHC screw and washer to remove the roller adjusting plate. Then, remove the spring and the roller assembly.
roller adjusting plate
CHC screws
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws to remove the roller adjusting support with the roller spacer plate. roller spacer plate roller adjusting support
■ Replace
and reassemble the roller as follows:
roller adjusting plate roller adjusting support
CHC screws M4x8
CHC screw M3x5 with washer 1 2 3
tappings roller spacer plate
spring
roller assembly
CHC screws M3x6
- Assemble the roller spacer plate on the roller adjusting support by screwing the 2 CHC screws M3x6 in the tappings # 2 and 3. - Screw the roller adjusting support on the reagent tray by using the 2 CHC screws M4x8.
Technical Manual RAA023
REAGENT TRAY
RAS380E - 9
Reagent tray
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
- Install the roller assembly and the spring on the roller adjusting support.
- Screw the roller adjusting plate on the roller assembly by using the CHC screw M3x5 with washer.
■ Put
the reagent tray back and remove the temperate area of the reagent tray by unscrewing the 3 CHC screws to adjust the tensioner roller.
2.5 mm
■ Make sure that there is 2.5 mm between the
roller support and the L plate. If necessary, adjust the tensioner roller by unscrewing the CHC screw.
RAS380E - 10
CHC screw L plate
REAGENT TRAY
Roller support
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Reagent tray
If you cannot adjust the tensioner roller to have 2.5 mm between the roller support and the L plate, then reassemble the roller spacer plate on the roller adjusting support by screwing the 2 CHC screws M3x6 in the tappings # 1 and 2.
■ Reassemble
2.3.
in reverse order.
Home sensor replacement
To know which adjustments have to be performed after parts replacement: see 3. Impacted adjustments, page 19.
■ Follow
the reagent tray dismantling procedure (see 1. Reagent tray dismantling, page 2) to access the home sensor.
■ Remove
the front deflector by unscrewing the 6 cruciform screws.
■ Remove
the thermal insulation (A).
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws and cut the Ty-Raps™ to release the home sensor and its wires. A
Technical Manual RAA023
REAGENT TRAY
RAS380E - 11
Reagent tray
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Disconnect ■
the home sensor connector.
Replace the home sensor, reconnect the home sensor connector, fasten the 2 CHC screws and put new Ty-Raps™ back.
■ Put
the thermal insulation back.
■ Put
the reagent tray back and remove the temperate area of the reagent tray by unscrewing the 3 CHC screws to adjust the home sensor.
■ Make
sure that the home flag (fixed under the reagent tray) passes in the middle of the home sensor and does not touch the home sensor. If necessary, adjust the home flag by unscrewing the CHC screw on the reagent tray.
■ Remove
RAS380E - 12
CHC screw
the reagent tray to put the front deflector back and reassemble in reverse order.
REAGENT TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
2.4.
Reagent tray
Motor replacement
To know which adjustments have to be performed after parts replacement: see 3. Impacted adjustments, page 19.
2.4.1. General procedure ■ Follow
the reagent tray dismantling procedure (see 1. Reagent tray dismantling, page 2) to access the
motor.
■ Unscrew
the 3 CHC screws and washers, disconnect the motor connector and remove the motor.
■ Replace ■ Put
the motor, fasten the 3 CHC screws and washers and reconnect the motor connector.
the reagent tray back to adjust the motor position.
■ Make
sure that there is no play between the reagent tray and the motor pinion but do not over-tighten the motor. If necessary, adjust the motor position by unscrewing the 3 CHC screws and washers.
■ Reassemble
Technical Manual RAA023
in reverse order.
REAGENT TRAY
RAS380E - 13
Reagent tray
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
2.4.2. Specific procedure ABX Pentra 400 V1 ■ Follow the reagent
tray dismantling procedure (see 1. Reagent tray dismantling, page 2) to access the
motor.
■ Unscrew
the 3 CHC screws and washers.
■ Disconnect
the motor connector and remove the motor with its peelable spacer.
Peelable spacer
■ Replace the motor with the old peelable spacer, fasten the 3 CHC screws and washers and reconnect
the motor connector. The peelable spacer is used to adjust the motor height positioning. This adjustment is done by the factory. You have to replace the motor with the old peelable spacer to keep the adjustment done by the factory. ■ Put
the reagent tray back to adjust the motor position.
■ Make sure that there is no play between the reagent tray and the motor pinion but do not over-tighten
the motor. If necessary, adjust the motor position by unscrewing the 3 CHC screws and washers. ■ Reassemble
RAS380E - 14
in reverse order.
REAGENT TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
2.5.
Reagent tray
Fans replacement
To know which adjustments have to be performed after parts replacement: see 3. Impacted adjustments, page 19.
■ Follow
the reagent tray dismantling procedure (see 1. Reagent tray dismantling, page 2) to access the
fans.
■ Remove the 2 deflectors by unscrewing the
10 cruciform screws.
Specific ABX Pentra 400 V1 ■ Unscrew
the 2 screws maintaining the fan support on the tray.
■ Pull
the fan up to remove it from the tray and cut the Ty-Raps™ to release the fan and its wires.
■ Disconnect ■ Unscrew ■ Replace
Technical Manual RAA023
the fan connector.
the 2 CHC screws to release the fan from its support. the fan and reassemble in reverse order.
REAGENT TRAY
RAS380E - 15
Reagent tray
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Caution!
Put the fan back on the tray by pressing carefully on the two sides of the fan in order not to break the fan. ■ Ensure that the fan is positioned in the correct direction: the letterings must be placed towards the tray center. Press both sides
Letterings
2.6.
NTC replacement
To know which adjustments have to be performed after parts replacement: see 3. Impacted adjustments, page 19.
■ Follow
the reagent tray dismantling procedure (see 1. Reagent tray dismantling, page 2) to access the
NTC.
■ Remove
the front deflector by unscrewing the 6 cruciform screws.
RAS380E - 16
REAGENT TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Reagent tray
■ Unscrew
the Torx screw and cut the Ty-Raps™ to release the NTC and its wires.
■ Disconnect ■ Replace
2.7.
the NTC connector.
the NTC and reassemble in reverse order.
Reagent tray closing assy replacement
To know which adjustments have to be performed after parts replacement: see 3. Impacted adjustments, page 19.
■ Follow
the reagent tray dismantling procedure (see 1. Reagent tray dismantling, page 2) to access the reagent tray closing assy.
■ Disconnect
the 2 connectors SW1 (no polarity), unscrew the 2 Torx screws and remove the reagent tray closing assy.
Torx screws
Connectors SW1 ■ Replace
Technical Manual RAA023
the reagent tray closing assy and reassemble in reverse order.
REAGENT TRAY
RAS380E - 17
Reagent tray
2.8.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Reagent tray door sensor replacement
To know which adjustments have to be performed after parts replacement: see 3. Impacted adjustments, page 19.
■ Follow
the reagent tray dismantling procedure (see 1. Reagent tray dismantling, page 2) to access the reagent tray door sensor.
■ Disconnect ■ Unscrew ■ Replace
the sensor connector.
the black nut to release the sensor. the sensor as well as its washer and nut and reassemble in reverse order.
Make sure that there is a space of 1 to 3 mm between the sensor and the upper side of the tray.
1-3 mm
Black nut
RAS380E - 18
REAGENT TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Reagent tray
3. Impacted adjustments
Replaced spare parts Impacted adjustments
Barcode Home Rollers Motor Fans NTC reader sensor
Door sensor
Dismantling
Reagent Tray Reagent Bar Code Reader Position
X
X
X
Central Loading Reagent Position
X
X
R1 Pos.-Reagent Rack for Sample Arm
X
X
R2 Pos.-Reagent Rack for Sample Arm
X
X
R3 Pos.-Reagent Rack for Sample Arm
X
X
R1 Pos.-Cal/Ctrl Rack for Sample Arm
X
X
R2 Pos.-Cal/Ctrl Rack for Sample Arm
X
X
R3 Pos.-Cal/Ctrl Rack for Sample Arm
X
X
R1 Pos.-Cassette for Sample Arm
X
X
R2 Pos.-Cassette for Sample Arm
X
X
R1 Pos.-Reagent Rack for Reagent Arm
X
X
R2 Pos.-Reagent Rack for Reagent Arm
X
X
R3 Pos.-Reagent Rack for Reagent Arm
X
X
R1 Pos.-Cassette for Reagent Arm
X
X
R2 Pos.-Cassette for Reagent Arm
X
X
X
X
Sample arm rotation ISE Sample (if present)
Technical Manual RAA023
X
REAGENT TRAY
X
X
X
X
RAS380E - 19
Reagent tray
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
4. Adjustments
Recommendations for use: When you adjust a position of the reagent tray by changing the number of steps for this position, please note that a change of 29 steps is approximately equal to a move of 1 mm linear. Please also note that this value is a mean value taking no account of the different reagent tray positions. If the cassette, reagent rack or calibrator/control reagent rack position adjustments are modified, then the corresponding reagent arm and sample arm position adjustments will have to be checked and readjusted if necessary. See RAS385: Arms, page 1.
4.1.
Functional positions to adjust
The following table lists the functional positions to adjust. Those positions are reached by three different types of adjustment: - the combination of two movements to obtain a centering or - performing an automatic "AUTO" adjustment or - performing a manual "MAN" adjustment The table also indicates the tool required to perform those adjustments. Modules Reagent Tray Sector
Position
Target
Type
Sample arm rotation Sector 1 Cassette 1 2
R1 on cassette R2 on cassette
R1 Pos.-Cassette for Sample Arm R2 Pos.-Cassette for Sample Arm
Sector 2 Reagent rack R1 Pos.-Reagent Rack R2 Pos.-Reagent Rack R3 Pos.-Reagent Rack
1-A 2-A 3-A
R1 Pos.-Reagent Rack for Sample Arm R2 Pos.-Reagent Rack for Sample Arm R3 Pos.-Reagent Rack for Sample Arm
1 2 3
R1 Pos.-Cal/Ctrl Rack for Sample Arm R2 Pos.-Cal/Ctrl Rack for Sample Arm R3 Pos.-Cal/Ctrl Rack for Sample Arm
Sector 3 Cal/Ctrl rack R1 Pos.-Cal/Ctrl Rack R2 Pos.-Cal/Ctrl Rack R3 Pos.-Cal/Ctrl Rack
RAS380E - 20
REAGENT TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
Tool
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Reagent tray
Modules Reagent Tray Sector
Position
Target
Type
Reagent arm rotation Sector 1 Cassette R1 on cassette R2 on cassette
1 2
R1 Pos.-Cassette for Reagent Arm R2 Pos.-Cassette for Reagent Arm
Sector 2 Reagent rack R1 Pos.-Reagent Rack R2 Pos.-Reagent Rack R3 Pos.-Reagent Rack
1-A 2-A 3-A
R1 Pos.-Reagent Rack for Reagent Arm R2 Pos.-Reagent Rack for Reagent Arm R3 Pos.-Reagent Rack for Reagent Arm
1 2 3
R1 Pos. Cal/Ctrl Rack for Reagent Arm* R2 Pos. Cal/Ctrl Rack for Reagent Arm* R3 Pos. Cal/Ctrl Rack for Reagent Arm*
1
Reagent Bar Code Reader Position
AUTO
1
Central Loading Reagent Position
MAN
Sector 3 Cal/Ctrl rack R1 Pos.-Cal/Ctrl Rack* R2 Pos.-Cal/Ctrl Rack* R3 Pos.-Cal/Ctrl Rack* Reagent Barcode Reader Sector 1 Cassette
Sector 36 Cassette
* At the moment, these functional positions are not used on HORIBA Medical range.
Technical Manual RAA023
REAGENT TRAY
RAS380E - 21
Tool
Reagent tray
4.2.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
"Reag tray adjusting tool" description
The "Reag tray adjusting tool" represents the functional positions to adjust as follows: - C1 and C2: functional positions of a cassette. - R1, R2 and R3: functional positions of a reagent rack, positions A1, A2 and A3. - CS1, CS2 and CS3: functional positions of a Cal/Ctrl rack.
CS1, CS2, CS3: Functional positions of a Cal/Ctrl rack
C1, C2: Functional positions of a cassette
Height adjustment
R1, R2, R3: Functional positions of a reagent rack A1, A2, A3
It is also used for barcode reader adjustments.
RAS380E - 22
REAGENT TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
4.3.
Reagent tray
Preliminary procedure ■ Connect
the power supply cable and switch the instrument on.
Ensure that the reagent and sample arms are in their respective wash towers.
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Tray.
■ Before
starting the position adjustments, load the "Reag tray adjusting tool" in the reagent tray:
A
- Select the Reagent radio button (A). - Press Motor Off (B). B
- Turn manually the reagent tray and load the "Reag tray adjusting tool" in the reagent tray.
- Press Check Home (C) to move the reagent tray to its home position. C
Technical Manual RAA023
REAGENT TRAY
RAS380E - 23
Reagent tray
4.4.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Reagent barcode reader position
Warning! Class 2 laser barcode reader Do not stare directly into beam or with optical instrument, as it may cause permanent eye damage.
4.4.1. Automatic adjustment The reagent barcode reader position can be adjusted automatically by using the CAB auto reader adjustment function (D). To use this function correctly, the "Reag tray adjusting tool" loaded in the reagent tray (see 4.3. Preliminary procedure, page 23) must be equipped with a barcode label in good condition and perfectly centered on the "Reag tray adjusting tool". ■ Press
Search (D1). The reagent tray moves to its home position. Then, the "Reag tray adjusting tool" moves to the Reagent Bar Code Reader Position position. The adjustment value for the Reagent Bar Code Reader Position position is calculated and then displayed in the corresponding field (D2). - The value is displayed in black if it is within range. - The value is displayed in red if it is out of range.
E
D 2 1
3
4
■ If
the adjustment value is correct, press Validate (D3). The value is then transferred in the Target field for the Reagent Bar Code Reader Position position (E). If not, press Cancel (D4) and try again.
C
■ Press Check Home (C) to move the reagent
tray to its home position.
4.4.2. Adjustment check Once the reagent barcode reader position is adjusted, check the reagent barcode reading as follows:
■
Put different cassettes and racks on the reagent tray.
A
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Barcode Test.
■ Select
the Reagent radio button (A).
■ Then,
press Check Tray (B). At the end of the cycle, make sure that the position of cassettes and racks on the screen corresponds to the position on the reagent tray.
RAS380E - 24
REAGENT TRAY
B
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
4.5.
Reagent tray
"Central Loading Reagent Position"
■ In
the Target scrolling list, select Central Loading Reagent Position (F).
G
■ In the Sector scrolling list, select any sector
F
("7" for this example) (G). ■ Press
Check Home (C).
■ Press Check Position to move the selected
sector to the Central Loading Reagent Position position (H).
C
H
C
H
■ Check the position of the selected sector in
front of the yellow arrow.
■ Adjust the position by changing the number
of steps in the Target field for the Central Loading Reagent Position position (E). - Increase the number of steps to move the tray anticlockwise. - Decrease the number of steps to move the tray clockwise. ■ Press Check Home (C) to move the reagent
tray to its home position, then check the position again (press Check Position (H)).
■ Put
E
the covers back.
Technical Manual RAA023
REAGENT TRAY
RAS380E - 25
Reagent tray
4.6.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Sampling in reagent tray adjustment (cassette, rack, cal/ctrl rack) ■ Load
the "Reag tray adjusting tool" in the reagent tray. See 4.3. Preliminary procedure, page 23.
■ Replace
the reagent and sample needles respectively by the "Dummy reagent needle" (see RAS385: Arms, 5.2. "Dummy reagent needle" installation, page 25) and the "Dummy sample needle" (see RAS385: Arms, 6.2. "Dummy sample needle" installation, page 38).
Adjustment example Adjustment of a sampling with the reagent needle in a cassette in position "C1".
Aim of this procedure: center the reagent needle in the R1 on Cassette position. This adjustment is performed with the "Reag tray adjusting tool" and the "Dummy reagent needle".
R1 on Cassette
R2 on Cassette
RAS380E - 26
REAGENT TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Reagent tray
a- Reagent tray tab ■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Tray.
■ In
the Target scrolling list, select R1 Pos.Cassette for Reagent Arm (F).
■ Press
F
Check Home (C).
■ Press Check Position to move the cassette
to the R1 Pos.- Cassette for Reagent Arm position (H), then check the "Reag tray adjusting tool" position:
E C
H
The "C1" hole of the "Reag tray adjusting tool" must be centered in the rear slot of the insulating cover.
■ Adjust
the position by changing the number of steps in the Target field for the R1 Pos.- Cassette for Reagent Arm position (E). - Y1 - Increase the number of steps to move the tray anticlockwise. - Y2 - Decrease the number of steps to move the tray clockwise. Y1
■
OK
Y2
Press Check Home (C) to move the reagent tray to its home position, then check the position again (press Check Position (H)).
Technical Manual RAA023
REAGENT TRAY
RAS380E - 27
Reagent tray
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
b- Reagent arm rotation tab ■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Arms.
■ Ensure ■ Ensure
that the sample arm is at its vertical home position. that the reagent arm is at its vertical and rotation home position.
■ Select
the reagent arm Rotation radio button (1).
1 2
■ In
the Position scrolling list, select R1 on Cassette (2).
■ Press
Check Position (3). 3
4 ■ Check the centering of the "Dummy reagent
needle" in the "Reag tray adjusting tool" as follows: - Select the reagent arm Vertical radio button (4). - Press Motor Off (5).
5
Reagent arm rotation / R1 on Cassette (b) +
+ - Slowly push the arm down, then check the position of the "Dummy reagent needle" in the "Reag tray adjusting tool".
Reagent tray / R1 Pos.- Cassette for Reagent Arm (a)
RAS380E - 28
REAGENT TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Press
Reagent tray
Check Home (6).
■ Adjust the position by changing the number
of steps in the Position field for the R1 on Cassette position (7). - Increase the number of steps to turn the reagent arm clockwise. - Decrease the number of steps to turn the reagent arm anticlockwise.
6
7
The principle of the adjustment consists in a combination of two movements: the reagent tray rotation (a) and the reagent arm rotation (b). If necessary, repeat the "a" and "b" adjustments by changing each adjustment with the + and - buttons. ■ Move
the reagent arm to its rotation home position as follows: Select the reagent arm Rotation radio button (1) and press Check Home (6).
■ Check
the position again as follows: Press Check Position (3) and check the centering of the needle again (see above).
■ Move
the reagent arm to its vertical and rotation home position as follows: Select the reagent arm Vertical radio button (4) and press Check Home (6). Check the reagent arm Rotation radio button (1) and press Check Home (6).
Follow the same adjustment principle for all the functional positions listed in the functional positions table. See 4.1. Functional positions to adjust, page 20.
Pay attention to select the correct module concerned and to correctly set the sectors, the positions and the targets.
■
Remove the "Dummy sample needle" and the "Dummy reagent needle" and put the sample and reagent needles back.
■ Remove
Technical Manual RAA023
the "Reag tray adjusting tool" from the reagent tray.
REAGENT TRAY
RAS380E - 29
Reagent tray
RAS380E - 30
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
REAGENT TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS381D
Sample tray In this procedure, specific instructions are given for previous ABX Pentra 400 hardware versions: ■ V1 corresponds to instruments with serial numbers below 2000.
RAS381: Sample tray
Concerns Sample tray dismantling Sample tray parts replacement Impacted adjustments Adjustments
Required tools Hexagonal keys Torx key Open-end wrench Flat screwdriver Phillips screwdriver TOOL, DYNAMO. SCREWDRIVER A302 MAG019A (1207851019) TOOL, DUMMY SAMPLE NEEDLE GBM1125 (1203601125)
Required products None
Intervention time N/A
Frequency On request
Specific kit or consumables None
Disposable gloves, eye protections and a lab coat must be worn by the operator. Local or national regulations must be applied in all the operations.
Sample tray
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
1. Sample tray dismantling ■ Switch
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
■ Remove
the covers (see RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1): Open the arms main cover and the ISE cover. Remove the external and internal sample covers.
This cover dismantling is enough to be able to adjust the sample tray. See 4. Adjustments, page 16. But, if necessary, the sample tray can be removed as follows.
■
Remove the barcode reader cover by unscrewing the 2 BHC screws and disconnecting the LED connector from the sample relay board (J2).
■ Loosen
the screw to turn the antistatic
brush.
RAS381D - 2
SAMPLE TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Remove the sample tray by
Sample tray
unscrewing the
5 low head CHC screws. ■ Reassemble in reverse order except covers.
Technical Manual RAA023
SAMPLE TRAY
RAS381D - 3
Sample tray
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
2. Sample tray parts replacement 2.1.
Barcode reader replacement
■ The
barcode reader frequency (550 Hz) allows the reading of high resolution barcodes (higher than or equal to 0.16 mm). However, this frequency does not allow the reading of higher resolution barcodes (lower than 0.16 mm). ■ To know which adjustments have to be performed after parts replacement: see 3. Impacted adjustments, page 15. ■
Remove the barcode reader cover by unscrewing the 2 BHC screws and disconnecting the LED connector from the sample relay board (J2).
■ Unplug
the barcode reader connector from the sample relay board (J5).
■ Unscrew the 2 CHC screws on the barcode
reader support to release the barcode reader from its support.
RAS381D - 4
SAMPLE TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Sample tray
■ Remove
the barcode reader.
■ Replace
the barcode reader and reassemble in reverse order.
To position correctly the barcode reader, screw the 2 CHC screws on the barcode reader support pushing the barcode reader as indicated on the following picture.
Technical Manual RAA023
SAMPLE TRAY
RAS381D - 5
Sample tray
2.2.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Sample tube detector replacement
To know which adjustments have to be performed after parts replacement: see 3. Impacted adjustments, page 15.
■
Remove the barcode reader cover by unscrewing the 2 BHC screws and disconnecting the LED connector from the sample relay board (J2).
■ Disconnect
the sample tube detector connector from the sample relay board (J3).
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws on the sample tube detector to release it from its support.
■ Replace
RAS381D - 6
the sample tube detector and reassemble in reverse order.
SAMPLE TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
2.3.
Sample tray
Home sensor replacement
To know which adjustments have to be performed after parts replacement: see 3. Impacted adjustments, page 15.
2.3.1. General procedure ■ Follow ■
the sample tray dismantling procedure. See 1. Sample tray dismantling, page 2.
Remove the power supply cover, the optic hatch and the reagent cover. See RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1.
■ Open
the computer fan box as follows: slightly loosen the 4 screws and remove the cover.
■ Remove
the blue tube from the computer
fan box.
■ Disconnect
the sample tray home sensor connector (C21) under the reagent tray.
Technical Manual RAA023
SAMPLE TRAY
RAS381D - 7
Sample tray
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Give
play to the sample tray motor by unscrewing the right CHC screw and washer and loosening the left CHC screw.
■ Remove
the belt from the motor pinion to pass the sample tray home sensor connector through the opening under the reagent tray.
■ Mark
the position of the sample tray home sensor support before unscrewing the 4 Torx screws of the support.
■ Unscrew ■ Replace
the CHC screw to release the sample tray home sensor and its wires. the sample tray home sensor and reassemble in reverse order.
Be very careful when you put back the cover of the computer fan box because you can touch/ disconnect the little board, shown on the following picture, with the cover (depending on the computer model).
RAS381D - 8
SAMPLE TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Sample tray
2.3.2. Specific procedure ABX Pentra 400 V1 ■ Follow
the sample tray dismantling procedure. See 1. Sample tray dismantling, page 2.
■ Remove
the power supply cover, the optic hatch and the reagent cover. See RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1.
■ Open
the computer fan box as follows: slightly loosen the 4 screws and remove the cover.
■ Remove
the blue tube from the computer
fan box.
■ Disconnect
the sample tray home sensor connector (C21) under the reagent tray.
■ Move
the sample tray motor support by unscrewing the right CHC screw and washer (A) and loosening the left CHC screw (B) to pass the sample tray home sensor connector through the opening under the reagent tray.
C
■ Mark
the position of the sample tray home sensor support before loosening the 4 CHC screws of the support (C). B
Technical Manual RAA023
SAMPLE TRAY
A
RAS381D - 9
Sample tray
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Unscrew ■ Replace
the CHC screw to release the sample tray home sensor and its wires.
the sample tray home sensor and reassemble in reverse order.
Be very careful when you put back the cover of the computer fan box because you can touch/ disconnect the little board, shown on the following picture, with the cover (depending on the computer model).
2.4.
Motor replacement
To know which adjustments have to be performed after parts replacement: see 3. Impacted adjustments, page 15.
2.4.1. General procedure ■ Follow ■
the sample tray dismantling procedure. See 1. Sample tray dismantling, page 2.
Remove the power supply cover, the optic hatch and the reagent cover. See RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1.
■ Open
the computer fan box as follows: slightly loosen the 4 screws and remove the cover.
■ Remove
the blue tube from the computer
fan box.
RAS381D - 10
SAMPLE TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Sample tray
■ Disconnect
the motor connector (M25) (A) and the optical encoder connector (E27) (B) under the reagent tray.
A
B
■ Remove
the motor without modifying the adjustment of the belt tensioner screw as follows: - Unscrew the right CHC screw and washer and loosen the left CHC screw to give play to the motor. - Unscrew the left CHC screw and washer to release the motor.
The belt tensioner screw is adjusted at 90 mNm with a dynamometric screwdriver.
Technical Manual RAA023
SAMPLE TRAY
RAS381D - 11
Sample tray
■ To
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
remove the motor from the instrument, it is necessary to slightly lift the reagent tray up as follows:
- Loosen the 2 CHC screws and washers of the left reagent tray foot.
- Loosen the 2 CHC screws, one with washer and one with a ground wire of the right reagent tray foot. - Carefully lift the reagent tray up.
■ Replace ■ Put
the motor, put the belt back on the motor pinion and fasten the left CHC screw and washer.
the belt back on the sample tray wheel and fasten the right CHC screw and washer.
■ Tighten
the left and right CHC screws.
■ Reassemble
in reverse order.
Be very careful when you put back the cover of the computer fan box because you can touch/ disconnect the little board, shown on the following picture, with the cover (depending on the computer model).
Because the reagent tray has been lifted up, check all the centering positions of the reagent and sample arms using the "Reag tray adjusting tool", the "Dummy reagent needle" and the "Dummy sample needle". See RAS385: Arms, page 1.
RAS381D - 12
SAMPLE TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Sample tray
2.4.2. Specific procedure ABX Pentra 400 V1 ■ Follow
the sample tray dismantling procedure. See 1. Sample tray dismantling, page 2.
■ Remove
the power supply cover, the optic hatch and the reagent cover. See RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1.
■ Open
the computer fan box as follows: slightly loosen the 4 screws and remove the cover.
■ Remove
the blue tube from the computer
fan box.
■ Disconnect
the motor connector (M25) (A) and the optical encoder connector (E27) (B) under the reagent tray.
B
A
■ Remove
the motor without modifying the adjustment of the belt tensioner screw as follows: - Unscrew the 2 CHC screws and washers to give play to the motor.
Technical Manual RAA023
SAMPLE TRAY
RAS381D - 13
Sample tray
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
- Unscrew the 4 CHC screws under the reagent tray to release the motor from its support.
The belt tensioner screw is adjusted at 90 mNm with a dynamometric screwdriver.
■ Replace
the motor and reassemble in reverse order.
Be very careful when you put back the cover of the computer fan box because you can touch/ disconnect the little board, shown on the following picture, with the cover (depending on the computer model).
RAS381D - 14
SAMPLE TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Sample tray
3. Impacted adjustments
Impacted adjustments
Replaced spare parts Barcode reader
Sample tube detector
Home sensor Motor Dismantling
Sample Tray Sample Bar code reader Position Sample Tube Detector Position
X
X X
X
External sampling Pos.
X
Internal sampling Pos.
X
Technical Manual RAA023
SAMPLE TRAY
RAS381D - 15
Sample tray
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
4. Adjustments
Recommendations for use: When you adjust a position of the sample tray by changing the number of steps for this position, please note that a change of 27 steps is approximately equal to a move of 1 mm linear. Please also note that this value is a mean value taking no account of the different sample tray positions. When you adjust a position by changing the number of steps for this position, press Check Home, then check the position again (press Check Position) to validate and save the new adjustment.
4.1.
Functional positions to adjust
The following table lists the functional positions to adjust. Those positions are reached by the combination of two movements to obtain a centering . The table also indicates the tool required to perform those adjustments. Modules Sample Tray Sector
Position
Target
External Sample
1
2
External Sampling Pos.
Internal Sample
1
1
Internal Sampling Pos.
Type
Tool
Sample arm rotation
Sample Barcode Reader Default value 332
N/A
Sample Bar code reader Position (332)
Sample tube detector 1
RAS381D - 16
1
Sample Tube Detector Position
SAMPLE TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
4.2.
Sample tray
Preliminary procedure ■ Connect ■ Go
the power supply cable and switch the instrument on.
to Services > Diagnostics > Tray.
■ Before
starting the position adjustments, load a sample cup rack on the sample tray in position "1".
A B ■ Select
the Sample radio button (A).
■ In
the Sector and Position scrolling lists, select "1" and "1" (B).
■ Press
Check Home (C). C
4.3.
Sample barcode reader position
Warning! Class 2 laser barcode reader Do not stare directly into beam or with optical instrument, as it may cause permanent eye damage.
■
To adjust this position, remove the barcode reader cover (see 1. Sample tray dismantling, page 2) to access the sample relay board.
■ Perform
the Preliminary procedure, page 17 but load a sample rack instead of a sample cup rack.
■ In
the Target scrolling list, select Sample Bar code reader Position (D).
■ Enter
"332" in the Target field for the Sample Bar code reader Position position (F).
D F
■ Press
Check Home (C), then press Check Position (E).
■ Close
Technical Manual RAA023
C
E
the Diagnostics menu and answer OK at the question: "Do you want to save parameters?".
SAMPLE TRAY
RAS381D - 17
Sample tray
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Go
to Services > Customer Services > Barcode.
■ Place
2
3
a 5 mL adaptor on the rack position
"2". ■ In
the Sector and Position scrolling lists, select "1" and "2" (1).
■ Press
Polling to allow continuous reading of the selected position (2).
1
■ Slightly
loosen the 2 CHC screws on the barcode reader support.
■ Adjust
the barcode reader position to center the beam on the 5 mL adaptor notch.
■ Tighten ■ Press
5 mL adaptor notch
the 2 CHC screws.
Stop (3).
■ Make sure that the beam is centered on the
rack position 1 as follows: - In the Sector and Position scrolling lists, select "1" and "1". - Press Polling and make sure that the beam is centered on the sample rack window.
RAS381D - 18
SAMPLE TRAY
sample rack window
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
4.4.
Sample tray
Sample tube detector position
The vertical centering of the beam is no more required (lightly positioned under the window) because the tube detector position is fixed from now.
■ Perform
the Preliminary procedure, page 17 but load a sample rack instead of a sample cup rack.
■ In
the Target scrolling list, select Sample Tube Detector Position (A).
■ Enter
"3860" in the Target field for the Sample Tube Detector Position position (B).
A B
■ Press
Check Home (C), then press Check Position (D).
C
D
A ■ The
middle window of the sample tray (A) must be approximately centered on the reflector.
B
The LED of the sample tube detector is lit (red light (B)) when the reflector is detected and unlit when the reflector is not detected.
■ Place
Technical Manual RAA023
a 5 mL adaptor on the rack position "2".
SAMPLE TRAY
RAS381D - 19
Sample tray
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
E ■ In
the Sector and Position scrolling lists, select "1" and "2" (E).
■ Press
Check Position (D). D
■ Turn
the potentiometer anticlockwise until the LED is unlit.
■ Then,
turn the potentiometer clockwise until the LED is lit.
■ Move
the sample tray clockwise by using the - button (E) until the LED is unlit and note the number of steps (a) displayed in the Target field for the Sample Tube Detector Position position (B).
■ Move
the sample tray anticlockwise by using the + button (F) until the LED is lit.
■ Move
the sample tray anticlockwise by using the + button (F) until the LED is unlit again and note the number of steps (b) displayed in the Target field for the Sample Tube Detector Position position (B).
■ Enter
the mean value of number of steps (a+b)/2 in the Target field for the Sample Tube Detector Position position (B) and press Check Position (D).
B C
E
D
F
■ Press Check Home (C) to move the sample
tray to its home position, then check the position again (press Check Position (D)).
RAS381D - 20
SAMPLE TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Sample tray
■ Make
sure that all types of sample tubes and cups are correctly detected as follows: - Load 6 sample racks/sample cup racks with several sample tubes and cups on the sample tray. - Go to Services > Diagnostics > Barcode Test.
A - Select the Sample Tray radio button (A) and press Check Tray (B). - At the end of the cycle, make sure that the position of sample tubes and cups on the screen corresponds to their position on the sample tray. Click in the Sector fields (C) to display the different racks. C B ■
If some sample tubes and cups are detected on physically empty positions, lightly turn the potentiometer clockwise and check the detection again (see above).
■
If some sample tubes and cups are not detected, slightly turn the potentiometer anticlockwise and check the detection again (see above).
The most sensitive positions are the rack positions "1" and "10" for each rack. Check the detection with and without sample tubes and cups on these positions.
■ Put
the barcode reader cover back.
Technical Manual RAA023
SAMPLE TRAY
RAS381D - 21
Sample tray
4.5.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Sampling in sample tray adjustment ■ Replace the
sample needle by the "Dummy sample needle". See RAS385: Arms, 6.2. "Dummy sample needle" installation, page 38.
Adjustment example Adjustment of a sampling with the sample needle in a sample cup (or tube) in internal position. a- Sample tray tab ■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Tray.
■ Load
a sample cup rack on the sample tray in sector "1", position "1" as follows: - Select the Sample radio button (A). - In the Sector and Position scrolling lists, select "1" and "1" (B). - Press Check Home (C).
A B
D
■ Move
the sample cup rack to the Internal Sampling Pos. position as follows: - In the Target scrolling list, select Internal Sampling Pos. (D). - Press Check Position (E).
F C
E
■ To
adjust the sample tray position (see Sample position, gray arrows) change the number of steps in the Target field for the Internal Sampling Pos. position (F). - Increase the number of steps to move the tray anticlockwise. - Decrease the number of steps to move the tray clockwise.
Sample position
Sample arm adjustment (b) "Internal Sample" "External Sample"
+ Sample tray adjustment (a) "Internal Sampling Pos." "External Sampling Pos." +
-
-
RAS381D - 22
SAMPLE TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Sample tray
b- Sample arm tab ■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Arms.
■ Place
the reagent arm in its wash tower as follows: - Select the sample arm Vertical radio button (1) and press Check Home (2). - Select the reagent arm Vertical radio button (A) and press Check Home (2). - Select the reagent arm Rotation radio button (B) and press Check Home (2). - In the Position scrolling list, select Wash Tower Position (C) and press Check Position (3). - Select the reagent arm Vertical radio button (A). - In the Position scrolling list, select Low Position in Wash Tower (D) and press Check Position (3).
A
1
B D C 2
3
■ Move
the sample arm to the Internal Sample position as follows: - Select the sample arm Rotation radio button (4) and press Check Home (2). - In the Position scrolling list, select Internal Sample (5). - Press Check Position (3) to move the sample arm over the sample cup rack position "2".
4
5 6 7
■ Check the centering of the "Dummy sample
needle" in the hole "1" of the sample cup rack as follows: - Select the sample arm Vertical radio button (1). - Maintain the arm with one hand, then press Motor Off (6). - Slowly push the arm down, then check the position of the "Dummy sample needle" in the sample cup rack position "1".
■ Press
Check Home (2) to move the sample arm to its vertical home position.
■ To
adjust the sample arm position (see Sample position, blue arrows) change the number of steps in the Position field for the Internal Sample position (7). - Increase the number of steps to turn the sample arm clockwise. - Decrease the number of steps to turn the sample arm anticlockwise.
Technical Manual RAA023
SAMPLE TRAY
RAS381D - 23
Sample tray
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Move
the sample arm to its rotation home position as follows: - Select the sample arm Rotation radio button (8). - Press Check Home (9).
■ Check
the position again as follows: - Press Check Position (10). - Check the centering of the "Dummy sample needle" again (see above).
8 9
10
The principle of the adjustment consists in a combination of two movements: the sample tray rotation (a) and the sample arm rotation (b). If necessary, repeat the "a" and "b" adjustments by changing each adjustment with the + and - buttons.
11 ■ Move
the sample arm to its vertical and rotation home position as follows: - Select the sample arm Vertical radio button (11) and press Check Home (9). - Select the sample arm Rotation radio button (12) and press Check Home (9).
12 9
■ Press Check Home (A) to move the sample
tray to its home position, then check the position again (press Check Position (B)). A
B
Follow the same adjustment principle for the external position described in the functional positions table. See 4.1. Functional positions to adjust, page 16. Pay attention to select the correct module concerned and to correctly set the sectors, the positions and the targets.
■ Remove ■ Put
RAS381D - 24
the "Dummy sample needle " and put the sample needle back.
the covers back.
SAMPLE TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS382F
Reaction tray
RAS382: Reaction tray
Concerns Reaction tray dismantling Reaction tray parts replacement Impacted adjustments Adjustments
Required tools Hexagonal keys Hexagonal screwdriver Flat screwdriver Phillips screwdriver OPTICAL, SEGMENT 1XXX TEST 9200787 (1229200787) TOOL, TEST SEGMENT XDA893A (1209131893) TOOL, DUMMY REAGENT NEEDLE GBM1124 (1203601124) TOOL, DUMMY SAMPLE NEEDLE GBM1125 (1203601125)
Required products None
Intervention time N/A
Frequency On request
Specific kit or consumables Cuvette segments
Disposable gloves, eye protections and a lab coat must be worn by the operator. Local or national regulations must be applied in all the operations.
Reaction tray
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
1. Reaction tray dismantling
In order not to damage the needles during dismantling, disable the arms (vertical and rotation movements) and put them on a sample cup rack over the reagent tray as shown on the following picture.
■ Switch
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
■ Remove
the covers (see RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1): - Open the arms main cover. - Remove the loader cover, the cuvettes hatch, the connection hatch and the cuvettes cover. - Lift the mixer assembly up by pressing the red button. - Remove the optic hatch, the left arm cover, the cuvettes tray plate and the mixer plate.
■ Remove
the unload rack.
■ Remove
the load rack as follows: - Open the 2 adhesive collars and release the wires of the "rack used segment full" sensor. - Disconnect the "rack used segment full" sensor (C19) and unscrew the 6 CHC screws.
"rack used segment full" sensor
RAS382F - 2
REACTION TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Reaction tray
- Disconnect the ground wire. - Open the adhesive collar and release the wires of the "new segment available" sensor. It is not necessary to disconnect this connector because the wires are long enough to put the load rack close to the instrument.
"new segment available" sensor
- Lightly lift the load rack up to disconnect the cuvette motion motor (M32) and the cuvette motion home sensor (C37), located under the load rack. - Remove the load rack.
■ Remove
the reaction tray cover by unscrewing the 3 CHC screws and washers.
Technical Manual RAA023
REACTION TRAY
RAS382F - 3
Reaction tray
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
2. Reaction tray parts replacement 2.1.
Flap door switch replacement
To know which adjustments have to be performed after parts replacement: see 3. Impacted adjustments, page 18.
■ First,
follow the reaction tray dismantling procedure. See 1. Reaction tray dismantling, page 2.
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws then remove the flap door switch cover.
B
■ Disconnect
the 2 flap door switch cables
(A). ■ Hold
the plate on which the screws are tightened (located in the reaction tray inside) and unscrew the 2 CHC screws (B), then remove the flap door switch. A
■ Install
the new flap door switch then fasten the 2 CHC screws.
■ Make
sure that the flap door switch works properly by hearing a characteristic "click". If not, adjust it by unscrewing/screwing the 2 CHC screws.
■ Connect
the 2 flap door switch cables.
■ Reinstall
the flap door switch cover.
■
Adjust the flap door switch cover with the 2 CHC screws so that the hatch closes properly by magnetization.
■ Reassemble
RAS382F - 4
in reverse order.
REACTION TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
2.2.
Reaction tray
NTC replacement
To know which adjustments have to be performed after parts replacement: see 3. Impacted adjustments, page 18.
■ First,
follow the reaction tray dismantling procedure. See 1. Reaction tray dismantling, page 2.
■ Disconnect
the flap door switch (A). A
■ Unscrew
the 7 CHC screws then remove the upper case.
Make sure that the holder disk is correctly positioned to remove the upper case without damaging the NTC.
NTC
Holder disk
Technical Manual RAA023
REACTION TRAY
RAS382F - 5
Reaction tray
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Unscrew
the CHC screw then remove the NTC from the upper case notch.
■ Remove
the NTC black support.
■ Remove
the rear plate by unscrewing the 8 CHC screws.
■ Disconnect
the NTC connector.
■ Go to Services > Diagnostics > Heating >
Reaction Heating. ■ In
the NTC Impedance field, enter the values written on the new NTC cable sticker.
RAS382F - 6
REACTION TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Reassemble
Reaction tray
in reverse order.
When reinstalling the NTC on the upper case, ensure that only the blue part of the cable is in the upper case notch.
NTC cable
Upper case notch
2.3.
Motor replacement
To know which adjustments have to be performed after parts replacement: see 3. Impacted adjustments, page 18.
■ First, ■
follow the reaction tray dismantling procedure. See 1. Reaction tray dismantling, page 2.
Unscrew the 7 CHC screws, disconnect the flap door switch and unscrew the NTC to remove the upper case. See 2.2. NTC replacement, page 5.
■ Unscrew
the ground wire and disconnect the motor connector.
Technical Manual RAA023
REACTION TRAY
RAS382F - 7
Reaction tray
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws, then remove the motor.
■ Replace
the motor, fasten the 2 CHC screws and reconnect the motor connector.
■ Make
sure that there is no play between the reaction tray crown wheel and the motor pinion but do not over-tighten the motor. If necessary, adjust the motor position by unscrewing the 2 CHC screws.
■ Reassemble
2.4.
in reverse order.
Rollers replacement
To know which adjustments have to be performed after parts replacement: see 3. Impacted adjustments, page 18.
2.4.1. Roller adjusting assy replacement ■ First, ■
follow the reaction tray dismantling procedure. See 1. Reaction tray dismantling, page 2.
Unscrew the 7 CHC screws, disconnect the flap door switch and unscrew the NTC to remove the upper case. See 2.2. NTC replacement, page 5.
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws of the roller adjusting assy and remove it.
RAS382F - 8
REACTION TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Reaction tray
■ Install
the new roller adjusting assy. The roller must touch the crown wheel.
■ Ensure that the crown wheel turns correctly.
Adjust the pressure using the adjusting screw.
■ Reassemble
in reverse order.
2.4.2. Lateral rollers replacement ■ First, ■
follow the reaction tray dismantling procedure. See 1. Reaction tray dismantling, page 2.
Unscrew the 7 CHC screws, disconnect the flap door switch and unscrew the NTC to remove the upper case. See 2.2. NTC replacement, page 5.
■ On the lateral roller to be replaced, unscrew
the 2 CHC screws of the lateral roller support and remove it.
■ Install
the new lateral roller. The screws must be placed alongside the crown wheel.
■ Reassemble
Technical Manual RAA023
in reverse order.
REACTION TRAY
RAS382F - 9
Reaction tray
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
2.4.3. Upper rollers replacement ■ First, ■
follow the reaction tray dismantling procedure. See 1. Reaction tray dismantling, page 2.
Unscrew the 7 CHC screws, disconnect the flap door switch and unscrew the NTC to remove the upper case. See 2.2. NTC replacement, page 5.
2.4.3.1. General procedure
If your instrument is equipped with an old model of optical bench (before "XDA829C"), please refer to the specific procedure: 2.4.3.2. Specific procedure ABX Pentra 400 with an old model of optical bench (before "XDA829C"), page 12.
■
Follow the optical bench dismantling procedure until you removed the optical bench. See RAS383: Optical bench, 1. Optical bench dismantling, page 2.
■ Unscrew
the 6 CHC screws to remove the holder disk.
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws of the upper roller support and remove it.
RAS382F - 10
REACTION TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Reaction tray
■ Unscrew
the CHC screw of the upper roller support then remove the roller from the support.
■ Install ■
the new roller on the upper roller support.
Install the upper roller support on the crown wheel. Ensure that there is a space of 0.2 mm between the roller and the crown wheel as follows: Stick a piece of adhesive tape on the crown wheel. Adjust the space between the roller and the crown wheel using the roller axis. The roller must turn when it is on the adhesive tape and must be fixed when it is on the crown wheel. Roller axis
0.2 mm
Adhesive tape ■ Leave
the adhesive tape on the crown wheel and check the position of the 2 other upper rollers.
■ Remove
the adhesive tape.
■ Reassemble
Technical Manual RAA023
in reverse order.
REACTION TRAY
RAS382F - 11
Reaction tray
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
2.4.3.2. Specific procedure ABX Pentra 400 with an old model of optical bench (before "XDA829C") This procedure is designed for ABX Pentra 400 equipped with an old model of optical bench (before "XDA829C") i.e. ABX Pentra 400 with an instrument serial number lower than 3195.
■ Unscrew
the 6 CHC screws to remove the holder disk.
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws of the upper roller support and remove it.
■ Unscrew
the CHC screw of the upper roller support then remove the roller from the support.
RAS382F - 12
REACTION TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Install
Reaction tray
the new roller on the upper roller support.
■ Install
the upper roller support on the crown wheel. Ensure that there is a space of 0.2 mm between the roller and the crown wheel as follows: Stick a piece of adhesive tape on the crown wheel. Adjust the space between the roller and the crown wheel using the roller axis. The roller must turn when it is on the adhesive holder and must be fixed when it is on the crown wheel. Roller axis
0.2 mm
Adhesive tape ■ Leave
the adhesive tape on the crown wheel and check the position of the 2 other upper rollers.
■ Remove
the adhesive tape.
■ Reassemble
in reverse order.
2.4.4. Down rollers replacement ■ First, ■
follow the reaction tray dismantling procedure. See 1. Reaction tray dismantling, page 2.
Unscrew the 7 CHC screws, disconnect the flap door switch and unscrew the NTC to remove the upper case. See 2.2. NTC replacement, page 5.
■ Follow
the 2.4.3. Upper rollers replacement, page 10 procedure until you removed the holder disk.
2.4.4.1. General procedure
If your instrument is equipped with an old model of optical bench (before "XDA829C"), please refer to the specific procedure: 2.4.4.2. Specific procedure ABX Pentra 400 with an old model of optical bench (before "XDA829C"), page 15.
Technical Manual RAA023
REACTION TRAY
RAS382F - 13
Reaction tray
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Remove
the crown wheel as follows: - Unscrew the 2 external CHC screws of each upper roller, mark them in order not to invert them when reassembling and remove them.
- Unscrew the 2 CHC screws of the lateral roller support "1" and remove it. - Unscrew one of the 2 CHC screws of the roller adjusting assy "2" and loosen the second CHC screw to turn the support. - Now, remove the crown wheel.
2
1
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws of the down roller to be replaced and remove it.
■ Reassemble
RAS382F - 14
in reverse order.
REACTION TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Reaction tray
2.4.4.2. Specific procedure ABX Pentra 400 with an old model of optical bench (before "XDA829C") This procedure is designed for ABX Pentra 400 equipped with an old model of optical bench (before "XDA829C") i.e. ABX Pentra 400 with an instrument serial number lower than 3195.
■ Remove
the crown wheel as follows: - Unscrew the 2 external CHC screws of each upper roller, mark them in order not to invert them when reassembling and remove them.
- Unscrew the 2 CHC screws of the lateral roller support "1" and remove it. - Unscrew one of the 2 CHC screws of the roller adjusting assy "2" and loosen the second CHC screw to turn the support. - Now, remove the crown wheel.
Technical Manual RAA023
REACTION TRAY
2
1
RAS382F - 15
Reaction tray
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws of the down roller to be replaced and remove it.
■ Reassemble
2.5.
in reverse order.
Home sensor replacement
To know which adjustments have to be performed after parts replacement: see 3. Impacted adjustments, page 18.
■ First, ■
follow the reaction tray dismantling procedure. See 1. Reaction tray dismantling, page 2.
Unscrew the 7 CHC screws, disconnect the flap door switch and unscrew the NTC to remove the upper case. See 2.2. NTC replacement, page 5.
■ Follow
the 2.4.3. Upper rollers replacement, page 10 procedure until you removed the holder disk.
■ Follow
the 2.4.4. Down rollers replacement, page 13 procedure to remove the crown wheel.
■ Remove
the rear plate by unscrewing the 8 CHC screws.
RAS382F - 16
REACTION TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Disconnect
Reaction tray
the home sensor connector.
■ Loosen
the 3 CHC screws supporting the lower box.
■ Unscrew
the CHC screw and remove the home sensor.
■ Cut
one ear of the new home sensor and twist the cables.
■ Install
the new home sensor and center it in the notch.
■ Reassemble
in reverse order.
When reinstalling the crown wheel, ensure that the home sensor does not touch the crown wheel flag.
■ Check
Technical Manual RAA023
all the reaction tray position adjustments. See 4. Adjustments, page 19.
REACTION TRAY
RAS382F - 17
Reaction tray
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
3. Impacted adjustments
Impacted adjustments
Replaced spare parts Flap door switch
NTC
Home sensor
Motor
Rollers Dismantling
Reaction Tray Offset
X
X
Mixing Position
X
X
Reagent Arm Position
X
X
Sample Arm Position
X
X
Automatic Loading
X
X
Handling Position
X
X
Reaction Tray cover (for needles)
X
X
X
X
X
X
Sample arm rotation Cuvette Position
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Reagent arm rotation Cuvette Position Mixer Cuvette Position Cuvette changer Load in Reaction Tray Position Heating menu Reaction Heating: NTC Impedance
RAS382F - 18
X
REACTION TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Reaction tray
4. Adjustments
Recommendations for use: When you adjust a position of the reaction tray by changing the number of steps for this position, please note that a change of 53 steps is approximately equal to a move of 1 mm linear.
4.1.
Functional positions to adjust
The following table lists the functional positions to adjust. Those positions are reached by three different types of adjustment: - the combination of two movements to obtain a centering or - performing an automatic "AUTO" adjustment or - performing a manual "MAN" adjustment The table also indicates the tool required to perform those adjustments. Modules Reaction Tray Sector Position
Target
Type
Tool
Optical Bench Light Beam 1
Offset
AUTO
Mixer Cuvette Position
1
2
Mixing Position
1
1
Reagent Arm Position
Reagent arm rotation Cuvette Position Sample arm rotation
+ Cuvette Position
1
2
Sample Arm Position
1
1
Automatic Loading
1
1
Handling Position
Cuvette changer Vertical: Motor Off; Horizontal: Load in Reaction Tray Position Reaction tray
Technical Manual RAA023
REACTION TRAY
MAN
RAS382F - 19
Reaction tray
4.2.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Preliminary procedure
Make sure that all the assemblies are at their home position before starting an adjustment. Make sure that the arms are in the upper position before moving a tray.
■ Connect ■ Go
the power supply cable and switch the instrument on.
to Services > Diagnostics > Tray.
■ Before
starting the position adjustments, select the position of the adjustment tool or cuvette segment on the reaction tray:
A C - Select the Reaction radio button (A). - Press Check Home (B). - In the Sector scrolling list, select "1" (C). B
RAS382F - 20
REACTION TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
4.3.
Reaction tray
Home position
This position adjustment is performed with an adjustment tool: OPTICAL, SEGMENT 1XXX TEST 9200787 (1229200787).
4.3.1. Adjustment tool installation ■ First,
follow the Preliminary procedure, page 20.
■ Manually
load the adjustment tool in the reaction tray in position "1" as follows:
- In the Target scrolling list, select Handling Position (D). - Press Check Position (E). The position "1" of the reaction tray moves to the Handling Position position. - Manually load the tool in the reaction tray.
D
E
Make sure that the tool is loaded properly into the reaction tray. It is necessary to press the tool completely down into the reaction tray.
4.3.2. Home position adjustment ■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Spectro. A B
■ Click
the Spectro Measure Adjustment tab (A). The number of steps of the reaction tray home offset is indicated in the Current offset field (B).
■ Press
C
Measure (C).
The instrument evaluates the quality of the current ajdustment. If the current adjustment is not satisfactory, a new offset is determined and the instrument carries out a second measure with this new offset. If this new offset is not satisfactory, a new offset is again determined and the instrument carries out a third measure.
Technical Manual RAA023
REACTION TRAY
RAS382F - 21
Reaction tray
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ If
the adjustment is not correct, press Cancel (F). The optical density curve and the calculated offset are erased. Run measure cycles until the adjustment is correct.
■ If
G
D
The calculated offset value is displayed in the Calculated offset field (D): - The value is displayed in green if it is within range (optical density curve in green (G)). - The value is displayed in red if it is out of range (optical density curve in red (G)). E
F
the adjustment is correct, press OK (E).
F
The offset value is transferred in the Offset field for the reaction tray home position (F).
■ Leave ■ If
RAS382F - 22
the adjustment tool in the reaction tray to adjust the other positions. the home position is adjusted, the other positions have to be adjusted too.
REACTION TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
4.4.
Reaction tray
Mixing Position
This position adjustment is performed with an adjustment tool: OPTICAL, SEGMENT 1XXX TEST 9200787 (1229200787). The position "2" of the adjustment tool will be used.
1
■ First,
2
follow the Preliminary procedure, page 20.
Make sure that the mixer assembly is in the upper position.
■
If the previous adjustment has been carried out, the adjustment tool is loaded in the reaction tray in position "1". If not, manually load it. See 4.3.1. Adjustment tool installation, page 21.
■ In
the Position scrolling list, select "2" (A).
A
■ In
the Target scrolling list, select Mixing Position (B).
B
■ Press
Check Position (C). The position "1" of the reaction tray moves to the Mixing Position position.
Technical Manual RAA023
REACTION TRAY
C
RAS382F - 23
Reaction tray
■ Go
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
to Services > Diagnostics > Arms.
■ Select
1
the Mixer radio button (1).
■ In the Position scrolling list, select Cuvette
2
Position (2). ■ Press
Check Position (3). The mixer moves over the reaction tray and the mixing paddle turns.
3
■ Wait
for the mixing paddle to stop turning, then manually pull the mixer down.
■ Check
the centering of the paddle on the mobile part of the tool position "2".
■ Manually
pull the mixer up.
reaction tray adjustment
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Tray.
■ Adjust the position by changing the number
of steps in the Target field for the Mixing Position position (D). - Increase the number of steps to turn the reaction tray clockwise. - Decrease the number of steps to move the reaction tray anticlockwise.
RAS382F - 24
REACTION TRAY
D
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Reaction tray
■ Adjust
the mixer positioning center as follows: - Loosen the 2 CHC screws of the mixer positioning center. - Move the mixer positioning center until the mixer paddle is centered on the mobile part of the tool position "2". - Fasten the 2 CHC screws of the mixer positioning center.
■ Move
the reaction tray to its home position (press Check Home (E)) then check the position again (press Check Position then manually pull the mixer down). E
1
■ Move
the mixer to its home position: - Go to Services > Diagnostics > Arms. - Select the Mixer radio button (1). - Press Check Home (4). 4
Leave the adjustment tool in the reaction tray to adjust the other positions.
Technical Manual RAA023
REACTION TRAY
RAS382F - 25
Reaction tray
4.5.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Arms position ■ Replace
the reagent and sample needles respectively by the "Dummy reagent needle" (see RAS385: Arms, 5.2. "Dummy reagent needle" installation, page 25) and the "Dummy sample needle" (see RAS385: Arms, 6.2. "Dummy sample needle" installation, page 38).
4.5.1. Reagent Arm Position ■ First,
follow the Preliminary procedure, page 20.
Make sure that the sample arm is in its vertical home position before moving the reagent arm.
If the previous adjustment has been carried out, the adjustment tool is loaded in the reaction tray in position "1". If not, manually load it. See 4.3.1. Adjustment tool installation, page 21. The position "1" of the adjustment tool will be used.
1
■ In
2
the Position scrolling list, select "1" (A).
A
■ In
the Target scrolling list, select Reagent Arm Position (B).
B
■ Press
Check Position (C). The position "1" of the reaction tray moves to the Reagent Arm Position position.
RAS382F - 26
REACTION TRAY
C
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Reaction tray
■ Move
the sample arm to its vertical home position as follows: - Go to Services > Diagnostics > Arms. - Select the sample arm Vertical radio button (1) and press Check Home (2).
3
4
7
■ Move
the reagent arm to its vertical and rotation home position as follows: - Select the reagent arm Vertical radio button (3) and press Check Home (2). - Select the reagent arm Rotation radio button (4). - In the Position scrolling list, select Cuvette Position (5). - Press Check Position (6).
1
5 2
6
The value of the rotation home offset (7) must not be modified. Adjust the rotation home position with the reagent arm mechanical adjustment described below.
3 ■ Check the centering of the "Dummy reagent
needle" into the hole of the tool position "1" as follows: - Select the reagent arm Vertical radio button (3). - Press Motor Off (8). 8
- Slowly push the arm down, then check the position of the "Dummy reagent needle" into the hole of the tool position "1". arm adjustment (RAS385)
reaction tray adjustment (RAS382)
Technical Manual RAA023
REACTION TRAY
RAS382F - 27
Reaction tray
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Loosen
the CHC screw on the reagent arm, then turn the reagent arm to center the "Dummy reagent needle" into the hole of the tool position "1".
■ Tighten
■ Press
the screw.
Check Home (2).
■ Check
the position again as follows: - Select the reagent arm Rotation radio button (4) and press Check Home (2). - Check the centering of the "Dummy reagent needle" again (see above).
4
2
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Tray.
■ Adjust the position by changing the number
of steps in the Target field for the Reagent Arm Position position (D). - Increase the number of steps to turn the reaction tray clockwise. - Decrease the number of steps to move the reaction tray anticlockwise.
D E
■ Move
the reaction tray to its home position (press Check Home (E)) then check the position again with the reagent needle (see above).
3 ■ Move
the reagent arm to its home position (vertical then rotation): - Go to Services > Diagnostics > Arms. - Select the reagent arm Vertical radio button (3) and press Check Home (2). - Select the reagent arm Rotation radio button (4) and press Check Home (2).
RAS382F - 28
4
2
REACTION TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Reaction tray
4.5.2. Sample Arm Position ■ First,
follow the Preliminary procedure, page 20.
This position corresponds to the home position. Therefore, the number of steps in the Target scrolling list must be "0". This is fixed and must not be changed. Follow this procedure to check the position only.
Make sure that the reagent arm is in its wash position (rotation and vertical) before moving the sample arm.
If the previous adjustment has been carried out, the adjustment tool is loaded in the reaction tray in position "1". If not, manually load it. See 4.3.1. Adjustment tool installation, page 21. The position "2" of the adjustment tool will be used.
1
■ In
2
the Position scrolling list, select "2" (A).
A
■ In
the Target scrolling list, select Sample Arm Position (B).
B
■ Press
Check Position (C). The position "1" of the reaction tray moves to the Sample Arm Position position.
Technical Manual RAA023
REACTION TRAY
C
RAS382F - 29
Reaction tray
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
1
■ Move the sample arm over the reaction tray
as follows: - Go to Services > Diagnostics > Arms. - Select the sample arm Vertical radio button (1) and press Check Home (2). - Select the sample arm Rotation radio button (3). - In the Position scrolling list, select Cuvette Position (4). - Press Check Position (5).
3 2
5
4 6
The value of the rotation home offset (6) must not be modified. Adjust the rotation home position with the sample arm mechanical adjustment described below.
1 ■ Check the centering of the "Dummy sample
needle" on the mobile part of the tool position "2" as follows: - Select the sample arm Vertical radio button (1). - Press Motor Off (7). 7
- Slowly push the arm down, then check the position of the "Dummy sample needle" on the mobile part of the tool position "2". arm adjustment (RAS385)
RAS382F - 30
REACTION TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Reaction tray
■ Loosen
the CHC screw on the sample arm, then turn the sample arm to center the "Dummy sample needle" on the mobile part of the tool position "2".
■ Tighten
■ Press
the screw.
Check Home (2).
■ Check
1
■ Move
3
the position again as follows: - Select the sample arm Rotation radio button (3) and press Check Home (2). - Check the centering of the "Dummy sample needle" again (see above). the sample arm to its home position (vertical then rotation) as follows: - Select the sample arm Vertical radio button (1) and press Check Home (2). - Select the sample arm Rotation radio button (3) and press Check Home (2).
2
■ Remove
the tool from the reaction tray as follows: - Go to Services > Diagnostics > Tray. - In the Sector scrolling list and in the Position scrolling list, select "1" and "1" (A). - In the Target scrolling list, select Handling Position (B). - Press Check Position (C). - Remove the tool from the reaction tray.
4.6.
A B
C
Cuvette changer ■ First,
install the "Test segment Pentra 400". See RAS384: Cuvette changer, 4.2. "Test segment Pentra 400" installation, page 32.
■ Perform
the reaction tray adjustment. See RAS384: Cuvette changer, 4.4. Adjustment of reaction tray "Automatic Loading" position, page 34.
Technical Manual RAA023
REACTION TRAY
RAS382F - 31
Reaction tray
4.7.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Handling Position ■ First,
follow the 4.2. Preliminary procedure, page 20.
■ Manually
load a cuvette segment in the reaction tray in position "1" as follows: - In the Target scrolling list, select Handling Position (A). - Press Check Position (B). The position "1" of the reaction tray moves to the Handling Position position. - Manually load the cuvette segment in the reaction tray.
A
B
■ Check the centering of the cuvette segment
in front of the upper case opening.
■ Adjust the position by changing the number
of steps in the Target field for the Handling Position position (C). - Decrease the number of steps to move the reaction tray anticlockwise. - Increase the number of steps to move the reaction clockwise. ■ Move
the reaction tray to its home position (press Check Home (D)) then check the position again (press Check Position).
■ Remove
the cuvette segment from the reaction tray as follows: - In the Sector scrolling list and in the Position scrolling list, select "1" and "1" (E). - In the Target scrolling list, select Handling Position (A). - Press Check Position (B). - Remove the cuvette segment from the reaction tray.
RAS382F - 32
REACTION TRAY
E A
D
B
C
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
4.8.
Reaction tray
Hole position check ■ Reinstall
the reaction tray cover by slightly turning the 3 CHC screws and washers.
■ Reconnect
the flap door switch.
4.8.1. Mixer hole position check ■ Lift
the mixer up.
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Arms.
■ Select ■ Press
1
the Mixer radio button (1).
Check Home (2)
3
■ In
the Position scrolling list, select Above Reaction Tray (3).
■ Press
Check Position (4): The mixer moves over the reaction tray and the mixing paddle turns. Wait for the mixing paddle to stop turning, then manually pull the mixer down.
2
4
■ Check
the mixer hole position in order to center it according to the mixer paddle. If not, adjust the position by unscrewing/ screwing the CHC screw.
■ Manually
pull the mixer up.
1
■ Move
the mixer to its home position: - Select the Mixer radio button (1). - Press Check Home (2). 2
Technical Manual RAA023
REACTION TRAY
RAS382F - 33
Reaction tray
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
4.8.2. Reagent hole position check
Make sure that the sample arm is in its vertical home position before moving the reagent arm.
■ Move the reagent arm over the reaction tray
as follows: - Go to Services > Diagnostics > Arms. - Select the reagent arm Vertical radio button (1) and press Check Home (2). - Select the reagent arm Rotation radio button (3) and press Check Home (2). This position corresponds to the Cuvette Position position. - Select the reagent arm Vertical radio button (1). - Press Motor Off (4).
■ Slowly
1
3 4
2
pull the reagent arm down.
■ Check
the reagent hole position in order to center it according to the "Dummy reagent needle". If not adjust the position by unscrewing/screwing the CHC screw.
1 ■ Move
the reagent arm to its home position (vertical then rotation) as follows: - Select the reagent arm Vertical radio button (1) and press Check Home (2). - Select the reagent arm Rotation radio button (3) and press Check Home (2).
3 2
RAS382F - 34
REACTION TRAY
4
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Reaction tray
4.8.3. Sample hole position check
Make sure that the reagent arm is in its wash position (rotation and vertical) before moving the sample arm.
■ Move the sample arm over the reaction tray
as follows: - Go to Services > Diagnostics > Arms. - Select the sample arm Vertical radio button (1) and press Check Home (2). - Select the sample arm Rotation radio button (3) and press Check Home (2). This position corresponds to the Cuvette Position position. - Select the sample arm Vertical radio button (1). - Press Motor Off (4).
■ Slowly
1
3 4
2
pull the sample arm down.
■ Check
the sample hole position in order to center it according to the "Dummy sample needle". If not adjust the position by unscrewing/screwing the CHC screw.
1 ■ Move
the sample arm to its home position (vertical then rotation) as follows: - Select the sample arm Vertical radio button (1) and press Check Home (2). - Select the sample arm Rotation radio button (3) and press Check Home (2).
3 2
■
Remove the "Dummy reagent needle" and the "Dummy sample needle" and put the reagent and sample needles back.
Technical Manual RAA023
REACTION TRAY
RAS382F - 35
Reaction tray
4.9.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Automatic loading position
This adjustment is described during the cuvette changer adjustment. See RAS384: Cuvette changer, 4.4. Adjustment of reaction tray "Automatic Loading" position, page 34.
RAS382F - 36
REACTION TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS548B
Fan and heater replacement
RAS548: Fan and heater replacement
Concerns Reaction tray lower box dismantling Fan replacement Heater replacement Impacted adjustments Check up after intervention
Required tools Hexagonal keys Hexagonal screwdriver Flat screwdriver Phillips screwdriver Pliers
Required products None
Intervention time N/A
Frequency On request
Specific kit or consumables None
Disposable gloves, eye protections and a lab coat must be worn by the operator. Local or national regulations must be applied in all the operations.
Fan and heater replacement
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
1. Reaction tray lower box dismantling
In order not to damage the needles during dismantling, disable the arms (vertical and rotation movements) and put them on a sample cup rack over the reagent tray as shown on the following picture.
■ Switch ■ Lift ■
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
up the arms main cover and the mixer.
Remove the loader cover, the cuvettes hatch, the connection hatch, the cuvettes cover, the optic hatch, the left arm cover, the cuvettes tray plate and the mixer plate. See RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1.
■ Remove
the rear plate by unscrewing the 8 CHC screws.
Heater connector
Fan connector
■ From
the instrument rear, disconnect the heater connector and the fan connector.
RAS548B - 2
REACTION TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Fan and heater replacement
On the lower box input (left side):
■ Remove
the 2 auto-grip strips maintaining the tubing cover and the casing.
■ Slide
the casing to reach the tubing.
Collar
■ Clamp
the tubing, then remove the collar using a flat screwdriver.
■ Disconnect
the input tubing from the lower
box.
On the lower box output (right side):
■ Unscrew
the CHC screw maintaining the braided ground wire.
■ Remove
the auto-grip strip maintaining the tubing cover.
■ Slide
the tubing cover to reach the tubing.
Technical Manual RAA023
REACTION TRAY
RAS548B - 3
Fan and heater replacement
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Collar
■ Clamp
the tubing, then remove the collar using a flat screwdriver.
■ Disconnect
the tubing from the lower box.
■ Remove the left condensate tubing from the
adhesive holder, then disconnect it from the "T" fitting.
■ Unscrew the 4 CHC screws maintaining the
lower box.
■ Remove
delicately the lower box.
■ Disconnect
RAS548B - 4
the condensate tubing from the lower box angle fitting.
REACTION TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Fan and heater replacement
2. Fan replacement ■ First,
perform the lower box dismantling. See 1. Reaction tray lower box dismantling, page 2.
■ Cut
the Ty-Rap™ maintaining the fan cable and the heater cable.
■ Unscrew
the 4 CHC screws then remove the thermic bulkhead and the fan.
■ Reassemble
Technical Manual RAA023
in reverse order.
REACTION TRAY
RAS548B - 5
Fan and heater replacement
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Be very careful when positioning the fan: ■ 2 arrows, located on the fan side, indicate the fan rotation direction and the air direction (A). The fan must breathe toward the heater (B). ■ Pay attention to place the fan cable in front of the cable notch (C). A
Air direction (toward the heater)
Fan rotation direction
B
Air direction (toward the heater)
C
RAS548B - 6
Lower box notch
Fan cable
REACTION TRAY
Cable notch
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Fan and heater replacement
■ The
thermic bulkhead notch must be placed in front of the spectrophotometer flat cable notch (A). ■ When connecting the cooling unit tubings on the lower box, pay attention to connect the Input and Output correctly (B). A Notch
B
Input
Output
Before fastening the 4 CHC screws maintaining the lower box, ensure that the reaction tray home sensor cable, the spectrophotometer flat cable, the fan cable and the heater cable are well positioned in their respective notches. Spectrophotometer flat cable notch Fan and heater notch
Reaction tray home sensor cable notch
Technical Manual RAA023
REACTION TRAY
RAS548B - 7
Fan and heater replacement
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
3. Heater replacement ■
First, perform the lower box dismantling procedure. See 1. Reaction tray lower box dismantling, page 2.
■ Cut
the Ty-Rap™ maintaining the fan cable and the heater cable.
■ Unscrew
the 4 CHC screws then remove the thermic bulkhead and the fan.
RAS548B - 8
REACTION TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Fan and heater replacement
■ Unscrew the 4 crosspieces then remove the
heater. ■ Reassemble
in reverse order.
Be careful when positioning the heater. The heater metallic flaps must be on top.
Be very careful when positioning the fan: ■ 2 arrows, located on the fan side, indicate the fan rotation direction and the air direction (A). The fan must breathe toward the heater (B). ■ Pay attention to place the fan cable in front of the cable notch (C). A
Air direction (toward the heater)
Technical Manual RAA023
REACTION TRAY
Fan rotation direction
RAS548B - 9
Fan and heater replacement
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
B
Air direction (toward the heater)
C
Lower box notch
Fan cable
Cable notch
■ The
thermic bulkhead notch must be placed in front of the spectrophotometer flat cable notch (A). ■ When connecting the cooling unit tubings on the lower box, pay attention to connect the Input and Output correctly (B). A Notch
RAS548B - 10
REACTION TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Fan and heater replacement
B
Input
Output
Before fastening the 4 CHC screws maintaining the lower box, ensure that the reaction tray home sensor cable, the spectrophotometer flat cable, the fan cable and the heater cable are well positioned in their respective notches. Spectrophotometer flat cable notch Fan and heater notch
Reaction tray home sensor cable notch
Technical Manual RAA023
REACTION TRAY
RAS548B - 11
Fan and heater replacement
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
4. Impacted adjustments None.
5. Check up after intervention ■ Connect
5.1.
the power supply cable and switch the instrument on.
Temperature check
■ Go
to Services > Customer Services > Analyser.
■ In
the Temperatures area, check the reaction tray temperature and the reagent tray temperature. - Reaction tray: 37°C (± 0.25°C) - Reagent tray: 4-10°C
5.2.
Glycol circuit check ■ On
RAS548B - 12
the lower box, make sure that there is no leak at the level of Input and Output fittings.
REACTION TRAY
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS383F
Optical bench
RAS383: Optical bench
Concerns Optical bench dismantling Optical bench mirror and lenses cleaning and replacement Impacted adjustments Optical bench check
Required tools Hexagonal keys Hexagonal screwdriver Open-end wrench Flat screwdriver Phillips screwdriver KIT, ANTISTATIC KIT MZZ015A (1207921015) TOOL, OPT. BENCH CLEANING KIT XEA945BS (1209159945)
Required products Dusting spray
Intervention time N/A
Frequency On request
Specific kit or consumables Cuvette segments
Disposable gloves, eye protections and a lab coat must be worn by the operator. Local or national regulations must be applied in all the operations.
Optical bench
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
1. Optical bench dismantling
As the electronic devices are very sensitive to electrostatic discharges (ESD), the use of an antistatic kit is mandatory during boards handling/dismantling.
1.1.
Dismantling
In order not to damage the needles during dismantling, disable the arms (vertical and rotation movements) and put them on a sample cup rack over the reagent tray as shown on the following picture.
■ Switch
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
■ Remove
the covers (see RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1): - Open the arms main cover. - Remove the loader cover, the cuvettes hatch, the connection hatch and the cuvettes cover. - Lift the mixer assembly up by pressing the red button. - Remove the optic hatch, the left arm cover, the cuvettes tray plate and the mixer plate. - Remove the recuperation jar.
■
Follow the reaction tray dismantling procedure. See RAS382: Reaction tray, 1. Reaction tray dismantling, page 2.
1.1.1. General procedure
If your instrument is equipped with an old model of optical bench (before "XDA829C"), please refer to the specific procedure: 1.1.2. Specific procedure ABX Pentra 400 with an old model of optical bench (before "XDA829C"), page 6.
RAS383F - 2
OPTICAL BENCH
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Optical bench
■ Unscrew the 7 CHC screws, disconnect the
A
flap door switch (A) and unscrew the NTC to remove the upper case.
■ Remove
the spectrophotometer cover as follows: - Remove the antistatic bruch by unscrewing the CHC screw and washer (A), then unscrew the crosspiece (use an openend wrench). - Unscrew the 4 CHC screws to remove the spectrophotometer cover.
A
B
■ Release
the spectrophotometer from the optical bench as follows: - Unscrew the flange (A) of the optical bench. - Unscrew the 2 CHC screws and washers (B) of the spectrophotometer.
A
B
Technical Manual RAA023
OPTICAL BENCH
RAS383F - 3
Optical bench
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
2 - Release the spectrophotometer gun from the optical bench. 1
At this stage of the procedure, you can dismantle the spectrophotometer as well as the acquisition board although this is not necessary to finish the optical bench dismantling.
■ Dismantle
the spectrophotometer as follows: - Remove the ground wires from the acquisition board by unscrewing the CHC screw (A). Take care not to lose the ground wires. - Unplug the flat cable (B).
A
D
■ Remove
the acquisition board from the spectrophotometer as follows: - Unscrew the two CHC screws of the acquisition board (C). - Slowly disconnect the acquisition board (D) to remove it. - Remove the aluminium insulating plate.
RAS383F - 4
OPTICAL BENCH
C
B
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Optical bench
■ Make
a mark on the sample wash tower support (to align the sample wash tower when reassembling), then unscrew the 2 CHC screws to remove the sample wash tower.
■ Disconnect
the lamp supply cable and loosen the 2 CHC screws. Turn the light lock and remove the lamp.
Warning! Hot surface Risk of personal injury due to hot surfaces within the instrument. Wait for the lamp to cool down before proceeding.
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws to remove the lamp supply cable support.
Technical Manual RAA023
OPTICAL BENCH
RAS383F - 5
Optical bench
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Unscrew
the 2 upper CHC screws and loosen the 2 bottom CHC screws to remove the fan plate.
■ Unscrew
the 4 CHC screws of the optical bench: 2 CHC M4x45 screws on the lamp side and 2 CHC M4x25 screws on the spectrophotometer side.
■ Remove
the optical bench.
1.1.2. Specific procedure ABX Pentra 400 with an old model of optical bench (before "XDA829C") This procedure is designed for ABX Pentra 400 equipped with an old model of optical bench (before "XDA829C") i.e. ABX Pentra 400 with an instrument serial number lower than 3195.
■ Unscrew the 7 CHC screws, disconnect the
flap door switch (A) and unscrew the NTC to remove the upper case.
RAS383F - 6
OPTICAL BENCH
A
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Optical bench
■ Unscrew
the 6 CHC screws to remove the holder disk.
■ Remove
the crown wheel as follows: - Unscrew the 2 external CHC screws of each upper roller, mark them in order not to invert them when reassembling and remove them.
- Unscrew the 2 CHC screws of the lateral roller support "1" and remove it. - Unscrew one of the 2 CHC screws of the roller adjusting assy "2" and loosen the second CHC screw to turn the support. - Now, remove the crown wheel.
Technical Manual RAA023
OPTICAL BENCH
2
1
RAS383F - 7
Optical bench
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Remove
the spectrophotometer cover as follows: - Remove the antistatic brush by unscrewing the CHC screw and washer (A), then unscrew the crosspiece (use an openend wrench). - Unscrew the 4 CHC screws to remove the spectrophotometer cover.
A
■ Remove
the ground wires by unscrewing the CHC screw from the acquisition board as well as the CHC screw and washer from the spectrophotometer.
RAS383F - 8
OPTICAL BENCH
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Optical bench
The acquisition board dismantling procedure is described below but is not necessary to dismantle the optical bench.
■ Remove
the acquisition board as follows: - Unplug the flat cable and unscrew the 2 CHC screws.
- Slowly disconnect the acquisition board to remove it. - Remove the aluminium insulating plate.
Technical Manual RAA023
OPTICAL BENCH
RAS383F - 9
Optical bench
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Make
a mark on the sample wash tower support (to align the sample wash tower when reassembling), then unscrew the 2 CHC screws to remove the sample wash tower.
■ Disconnect
the lamp supply cable and loosen the 2 CHC screws. Turn the light lock and remove the lamp.
Warning! Hot surface Risk of personal injury due to hot surfaces within the instrument. Wait for the lamp to cool down before proceeding.
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws to remove the lamp supply cable support.
■ Unscrew
the 2 upper CHC screws and loosen the 2 bottom CHC screws to remove the fan plate.
RAS383F - 10
OPTICAL BENCH
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Optical bench
■ Unscrew
the 5 CHC screws to remove the optical bench.
■ Slightly
loosen the little screw.
■ Then, separate the spectrophotometer from
the optical bench.
Technical Manual RAA023
OPTICAL BENCH
RAS383F - 11
Optical bench
1.2.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Reassembly
1.2.1. General procedure
If your instrument is equipped with an old model of optical bench (before "XDA829C"), please refer to the specific procedure: 1.2.2. Specific procedure ABX Pentra 400 with an old model of optical bench (before "XDA829C"), page 14.
■ Put
the optical bench in place. Two dog points located under the optical bench ensure that you put it in the correct position.
■ Reassemble
the spectrophotometer as well as the acquisition board in reverse order. Do not forget to put the ground wires back.
■ Put
the spectrophotometer in place. The spectrophotometer gun must reach the end stop.
A
■ Tighten
the 2 CHC screws and washers (A) of the spectrophotometer to hold it in place.
A
■ Tighten
the 4 CHC screws of the optical bench to hold it in place: 2 CHC M4x45 screws on the lamp side and 2 CHC M4x25 screws on the spectrophotometer side.
RAS383F - 12
OPTICAL BENCH
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Optical bench
■ Put the flange of the optical bench back and
tighten it (B) to hold the spectrophotometer gun in place.
B
■ Reassemble
the fan plate and the lamp supply cable support in reverse order.
■ Reassemble
the lamp in reverse order.
Do not touch the glass part of the lamp with your fingers! Make sure that the lamp is correctly positioned.
■ Put
the sample wash tower back.
■ Reassemble
the spectrophotometer cover in reverse order (do not forget the antistatic brush).
■ Reassemble
the upper case in reverse order.
■ Now, ■ Put
connect the power supply cable and switch the instrument on.
the reaction tray cover back and check the holes position.
■ Reassemble ■ Put
and readjust if necessary the cuvette changer. See RAS384: Cuvette changer, page 1.
the covers back.
■ Follow
the optical bench check procedure. See 4. Optical bench check, page 31.
■ Follow
the check up after intervention procedure. See RAS393: Check up after intervention, page 1.
Technical Manual RAA023
OPTICAL BENCH
RAS383F - 13
Optical bench
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
1.2.2. Specific procedure ABX Pentra 400 with an old model of optical bench (before "XDA829C") This procedure is designed for ABX Pentra 400 equipped with an old model of optical bench (before "XDA829C") i.e. ABX Pentra 400 with an instrument serial number lower than 3195.
■ Reassemble
the spectrophotometer and the optical bench without tightening the little screw.
■ Put
the assembly back on the reaction tray.
■ Tighten
the 4 CHC screws of the optical bench, indicated in blue on the following figure.
■ Make
sure that the spectrophotometer is correctly engaged in the optical bench.
Spectrophotometer NOT OK
Spectrophotometer OK
■ Now,
tighten the little screw.
■ Tighten
RAS383F - 14
the last CHC screw of the optical bench, indicated in red.
OPTICAL BENCH
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Optical bench
■ Reassemble
the fan plate and the lamp supply cable support in reverse order.
■ Reassemble
the lamp in reverse order.
Do not touch the glass part of the lamp with your fingers! Make sure that the lamp is correctly positioned.
■ Put
the sample wash tower back.
■ Reassemble
the acquisition board in reverse order and put its ground wires back.
■ Reassemble
the spectrophotometer cover in reverse order (do not forget the antistatic brush).
■ Put
the crown wheel and the rollers back.
■ Reassemble
the holder disk as follows: - Put the holder disk back without tightening the 6 CHC screws. - Position 3 cuvette segments into the reaction tray as shown on the following figure, to adjust the holder disk. - Now, tighten the 6 CHC screws.
■ Reassemble ■ Now,
the upper case back.
connect the power supply cable and switch the instrument on.
■ Check
all the reaction tray position adjustments. See RAS382: Reaction tray, 2. Reaction tray parts replacement, page 4.
■ Put
the reaction tray cover back.
■ Reassemble ■ Put
and readjust if necessary the cuvette changer. See RAS384: Cuvette changer, page 1.
the covers back.
■ Follow
the optical bench check procedure. See 4. Optical bench check, page 31.
■ Follow
the check up after intervention procedure. See RAS393: Check up after intervention, page 1.
Technical Manual RAA023
OPTICAL BENCH
RAS383F - 15
Optical bench
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
2. Optical bench mirror and lenses cleaning and replacement
Take care not to touch the mirror or the lenses with your fingers. Wear gloves to handle the mirror and the lenses.
2.1.
Condensing lens cleaning and replacement
2.1.1. Dismantling 2.1.1.1. General procedure
If your instrument is equipped with an old model of optical bench (before "XDA829C"), please refer to the specific procedure: 2.1.1.2. Specific procedure ABX Pentra 400 with an old model of optical bench (before "XDA829C"), page 18.
■
Follow the reaction tray dismantling procedure. See RAS382: Reaction tray, 1. Reaction tray dismantling, page 2.
■ Disconnect
the lamp supply cable and loosen the 2 CHC screws. Turn the light lock and remove the lamp.
Warning! Hot surface Risk of personal injury due to hot surfaces within the instrument. Wait for the lamp to cool down before proceeding.
RAS383F - 16
OPTICAL BENCH
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Optical bench
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws to remove the lamp supply cable support.
■ Unscrew
the 2 upper CHC screws and loosen the 2 bottom CHC screws to remove the fan plate.
■ Unscrew
the lamp socket screws (A) to remove it.
A
B
■ Unscrew
the condensing lens holder (B) to remove it.
Technical Manual RAA023
OPTICAL BENCH
RAS383F - 17
Optical bench
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Slightly
loosen the little screw to free the
lens.
2.1.1.2. Specific procedure ABX Pentra 400 with an old model of optical bench (before "XDA829C") This procedure is designed for ABX Pentra 400 equipped with an old model of optical bench (before "XDA829C") i.e. ABX Pentra 400 with an instrument serial number lower than 3195.
■ Follow
the optical bench dismantling procedure. See 1.1. Dismantling, page 2.
■ Unscrew the 2 CHC screws and remove the
mirror clip. ■ Remove
the mirror cautiously and place it on paper.
■ To
access the condensing lens: - Slightly loosen the little screw and remove the cap.
RAS383F - 18
OPTICAL BENCH
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Optical bench
- Turn the optical bench over, unscrew the 4 CHC screws and remove the heat sink cover.
■ Dismantle
the condensing lens as follows: - Slightly loosen the little screw to free the lens.
- Turn the optical bench over, use paper to protect the lens exit and push cautiously the lens with a plastic tool passing through the mirror hole.
Pushing the lens, take care not to touch the lens but the metallic part.
Technical Manual RAA023
OPTICAL BENCH
RAS383F - 19
Optical bench
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
2.1.2. Cleaning and replacement A
B
■ Remove
the condensing lens from its metallic support as follows: - Adjust the lens dismantling key (provided in the optical bench cleaning kit (A)) in the nut notches (B) and unscrew the nut.
- Remove the lens from its metallic support using the pen with suction cup (provided in the optical bench cleaning kit) and place it on paper.
Make sure that the pen with suction cup is clean before use. If necessary, clean it with a cleaning towelette (provided in the optical bench cleaning kit).
■ Clean each side of the condensing lens with
a cleaning towelette. Wipe the condensing lens with paper.
■ Put
the condensing lens back in its metallic support using the pen with suction cup and fasten the nut.
Take care that the convex side of the lens is upwards.
■ Remove
any dust from the condensing lens using a dusting spray. Make sure that there are no marks on the condensing lens.
RAS383F - 20
OPTICAL BENCH
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Optical bench
2.1.3. Reassembly 2.1.3.1. General procedure
If your instrument is equipped with an old model of optical bench (before "XDA829C"), please refer to the specific procedure: 2.1.3.2. Specific procedure ABX Pentra 400 with an old model of optical bench (before "XDA829C"), page 22.
■ Put
the condensing lens back in its holder.
■ Put
the lens holder back in its original position. Make sure that the convex side of the lens is facing the right direction (opposite to the lamp side). Make sure that the lens holder reaches the end stop so that it is properly placed.
CONDENSING LENS focal length = 20 mm
■ Make
sure that the lens is well-positioned and fully inserted.
■ Screw
the condensing lens holder.
■ Tighten ■ Screw
the little screw on top to block the lens.
the lamp socket.
■ Reassemble
Technical Manual RAA023
the rest of the instrument in reverse order.
OPTICAL BENCH
RAS383F - 21
Optical bench
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
2.1.3.2. Specific procedure ABX Pentra 400 with an old model of optical bench (before "XDA829C") This procedure is designed for ABX Pentra 400 equipped with an old model of optical bench (before "XDA829C") i.e. ABX Pentra 400 with an instrument serial number lower than 3195.
■ Reassemble
the condensing lens as follows: - Put the lens back in the optical bench ensuring that it is installed in the correct way. - Make sure that the lens is well-positioned and fully inserted.
- Tighten the little screw to block the lens.
■ Reassemble ■ Clean
in reverse order the heat sink cover and the cap.
the mirror with a cleaning towelette. Wipe the mirror with paper.
■ Remove
any dust from the mirror using a dusting spray. Make sure that there are no marks on the mirror.
■ Reassemble ■ Follow
RAS383F - 22
in reverse order the mirror.
the optical bench reassembly procedure. See 1.2. Reassembly, page 12.
OPTICAL BENCH
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
2.2.
Optical bench
Shaping lens cleaning and replacement
2.2.1. Dismantling 2.2.1.1. General procedure
If your instrument is equipped with an old model of optical bench (before "XDA829C"), please refer to the specific procedure: 2.2.1.2. Specific procedure ABX Pentra 400 with an old model of optical bench (before "XDA829C"), page 24.
■
Follow the reaction tray dismantling procedure. See RAS382: Reaction tray, 1. Reaction tray dismantling, page 2.
■ Unscrew the 7 CHC screws, disconnect the
flap door switch (A) and unscrew the NTC to remove the upper case.
A
■ Unscrew
the flange to have access to the shaping lens holder.
■ Remove
Technical Manual RAA023
the shaping lens holder.
OPTICAL BENCH
RAS383F - 23
Optical bench
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
2.2.1.2. Specific procedure ABX Pentra 400 with an old model of optical bench (before "XDA829C") This procedure is designed for ABX Pentra 400 equipped with an old model of optical bench (before "XDA829C") i.e. ABX Pentra 400 with an instrument serial number lower than 3195.
■ Follow
the optical bench dismantling procedure. See 1.1. Dismantling, page 2.
■ Dismantle
the shaping lens as follows: - Slightly loosen the little screw to free the lens. - Remove the lens and place it on paper.
2.2.2. Cleaning and replacement
■ Remove
the shaping lens from its metallic support as follows: - Slightly loosen the screw and lift up the metallic support.
- Take the lens using the pen with suction cup (provided in the optical bench cleaning kit) and place it on paper.
RAS383F - 24
OPTICAL BENCH
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Optical bench
■ Clean
each side of the shaping lens with a cleaning towelette (provided in the optical bench cleaning kit). Wipe the shaping lens with paper.
■ Remove
any dust from the shaping lens using a dusting spray and make sure that there are no marks on the shaping lens.
■ Put
the shaping lens back in its metallic support using the pen with suction cup and tighten the screw.
Take care that the convex side of the lens is downwards.
SHAPING LENS focal length = 25 mm
Technical Manual RAA023
OPTICAL BENCH
RAS383F - 25
Optical bench
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
2.2.3. Reassembly 2.2.3.1. General procedure
If your instrument is equipped with an old model of optical bench (before "XDA829C"), please refer to the specific procedure: 2.2.3.2. Specific procedure ABX Pentra 400 with an old model of optical bench (before "XDA829C"), page 26.
■ Put
the lens holder back in its original position.
Make sure that the lens holder reaches the end stop so that it is properly placed.
■ Put
the flange back and tighten the flange screws.
■ Reassemble
the rest of the instrument in reverse order.
2.2.3.2. Specific procedure ABX Pentra 400 with an old model of optical bench (before "XDA829C") This procedure is designed for ABX Pentra 400 equipped with an old model of optical bench (before "XDA829C") i.e. ABX Pentra 400 with an instrument serial number lower than 3195.
■ Reassemble
the shaping lens as follows: - Put the lens back in the optical bench ensuring that it is installed in the correct way.
- Make sure that the lens is well-positioned and aligned with the optical bench as shown on the following picture.
RAS383F - 26
OPTICAL BENCH
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Optical bench
- Tighten the little screw to block the lens.
■ Follow
Technical Manual RAA023
the optical bench reassembly procedure. See 1.2. Reassembly, page 12.
OPTICAL BENCH
RAS383F - 27
Optical bench
2.3.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Coupling lens cleaning and replacement ■ Follow
the optical bench dismantling procedure until you dismantled the spectrophotometer. See 1.1. Dismantling, page 2.
The coupling lens is located inside the reception barrel of the spectrophotometer. To replace the coupling lens, you have to replace the reception barrel.
■ Unscrew
the 4 CHC screws on the spectrophotometer to remove the reception barrel.
■ Remove
the coupling lens from the reception barrel as follows: - Adjust the lens dismantling key (provided in the optical bench cleaning kit) in the nut notches or use a ruler and unscrew the nut.
- Gently turn the barrel over onto an optical paper on the workbench.
RAS383F - 28
OPTICAL BENCH
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Optical bench
- Remove the lens from the reception barrel using the pen with suction cup (provided in the optical bench cleaning kit) and place it on paper.
■ Clean
each side of the coupling lens with a cleaning towelette (provided in the optical bench cleaning kit). Wipe the coupling lens with paper.
■ Put
the coupling lens back in the reception barrel using the pen with suction cup and fasten the nut.
Take care that the convex side of the lens is upwards.
COUPLING LENS focal length = 20 mm
■ Remove
any dust from the coupling lens using a dusting spray and make sure that there are no marks on the coupling lens.
■ Reassemble ■ Follow
Technical Manual RAA023
in reverse order.
the optical bench reassembly procedure. See 1.2. Reassembly, page 12.
OPTICAL BENCH
RAS383F - 29
Optical bench
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
3. Impacted adjustments
These adjustments are necessary only if your instrument is equipped with an old model of optical bench (before "XDA829C").
Impacted adjustments
Mirror and lenses replacement
Reaction Tray Offset
X
Mixing Position
X
Reagent Arm Position
X
Sample Arm Position
X
Automatic Loading
X
Handling Position
X
Reaction Tray cover (for needles)
X
Sample arm rotation Cuvette Position
X
Reagent arm rotation Cuvette Position
X Mixer
Cuvette Position
X
Cuvette changer Load in Reaction Tray Position
X
See RAS382: Reaction tray, 4. Adjustments, page 19.
RAS383F - 30
OPTICAL BENCH
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Optical bench
4. Optical bench check ■ Run
an initialization and once the instrument is Ready, go to Services > Diagnostics > Tray.
■ Select
the Reaction radio button and press Motor Off.
■ Manually ■ Then,
remove all the cuvette segments from the reaction tray.
press Check Home.
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Spectro > Spectro Settings. This tab displays the list of spectrophotometer initialization steps (A) and five subtabs to perform each initialization step (B). Once a step is performed, it is marked "Done" in the list.
1. Measure Gain ■ Click
the Measure Gain tab (B).
■ Press
Start (C).
■ When
the message "After the gain measurement, the spectrophotometer is initialized." is displayed, press OK. Then, the following message is displayed: "Verify absence of segment in sector 1."
D
E
■ Make sure that there
is no cuvette segment in the sector 1 of the reaction tray and press OK. Once the step is performed, the gain and the light intensity measured on air (without cuvette) are displayed for each wavelength.
■ Make
sure that the gains (D) are included between 1 and 95%.
C A
B
■ Make
sure that the light intensities (E) are included between 57200 and 65535 (~ 61000).
Technical Manual RAA023
OPTICAL BENCH
RAS383F - 31
Optical bench
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
2. I Black C ■ Click
the I Black tab (A).
■ Press
Start (B). Once the step is performed, the black intensity measured in the black (with the inter-sector located between the sectors 1 and 6 of the reaction tray) is displayed for each wavelength.
■ Make
sure that the black intensities (C) are included between 1400 and 2000.
A B
3. Lamp Stabilization
■ Click
the Lamp Stabilization tab (A).
■ Press
Start (B). A B
Then, the following message is displayed: "Verify absence of segment in sector 1." ■ Make
sure that there is no cuvette segment in the sector 1 of the reaction tray and press OK. During the lamp stabilization, the light intensity measured on air (without cuvette) and the deviation are displayed for each wavelength every 12 s during 600 s maximum. The light intensities (LI) are checked to ensure that they are included between 57200 and 65535. The deviations (Dev) are checked to ensure that the difference between 2 consecutive absorbances < 0.00022. Once the step is performed, the following message is displayed: "Stability of lamp done."
4. I0 Air ■ Click
C
the I0 Air tab (A).
■ Press
Start (B). Then, the following message is displayed: "Verify absence of segment in sector 1."
■ Make sure that there
is no cuvette segment in the sector 1 of the reaction tray and press OK. Once the step is performed, the light intensity measured on air (without cuvette) is displayed for each wavelength.
■ Make
sure that the light intensities (C) are included between 57200 and 65535.
RAS383F - 32
OPTICAL BENCH
A B
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Optical bench
5. I0 Water ■ Click
the I0 Water tab (A).
C
■ Press
Start (B). Then, the following message is displayed: "Put a new segment in sector 1 and manually fill the first cuvette with 200 µL of H2O in the handling position."
■ Manually
load a cuvette segment into the sector 1 of the reaction tray, manually fill the first cuvette with 200 µL of H2O and press OK. Once the step is performed, the light intensity measured through a water-filled cuvette is displayed for each wavelength (C).
A B
B
■ Go to Services > Diagnostics > Spectro >
Spectro Measurement. ■ Select
A
the Reference on Air radio button
C
(A). ■ In
the 1st WL scrolling list (B), select "340".
■ Press
Read (C). D
■ Make
sure that the values displayed in the Dynamic Optical Reading table (D) are close to 0.
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Tray.
■ Select
the Reaction radio button and press Motor Off.
■ Manually ■ Then,
position 6 new cuvette segments into the reaction tray.
press Check Home.
■ Go to Services > Diagnostics > Spectro >
Spectro Measurement. ■ Select
the Reference on Air radio button
B
(A). ■ In
the 1st WL scrolling list (B), select "340".
■ Press
A
Read (C).
C
■ Make
sure that the values displayed in the Dynamic Optical Reading table (D) are included between 0.060 and 0.120.
■ In
the 1st WL scrolling list (B), select "700".
■ Press
D
Read (C).
■ Make
sure that the values displayed in the Dynamic Optical Reading table (D) are included between 0.050 and 0.090.
Technical Manual RAA023
OPTICAL BENCH
RAS383F - 33
Optical bench
RAS383F - 34
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
OPTICAL BENCH
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS656B
Partial condensing lens cleaning
RAS656: Partial condensing lens cleaning
Concerns Preliminary operations Optical bench lamp dismantling Condensing lens cleaning (lamp side) Checks after intervention
Required tools Pair of scissors TOOL, ALLEN SCREWDRIVER 2MM MAB086A (1207821086)
Required products Alcohol
Intervention time 0 h 15
Frequency On request
Specific kit or consumables Cuvette segments TOOL, LAMP LENS CLEANING KIT XEC011AS (1209179011)
Disposable gloves, eye protections and a lab coat must be worn by the operator. Local or national regulations must be applied in all the operations.
Partial condensing lens cleaning
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Follow this procedure to clean the lamp side of the condensing lens with the help of the TOOL, LAMP LENS CLEANING KIT XEC011AS (1209179011) and without dismantling the optical bench.
1. Preliminary operations 1.1.
TOOL, LAMP LENS CLEANING KIT
crystal tube
optic wipes
crystal tube
1.2.
tool
Tool preparation
■ Take
the tool.
■ Cut
2 strips of about 25 x 200 mm from an "optic wipes" sheet.
■ Twiddle the first strip on itself and insert it in
23 mm
the crystal tube "3/5" present at the extremity of the tool. ■ Cut the strip at about 23 mm of the tool axe,
as illustrated on the following picture: For a better handling of the tool, you can also put a crystal tube lenght at the other extremity of the tool. This crystal tube lenght is in the little bag, ref. EAE011A (1202241011), which contains about 10 cm of crystal tube.
RAS656B - 2
OPTICAL BENCH
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Partial condensing lens cleaning
2. Optical bench lamp dismantling ■ Refer
to your user manual to dismantle the lamp to access the condensing lens (lamp side).
Warning! Hot surface Risk of personal injury due to hot surfaces within the instrument. Wait for the lamp to cool down before proceeding.
Do not touch the glass part of the lamp with your fingers!
spectrophotometer
access to condensing lens
reagent tray cover
Technical Manual RAA023
OPTICAL BENCH
RAS656B - 3
Partial condensing lens cleaning
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
3. Condensing lens cleaning (lamp side) ■ Saturate ■
the tool strip with alcohol.
Insert the tool at 45° in the opening designed for the lamp (A), then bring it to the vertical to lead up the strip in touch with the lens (B).
A
■
B
Once the tool is correctly inserted, get in touch with the lens and clean it by making small rotational movements and keeping the tool as vertical as possible. As the lens surface is positioned further than the emission chamber walls, the lens contact is perceptible.
■ Remove
the tool.
■ Replace
the alcohol strip with a second non-alcohol strip to make the lens dry.
■ If
needed, clean the lamp with an "optic wipes" sheet.
■ Please
refer to your user manual to reassemble the lamp.
4. Checks after intervention ■
Follow the optical bench check procedure (see RAS383: Optical bench, 4. Optical bench check, page 31) to control the cleaning efficiency.
RAS656B - 4
OPTICAL BENCH
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS386G
Mixer In this procedure, specific instructions are given for previous ABX Pentra 400 hardware versions: ■ V1 corresponds to instruments with serial numbers below 2000.
RAS386: Mixer
Concerns Mixer paddle replacement Mixer assembly dismantling Mixer assembly parts replacement Impacted adjustments Adjustments
Required tools Hexagonal keys Phillips screwdriver OPTICAL, SEGMENT 1XXX TEST 9200787 (1229200787)
Required products None
Intervention time N/A
Frequency On request
Specific kit or consumables Cuvette segments
Disposable gloves, eye protections and a lab coat must be worn by the operator. Local or national regulations must be applied in all the operations.
Mixer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
1. Mixer paddle replacement ■ Connect
the power supply cable and switch the instrument on.
■ Go
to Services > Customer Services > Cycles.
■ Press
Replace Mixer Paddle. The following message appears: "Replace the mixer paddle and click OK when done."
■ Open
the arms main cover.
■ Remove the mixer cover by unscrewing the
3 BHC screws. See RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1. ■ Lift
the mixer assembly up by pressing the red button.
■ Loosen
the CHC screw and remove the mixer paddle by pulling it down.
■ Replace
the mixer paddle and reassemble in reverse order.
When reassembling, make sure that the mixer paddle is pushed up to the maximum in its support.
■ Press
RAS386G - 2
OK when finished.
MIXER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Mixer
2. Mixer assembly dismantling
In order not to damage the needles during dismantling, disable the arms (vertical and rotation movements) and put them on a sample cup rack over the reagent tray as shown on the following picture.
■ Switch
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
■ Remove
the covers (see RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1): - Open the arms main cover. - Remove the mixer cover.
■ Lift
the mixer assembly up by pressing the red button.
■ Cut
the Ty-Rap™ maintaining the home sensor wires, then disconnect the home sensor connector, the motor and the mixer paddle motor.
Technical Manual RAA023
MIXER
RAS386G - 3
Mixer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Manually
push down the cylinder to move the XY carriage up (A), then forward (B).
B A
■ Disconnect
the wash tower tubings, then remove the wash tower.
■ Remove
the rear plate by unscrewing the 8 CHC screws to access the mixer assembly foot.
RAS386G - 4
MIXER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Mixer
■ Then,
unscrew the 6 CHC screws of the mixer assembly foot.
■ Disconnect
the 2 connectors of the "mixer present switch".
■
Cut the Ty-Rap™ maintaining the reagent arm vertical motor cable and gently remove the mixer assembly.
■ Reassemble
in reverse order.
■ When
reassembling, turn the 6 CHC screws of the mixer assembly foot without tightening them. Push the mixer assembly down and check if it is correctly engaged. Then, tighten the 6 CHC screws of the mixer assembly foot. ■ Be careful not to clamp the tubings and wires when you push the mixer assembly down. ■ After the mixer assembly replacement, it is necessary to readjust all the mixer positions. See 5. Adjustments, page 17.
In case of mixer assembly replacement, dismantle the mixer paddle from the old mixer assembly and reassemble it on the new mixer assembly. See 1. Mixer paddle replacement, page 2.
Technical Manual RAA023
MIXER
RAS386G - 5
Mixer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
3. Mixer assembly parts replacement 3.1.
Home sensor replacement
To know which adjustments have to be performed after parts replacement: see 4. Impacted adjustments, page 16.
■ Switch
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
■ Remove
the covers (see RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1): - Open the arms main cover. - Remove the mixer cover.
■ Lift
the mixer assembly up by pressing the red button.
■ Cut
the Ty-Rap™ maintaining the home sensor wires, then disconnect the home sensor connector, the motor and the mixer paddle motor.
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws to remove the home sensor.
■ Replace
the home sensor and reassemble in reverse order.
RAS386G - 6
MIXER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
3.2.
Mixer
Motor replacement
To know which adjustments have to be performed after parts replacement: see 4. Impacted adjustments, page 16.
■ Switch
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
■ Remove
the covers (see RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1): - Open the arms main cover. - Remove the mixer cover.
■ Lift
the mixer assembly up by pressing the red button.
■ Disconnect
the motor.
■ Manually
push down the cylinder to move the XY carriage up.
Technical Manual RAA023
MIXER
RAS386G - 7
Mixer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Loosen
the motor axis screw.
■ Cut
the Ty-Rap™ and unscrew the 2 CHC screws to remove the motor.
■ Replace
the motor and reassemble in reverse order.
When reassembling, make sure that you tighten the motor axis screw on the plane of the motor axis.
RAS386G - 8
MIXER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
3.3.
Mixer
Mixer paddle motor
To know which adjustments have to be performed after parts replacement: see 4. Impacted adjustments, page 16.
■ Switch
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
■ Remove
the covers (see RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1): - Open the arms main cover. - Remove the mixer cover.
■ Lift
the mixer assembly up by pressing the red button.
■ Disconnect
the mixer paddle motor.
■ At
the back of the mixer, cut the 2 Ty-Raps™ maintaining the mixer paddle motor wires.
■ Remove the mixer paddle motor wires from
the wire guide and the adhesive holder.
Technical Manual RAA023
MIXER
RAS386G - 9
Mixer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Specific ABX Pentra 400 V1 ■ Cut
the Ty-Raps™ maintaining the wires.
B ■ Loosen
the CHC screw (A) and remove the mixer paddle by pulling it down.
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws to remove the mixer paddle motor (B).
■ Replace
the mixer paddle motor and reassemble in reverse order.
A
When reassembling, to avoid risk of wire breaking, ensure that: ■ the O-ring maintaining the mixer paddle motor wires is well positioned at the bottom of the mixer paddle motor (A); ■ the mixer paddle motor wires are well flattened on the mixer paddle motor (B); ■ the ring marker is positioned at the top of the mixer paddle motor close to the welding (C); ■ the mixer paddle motor wires are placed in the correct way: - the wire length between the O-ring bottom and the XY carriage wire guide is 105 mm +/- 3 (D), - the wire length between the XY carriage wire guide and the upper wire guide is 70 mm +/- 3 (E).
C
B A
RAS386G - 10
MIXER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Mixer
70 mm +/- 3 E
105 mm +/- 3 D
When reassembling, make sure that the mixer paddle is pushed up to the maximum in its support.
Technical Manual RAA023
MIXER
RAS386G - 11
Mixer
3.4.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Cylinder replacement
To know which adjustments have to be performed after parts replacement: see 4. Impacted adjustments, page 16.
■ Switch
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
■ Remove
the covers (see RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1): - Open the arms main cover. - Remove the mixer cover.
■ Lift
the mixer assembly up by pressing the red button.
A ■ Unscrew
the CHC screw "A".
■ Unscrew
the CHC screw "B" and plastic
washer. ■ Release
the mixer paddle motor cable and remove the plate.
B
■ Loosen
RAS386G - 12
the 2 CHC screws of the motor.
MIXER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Unscrew
Mixer
the CHC screw and nut of the
cylinder.
■ Unscrew the 2 CHC screws and washers of
the X axis. ■ Pull
the X axis forward.
■ Remove
the cylinder and replace it.
■ When
reassembling, make sure that you tighten the cylinder screw on the flat spot of the motor axis.
Technical Manual RAA023
MIXER
RAS386G - 13
Mixer
3.5.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Cylinder spring replacement
To know which adjustments have to be performed after parts replacement: see 4. Impacted adjustments, page 16.
■ Switch
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
■ Remove
the covers (see RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1): - Open the arms main cover. - Remove the mixer cover.
■ Lift
the mixer assembly up by pressing the red button.
■ Unscrew the CHC screw inside the cylinder
to remove the cylinder spring. ■ Replace the cylinder spring and reassemble
in reverse order.
■ When
reassembling, make sure that the CHC screw is right above the cylinder. the cylinder spring replacement, make sure that the XY carriage moves down without moving backward.
■ After
RAS386G - 14
MIXER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
3.6.
Mixer
"Mixer present switch" replacement
To know which adjustments have to be performed after parts replacement: see 4. Impacted adjustments, page 16.
■ Switch
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
■ Remove
the covers (see RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1): Open the arms main cover.
■ Lift
the mixer assembly up by pressing the red button.
■ Remove
the rear plate by unscrewing the 8 CHC screws to access the "mixer present switch".
■ Disconnect
the 2 connectors and unscrew the 2 CHC screws to remove the "mixer present switch".
■ Replace
the "mixer present switch" and reassemble in reverse order.
After the "mixer present switch" replacement, it is necessary to make sure that it works correctly. See RAS394: Sensors check and adjustment, 6. "Mixer present switch", page 7.
Technical Manual RAA023
MIXER
RAS386G - 15
Mixer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
4. Impacted adjustments
Paddle Home sensor Paddle motor
Mixer motor
Cylinder or Mixer assy dismantling Switch cylinder spring or replacement
Mixer Home position
X
X
Above Reaction Tray
X
X
X
Cuvette Position
X
X
X
Reaction tray Mixing Position
RAS386G - 16
X
MIXER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Mixer
5. Adjustments
Disable the arms (vertical and rotation movements) and put them on a sample cup rack over the reagent tray as shown on the following figure.
■ Switch ■ Open
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
the arms main cover.
■
Remove the mixer cover, the loader cover, the cuvettes hatch, the connection hatch, the cuvettes cover, the optic hatch, the left arm cover, the cuvettes tray plate and the mixer plate. See RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1.
■
Remove the unload rack, the load rack and the reaction tray cover. See RAS382: Reaction tray, 1. Reaction tray dismantling, page 2.
■ Connect ■ Lift
the power supply cable and switch the instrument on.
the mixer assembly up by pressing the red button.
Before starting position adjustments, make sure that the CHC screw is right above the cylinder.
Technical Manual RAA023
MIXER
RAS386G - 17
Mixer
5.1.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Home position
A ■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Arms.
■ Move
the mixer to its home position as follows: - Select the Mixer radio button (A) and press Check Home (B). B
■ Position the mixing paddle motor assy in its
upper position as follows: - Loosen the 2 CHC screws of the mixing paddle motor assy. - Place the mixing paddle motor assy in its upper position. - Screw the 2 CHC screws. ■ Make
sure that the mixer paddle is pushed up to the maximum in its support.
A ■ Check
the distance between the XY carriage and the low carriage.
■ Adjust
this position to have 7 mm +/- 0.5 between the XY carriage and the low carriage by moving the home flag (A). - Move the home flag down to move the XY carriage up. - Move the home flag up to move the XY carriage down.
7 mm +/- 0.5
■ Press
Check Home (B), then check the position again.
RAS386G - 18
MIXER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Mixer
■ Manually
make sure that there is a gap of about 2 mm between the end of the mixer paddle and the wash tower bottom by moving the wash tower up and down.
≈2 mm
5.2.
Reaction tray "Mixing Position" ■
Adjust the reaction tray Mixing Position position. See RAS382: Reaction tray, 4.4. Mixing Position, page 23.
■ Remove
the tool from the reaction tray as follows: - Go to Services > Diagnostics > Tray. - In the Sector and Position scrolling lists, select "1" and "1" (1). - In the Target scrolling list, select Handling Position (2). - Press Check Position (3). - Remove the tool from the reaction tray.
Technical Manual RAA023
MIXER
1 2
3
RAS386G - 19
Mixer
5.3.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
"Cuvette" position
The mixer assembly should be in up position.
■ Go
A
to Services > Diagnostics > Arms.
■ In the Position scrolling list, select Cuvette
(A). ■ Press
Check Position (B). B
■ Check
the distance between the XY carriage and the low carriage. This distance must be 7 mm +/- 1.
7 mm +/- 1
■ Adjust the position by changing the number
of steps for the Cuvette position (C). - Increase the number of steps to move the XY carriage down. - Decrease the number of steps to move the XY carriage up. ■ Press
Check Home (D) and check the position again.
■ Manually
RAS386G - 20
C
D
pull the mixer assembly up.
MIXER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
5.4.
Mixer
Mixer paddle height
Follow this procedure to adjust the mixer paddle height in the cuvette. The distance between the end of the mixer paddle and the bottom of the cuvette must be 3 mm.
3 mm
The mixer assembly should be in up position.
■ Manually
load a cuvette segment in the reaction tray as follows: - Go to Services > Diagnostics > Tray. - Select the Reaction radio button (1) and press Check Home (2). - In the Sector and Position scrolling lists, select "1" and "1" (3). - In the Target scrolling list, select Handling Position (4). - Press Check Position (5). - Manually load a cuvette segment in the reaction tray. - In the Target scrolling list, select Mixing Position (4). - Press Check Position (5) to move the cuvette segment to the Mixing Position position.
Technical Manual RAA023
MIXER
1 3 4
2
5
RAS386G - 21
Mixer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
A ■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Arms.
C
■ Select the
Mixer radio button (A) and press Check Home (B).
■ In the Position scrolling list, select Cuvette
(C). ■ Press
Check Position (D).
B
D
■ When
the mixing paddle stops turning, manually push the mixer assembly down to engage it.
■ Unscrew the 2 CHC screws maintaining the
mixer paddle motor then move down the paddle until the end of the paddle touches the bottom of the cuvette.
■ Measure
the distance D between the bottom of the mixing paddle motor assy and the top of the reaction tray cover (if the reaction tray cover is removed, make the measurement at the top of the cuvette).
■ Lift the mixer paddle up by 3 mm and screw
the 2 CHC screws maintaining the mixer paddle motor. (Adjustment value = measured distance D 3 mm)
D
■ Press
Check Home (B) and check the position again.
■ Manually
RAS386G - 22
pull the mixer assembly up.
MIXER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Mixer
■ Remove
the cuvette segment from the reaction tray as follows: - Go to Services > Diagnostics > Tray. - In the Sector and Position scrolling lists, select "1" and "1" (3). - In the Target scrolling list, select Handling Position (4). - Press Check Position (5). - Remove the cuvette segment from the reaction tray.
5.5.
3 4
5
"Above Reaction Tray" position
Follow this procedure to adjust the mixer paddle height above the reaction tray.
■ Reinstall
the reaction tray cover.
The mixer assembly should be in up position.
A ■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Arms.
■ Select the
Mixer radio button (A) and press Check Home (B).
C
■ In
the Position scrolling list, select Above Reaction Tray (C).
■ Press
Check Position (D).
■ When
the mixing paddle stops turning, press Motor Off (E).
Technical Manual RAA023
B
MIXER
D
E
RAS386G - 23
Mixer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Manually push the mixer assembly down to
engage it. ■ Check
the distance between the end of the mixer paddle and the top of the reaction tray cover (not above the mixer hole). This distance must be 1-2 mm.
1-2 mm
Mixer hole
■ Adjust the mixer paddle height by changing
the number of steps for the Above Reaction Tray position (F). - Increase the number of steps to move the XY carriage down. - Decrease the number of steps to move the XY carriage up. ■ Press
Check Home (B) and check the position again.
■ Manually ■ Put
F
B
pull the mixer assembly up.
the covers back.
Specific ABX Pentra 400 V1 ■ When
reassembling, check the cuvette changer adjustments. See RAS384: Cuvette changer, 4. Adjustments, page 31.
RAS386G - 24
MIXER
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS385G
Arms In this procedure, specific instructions are given for previous ABX Pentra 400 hardware versions: ■ V1 corresponds to instruments with serial numbers below 2000. ■ V2 corresponds to instruments with serial numbers between 2000 and 2999.
RAS385: Arms
Concerns Needles replacement Arms assembly dismantling Arms assembly parts replacement Impacted adjustments Reagent arm adjustment Sample arm adjustment Level detection check Shock detection check
Required tools Hexagonal keys Torx key Flat screwdriver Phillips screwdriver TOOL, DYNAMO. SCREWDRIVER A302 MAG019A (1207851019) OPTICAL, SEGMENT 1XXX TEST 9200787 (1229200787) TOOL, REAG TRAY ADJUSTING TOOL XDB097AS (1209149097) TOOL, DUMMY REAGENT NEEDLE GBM1124 (1203601124) TOOL, DUMMY SAMPLE NEEDLE GBM1125 (1203601125)
Required products Distilled water TOOL, THREADLOCKING LAX003A (1207721003)
Intervention time N/A
Frequency On request
Specific kit or consumables None Disposable gloves, eye protections and a lab coat must be worn by the operator. Local or national regulations must be applied in all the operations.
Arms
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
1. Needles replacement ■ Connect ■ Go
1.1.
the power supply cable and switch the instrument on.
to Services > Customer Services > Cycles.
Reagent needle replacement
■ Press
Replace Reagent needle. The following message appears: "Replace the needle and click OK when done."
■ Open
the arms main cover.
■ Remove
the reagent arm bracket cover by unscrewing the 2 BHC screws. See RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1.
■ Make
sure that the reagent needle is above its wash tower and disconnect the teflon tubing of the reagent needle from the syringe block support.
■ Remove
the teflon tubing of the reagent needle from the 2 plastic collars.
RAS385G - 2
ARMS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Arms
■ Disconnect the level detection cable (A) and
loosen the 2 CHC screws (B) to free the needle. A B
■ Disconnect
the reagent needle connector and remove the needle.
■ Replace
the needle and reassemble in reverse order.
Specific ABX Pentra 400 V1 When reassembling, take care that the plastic collars are positioned in the correct way and the teflon tubing is passing in front of the electrical wire.
Be careful not to clamp the tubing and wires of the reagent arm when you fasten the reagent arm bracket cover.
Technical Manual RAA023
ARMS
RAS385G - 3
Arms
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Press
OK when finished. The following message appears: "Click OK to continue."
■ Press
A
OK again.
■ If
the level detection of the reagent needle is enabled, a message informs the user that the calibration of the reagent level detection will be automatically performed.
1.2.
B
■ Press
Priming Cycle (A).
■ Press
Reagent pressure calibration (B).
Sample needle replacement
■ Press
Replace Sample needle. The following message appears: "Replace the needle and click OK when done."
■ Open
the arms main cover.
■ Remove
the sample arm bracket cover by unscrewing the 2 BHC screws. See RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1.
■ Make
sure that the sample needle is above its wash tower and disconnect the teflon tubing of the sample needle from the syringe block support.
RAS385G - 4
ARMS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Arms
■ Remove
the teflon tubing of the sample needle from the 2 plastic collars.
When reassembling, take care that the plastic collars are positioned in the correct way. See the picture above.
■ Disconnect the level detection cable (A) and
loosen the sample needle locking screw (B) to release the needle. ■ Remove
the needle.
■ Replace
the needle and reassemble in reverse order. A B
■ Before
the sample arm bracket cover reassembly: position, as much as possible, the sample needle locking screw towards the sample arm inside. ■ Take care that the tubing is correctly positioned in the sample arm bracket cover and be careful not to clamp the tubing nor the wires of the sample arm when you fasten the sample arm bracket cover. ■ When the sample arm bracket cover is fastened, make sure that the shock detection runs smoothly. See 8. Shock detection check, page 59.
Technical Manual RAA023
ARMS
RAS385G - 5
Arms
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Press
OK when finished. The following message appears: "Click OK to continue."
■ Press
OK again.
■ Press
Priming Cycle (A).
■ Press
Sample pressure calibration (B).
RAS385G - 6
A
B
ARMS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Arms
2. Arms assembly dismantling ■ Switch
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable. It is advisable to remove the needles before dismantling the arms assembly (in order not to damage them).
■ Remove
the covers (see RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1): - Open the arms main cover and the ISE cover. - Remove the external and internal sample covers, the optic hatch, the arms covers, the cuvettes tray plate, the reagent plate, the loader cover, the mother board cover and the mixer plate.
■
Disconnect the 2 connectors from the reagent level detection board (J2 and J4) and the connector from the sample level detection board (J2).
■ Disconnect
the reagent arm vertical motor from the mother board (J58).
■ Disconnect
the sample arm vertical motor from the mother board (J59).
■ Unscrew the 2 CHC screws maintaining the
arms assembly.
■
Slightly lift the arms assembly up, then cut the Ty-Rap™ and disconnect the 2 home sensor connectors (A) and the 2 rotation motors (B).
B
A
■ Remove
Technical Manual RAA023
the arms assembly.
ARMS
RAS385G - 7
Arms
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
B
A Specific ABX Pentra 400 V1 ■ First,
cut the Ty-Rap™ and disconnect the 2 home sensor connectors (A) and the 2 rotation motors (B).
B ■ Then,
unscrew the 4 CHC screws to remove the arms assembly.
■ Reassemble
in reverse order.
Make sure that all the wiring is in the correct position before putting a new Ty-Rap™ and make sure that the wires are not in the way of the home sensors.
RAS385G - 8
ARMS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Arms
3. Arms assembly parts replacement 3.1.
Home sensors replacement
This procedure describes how to replace the 2 vertical home sensors and the 2 rotation home sensors: - 3.1.1. Vertical home sensor, page 9 - 3.1.2. Rotation home sensor, page 11.
To know which adjustments have to be performed after parts replacement: see 4. Impacted adjustments, page 21.
3.1.1. Vertical home sensor ■ Follow
the arms assembly dismantling procedure. See 2. Arms assembly dismantling, page 7.
C ■ Cut
the Ty-Rap™ (A) and disconnect the 2 vertical motor connectors (B).
■ Unscrew
the CHC screw (C) to release the vertical home sensor and its wires. B A
C Specific ABX Pentra 400 V1 and V2 ■ Cut
the Ty-Rap™ (A) and disconnect the 2 vertical motor connectors (B).
■ Unscrew
the CHC screw (C) to release the vertical home sensor and its wires.
B A
Technical Manual RAA023
ARMS
RAS385G - 9
Arms
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Cut
one side of the new vertical home sensor as indicated on the picture.
■ Reassemble ■ Reposition
1
in reverse order.
the cable and gather it with a Ty-Rap™ as shown on the following pictures: 3
2
■
To ensure that the cable is correctly positioned, check the cable bend (refer to the following picture) when the rack rail assembly is in low position. Reagent arm
Sample arm
■ Make
sure that the home flag passes in the middle of the home sensor and does not touch the home sensor. If necessary, manually adjust the home flag position.
RAS385G - 10
ARMS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Arms
3.1.2. Rotation home sensor ■ Follow
the arms assembly dismantling procedure. See 2. Arms assembly dismantling, page 7.
■ Unscrew
the CHC screw to release the rotation home sensor and its wires.
■ Cut
one side of the new rotation home sensor as indicated on the picture.
■ Reassemble
in reverse order.
■ Make
sure that the home flag passes in the middle of the home sensor and does not touch the home sensor. If necessary, adjust the home flag position by unscrewing the 2 CHC screws and/or manually adjust the home flag position.
Specific ABX Pentra 400 V1 and V2 ■ Make
sure that the home flag passes in the middle of the home sensor and does not touch the home sensor. If necessary, adjust the home flag position by unscrewing the 2 CHC screws and/or manually adjust the home flag position.
Technical Manual RAA023
ARMS
RAS385G - 11
Arms
3.2.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Motors replacement
This procedure describes how to replace the reagent and sample vertical motors and the reagent and sample rotation motors: - 3.2.1. Vertical motor, page 12 - 3.2.2. Rotation motor, page 14.
To know which adjustments have to be performed after parts replacement: see 4. Impacted adjustments, page 21.
3.2.1. Vertical motor ■ Follow
the arms assembly dismantling procedure. See 2. Arms assembly dismantling, page 7.
A
■ Remove
the vertical home flag by unscrewing the 2 CHC screws (A).
B A
■ Remove
the end stop by unscrewing the 2 CHC screws (B). B
■ Remove
the wire guide support by unscrewing the 2 CHC screws (C). C
C
Specific ABX Pentra 400 V1 and V2 ■ Remove
the end stop by unscrewing the 2 CHC screws.
On the reagent arm, before removing end stop screws, note the position of the screws on the end stop to reassemble it in the same way.
RAS385G - 12
ARMS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Arms
■ Unscrew
the 3 CHC screws to release the support of the vertical motor and home sensor.
■ Remove
the vertical motor as follows: - Unscrew the 3 CHC screws and washers (A). - Then, unscrew the last CHC screw taking care not to lose the spring (B). - Disconnect the motor connector and remove the motor.
A
B
Specific ABX Pentra 400 V1 and V2 ■ Unscrew
the 3 CHC screws to release the support of the vertical motor and home sensor.
■ Remove
the vertical motor as follows: - Unscrew the 3 CHC screws and washers (A). - Then, unscrew the last CHC screw taking care not to lose the spring (B). - Disconnect the motor connector and remove the motor.
A
B
Specific ABX Pentra 400 V1 ■ There
is no spring on the last CHC screw for ABX Pentra 400 V1.
■ Replace
the vertical motor and reassemble in reverse order.
When reassembling, put threadlocking LOCTITE 222 on the end of the 4 CHC screws. First turn the 3 CHC screws and washers without tightening them. Then, turn the last CHC screw with the spring and tighten the 4 CHC screws.
Technical Manual RAA023
ARMS
RAS385G - 13
Arms
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
3.2.2. Rotation motor ■ Follow
the arms assembly dismantling procedure. See 2. Arms assembly dismantling, page 7.
■ Remove
the rotation motor as follows: - Unscrew the belt tensioner screw (A). - Then, unscrew the 4 CHC screws and washers and remove the motor.
A
■ Replace the rotation motor and reassemble
in reverse order.
When reassembling, first turn the 4 CHC screws and washers without tightening them. Then, fasten the belt tensioner screw at 90 mN.m with a dynamometric screwdriver and tighten the 4 CHC screws.
3.3.
Reagent or sample rack rail assembly replacement
To know which adjustments have to be performed after parts replacement: see 4. Impacted adjustments, page 21.
3.3.1. General procedure ■ Follow
the arms assembly dismantling procedure. See 2. Arms assembly dismantling, page 7.
■ Remove
the arm cable. See 3.4. Arm cables replacement, page 19.
■ Unscrew
the CHC screw on the arm to remove the arm.
RAS385G - 14
ARMS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Arms
A
■ Remove
the vertical home flag by unscrewing the 2 CHC screws (A).
B A
■ Remove
the end stop by unscrewing the 2 CHC screws (B). B
■ Remove
the wire guide support by unscrewing the 2 CHC screws (C). C
C
■ Unscrew
the 3 CHC screws to release the support of the vertical motor and home sensor.
■ Unscrew
the 3 CHC screws to remove the rack rail assembly ring.
belt
■ Loosen
the belt tensioner screw (A) as well as the 4 CHC screws and washers (B), then remove the belt.
C
B
■ Unscrew
the 3 CHC screws (C) to remove the pulley.
A
pulley
Technical Manual RAA023
ARMS
RAS385G - 15
Arms
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Remove
the rack rail assembly by pulling it downwards.
As the rack rail assembly is solidly built, you might have to pull it hard.
■ Replace
the rack rail assembly and reassemble in reverse order. When reassembling the pulley, first fasten the pulley and put the belt back. Then, fasten the belt tensioner screw at 90 mN.m with a dynamometric screwdriver and tighten the 4 CHC screws and washers.
3.3.2. Specific procedure ABX Pentra 400 V1 and V2 ■ Follow
the arms assembly dismantling procedure. See 2. Arms assembly dismantling, page 7.
■ Unscrew
the CHC screw on the arm to remove the arm.
RAS385G - 16
ARMS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Arms
■ Remove
the vertical home flag by unscrewing the 2 CHC screws (A).
■ Remove
the end stop by unscrewing the 2 CHC screws (B).
A B
On the reagent arm, before removing the end stop screws, note the position of the screws on the end stop to reassemble it in the same way.
■ Unscrew
the 3 CHC screws to release the support of the vertical motor and home sensor.
■ Unscrew
the 3 CHC screws to remove the rack rail assembly ring.
Specific ABX Pentra 400 V1 To remove the rack rail assembly ring, unscrew the CHC screw and crosspiece as well as the 4 CHC screws. Keep the ring to replace it on the new rack rail assembly.
Technical Manual RAA023
ARMS
RAS385G - 17
Arms
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
belt
■ Loosen
the belt tensioner screw (A) as well as the 4 CHC screws and washers (B), then remove the belt.
C
B
■ Unscrew
the 3 CHC screws (C) to remove the pulley.
A
pulley
■ Remove
the rack rail assembly by pulling it downwards.
As the rack rail assembly is solidly built, you might have to pull it hard.
■ Replace
the rack rail assembly and reassemble in reverse order.
■ Because
the up/down reagent arm motor rotation way is inverted, it is mandatory to replace the reagent arm vertical motor cable with the new one (provided in the reagent rack rail assembly replacement kit). Specific ABX Pentra 400 V1 Dismantle the ring from the new rack rail assembly and replace it with the ABX Pentra 400 V1 ring. Reassemble in reverse order with the new pulley and the new vertical motor and home sensor assembly (both provided in the rack rail assembly replacement kit).
RAS385G - 18
ARMS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Arms
When reassembling the pulley, first fasten the pulley and put the belt back. Then, fasten the belt tensioner screw at 90 mN.m with a dynamometric screwdriver and tighten the 4 CHC screws and washers. When reassembling the reagent arm, be careful to well position the CHC screws on the end stop. Some end stops have 2 holes and others have 4 holes. Refer to the following picture to know the correct positioning of the end stop screws.
End stop with 2 holes
3.4.
End stop with 4 holes
Arm cables replacement ■ Follow
the arms assembly dismantling procedure. See 2. Arms assembly dismantling, page 7.
■ Disconnect
the 2 connectors from the reagent level detection board (J2 and J4) or the connector from the sample level detection board (J2).
■
Remove the reagent or sample rack rail assembly carefully in order not to clamp and not to damage the cables. See 3.3. Reagent or sample rack rail assembly replacement, page 14.
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws of the upper arm axis frame.
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws of the lower arm axis frame.
Technical Manual RAA023
ARMS
RAS385G - 19
Arms
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Remove
the cable from the wire guides.
■ Reassemble
in reverse order.
■ To
reinstall the cable on the rack rail assembly, proceed as follows: - Place the cable into the groove of the hubcap.
- Slowly slide the arm axis frame over the cable. Be careful not to clamp the cable.
■ Be
careful not to clamp the cable in the arm notch. Ty-Rap™ must be positioned close to the arm.
■ The
Arm notch
Ty-Rap™
RAS385G - 20
ARMS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Arms
4. Impacted adjustments
The indications in the following table have to be taken into account only if a preliminary adjustment with the TOOL, REAG TRAY ADJUSTING TOOL XDB097AS (1209149097) has been performed by the factory or during a previous intervention. If it is not the case, it is imperative to perform all the adjustments of the functional positions mentioned.
Sample arm
Needles
Vertical Horizontal Vertical Horizontal Home Home Rails motor motor sensor sensor
Whole module dismantling
Sample arm rotation Cuvette Position (O)
X
V1 only
Wash Tower Position
V1 only
R1 Pos.-Reagent Rack
V1 only
R2 Pos.-Reagent Rack
V1 only
R3 Pos.-Reagent Rack
V1 only
R1 Pos.-Cal/Ctrl Rack
V1 only
R2 Pos.-Cal/Ctrl Rack
V1 only
R3 Pos.-Cal/Ctrl Rack
V1 only
R1 on Cassette
V1 only
R2 on Cassette
V1 only
External sample
V1 only
Internal sample
V1 only
ISE sample
V1 only
X
V1 only
Sample arm vertical Low Position in Cuvette
X
X
X
Low Position in Wash Tower
X
X
X
Low Position in Sample Cup
X
X
X
Low Position in Sample tube
X
X
X
Low Position in Reagent rack
X
X
X
Low Position in Cassette
X
X
X
Low Position CalCs on reagent tray
X
X
X
Low Position in ISE Tower
X
X
X
Technical Manual RAA023
ARMS
RAS385G - 21
Arms
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Reagent arm
Needles
Vertical Horizontal Whole Vertical Horizontal Home Home Rails module motor motor sensor sensor dismantling
Reagent arm rotation Cuvette Position (O)
X
V1 only
X
V1 only
Wash Tower Position R1 Pos.-Reagent Rack R2 Pos.-Reagent Rack R3 Pos.-Reagent Rack R1 on Cassette R2 on Cassette Reagent arm vertical Low Position in Reaction Tray
X
X
X
Low Position in Wash Tower
X
X
X
Low Position in Reagent/Cal/Ctrl Rack
X
X
X
Low Position in Cassette
X
X
X
RAS385G - 22
ARMS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Arms
5. Reagent arm adjustment
Recommendations for use: When you adjust a position of the reagent arm by changing the number of steps for this position, please note that: - for the rotation movement, a change of 12 steps is approximately equal to a move of 1 mm linear. - for the vertical movement, a change of 128 steps is approximately equal to a move of 1 mm.
5.1.
Functional positions to adjust
The following table lists the functional positions to be adjusted. Those positions are reached by three different types of adjustments: - the combination of two movements to obtain a centering or - performing an automatic "AUTO" adjustment or - performing a manual "MAN" adjustment The table also indicates the tool required to perform those adjustments. Modules Reagent Arm Rotation Sector
Position
1
1
Position
Type
Tool
Reaction tray Reagent Arm Position
Wash tower
Cuvette Position
Wash Tower Position
Reagent tray R1 Pos.-Reagent Rack for Reagent arm 2 R2 Pos.-Reagent Rack for Reagent arm Reagent Rack R3 Pos.-Reagent Rack for Reagent arm R1 Pos.-Cassette for Reagent arm R2 Pos.-Cassette for Reagent arm
Technical Manual RAA023
1 Cassette
1-A 2-A 3-A 1 2
ARMS
R1 Pos.-Reagent Rack R2 Pos.-Reagent Rack R3 Pos.-Reagent Rack R1 on Cassette R2 on Cassette
RAS385G - 23
Arms
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Modules Reagent Arm Vertical Sector
Position
Position
Type
1
10
Low position in Reaction Tray
AUTO
Low Position in Wash Tower
MAN
Low Position in Reagent/ Cal/Ctrl Rack Low position in Cassette
AUTO
Tool
Reaction tray Reagent Arm Position
Wash tower
Reagent tray
(Motor Off)
■
Before starting the position adjustments, remove the covers (see RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1): - Open the arms main cover. - Remove the external and internal sample covers, then remove the optic hatch. - Lift the mixer up, then unscrew the 2 CHC screws of the left arm cover.
- Remove the cuvettes tray plate, the cuvettes hatch and the arm bracket covers. ■ Connect ■ Press
the power supply cable and switch the instrument on.
Stop to stop the initialization. Always move the sample arm to its upper position (vertical home position) before moving the reagent arm. Always move the sample and reagent arms to their upper positions (vertical home position) before moving any tray.
RAS385G - 24
ARMS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
5.2.
Arms
"Dummy reagent needle" installation ■ Perform
the reagent needle dismantling. See 1.1. Reagent needle replacement, page 2.
■ Install
the "Dummy reagent needle" on the reagent arm.
5.3.
Reagent arm rotation adjustment
5.3.1. Cuvette positions The cuvette position adjustments are performed with an adjustment tool: OPTICAL, SEGMENT 1XXX TEST 9200787 (1229200787). The following positions of the adjustment tool will be used: "1", "2" and "10".
1
Technical Manual RAA023
10
2
ARMS
RAS385G - 25
Arms
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Adjustment tool installation
■ Go
A
to Services > Diagnostics > Tray.
■ Select ■ Press
the Reaction radio button (A). C
Check Home (B).
■ In
the Sector and Position scrolling lists, select "1" and "1" (C).
D
■ In
the Target scrolling list, select Handling Position (D).
■ Press
Check Position (E).
■ Load
the tool into the reaction tray.
B
E
Make sure that the tool is loaded properly in the reaction tray. It is necessary to press the tool completely down in the reaction tray.
"Cuvette Position" ■ The
rotation adjustment value for the Cuvette Position position is factory adjusted on the rotation home position, therefore, the number of steps for the Cuvette Position position is 0. This is fixed and must not be changed. ■ If the rotation home position is adjusted, the other positions have to be adjusted too.
Follow this procedure to have the reagent needle centered in the cuvette.
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Tray.
■ In
the Sector and Position scrolling lists, select "1" and "1" (A).
■ In
the Target scrolling list, select Reagent Arm Position (B).
■ Press
Check Position to move the tool to the Reagent Arm Position position (C).
RAS385G - 26
ARMS
A B
C
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Go
Arms
to Services > Diagnostics > Arms.
1
3
■ Move
the sample arm to its vertical home position as follows: - Select the sample arm Vertical radio button (1) and press Check Home (2).
4
■ Move
the reagent arm to its vertical and rotation home position as follows: - Select the reagent arm Vertical radio button (3) and press Check Home (2). - Select the reagent arm Rotation radio button (4) and press Check Home (2).
5 2
The value of the rotation home offset (5) must not be modified. Adjust the rotation home position with the mechanical adjustment described below.
3 ■ Check the centering of the "Dummy reagent
needle" in the hole of the tool position "1" as follows: - Select the reagent arm Vertical radio button (3). - Press Motor Off (6). 6
- Slowly push the arm down, then check the position of the "Dummy reagent needle" in the hole of the tool position "1" arm adjustment (RAS385)
reaction tray adjustment (RAS382)
Technical Manual RAA023
ARMS
RAS385G - 27
Arms
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Loosen
the CHC screw on the reagent arm, then turn the reagent arm to center the "Dummy reagent needle" in the hole of the tool position "1".
■ Tighten
■ Press
the screw.
Check Home (2). 3
■ Check
the position again as follows: - Select the reagent arm Rotation radio button (4) and press Check Home (2). - Check the centering of the "Dummy reagent needle" again (see above).
4
■ Move
the reagent arm to its vertical and rotation home position as follows: - Select the reagent arm Vertical radio button (3) and press Check Home (2). - Select the reagent arm Rotation radio button (4) and press Check Home (2).
RAS385G - 28
2
ARMS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Arms
5.3.2. Wash Tower Position
Follow this procedure to have the reagent needle centered in its wash tower.
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Arms.
■ Ensure ■ Ensure
that the sample arm is at its vertical home position. that the reagent arm is at its vertical and rotation home position.
■ Select
the reagent arm Rotation radio button (1).
■ In
the Position scrolling list, select Wash Tower Position (2).
■ Press
Check Position (3).
■ Check the centering of the "Dummy reagent
needle" in the wash tower as follows: - Select the reagent arm Vertical radio button (4). - Press Motor Off (5). - Slowly push the arm down, then check the position of the "Dummy reagent needle" in the wash tower. ■ Press
4
Check Home (6).
■ Adjust the position by changing the number
of steps in the Position field for the Wash Tower Position position (7). - Increase the number of steps in order to turn the reagent arm clockwise. - Decrease the number of steps in order to turn the reagent arm anticlockwise.
1 2 7 6
3
5
■ Move
the reagent arm to its rotation home position as follows: - Select the reagent arm Rotation radio button (1) and press Check Home (6).
■ Check
the position again as follows: - Press Check Position (3) and check the centering of the "Dummy reagent needle" again (see above).
■ Move
the reagent arm to its vertical and rotation home position as follows: - Select the reagent arm Vertical radio button (4) and press Check Home (6). - Select the reagent arm Rotation radio button (1) and press Check Home (6).
5.3.3. Reagent Tray Position See RAS380: Reagent tray, 4.6. Sampling in reagent tray adjustment (cassette, rack, cal/ctrl rack), page 26.
Technical Manual RAA023
ARMS
RAS385G - 29
Arms
5.4.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Reagent arm vertical adjustment
5.4.1. "Low Position in Reaction Tray"
Follow this procedure to adjust the reagent needle height in the cuvette. The point of the needle must be 2 mm above the bottom of the cuvette.
2 mm
This adjustment is made automatically using the adjustment tool.
■ Ensure ■ Ensure
■ Go
that the sample arm is at its vertical home position. that the reagent arm is at its vertical and rotation home position.
to Services > Diagnostics > Tray.
■ In
the Sector and Position scrolling lists, select "1" and "10" (A).
■ In
the Target scrolling list, select Reagent Arm Position (B).
■ Press
Check Position to move the tool to the Reagent Arm Position position (C).
RAS385G - 30
ARMS
A B
C
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Arms
1 ■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Arms.
■ Select
the reagent arm Vertical radio button (1).
2
■ Select
the Automatic adjustment check box (2). It opens the automatic adjustment function.
■ In
the Reference point scrolling list, select Fixed test segment in reaction tray (3).
■ Press
Motor Off (4) and slowly push the arm down. The "Dummy reagent needle" is manually moved down into the hole of the tool position "10", this position is used as vertical reference position.
■ Press
Measure height (5). The "Dummy reagent needle" moves to its vertical home position measuring the number of steps between the 2 positions. This measured number of steps is added to an offset to calculate the value for the Low Position in Reaction Tray position. This calculated value is displayed in the table (6). - The value is displayed in black if it is within range. - The value is displayed in red if it is out of range.
3 8 6
4
5
7
9
■ If
the adjustment value is correct, press Validate AA (7). The value is then transferred in the Position field for the Low Position in Reaction Tray position (8). If not, press Cancel AA (9).
■ Deselect the Automatic adjustment check
box.
■ Remove
the tool from the reaction tray as follows: - Go to Services > Diagnostics > Tray. - In the Sector and Position scrolling lists, select "1" and "1" (A). - In the Target scrolling list, select Handling Position (B). - Press Check Position (C). - Remove the tool from the reaction tray.
Technical Manual RAA023
ARMS
A B
C
RAS385G - 31
Arms
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
5.4.2. "Low Position in Wash Tower" Follow this procedure to adjust the reagent needle height in its wash tower. The distance between the underside of the reagent arm and the top of the wash tower must be 91 mm +/- 0.5.
91 mm +/- 0.5
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Arms. ■ Ensure ■ Ensure
that the sample arm is at its vertical home position. that the reagent arm is at its vertical and rotation home position.
■ Select
the reagent arm Rotation radio button (1).
■ In
the Position scrolling list, select Wash Tower Position (2) and press Check Position (3).
■ Select
the reagent arm Vertical radio button (4).
■ Check
the position as follows: - In the Position scrolling list, select Low Position in Wash Tower (5) and press Check Position (3). - Check the "Dummy reagent needle" height in the wash tower.
4 5 6
1 2
■ Adjust
the reagent needle height by changing the number of steps for the Low Position in Wash Tower position (6) using the + and/or - buttons. - + = Increase the number of steps to move the reagent arm down. - - = Decrease the number of steps to move the reagent arm up.
7
3
■ Move
the reagent arm to its vertical and rotation home position as follows: - Select the reagent arm Vertical radio button (4) and press Check Home (7). - Select the reagent arm Rotation radio button (1) and press Check Home (7).
RAS385G - 32
ARMS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Arms
5.4.3. Reagent tray position Follow this procedure to adjust the reagent needle height in the vial ("Low Position in Reagent/Cal/Ctrl Rack") and in the cassette ("Low Position in Cassette"). The point of the needle must be 1 mm above the bottom of the vial and 1 mm above the bottom of the cassette.
Vial
Cassette
1 mm
1 mm
These two adjustments are made automatically, in only one go. See "ABX Cassette" (without level detection), page 33. ■ Ensure ■ Ensure
that the sample arm is at its vertical home position. that the reagent arm is at its vertical and rotation home position.
"ABX Cassette" (without level detection)
The vertical position adjustment in a cassette is the same for both R1 and R2. We will do the position adjustment for R1.
■ Move
the "Reag tray adjusting tool" to the R1 Pos.- Cassette for Reagent Arm position.
To load the "Reag tray adjusting tool" on the reagent tray and to move it to the R1 Pos.Cassette for Reagent Arm position, see RAS380: Reagent tray, 4.3. Preliminary procedure, page 23.
Technical Manual RAA023
ARMS
RAS385G - 33
Arms
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
A
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Tray.
■ Select ■ Press
the Reagent radio button (A).
Motor Off (B). B
"Reag tray adjusting tool" notch
■ Manually
move the reagent tray to position the "Reag tray adjusting tool" so as to make the adjustment easier.
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Arms.
4
■ Select
the reagent arm Rotation radio button (1).
■ In
the Position scrolling list, select R1 on Cassette (2).
■ Press
5 1
Check Position (3).
2
■ Select
the reagent arm Vertical radio button (4).
■ Select
the Automatic adjustment check box (5). It opens the automatic adjustment function.
3
■ In
the Reference point scrolling list, select ABX Cassette (6).
■ Press
6
Check Position (3).
■ Then,
use the + and/or - buttons to adjust the position of the "Dummy reagent needle". - + = Increase the number of steps to move the reagent arm down. - - = Decrease the number of steps to move the reagent arm up.
RAS385G - 34
ARMS
3
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Arms
The point of the "Dummy reagent needle" must be positioned right above the notch of the "Reag tray adjusting tool" (as shown on the following figure), this position is used as vertical reference position.
■ Press
Measure height (7). The "Dummy reagent needle" moves to its vertical home position measuring the number of steps between the 2 positions. This measured number of steps is added to 2 different offsets to calculate the value for the Low Position in Cassette position and the value for the Low Position in Reagent/ Cal/Ctrl Rack position. These calculated values are displayed in the table (8). - The values are displayed in black if they are within range. - The values are displayed in red if they are out of range.
3 10 5 8 1
■ If
the adjustment values are correct, press Validate AA (9). The values are then transferred in the Position field for the Low Position in Cassette position and for the Low Position in Reagent/Cal/Ctrl Rack position (10). If not, press Cancel AA (11).
12
4
7
9
11
■ Deselect the Automatic adjustment check
box (5). ■ Move
the reagent arm to its rotation home position as follows: - Select the reagent arm Rotation radio button (1) and press Check Home (12).
Technical Manual RAA023
ARMS
RAS385G - 35
Arms
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
6. Sample arm adjustment
Recommendations for use: When you adjust a position of the sample arm by changing the number of steps for this position, please note that: - for the rotation movement, a change of 8 steps is approximately equal to a move of 1 mm linear. - for the vertical movement, a change of 128 steps is approximately equal to a move of 1 mm. Place the reagent arm in low position in the wash tower before moving the sample arm. See 5.4.2. "Low Position in Wash Tower", page 32.
6.1.
Functional positions to adjust
The following table lists the functional positions to be adjusted. Those positions are reached by three different types of adjustments: - the combination of two movements to obtain a centering or - performing an automatic "AUTO" adjustment or - performing a manual "MAN" adjustment The table also indicates the tool required to perform those adjustments.
RAS385G - 36
ARMS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Arms
Modules Sample Arm Rotation Sector
Position
1
2
Position
Type
Tool
Reaction tray Sample Arm Position
Cuvette Position
Wash tower
Wash Tower Position
Reagent tray R1 Pos.-Reagent Rack for Sample arm 2 R2 Pos.-Reagent Rack for Sample arm Reagent Rack R3 Pos.-Reagent Rack for Sample arm
1-A 2-A 3-A
R1 Pos.-Reagent Rack R2 Pos.-Reagent Rack R3 Pos.-Reagent Rack
R1 Pos.-Cal/Ctrl Rack for Sample arm 3 R2 Pos.-Cal/Ctrl Rack for Sample arm Cal/Ctrl Rack R3 Pos.-Cal/Ctrl Rack for Sample arm
1 2 3
R1 Pos.-Cal/Ctrl Rack R2 Pos.-Cal/Ctrl Rack R3 Pos.-Cal/Ctrl Rack
1 Cassette
1 2
R1 on Cassette R2 on Cassette
External Sampling Pos.
1
2
External Sample
Internal Sampling Pos.
1
1
Internal Sample
R1 Pos.-Cassette for Sample arm R2 Pos.-Cassette for Sample arm Sample tray
ISE Tower
ISE Sample
Modules Sample Arm Vertical Sector
Position
1
10
Position
Type
Tool
Reaction tray Sample Arm Position
Wash tower
Low Position in Cuvette
AUTO
Low Position in Wash tower
MAN
Reagent tray Low Position in Reagent rack Low Position in Cassette Low Position CalCs on reagent tray
(Motor Off)
AUTO
Sample tray (Motor Off)
Low Position in Sample Cup Low Position in Sample Tube
1
ISE Tower
Technical Manual RAA023
Low Position in ISE Tower
ARMS
RAS385G - 37
Arms
6.2.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
"Dummy sample needle" installation ■ Perform
the sample needle dismantling procedure. See 1.2. Sample needle replacement, page 4.
■ Install
the "Dummy sample needle" on the sample arm.
6.3.
Sample arm rotation adjustment
6.3.1. Cuvette positions Adjustment tool installation The cuvette position adjustments are performed with the adjustment tool already used for the reagent arm.
1
10
2
It is necessary to load this adjustment tool in the reaction tray. Follow the procedure described in Adjustment tool installation, page 26.
RAS385G - 38
ARMS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Arms
"Cuvette Position" ■ The
rotation adjustment value for the Cuvette Position position is factory adjusted on the rotation home position, therefore, the number of steps for the Cuvette Position position is 0. This is fixed and must not be changed. ■ If the rotation home position is adjusted, the other positions have to be adjusted too.
Follow this procedure to have the sample needle centered in the cuvette.
■ Go
A
to Services > Diagnostics > Tray.
■ Select ■ Press
the Reaction radio button (A).
C
Check Home (B).
■ In
the Sector and Position scrolling lists, select "1" and "2" (C).
D
■ In
the Target scrolling list, select Sample Arm Position (D).
B
E
■ Press
Check Position to move the tool to the Sample Arm Position position (E).
1 ■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Arms.
■ Move
the sample arm to its vertical and rotation home position as follows: - Select the sample arm Vertical radio button (1) and press Check Home (2). - Select the sample arm Rotation radio button (3) and press Check Home (2).
4 3 2
The value of the rotation home offset (4) must not be modified. Adjust the rotation home position with the mechanical adjustment described below.
Technical Manual RAA023
ARMS
RAS385G - 39
Arms
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
1 ■ Check the centering of the "Dummy sample
needle" on the mobile part of the tool position "2" as follows: - Select the sample arm Vertical radio button (1). - Press Motor Off (5).
5
- Slowly push the arm down, then check the position of the "Dummy sample needle" on the mobile part of the tool position "2".
arm adjustment
■ Loosen
the CHC screw on the sample arm, then turn the sample arm to center the "Dummy sample needle" on the mobile part of the tool position "2".
■ Tighten
■ Press
the screw.
Check Home (2). 1
■ Check
the position again as follows: - Select the sample arm Rotation radio button (3) and press Check Home (2). - Check the centering of the "Dummy sample needle" again (see above).
■ Move
the sample arm to its vertical and rotation home position as follows: - Select the sample arm Vertical radio button (1) and press Check Home (2). - Select the sample arm Rotation radio button (3) and press Check Home (2).
RAS385G - 40
3 2
ARMS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Arms
6.3.2. Wash Tower Position
Follow this procedure to have the sample needle centered in its wash tower.
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Arms.
Ensure that the sample arm is at its vertical and rotation home position.
■ Select
the sample arm Rotation radio button (1).
■ In
the Position scrolling list, select Wash Tower Position (2).
■ Press
Check Position (3).
■ Check the centering of the "Dummy sample
needle" in the wash tower as follows: - Select the sample arm Vertical radio button (4). - Press Motor Off (5). - Slowly push the arm down, then check the position of the "Dummy sample needle" in the wash tower. ■ Press
4
Check Home (6).
■ Adjust the position by changing the number
of steps in the Position field for the Wash Tower Position position (7). - Increase the number of steps in order to turn the sample arm clockwise. - Decrease the number of steps in order to turn the sample arm anticlockwise. ■ Move
the sample arm to its rotation home position as follows: - Select the sample arm Rotation radio button (1) and press Check Home (6).
1 2 6
3
5 7
■ Check
the position again as follows: Press Check Position (3) and check the centering of the "Dummy sample needle" again (see above).
■ Move
the sample arm to its vertical and rotation home position as follows: - Select the sample arm Vertical radio button (4) and press Check Home (6). - Select the sample arm Rotation radio button (1) and press Check Home (6).
6.3.3. Reagent Tray Position See RAS380: Reagent tray, 4.6. Sampling in reagent tray adjustment (cassette, rack, cal/ctrl rack), page 26.
Technical Manual RAA023
ARMS
RAS385G - 41
Arms
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
6.3.4. Sample Tray Position See RAS381: Sample tray, 4.5. Sampling in sample tray adjustment, page 22.
6.3.5. ISE Position
Follow this procedure to center the sample needle in the ISE mix cup.
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Arms.
Ensure that the sample arm is at its vertical and rotation home position.
■ Select
the sample arm Rotation radio button (1).
4
■ In
the Position scrolling list, select ISE Sample (2).
■ Press
1
Check Position (3).
■ Check the centering of the "Dummy sample
2
needle" in the ISE mix cup as follows: - Select the sample arm Vertical radio button (4). - Press Motor Off (5).
3
- Slowly push the arm down, then check the position of the "Dummy sample needle" in the ISE mix cup.
RAS385G - 42
ARMS
5
+ -
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Press
Arms
Check Home (6).
■ Adjust the position by changing the number
of steps in the Position field for the ISE Sample position (7). - Increase the number of steps in order to turn the sample arm clockwise. - Decrease the number of steps in order to turn the sample arm anticlockwise.
4
■ Move
the sample arm to its rotation home position as follows: - Select the sample arm Rotation radio button (1) and press Check Home (6).
1
■ Check
the position again as follows: - Press Check Position (3) and check the centering of the "Dummy sample needle" again (see above).
6
3 7
■ Move
the sample arm to its vertical and rotation home position as follows: - Select the sample arm Vertical radio button (4) and press Check Home (6). - Select the sample arm Rotation radio button (1) and press Check Home (6).
6.4.
Sample arm vertical adjustment
6.4.1. "Low Position in Cuvette" Follow this procedure to adjust the sample needle in the cuvette. The point of the needle must be 2 mm above the bottom of the cuvette.
2 mm
This adjustment is made automatically using the adjustment tool.
Ensure that the sample arm is at its vertical and rotation home position.
Technical Manual RAA023
ARMS
RAS385G - 43
Arms
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Tray.
A
■ In
the Sector and Position scrolling lists, select "1" and "10" (A).
B
■ In
the Target scrolling list, select Sample Arm Position (B).
■ Press
Check Position to move the tool to the Sample Arm Position position (C).
C
1 ■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Arms.
2
■ Select the sample arm Vertical radio button
(1). ■ Select
the Automatic adjustment check box (2). It opens the automatic adjustment function.
■ In
the Reference point scrolling list, select Fixed test segment in reaction tray (3). 3
■ Press
Motor Off (4) and slowly push the arm down. The "Dummy sample needle" is manually moved down into the hole of the tool position "10", this position is used as vertical reference position.
4
Take care of the shock detection. It should not be activated otherwise the adjustment won’t be correct.
RAS385G - 44
ARMS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Arms
■ Press
Measure height (5). The "Dummy sample needle" moves to its vertical home position measuring the number of steps between the 2 positions. This measured number of steps is added to an offset to calculate the value for the Low Position in Cuvette position. This calculated value is displayed in the table (6). - The value is displayed in black if it is within range. - The value is displayed in red if it is out of range.
2 6 8 5
■ If
the adjustment value is correct, press Validate AA (7). The value is then transferred in the Position field for the Low Position in Cuvette position (8). If not, press Cancel AA (9).
9
7
■ Deselect the Automatic adjustment check
box (2).
■ Remove
the tool from the reaction tray as follows: - Go to Services > Diagnostics > Tray. - In the Sector and Position scrolling lists, select "1" and "1" (A). - In the Target scrolling list, select Handling Position (B). - Press Check Position (C). - Remove the tool from the reaction tray.
Technical Manual RAA023
ARMS
A B
C
RAS385G - 45
Arms
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
6.4.2. "Low Position in Wash Tower" Follow this procedure to adjust the sample needle height in its wash tower. The distance between the underside of the sample arm and the top of the wash tower must be 111 mm +/- 0.5.
111 mm +/- 0.5
Ensure that the sample arm is at its vertical and rotation home position.
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Arms.
■ Select
the sample arm Rotation radio button (1).
■ In
the Position scrolling list, select Wash Tower Position (2) and press Check Position (3).
■ Select the sample arm Vertical radio button
(4). ■ Check
the position as follows: - In the Position scrolling list, select Low Position in Wash Tower (5). - Press Check Position (3) and check the "Dummy sample needle" height in the wash tower.
4 5
■ Adjust
the reagent needle height by changing the number of steps for the Low Position in Wash Tower position (6) using the + and/or - buttons. - + = Increase the number of steps to move the reagent arm down. - - = Decrease the number of steps to move the reagent arm up.
1 7
3
6
2
■ Move
the sample arm to its vertical and rotation home position as follows: - Select the sample arm Vertical radio button (4) and press Check Home (7). - Select the sample arm Rotation radio button (1) and press Check Home (7).
RAS385G - 46
ARMS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Arms
6.4.3. Reagent Tray Position Follow this procedure to adjust the sample needle height in the vial ("Low Position in Reagent rack"), in the sample cup ("Low position CalCs on reagent tray") and in the cassette ("Low Position in Cassette"). The point of the needle must 1 mm above the bottom of the vial, 1 mm above the bottom of the sample cup and 1 mm above the bottom of the cassette.
Vial
Sample cup
Cassette
1 mm
1 mm
1 mm
These three adjustments are made automatically, in only one go. See "ABX Cassette" (without level detection), page 47.
Ensure that the sample arm is at its vertical and rotation home position.
"ABX Cassette" (without level detection)
The vertical position adjustment in a cassette is the same for both R1 and R2. We will do the position adjustment for R1.
■ Move
the "Reag tray adjusting tool" to the R1 Pos.- Cassette for Sample Arm position.
To load the "Reag tray adjusting tool" on the reagent tray and to move it to the R1 Pos.Cassette for Sample Arm position, see RAS380: Reagent tray, 4.3. Preliminary procedure, page 23.
Technical Manual RAA023
ARMS
RAS385G - 47
Arms
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
A
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Tray.
■ Select ■ Press
the Reagent radio button (A).
Motor Off (B). B
■ Manually
move the reagent tray to position the "Reag tray adjusting tool" so as to make the adjustment easier.
"Reag tray adjusting tool" notch ■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Arms. 4
■ Select
the sample arm Rotation radio button (1).
5
■ In
the Position scrolling list, select R1 on Cassette (2).
■ Press
Check Position (3). 1
■ Select the sample arm Vertical radio button
(4).
3
■ Select
the Automatic adjustment check box (5). It opens the automatic adjustment function.
2
■ In
the Reference point scrolling list, select ABX Cassette (6).
■ Press
Check Position (3).
6
■ Then,
use the + and/or - buttons to adjust the position of the "Dummy sample needle". - + = Increase the number of steps to move the sample arm down. - - = Decrease the number of steps to move the sample arm up.
RAS385G - 48
ARMS
3
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Arms
The point of the "Dummy sample needle" must be positioned right above the notch of the "Reag tray adjusting tool" (as shown on the following figure), this position is used as vertical reference position.
Take care of the shock detection. It should not be activated otherwise the adjustment won’t be correct. ■ Press
Measure height (7). The "Dummy sample needle" moves to its vertical home position measuring the number of steps between the 2 positions. This measured number of steps is added to 3 different offsets to calculate the value for the Low Position in Cassette position, the value for the Low position CalCs on reagent tray position and the value for the Low Position in Reagent rack position. These calculated values are displayed in the table (8). - The values are displayed in black if they are within range. - The values are displayed in red if they are out of range.
5 8 10
■ If
the adjustment values are correct, press Validate AA (9). The values are then transferred in the Position field for the Low Position in 12 Cassette position, for the Low position CalCs on reagent tray position and for the Low Position in Reagent rack position (10). If not, press Cancel AA (11).
■ Deselect
1 7
9
11
the Automatic adjustment check
box (5). ■ Move
the sample arm to its rotation home position as follows: - Select the sample arm Rotation radio button (1) and press Check Home (12).
■ Remove
the "Reag tray adjusting tool" from the reagent tray.
Technical Manual RAA023
ARMS
RAS385G - 49
Arms
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
6.4.4. Sample Tray Position Follow this procedure to adjust the sample needle height in the sample cup ("Low Position in Sample Cup") and in the sample tube ("Low Position in Sample Tube"). The point of the needle must be 1 mm above the bottom of the sample cup and 1 mm above the bottom of the sample tube.
Sample cup
Sample tube
1 mm
1 mm
These two adjustments are made automatically, in only one go. See "Sample tube rack" (without level detection), page 50.
Ensure that the sample arm is at its vertical and rotation home position.
"Sample tube rack" (without level detection)
The vertical position adjustment in a sample tube is valid and is the same for both the External Sample and Internal Sample positions. We will do the position adjustment for the Internal Sample position.
■ Load
a sample rack on the sample tray in position "1".
■ Move
the position "1" of this sample rack to the Internal Sampling Pos. position.
To load a sample rack on the sample tray in position "1" and to move the position "1" of this sample rack to the Internal Sampling Pos. position, see RAS381: Sample tray, 4.2. Preliminary procedure, page 17.
RAS385G - 50
ARMS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Arms
A
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Tray.
■ Select ■ Press
the Sample radio button (A).
Motor Off (B). B
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Arms. 4
■ Select
the sample arm Rotation radio button (1).
■ In the Position scrolling list, select
5
Internal
Sample (2). ■ Press
Check Position (3). 1
■ Select the sample arm Vertical radio button
(4).
3
■ Select
the Automatic adjustment check box (5). It opens the automatic adjustment function.
2
■ In
the Reference point scrolling list, select Sample tube rack (6).
■ Press
Check Position (3).
6
■ Then,
use the + and/or - buttons to adjust the position of the "Dummy sample needle". - + = Increase the number of steps to move the sample arm down. - - = Decrease the number of steps to move the sample arm up.
3
The point of the "Dummy sample needle" must be positioned right above the upper part of the sample rack (as shown on the following picture), this position is used as vertical reference position. Manually move the sample tray to position the sample rack so as to make the adjustment easier.
Technical Manual RAA023
ARMS
RAS385G - 51
Arms
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Take care of the shock detection. It should not be activated otherwise the adjustment won’t be correct.
■ Press
Measure height (7). The "Dummy sample needle" moves to its vertical home position measuring the number of steps between the 2 positions. This measured number of steps is added to 2 different offsets to calculate the value for the Low Position in Sample Tube position and the value for the Low Position in Sample Cup position. These calculated values are displayed in the table (8). - The values are displayed in black if they are within range. - The values are displayed in red if they are out of range.
5 8 10 1
■ If
the adjustment values are correct, press Validate AA (9). The values are then transferred in the Position field for the Low Position in Sample Tube position and for the Low Position in Sample Cup position (10). If not, press Cancel AA (11).
12
7
9
11
■ Deselect the Automatic adjustment check
box (5). ■ Move
the sample arm to its rotation home position as follows: - Select the sample arm Rotation radio button (1) and press Check Home (12).
RAS385G - 52
ARMS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Arms
6.4.5. "Low Position in ISE Tower" Follow this procedure to adjust the sample needle height in the ISE mix cup. The distance between the underside of the sample arm and the top of the ISE mix cup must be 121 mm +/- 0.5.
121 mm +/- 0.5
This adjustment is made automatically proceeding as follows.
Ensure that the sample arm is at its vertical and rotation home position.
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Arms.
■ Select
the sample arm Rotation radio button (1).
5
■ In
the Position scrolling list, select ISE Sample (2).
■ Press
Check Position (3).
■ Press
Motor Off (4).
6
1
■ Select the sample arm Vertical radio button
3
(5).
4
2
■ Select
the Automatic adjustment check box (6). It opens the automatic adjustment function.
■ In
the Reference point scrolling list, select ISE (7).
■ Press
Check Position (3).
■ Then,
use the + and/or - buttons to adjust the position of the "Dummy sample needle". The end of the "Dummy sample needle" must be positioned right above the upper part of the ISE mix cup, this position is used as vertical reference position. - + = Increase the number of steps to move the sample arm down. - - = Decrease the number of steps to move the sample arm up.
Technical Manual RAA023
ARMS
7
3
RAS385G - 53
Arms
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Take care of the shock detection. It should not be activated otherwise the adjustment won’t be correct.
■ Press
Measure height (8). The "Dummy sample needle" moves to its vertical home position measuring the number of steps between the 2 positions. This measured number of steps is added to an offset to calculate the value for the Low Position in ISE Tower position. This calculated value is displayed in the table (9). - The value is displayed in black if it is within range. - The value is displayed in red if it is out of range.
6 9 11
8
■ If
the adjustment value is correct, press Validate AA (10). The value is then transferred in the Position field for the Low Position in ISE Tower position (11). If not, press Cancel AA (12).
10
12
■ Deselect the Automatic adjustment check
box (6). ■ Check
the position as follows: - In the Position scrolling list, select Low Position in ISE Tower (13). - Press Check Position (3) and check the "Dummy sample needle" height in the ISE mix cup.
5 13
■ Move
the sample arm to its vertical and rotation home position as follows: - Select the sample arm Vertical radio button (5) and press Check Home (14). - Select the sample arm Rotation radio button (1) and press Check Home (14).
■
1 14
3
Remove the "Dummy sample needle" and the "Dummy reagent needle" and put the sample and reagent needles back.
RAS385G - 54
ARMS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Arms
7. Level detection check 7.1.
Reagent arm
The principle of this procedure is to move the reagent arm down until it detects the liquid in the vial.
■ Half-fill ■ Place
a "15 mL vial" with distilled water.
this vial on R1 / A on a reagent rack.
■ Move
the position R1 / A of this reagent rack to the R1 Pos.- Reagent Rack for Reagent Arm position.
R1
To load a reagent rack on the reagent tray and to move the position R1 / A of this reagent rack to the R1 Pos.- Reagent Rack for Reagent Arm position, see RAS380: Reagent tray, page 1.
■ Ensure ■ Ensure
Technical Manual RAA023
that the sample arm is at its vertical and rotation home position. that the reagent arm is at its vertical and rotation home position.
ARMS
RAS385G - 55
Arms
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Arms.
■ Select
the reagent arm Rotation radio button (A).
■ In
the Position scrolling list, select R1 Pos. - Reagent Rack (B).
■ Press
Check Position to move the reagent arm right above the filled vial on the reagent tray (C).
■ Select
the reagent arm Vertical radio button (D).
■ In
the Position scrolling list, select Low Position in Reagent/Cal/Ctrl Rack (E), then note the number of steps corresponding to this position (F).
D E
■ Select the Reagent Detection radio button
F
(G). A
■ Let
the Sensibility field at its default value (= 0). This field is used to set the sensitivity level used during the reagent level detection. See Section 3: Technology, 4.1. Reagent level detection, page 3-22.
B G
the Max Step field, type the number of steps previously noted (H).
J
I
■ In
K
H
C
■ Press
Level detection (I). The reagent arm moves down until the reagent needle touches the water.
■ Make
sure that the Level detection light turns green (J).
■ Move
the reagent arm to its vertical and rotation home position as follows: - Select the reagent arm Vertical radio button (D) and press Check Home (K). - Select the reagent arm Rotation radio button (A) and press Check Home (K).
In case of a problem, see Section 4: Electric and electronic principles, 3.3. Reagent level detection board, page 4-20 to check the reagent level detection board (LEDs state).
RAS385G - 56
ARMS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
7.2.
Arms
Sample arm
The principle of this procedure is to move the sample arm down until it detects the liquid in the vial.
■ Half-fill ■ Place
a "15 mL vial" with distilled water.
this vial on R1 / A on a reagent rack.
■ Move
the position R1 / A of this reagent rack to the R1 Pos.- Reagent Rack for Sample Arm position.
R1
To load a reagent rack on the reagent tray and to move the position R1 / A of this reagent rack to the R1 Pos.- Reagent Rack for Sample Arm position, see RAS380: Reagent tray, page 1.
■ Ensure
that the sample arm is at its vertical and rotation home position. that the reagent arm is in its wash tower. See 5.4.2. "Low Position in Wash Tower", page 32.
■ Ensure
Technical Manual RAA023
ARMS
RAS385G - 57
Arms
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Arms.
■ Select
the sample arm Rotation radio button (1).
■ In
the Position scrolling list, select R1 Pos. - Reagent Rack (2).
■ Press
Check Position to move the sample arm right above the filled vial on the reagent tray (3).
■ Select the sample arm Vertical radio button
(4).
4
■ In
the Position scrolling list, select Low Position in Reagent rack (5), then note the number of steps corresponding to this position (6).
■ Select
5 6
the Sample Detection radio button 1
(7). ■ In
the Max Step field, type the number of steps previously noted (8).
■ Press
Level detection (9). The sample arm moves down until the sample needle touches the water.
2 7 8
11
9
10
3
■ Make
sure that the Level detection light turns green (10).
■ Move
the sample arm to its vertical and rotation home position as follows: - Select the sample arm Vertical radio button (4) and press Check Home (11). - Select the sample arm Rotation radio button (1) and press Check Home (11).
In case of a problem, see Section 4: Electric and electronic principles, 3.2. Sample level detection board XAA486AS (1209108486), page 4-18 to check the sample level detection board.
RAS385G - 58
ARMS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Arms
8. Shock detection check
The shock detection is available for the sample arm only.
The principle of this procedure is to move the sample arm down until it detects the bottom of the vial.
■ Replace ■ Go
the hall-filled vial on the reagent rack with an empty one.
to Services > Diagnostics > Arms.
■ Follow
the same procedure as that for the sample arm level detection but, in the Max Step field, add some steps (100 steps by 100 steps) to the number of steps previously noted (1).
■ Press
Level detection (2). The sample arm moves this number of steps down. - If the needle touches the bottom of the vial before running this number of steps, it will stop and the Shock Detection light turns green (3). - If the needle doesn’t touch the bottom of the vial, the Shock Detection light stays red (3). In this case, it is necessary to add some steps in the Max Step field (1) again and press Level detection (2) again.
■ Put
3 1
2
the covers back.
Technical Manual RAA023
ARMS
RAS385G - 59
Arms
RAS385G - 60
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
ARMS
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS384F
Cuvette changer In this procedure, specific instructions are given for previous ABX Pentra 400 hardware versions: ■ V1 corresponds to instruments with serial numbers below 2000.
RAS384: Cuvette changer
Concerns Cuvette changer racks dismantling Cuvette changer parts replacement Impacted adjustments Adjustments
Required tools Hexagonal keys Torx key Phillips screwdriver TOOL, DYNAMO. SCREWDRIVER A302 MAG019A (1207851019) TOOL, TEST SEGMENT XDA893A (1209131893)
Required products None
Intervention time N/A
Frequency On request
Specific kit or consumables Cuvette segments
Disposable gloves, eye protections and a lab coat must be worn by the operator. Local or national regulations must be applied in all the operations.
Cuvette changer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
1. Cuvette changer racks dismantling
In order not to damage the needles during dismantling, disable the arms (vertical and rotation movements) and put them on a sample cup rack over the reagent tray as shown on the following picture.
■ Switch
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
■ Remove
the covers (see RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1): - Open the arms main cover. - Remove the loader cover, the cuvettes hatch, the connection hatch and the cuvettes cover. - Lift the mixer assembly up by pressing the red button. - Remove the optic hatch, the left arm cover, the cuvettes tray plate and the mixer plate.
■ Remove
the unload rack.
■ Remove
the load rack as follows: - Open the 2 adhesive collars and release the wires of the "rack used segment full" sensor. - Disconnect the "rack used segment full" sensor (C19) and unscrew the 6 CHC screws.
"rack used segment full" sensor
RAS384F - 2
CUVETTE CHANGER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Cuvette changer
- Disconnect the ground wire. - Open the adhesive collar and release the wires of the "new segment available" sensor. It is not necessary to disconnect this connector because the wires are long enough to put the load rack close to the instrument.
"new segment available" sensor
- Lightly lift the load rack up to disconnect the cuvette motion motor (M32) and the cuvette motion home sensor (C37), located under the load rack. - Remove the load rack.
On the instruments equipped with centering pins on the load rack support, the readjusting is not mandatory. For the other instruments: see 3. Impacted adjustments, page 30.
■ Remove
the reaction tray cover by unscrewing the 3 CHC screws and washers.
Technical Manual RAA023
CUVETTE CHANGER
RAS384F - 3
Cuvette changer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
2. Cuvette changer parts replacement 2.1.
Cuvette changer
2.1.1. Home sensors replacement Horizontal home sensor
To know which adjustments have to be performed after parts replacement: see 3. Impacted adjustments, page 30.
■ Switch
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
■ Remove
the rear plate by unscrewing the 6 CHC screws to access the cuvette changer horizontal home sensor.
■ Cut
the Ty-Rap™ maintaining the motor wires and the home sensor wires.
■ Disconnect the motor connector (A) and the
C A
motor/home sensor connector (B). ■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws to remove the home sensor and its wires (C). B
■ Replace
the home sensor and reassemble in reverse order.
■ Make
sure that the home flag passes in the middle of the home sensor and does not touch the home sensor.
RAS384F - 4
CUVETTE CHANGER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Cuvette changer
Vertical sensors
To know which adjustments have to be performed after parts replacement: see 3. Impacted adjustments, page 30.
■ Switch
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
■ Remove
the covers (see RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1): - Open the arms main cover. - Remove the loader cover, the cuvettes hatch, the connection hatch and the cuvettes cover.
■ Replace the cuvette changer vertical sensor (home and/or low position) by following the corresponding
procedure. 1. Vertical home sensor
■ Cut
the Ty-Rap™ maintaining the wires of the "new segment available" sensor.
■ Disconnect
A
the home sensor connector
(C17). ■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws to remove the home sensor and its wires (A).
■ Replace
the home sensor and reassemble in reverse order. C17
2. Vertical low position sensor
■ Cut
the Ty-Rap™ maintaining the wires of the vertical low position sensor.
■ Disconnect
the low position sensor connector (C61).
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws to remove the low position sensor and its wires (A).
C61
■ Replace
the home sensor and reassemble in reverse order.
■ Replace
the low position sensor and reassemble in reverse order. A
When reassembling, fasten the low position sensor in its lowest position.
Technical Manual RAA023
CUVETTE CHANGER
RAS384F - 5
Cuvette changer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
2.1.2. Horizontal motor replacement
To know which adjustments have to be performed after parts replacement: see 3. Impacted adjustments, page 30.
■ Switch
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
■ Remove
the rear plate by unscrewing the 6 CHC screws to access the cuvette changer horizontal motor.
motor connector ■ Disconnect ■ Unscrew
the motor connector.
the 2 CHC screws to remove the
motor. ■ Replace
the motor and reassemble in reverse order. motor screws
When reassembling, take care that the motor connector is correctly positioned.
RAS384F - 6
CUVETTE CHANGER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Cuvette changer
■ Adjust
the belt tensioner screw as follows: - Loosen the 2 CHC screws of the belt support. - Loosen the belt tensioner screw, then turn it at 90 mN.m (not for ABX Pentra 400 V1) with a dynamometric screwdriver. - Tighten the 2 CHC screws of the belt support.
belt support screws
belt tensioner screw
2.1.3. Vertical motor replacement
To know which adjustments have to be performed after parts replacement: see 3. Impacted adjustments, page 30.
General procedure ■ Switch
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
■ Remove
the covers (see RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1): Remove the loader cover, the cuvettes hatch, the connection hatch and the cuvettes cover.
■ Remove ■
the unload rack.
Remove the rear plates by unscrewing the 14 CHC screws to access the cuvette changer vertical motor.
Technical Manual RAA023
CUVETTE CHANGER
RAS384F - 7
Cuvette changer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
V5 V4
■ Dismantle
the manifold as follows: - Disconnect the valves 3, 4 and 5 of the manifold, at the rear of the instrument.
V3
- Unscrew the 4 CHC screws and remove the manifold.
■ Disconnect
the motor connector (M15).
■ Unscrew the 2 CHC screws maintaining the
motor.
RAS384F - 8
CUVETTE CHANGER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Cuvette changer
■ Release
the motor and the endless screw as follows: - Block the grabber carriage up with one hand. - With the other hand, release the endless screw from the cuvette changer assembly by turning the endless screw clockwise.
2 - Remove the motor and the endless screw.
1
motor connector position ■ Replace
the motor and the endless screw and reassemble in reverse order.
■ Take ■ Take
Technical Manual RAA023
care that the motor connector is correctly positioned. care not to clamp the tubings when reassembling the manifold.
CUVETTE CHANGER
RAS384F - 9
Cuvette changer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Specific procedure ABX Pentra 400 V1 ■ Switch
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
■ Remove
the covers (see RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1): Remove the loader cover, the cuvettes hatch, the connection hatch and the cuvettes cover.
■ Remove
the unload rack.
■ Remove
the rear plates by unscrewing the 14 CHC screws to access the cuvette changer vertical
motor.
V5 V4
■ Dismantle
the manifold as follows: - Disconnect the valves 3, 4 and 5 of the manifold, at the rear of the instrument.
V3
- Unscrew the 4 CHC screws and remove the manifold.
RAS384F - 10
CUVETTE CHANGER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Cuvette changer
■ Loosen
the upper screw of the motor/ endless screw coupling.
■ Disconnect
the motor connector (M15) and unscrew the 2 CHC screws maintaining the motor.
■ Remove
the motor assembly taking care not to drop the endless screw down.
■ Replace
the motor assembly and reassemble in reverse order.
■ Ensure that you tighten the upper screw of the motor/endless screw coupling in the endless
screw notch. care that the motor connector is correctly positioned. ■ Take care not to clamp the tubings when reassembling the manifold. ■ Take
Technical Manual RAA023
CUVETTE CHANGER
RAS384F - 11
Cuvette changer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
2.1.4. Silent blocks replacement
To know which adjustments have to be performed after parts replacement: see 3. Impacted adjustments, page 30.
■ Switch
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
■ Remove
the covers (see RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1): - Open the arms main cover. - Remove the loader cover.
■ Remove ■ Check
the unload rack.
if the cuvette changer carriage assembly has two or four silent blocks.
4 silent blocks
2 silent blocks
■ If
the cuvette changer carriage assembly already has four silent blocks, replace them by referring to the General procedure: four silent blocks, page 12. ■ If the cuvette changer carriage assembly has only two silent blocks, you must install the whole KIT, SILENT BLOCK CARRIAGE ASSY XEC205AS (1209179205) by referring to the Specific procedure: two silent blocks, page 13.
General procedure: four silent blocks
■ Unscrew the 4 CHC screws M3x6 of the nut
support.
RAS384F - 12
CUVETTE CHANGER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Lift
Cuvette changer
up the nut support.
■ Unscrew
the 4 silent blocks to replace
them.
Specific procedure: two silent blocks ■ Remove
the mother board cover. See RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1. B
■ Unscrew
the left screw of the main cover switch support and loosen the right screw.
■ Turn
the main cover switch support (A) to access the 2 screws of the cuvette changer upper plate.
■ Unscrew
the 2 screws of the cuvette changer upper plate (B).
A
J20
■ Disconnect
the cuvette changer horizontal motor from the mother board (J20).
■ Cut
the Ty-Rap™ maintaining the motor wires and release the wires.
Technical Manual RAA023
CUVETTE CHANGER
RAS384F - 13
Cuvette changer
■ Open
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
the adhesive collar (A).
■ Disconnect
the connector of the "new segment available" sensor (B).
B
C
■ Disconnect
the 2 connectors of the "rack used segment in position" sensor (C).
free connector
A
When reassembling, take care to the position of the 2 connectors of the "rack used segment in position" sensor.
C ■ Cut
the Ty-Rap™ maintaining the wires of both vertical sensors (A).
■ Disconnect
the 2 vertical sensors (B).
■ Cut
the 3 Ty-Raps™ maintaining the cuvette changer strand.
■ Open the adhesive collar (C) and release the
B
strand from the cuvette changer course. A
■ Unscrew
the 5 screws of the cuvette changer upper plate.
RAS384F - 14
CUVETTE CHANGER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Cuvette changer
■ Unscrew
the 3 screws of the cuvette changer upper plate and remove the plate.
■ Remove
the cuvette changer carriage assembly.
■ Unscrew
the 3 CHC screws M4x6 of the carriage assembly plate.
■ Unscrew
the 3 CHC screws M3x6 of the grabber rail.
■ Separate
the carriage assembly plate from the carriage assembly block.
Technical Manual RAA023
CUVETTE CHANGER
RAS384F - 15
Cuvette changer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Remove
the two angle brackets from the carriage assembly block.
A
B
■ Unscrew
the 3 CHC screws of the nut (A) and remove it from its support.
■ Unscrew the 2 CHC screws of the anti-twist
bearing (B) and remove it from the carriage assembly block.
■
Take the new carriage assembly block (provided in the KIT, SILENT BLOCK CARRIAGE ASSY XEC205AS (1209179205)). - Fasten the 4 new silent blocks. - Take the new nut support and install the nut in its support. - Reassemble the nut and its support without tightening the support on the new carriage assembly block. - Reassemble the anti-twist bearing without tightening it. - Reassemble in reverse order the two angle brackets and the carriage assembly plate.
■ Reassemble ■ Manually ■ Now,
RAS384F - 16
in reverse order the cuvette changer carriage assembly.
move the cuvette changer carriage assembly in low position.
tighten the 4 CHC screws M3x6 of the nut support and the anti-twist bearing.
CUVETTE CHANGER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Cuvette changer
2.1.5. Grabber rail + carriage replacement
To know which adjustments have to be performed after parts replacement: see 3. Impacted adjustments, page 30.
Specific ABX Pentra 400 V1 To replace the grabber rail + carriage on the ABX Pentra 400 V1, you have to replace the complete grabber assembly by following the procedure Specific procedure ABX Pentra 400 V1, page 19.
General procedure ■
Follow the cuvette changer racks dismantling procedure. See 1. Cuvette changer racks dismantling, page 2.
■ Loosen
the 2 CHC screws maintaining the grabber on the belt.
■ Unscrew the 4 CHC screws maintaining the
grabber on its rail.
■ Unscrew
the 3 CHC screws of the grabber rail and remove the rail with its carriage.
In order not to lose the balls, never remove the carriage from the rail.
Technical Manual RAA023
CUVETTE CHANGER
RAS384F - 17
Cuvette changer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Replace
and reassemble in reverse order the grabber rail as follows: - Take care to the position of the rail: the end of the rail must be at the level of the end stop. - Push on the middle of the rail (as indicated by the arrow on the picture) when tightening the 3 CHC screws to respect the balance.
■ Reassemble
RAS384F - 18
end stop
in reverse order.
CUVETTE CHANGER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Cuvette changer
Specific procedure ABX Pentra 400 V1 ■ Follow
the cuvette changer racks dismantling procedure. See 1. Cuvette changer racks dismantling,
page 2.
Torx screw of grabber rail ■ Unscrew the 2 CHC screws maintaining the
horizontal home flag on the grabber.
Torx screw of grabber rail ■ Unscrew
the 2 Torx screws of the grabber rail and remove the grabber assembly (grabber + rail + carriage).
■ Dismantle ■ Replace
the horizontal home flag from the new grabber assembly.
the grabber assembly and reassemble in reverse order.
When reassembling, take care to the position of the rail: the end of the rail must be at the level of the plate.
Technical Manual RAA023
CUVETTE CHANGER
RAS384F - 19
Cuvette changer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
2.1.6. Grabber spring replacement
To know which adjustments have to be performed after parts replacement: see 3. Impacted adjustments, page 30.
■ Switch
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
■ Remove
the covers (see RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1): - Open the arms main cover. - Remove the loader cover.
■ Remove
the unload rack.
■ Remove the circlip by pushing up the finger
and using a flat screwdriver. circlip
■ Release
the finger from the grabber and replace the spring.
■ Reassemble
finger
in reverse order.
2.1.7. Cuvette changer replacement
To know which adjustments have to be performed after parts replacement: see 3. Impacted adjustments, page 30.
Specific ABX Pentra 400 V1 To replace the cuvette changer on the ABX Pentra 400 V1, you have to replace the complete cuvette changer assembly by using the cuvette changer update kit. ■
Follow the cuvette changer racks dismantling procedure. See 1. Cuvette changer racks dismantling, page 2.
■ Remove
the mother board cover (see RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1) to access the "main cover closed" sensor.
■ Remove
the "main cover closed" sensor with its support by unscrewing the 2 CHC screws of its support.
RAS384F - 20
CUVETTE CHANGER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Cuvette changer
■ Remove
the rear plate by unscrewing the 6 CHC screws to access the cuvette changer horizontal motor.
■ Cut
the Ty-Rap™ maintaining the motor wires and the home sensor wires.
A
■ Disconnect the motor connector (A) and the
motor/home sensor connector (B). B
■ Disconnect
the cuvette changer vertical motor connector (M15).
■ Disconnect
the 2 connectors of the "rack used segment in position" sensor. Then, unscrew the left CHC screw and loosen the right one to release the "rack used segment in position" sensor.
free connector
Technical Manual RAA023
CUVETTE CHANGER
RAS384F - 21
Cuvette changer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
When reassembling, take care to the position of the 2 connectors of the "rack used segment in position" sensor.
A
A
A
A
A
■ Disconnect
the 2 vertical sensors (C17 and
C61).
C17
■ Cut
the 4 Ty-Raps™ maintaining the cuvette changer strand.
C61
■ Release
the strand from the cuvette changer course (B).
■ Unscrew the 7 CHC screws maintaining the
cuvette changer on the right plate (A).
A
A
B
Take care to the 2 ground wire supports.
RAS384F - 22
CUVETTE CHANGER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Cuvette changer
A
■ Unscrew
the 2 top CHC screws (A) and the 2 bottom CHC screws (B) maintaining the cuvette changer on the left plate.
B
■ Unscrew
the 3 CHC screws at the rear of the instrument to give play to the cuvette changer and gently lift up the cuvette changer to remove it.
■ Replace
the cuvette changer and reassemble in reverse order.
■ Readjust
Technical Manual RAA023
the switch position of the "rack used segment in position" sensor.
CUVETTE CHANGER
RAS384F - 23
Cuvette changer
2.2.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Cuvette changer racks
2.2.1. Cuvette motion home sensor replacement ■
Follow the cuvette changer racks dismantling procedure. See 1. Cuvette changer racks dismantling, page 2.
■ Turn
the load rack over to access the cuvette motion home sensor.
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws to remove the home sensor and its wires.
■ Replace
the home sensor and reassemble in reverse order.
2.2.2. Cuvette motion motor replacement Specific ABX Pentra 400 V1 ■To replace the cuvette motion motor on ABX Pentra 400 V1, you have to replace the complete load rack assembly by following the procedure Specific procedure ABX Pentra 400 V1, page 25. ■To know which adjustments have to be performed after parts replacement: see 3. Impacted adjustments, page 30.
General procedure ■
Follow the cuvette changer racks dismantling procedure. See 1. Cuvette changer racks dismantling, page 2.
■ Turn
the load rack over to access the cuvette motion motor.
■ Disconnect
the ground wire and unscrew the 4 CHC screws.
RAS384F - 24
CUVETTE CHANGER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Cuvette changer
■ Turn
the load rack over and unscrew the 4 Torx screws to release the cuvette motion motor assembly.
■ Replace
the cuvette motion motor assembly and reassemble in reverse order. When reassembling, first turn the 8 screws without tightening them. Then, tighten the 8 screws.
Specific procedure ABX Pentra 400 V1 ■ Follow
the cuvette changer racks dismantling procedure. See 1. Cuvette changer racks dismantling,
page 2.
■ Dismantle
the two iron corners maintaining the load rack assembly on the cuvette changer by unscrewing the 4 CHC screws.
■ Assemble
the two new iron corners. Do not tighten the screws.
■ Put
the new load rack assembly in place using the centering pins and reconnect the connectors in reverse order.
■ Screw ■ Then,
the load rack assembly on the computer. Do not tighten the screws.
screw the load rack assembly on the iron corners. Do not tighten the screws.
■ Now, tighten the 4 CHC screws maintaining
the iron corners.
Technical Manual RAA023
CUVETTE CHANGER
RAS384F - 25
Cuvette changer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Then, tighten the 6 CHC screws maintaining
the load rack assembly on the computer and the iron corners.
■ Reassemble
in reverse order.
After the load rack assembly replacement, it is necessary to readjust the cuvette changer by following the procedures 4.7. Adjustment of new cuvette segment loading (load rack), page 39 and 4.8. Adjustment of used cuvette segment unloading (unload rack), page 43. Then, check the adjustment by following the procedure 4.9. Adjustment check, page 47.
RAS384F - 26
CUVETTE CHANGER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Cuvette changer
2.2.3. "Rack used segment full" sensor replacement ■
Follow the cuvette changer racks dismantling procedure. See 1. Cuvette changer racks dismantling, page 2. To avoid risk of damage on the sensor connector, disconnect it as follows: ■ Press the clip to move it up (A). ■ Disconnect the male and female part of the connector (B).
B B
A
■ Remove
the 2 black adhesive tapes on the left side of the load rack.
■ Unscrew
the 4 CHC screws and the 5 Torx screws to release the left side of the load rack.
■ Unscrew the 2 CHC screws and remove the
black adhesive tape to remove the sensor and its wires. ■ Replace
the sensor and reassemble in reverse order.
Technical Manual RAA023
CUVETTE CHANGER
RAS384F - 27
Cuvette changer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
2.2.4. "New segment available" sensor replacement ■ Switch
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
■ Remove
covers (see RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1): - Open the arms main cover. - Remove the loader cover, the cuvettes hatch, the connection hatch and the cuvettes cover.
■ Open
the adhesive collar and release the wires of the "new segment available" sensor (A).
■ Disconnect
the "new segment available" sensor (C38).
B
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws to remove the sensor and its wires (B). C38
A
To avoid risk of damage on the sensor connector, disconnect it as follows: ■ Press the clip to move it up (A). ■ Disconnect the male and female part of the connector (B).
B B
A ■ Replace
the sensor and reassemble in reverse order. The connectors of the "rack used segment full" sensor (C19) and the "new segment available" sensor (C38) have been modified. ■ In ABX Pentra 400 V1: it is necessary to use the "Cable, adaptor sensor rack" (provided in the sensor kit) to connect the sensor to the right cable (linked to the mother board). ■ If
the instrument has a serial number anterior to #133: before installing the adaptor, it is mandatory to replace the 4 points connectors C19 (for the unload rack) and C38 (for the load rack) by new ones with 3 points. Proceed as follows: - Disconnect the male and female parts of the connector. - Replace the 4 points female connector by the new 3 points connector (provided in the sensor kit): Connect the first pin (which was in position 1 on the 4 points connector) in position 1 on the new connector. Connect the second pin in position 2. Do not disconnect the third pin. Connect the fourth pin in position 3. Cut the third wire end: cut the 4 points female connector. See picture on next page. - Reconnect the male and female parts of the connector.
RAS384F - 28
CUVETTE CHANGER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Cuvette changer
3 points connector
pos.3 pos.2 pos.1
3rd pin pos.4 pos.3 pos.2 pos.1 4 points connector
Technical Manual RAA023
CUVETTE CHANGER
RAS384F - 29
Cuvette changer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
3. Impacted adjustments
Replaced spare parts Impacted adjustments
Horizontal Vertical Vertical low Horizontal Vertical Silent Home Home position motor motor blocks sensor sensor sensor
Grabber Cuvette Grabber rail + changer spring Carriage complete
Rack new segment dismantling
Reaction tray Automatic Loading Reaction tray cover (for needles)
X X
X
X
X
X
X
Cuvette changer horizontal Backward Position in Reaction Tray
X
X
X
X
Load in Reaction Tray Position
X
X
X
X
Taking New Segment Pos
X
X
X
X
V1 only
Load Used Segment Position
X
X
X
X
V1 only
Cuvette changer vertical Used Cuvette Holder Position
X
X
X
X
V1 only
New Cuvette Holder Position
X
X
X
X
V1 only
Pause Position Above Reaction Tray
X
X
X
X
Low Position on Reaction Tray
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Grabber adjustment
RAS384F - 30
CUVETTE CHANGER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Cuvette changer
4. Adjustments
Recommendations for use: When you adjust a position of the cuvette changer by changing the number of steps for this position, please note that: - for the horizontal motion, a change of 130 steps is approximately equal to a move of 1 mm. - for the vertical motion, a change of 530 steps is approximately equal to a move of 1 mm.
Follow the procedures 4.2. "Test segment Pentra 400" installation, page 32 and 4.3. Grabber mechanical adjustment, page 33 before proceeding to the adjustments.
When you adjust a position by changing the number of steps for this position, press Check Home, then check the position again (press Check Position) to validate and save the new adjustment.
4.1.
Introduction
The following procedure is used to adjust the cuvette segment loading/unloading mechanism and the different grabber positions:
- Reaction tray adjustment ■ Automatic
Loading position: Reaction tray cuvette segment loading/unloading position.
- Grabber horizontal positions adjustment ("Horizontal Motions") ■ Load ■
in Reaction Tray Position position: Cuvette segment loading in the reaction tray.
Backward Position in Reaction Tray position: Grabber back position to release a cuvette segment in the reaction tray.
■ Taking ■ Load
New Segment Pos position: New cuvette segment loading (load rack).
Used Segment Position position: Used cuvette segment unloading (unload rack).
- Grabber vertical positions adjustment ("Vertical Motions") ■ Low
Position on Reaction Tray position: Cuvette segment loading in the reaction tray.
■ Pause ■ New
Position Above Reaction Tray position: Intermediate grabber position above the reaction tray.
Cuvette Holder Position position: New cuvette segment loading (load rack).
■ Used
Cuvette Holder Position position: Used cuvette segment unloading (unload rack).
- Rack rails positions adjustment ■ Load
rack rail position adjustment.
■ Unload
Technical Manual RAA023
rack rail position adjustment.
CUVETTE CHANGER
RAS384F - 31
Cuvette changer
4.2.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
"Test segment Pentra 400" installation
The adjustments of the reaction tray, the grabber horizontal and vertical positions, and the rack rails positions are performed with an adjustment tool: TOOL, TEST SEGMENT XDA893A (1209131893). ■ Connect
the power supply cable and switch the instrument on.
A
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Tray.
■ Disable
the reaction tray as follows: Select the Reaction radio button (A) and press Motor Off (B). B
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Cuvette Changer.
A
C
■ Disable
the cuvette changer vertical and horizontal motors as follows: - Select the Vertical Motions radio button (A) and press Motor Off (B). - Select the Horizontal Motions radio button (C) and press Motor Off (B).
B
■ Install the "Test segment Pentra 400" on the
grabber using a CHC screw (M3x10).
RAS384F - 32
CUVETTE CHANGER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
4.3.
Cuvette changer
Grabber mechanical adjustment
The purpose of this mechanical adjustment is to adjust the grabber orientation in the reaction tray.
Each time you have to manually move the grabber, you must use the endless screw (vertical movement) and the grabber gear wheel (horizontal movement).
■ Loosen the 6 CHC screws of the grabber to
move it freely and adjust it.
Specific ABX Pentra 400 V1 The grabber is maintained by 4 CHC screws for ABX Pentra 400 V1.
■ Manually
move the grabber to insert the "Test segment Pentra 400" into the reaction tray, the tool must be fully inserted but must not be constrained (you can feel a resistance on the endless screw when the tool is constrained).
■ Center the "Test segment Pentra 400" in the
reaction tray and tighten the grabber screws.
Technical Manual RAA023
CUVETTE CHANGER
RAS384F - 33
Cuvette changer
4.4.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Adjustment of reaction tray "Automatic Loading" position
The purpose of this adjustment is to obtain a correct cuvette segment loading in the reaction tray. The adjustment is done by changing the number of steps for the reaction tray Automatic Loading position. ■ Manually
move the grabber to remove the "Test segment Pentra 400" from the reaction tray. A
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Tray.
■ Select
the Reaction radio button (A) and press Check Home (B).
■ Select
the Automatic Loading position (C) and press Check Position (D).
C B
D
■ Manually
move the grabber to insert the "Test segment Pentra 400" in the reaction tray.
■ Adjust the reaction tray position to have the
"Test segment Pentra 400" centered in the tray, by changing the number of steps for the reaction tray Automatic Loading position. - Increase the number of steps to turn the reaction tray clockwise. - Decrease the number of steps to turn the reaction tray anticlockwise.
Before changing the number of steps for the reaction tray Automatic Loading position, manually move the grabber to remove the "Test segment Pentra 400" from the reaction tray.
■ Move
the reaction tray to its home position (press Check Home (B)) then check the position again (press Check Position (D)).
■ Manually
move the grabber to remove the "Test segment Pentra 400" from the reaction tray. B
RAS384F - 34
CUVETTE CHANGER
D
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
4.5.
Cuvette changer
Adjustment of cuvette segment loading into the reaction tray
"Horizontal Motions > Load in Reaction Tray Position" position ■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Cuvette Changer.
■ Select the Vertical Motions radio button (A)
and press Check Home (B). ■ Select
the Horizontal Motions radio button (C) and press Check Home (B).
A
C
■ Select
the Vertical Motions > Pause Position Above Reaction Tray position (D) and press Check Position (E).
D
F
■ Select
the Horizontal Motions > Load in Reaction Tray Position position (F) and press Check Position (E).
B
E
G
■ Disable
the cuvette changer vertical motor as follows: Select the Vertical Motions radio button (A) and press Motor Off (G).
■ Manually
move the grabber downward to insert the "Test segment Pentra 400" in the reaction tray. The "Test segment Pentra 400" must not touch the reaction tray.
■ Adjust
this position to have the "Test segment Pentra 400" centered into the reaction tray, by changing the number of steps for the Horizontal Motions > Load in Reaction Tray Position position. - Increase the number of steps to move the grabber forward. - Decrease the number of steps to move the grabber backwards.
■ Manually
move the grabber upwards to remove the "Test segment Pentra 400" from the reaction tray.
■ Check
this position for each sector of the reaction tray as follows: - Go to Services > Diagnostics > Tray. - Select a sector of the reaction tray (A) and press Check Position (B) to move this sector to the Automatic Loading position. - Manually move the grabber downward to insert the "Test segment Pentra 400" into the reaction tray. - Manually move the grabber upwards to remove the "Test segment Pentra 400" from the reaction tray.
Technical Manual RAA023
CUVETTE CHANGER
A
B
RAS384F - 35
Cuvette changer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
"Vertical Motions > Low Position on Reaction Tray" position ■ Remove ■ Install
the "Test segment Pentra 400" from the grabber.
a cuvette segment on the grabber.
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Cuvette Changer.
■ Select the Vertical Motions radio button (A)
and press Check Home (B).
A
C
■ Select
the Horizontal Motions radio button (C) and press Check Home (B).
D
F
■ Select
the Horizontal Motions > Load in Reaction Tray Position position (F) and press Check Position (E).
■ Select
the Vertical Motions > Low Position on Reaction Tray position (D) and press Check Position (E).
B
E
G
■ The
cuvette segment must be fully inserted but must not be forced by the grabber. The circlip must slightly be raised up (< 1 mm) and the finger must not touch at the top.
circlip
■ Adjust
this position by changing the number of steps for the Vertical Motions > Low Position on Reaction Tray position. - Increase the number of steps to move the grabber downward. - Decrease the number of steps to move the grabber upwards.
RAS384F - 36
CUVETTE CHANGER
< 1 mm
finger
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Cuvette changer
"Horizontal Motions > Backward Position in Reaction Tray" position
■ Select
the Horizontal Motions > Backward Position in Reaction Tray position (A) and press Check Position (B).
A
B
■ The
grabber must release the cuvette segment without touching the reaction tray upper case.
■ Adjust
this position by changing the number of steps for the Horizontal Motions > Backward Position in Reaction Tray position. - Increase the number of steps to move the grabber forward. - Decrease the number of steps to move the grabber backwards.
■ Select
the Horizontal Motions > Load in Reaction Tray Position position (A) and press Check Position (B).
C
A
■ Select
the Vertical Motions radio button (C) and press Check Home (D).
■ Put
the reaction tray cover back.
D
B
Make sure that the reagent and sample needles as well as the mixer paddle do not touch the reaction tray cover.
Technical Manual RAA023
CUVETTE CHANGER
RAS384F - 37
Cuvette changer
4.6.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Adjustment of "Vertical Motions > Pause Position Above Reaction Tray" position
A
E ■ Select
the Horizontal Motions radio button (A) and press Check Home (B).
locating pin
C
■ Select
the Vertical Motions > Pause Position Above Reaction Tray position (C) and press Check Position (D).
B
D
■ Adjust
this position for a gap of 2 mm between the cuvette segment and the reaction tray cover, by changing the number of steps for the Vertical Motions > Pause Position Above Reaction Tray position. - Increase the number of steps to move the grabber downward. - Decrease the number of steps to move the grabber upwards.
2 mm
Make sure that the cuvette segment does not touch the reaction tray cover when you press the cuvette segment down. ■ When
the grabber is in this position, the vertical home flag should not cut the beam of the vertical low position sensor. For this, make sure that the voltage on the connector C61 Pin 1-3 is < 1 V. If not, readjust the position by lightly moving the grabber upwards.
vertical home flag vertical low position sensor C61
RAS384F - 38
CUVETTE CHANGER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Select
the Vertical Motions radio button (E) and press Check Home (B).
■ Remove
4.7.
Cuvette changer
the cuvette segment from the grabber.
Adjustment of new cuvette segment loading (load rack)
Load rack rail adjustment ■ Reassemble ■ Stick
in reverse order the load rack. See 1. Cuvette changer racks dismantling, page 2.
a piece of paper on the "new segment available" sensor to avoid the rail movement.
A ■ Select
the Cuvette Motion radio button (A) and press Check Home (B).
B
■ Loosen
the 6 CHC screws maintaining the load rack on its support.
C
E
■ Disable
the cuvette changer vertical and horizontal motors as follows: - Select the Vertical Motions radio button (C) and press Motor Off (D). - Select the Horizontal Motions radio button (E) and press Motor Off (D). D
Technical Manual RAA023
CUVETTE CHANGER
RAS384F - 39
Cuvette changer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Install the "Test segment Pentra 400"on the
grabber. ■ Manually
move the grabber above the load
rack rail. ■ Adjust the load rack so that the rail does not
touch the "Test segment Pentra 400".
3
1
5
6
4
2
■ Once
the load rack is adjusted, tighten the 6 CHC screws maintaining the load rack on its support by following the order of screws indicated on the picture.
RAS384F - 40
CUVETTE CHANGER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Cuvette changer
"Vertical Motions > New Cuvette Holder Position" position
■ Select
the Horizontal Motions radio button (A) and press Check Home (B).
A
C
■ Select
the Vertical Motions radio button (C) and press Check Home (B).
D
■ Select
the Vertical Motions > New Cuvette Holder Position position (D) and press Check Position (E).
E
B
F
After a Vertical Motions > Check Home, the grabber moves to the Vertical Motions > New Cuvette Holder Position position, then the grabber does not move when you select the Vertical Motions > New Cuvette Holder Position position and press Check Position.
■ Disable
the cuvette changer horizontal motor as follows: Select the Horizontal Motions radio button (A) and press Motor Off (F).
■ Manually
move the grabber above the load
rack rail. ■ Adjust
this position to have the end of the load rack rail aligned with the upper mark of the "Test segment Pentra 400", by changing the number of steps for the Vertical Motions > New Cuvette Holder Position position. - Increase the number of steps to move the grabber downward. - Decrease the number of steps to move the grabber upwards.
A
C ■ Select
the Horizontal Motions radio button (A) and press Check Home (B).
■ Select
the Vertical Motions radio button (C) and press Check Home (B). B
Technical Manual RAA023
CUVETTE CHANGER
RAS384F - 41
Cuvette changer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
"Horizontal Motions > Taking New Segment Pos" position ■ Remove ■ Install
the "Test segment Pentra 400" from the grabber.
a cuvette segment on the load rack, in position to be loaded by the grabber.
■ Select
the Horizontal Motions radio button (A) and press Check Home (B).
■ Select
the Vertical Motions radio button (C) and press Check Home (B).
A
C
D
■ Select
the Vertical Motions > New Cuvette Holder Position position (D) and press Check Position (E).
■ Select
the Horizontal Motions > Taking New Segment Pos position (F) and press Check Position (E).
F
E
B
■ Make
sure that the grabber is against the cuvette segment and adjust this position for a gap of 0 to 0.1 mm between the load rack rail and the cuvette segment, by changing the number of steps for the Horizontal Motions > Taking New Segment Pos position. - Increase the number of steps to move the grabber forward. - Decrease the number of steps to move the grabber backwards.
■ Select
the Horizontal Motions radio button (A) and press Check Home (B).
A
C
■ Select
the Vertical Motions radio button (C) and press Check Home (B).
■ Remove
the cuvette segment from the load
rack.
RAS384F - 42
B
CUVETTE CHANGER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
4.8.
Cuvette changer
Adjustment of used cuvette segment unloading (unload rack)
Unload rack rail adjustment ■ Install
the "Test segment Pentra 400" on the grabber.
■ Loosen
the 2 CHC screws of the locating
pin. ■ Put
the unload rack back.
■ Tighten
the 2 CHC screws of the locating
pin.
A
C
■ Disable
the cuvette changer vertical and horizontal motors as follows: - Select the Vertical Motions radio button (A) and press Motor Off (B). - Select the Horizontal Motions radio button (C) and press Motor Off (B). B
■ Loosen
the 3 CHC screws maintaining the unload rack rail.
Technical Manual RAA023
CUVETTE CHANGER
RAS384F - 43
Cuvette changer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Manually
move the grabber above the unload rack rail.
■ Adjust
the unload rack rail so that the rail does not touch the "Test segment Pentra 400".
1 ■ Once
the unload rack rail is adjusted, tighten the 3 CHC screws maintaining the unload rack rail by following the order of screws indicated on the picture.
2
■ Check
the adjustment by manually moving the grabber back and forth above the unload rack rail. 3
RAS384F - 44
CUVETTE CHANGER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Cuvette changer
"Vertical Motions > Used Cuvette Holder Position" position ■ Select
the Horizontal Motions radio button (A) and press Check Home (B).
■ Select
the Vertical Motions radio button (C) and press Check Home (B).
A
C
■ Select
the Vertical Motions > Used Cuvette Holder Position position (D) and press Check Position (E).
D
F
■ Disable
the cuvette changer horizontal motor as follows: Select the Horizontal Motions radio button (A) and press Motor Off (G).
E
B
G
■ Manually
move the grabber above the unload rack rail.
■ Adjust
this position to have the end of the unload rack rail aligned with the lower mark of the "Test segment Pentra 400", by changing the number of steps for the Vertical Motions > Used Cuvette Holder Position position. - Increase the number of steps to move the grabber downward. - Decrease the number of steps to move the grabber upwards.
A
C ■ Select
the Horizontal Motions radio button (A) and press Check Home (B).
■ Select
the Vertical Motions radio button (C) and press Check Home (B). B
Technical Manual RAA023
CUVETTE CHANGER
RAS384F - 45
Cuvette changer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
"Horizontal Motions > Load Used Segment Position" position ■ Remove ■ Install
the "Test segment Pentra 400" from the grabber.
a cuvette segment on the unload rack.
C
A ■ Disable
the cuvette changer vertical and horizontal motors as follows: - Select the Vertical Motions radio button (A) and press Motor Off (B). - Select the Horizontal Motions radio button (C) and press Motor Off (B). B
■ Manually
move the grabber so that the grabber moves between 2 cuvettes without rubbing.
grabber between 2 cuvettes
If you cannot do this preliminary adjustment correctly, readjust the unload rack rail. See Unload rack rail adjustment, page 43.
■ Select
the Horizontal Motions radio button (C) and press Check Home (D).
C
A
■ Select
the Horizontal Motions > Load Used Segment Position position (E) and press Check Position (F).
E
■ Push
the cuvette segment against the grabber.
■ Select
the Horizontal Motions radio button (C) and press Check Home (D).
RAS384F - 46
CUVETTE CHANGER
D
F
B
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Cuvette changer
■ Adjust
this position for a gap of 2.5 mm between the end of the unload rack rail and the cuvette segment, by changing the number of steps for the Horizontal Motions > Load Used Segment Position position. - Increase the number of steps to move the grabber forward. - Decrease the number of steps to move the grabber backwards.
■ Remove
the cuvette segment from the unload rack.
If the gap between the end of the unload rack rail and the cuvette segment is higher than 2.5 mm, the unload rack will not be able to store 30 cuvette segments.
4.9.
Adjustment check ■ Remove
the piece of paper on the "new segment available" sensor.
■ Select
the Horizontal Motions radio button (A) and press Check Home (B).
A
C
D
■ Select
the Vertical Motions radio button (C) and press Check Home (B).
■ Select the
Cuvette Motion radio button (D) and press Check Home (B).
B
A ■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Tray.
■ Disable
the reaction tray as follows: Select the Reaction radio button (A) and press Motor Off (B).
■ Make sure that there
is no cuvette segment in the reaction tray. If necessary, manually remove the cuvette segments.
■ Select
the Reaction radio button (A) and press Check Home (C).
Technical Manual RAA023
CUVETTE CHANGER
C
B
RAS384F - 47
Cuvette changer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Check
the adjustments by loading and unloading a cuvette segment in each sector of the reaction tray as follows: - Go to Services > Diagnostics > Cuvette Changer. - Select the Segment radio button. - Select a sector of the reaction tray and press Load. - Check if the cuvette segment loading is correct, then press Unload. - Check if the cuvette segment unloading is correct.
■ Repeat
the procedure above for each sector of the reaction tray.
Repeat the adjustment check procedure above several times.
■ If
there is no problem during the cycles, put the covers back.
RAS384F - 48
CUVETTE CHANGER
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS392G
Internal computer
RAS392: Internal computer
Concerns Computer dismantling Ferrites installation (for computer models from "CCC014H") Computer parts replacement
Required tools Hexagonal keys Open-end wrench Flat screwdriver Phillips screwdriver KIT, ANTISTATIC KIT MZZ015A (1207921015)
Required products None
Intervention time 1 h 00
Frequency On request
Specific kit or consumables None
Disposable gloves, eye protections and a lab coat must be worn by the operator. Local or national regulations must be applied in all the operations.
Internal computer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
1. Computer dismantling ■ Switch
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
■ Remove
the covers (see RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1): - Open the arms main cover and the ISE cover. - Remove the external and internal sample covers, the power supply cover and the optic hatch.
- Lift the mixer up, then unscrew the 2 CHC screws of the left arm cover. - Remove the cuvettes tray plate, the reagent cover, the cuvettes hatch, the connection hatch and the cuvettes cover.
■ Open
the computer fan box as follows: Slightly loosen the 4 screws and remove the cover.
■ Unscrew
the 3 CHC screws and washers inside the computer fan box, remove the deflector PC/BO and remove the blue tube from the computer fan box.
■ Disconnect
RAS392G - 2
the mouse and the keyboard as well as the other computer connections.
COMPUTER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Internal computer
■ Unscrew the 3 CHC screws under the frame
and the 2 CHC screws maintaining the load rack of the cuvette changer.
■ Carefully
pull, then lift the computer assembly.
■ Unscrew
the CHC screw and washer maintaining the power supply cable.
Computer models from 1300013734
1
2
3
■ Disconnect
the power supply cable (1), the mother board cable (2), the RS232 cable (3) and, if necessary, the printer cable (4).
■ Then,
remove the computer assembly.
Computer models < 1300013734 1
2
3
4
For computer models from "CCC014H", please ensure that the power supply cable is equipped with two ferrites (one close to the computer assembly and another close to the power supply). See 2. Ferrites installation (for computer models from "CCC014H"), page 5.
Technical Manual RAA023
COMPUTER
RAS392G - 3
Internal computer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Dismantle
the computer fan box as follows: Unscrew the 2 CHC screws and washers and remove the computer fan box.
■ Unscrew
the 6 CHC screws, then remove the computer assembly from its cover.
■ Reassemble
in reverse order.
Be very careful when you put back the cover of the computer fan box because you can touch/ disconnect the little board, shown on the following picture, with the cover (depending on the computer model).
Please note that computer models from 1300013734 are no longer equipped with PS/2 ports (mouse, keyboard) or parallel port (printer). All the peripherals (mouse, keyboard, printer) should be connected into the USB ports.
RAS392G - 4
COMPUTER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Internal computer
2. Ferrites installation (for computer models from "CCC014H") ■ Switch
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
■ Remove
the covers (see RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1): - Open the arms main cover and the ISE cover. - Remove the external and internal sample covers, the power supply cover and the optic hatch.
- Lift the mixer up, then unscrew the 2 CHC screws of the left arm cover. - Remove the cuvettes tray plate, the reagent cover, the cuvettes hatch, the connection hatch and the cuvettes cover.
2.1.
Ferrite installation close to the computer assembly ■ Follow ■ Install
the computer dismantling procedure. See 1. Computer dismantling, page 2.
one ferrite on the power supply cable as follows:
You can find two types of power supply cables: - new shielded power supply cable - old unshielded power supply cable.
■ New
shielded power supply cable - Open the ferrite. - Place the power supply cable in the ferrite. - Make a loop with the power supply cable, then close the ferrite.
Technical Manual RAA023
COMPUTER
ferrite
RAS392G - 5
Internal computer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Old
unshielded power supply cable - Open the ferrite. - Place the power supply cable in the ferrite, then close the ferrite.
2.2.
ferrite
Ferrite installation close to the power supply
■ Disconnect
the power supply connector from the power supply.
If needed, to access the power supply cable, dismantle the power supply by referring to the procedure RAS390: Power supply replacement, page 1.
■ Find
the cable connected to the computer assembly.
■ Install
one ferrite on the power supply cable as follows:
You can find two types of power supply cables: - new shielded power supply cable - old unshielded power supply cable.
RAS392G - 6
COMPUTER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Internal computer
■ New
shielded power supply cable - Open the ferrite. - Place the power supply cable in the ferrite. - Make a loop with the power supply cable, then close the ferrite.
ferrite
■ Old
unshielded power supply cable - Open the ferrite. - Place the power supply cable in the ferrite, then close the ferrite.
■ Reconnect ■ Put
ferrite
the power supply connector on the power supply.
the covers back.
Technical Manual RAA023
COMPUTER
RAS392G - 7
Internal computer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
3. Computer parts replacement
As the electronic devices are very sensitive to electrostatic discharges (ESD), the use of an antistatic kit is mandatory during boards handling/dismantling.
As several computer models are available, a label, stuck on the rear plate, allows you to identify the computer model.
This label can be read from the optic hatch opening with the help of a flashlight, without dismantling the computer assembly first.
The table below lists the computer assembly spare parts and indicates their compatibility with the different computer models in the field. since instrument serial #1
Touch screen (separately)
LCD touch screen (complete)
CD-ROM drive
N/A
XAA511BS (1209109511)
N/A
CBT018A
(1209179074)2
CCC014G->H P4-0853
XAA511BS (1209109511)
N/A
CBT018A
CCC014J
P4-2166
XAA511BS (1209109511)
N/A
CCC014K
P4-2349
XAA511BS (1209109511)
CCC014L
P4-3214
CCC014M CCC014N
PC assembly
CCC014A->F
RAS392G - 8
Hard drive XEC074AS
SD RAM board Mother board
Sound amplification board
N/A
N/A
N/A
(1209179074)2
N/A
N/A
N/A
CBT018A
1201772017
N/A
N/A
N/A
N/A
CBT018A
1201772017
N/A
N/A
N/A
XAA511BS (1209109511)
N/A
CBT021A (1201771021)
1201772017
N/A
N/A
N/A
P4-3391
XAA511BS (1209109511)
N/A
CBT021A (1201771021)
1201772017
N/A
N/A
N/A
P4-4000 / C4-0110
XAA511BS (1209109511)
N/A
CBT021A (1201771021)
1201772017
N/A
N/A
N/A
COMPUTER
XEC074AS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
PC assembly
since instrument serial #1 P4-4072 / C4-0473
1300013734
Internal computer
Touch screen (separately)
LCD touch screen (complete)
CD-ROM drive
Hard drive
N/A
XDB355A (1209141355)
N/A
1201772017
SD RAM board Mother board
1300014030
1300023975
Sound amplification board 1300018920
1Please note that the computer assembly may have been changed on the instrument. In this case, do
not take into account the instrument serial # mentioned above. Obsolete when sold out.
2
3.1.
Computer models from 1300013734 ■ Follow
the computer dismantling procedure. See 1. Computer dismantling, page 2.
■ Loosen
the three CHC screws located on the right side (close to the fan).
■ Unscrew
the seven CHC screws, then remove the rear plate.
■ Take care of the USB port cable, disconnect
it.
3.1.1. To dismantle/replace the SD RAM board
A ■ Open
the two latches to free the SD RAM board (A).
B
■ Gently
pull the SD RAM board to disconnect it (B).
A
Technical Manual RAA023
COMPUTER
RAS392G - 9
Internal computer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
3.1.2. To dismantle/replace the mother board
■ Dismantle
the SD RAM board.
■ Disconnect
all the cables from the mother
board. ■ Unscrew
the four CHC screws to remove the mother board.
3.1.3. To dismantle/replace the hard drive
■ Dismantle ■ Unplug
the mother board.
the connector from the hard drive.
■ Unscrew
the four CHC screws to remove the hard drive.
■ The
hard drive is not loaded with the Windows master P400/C400. Therefore, you have to install the Windows master P400/C400 by referring to the procedure RAS533: Windows master installation, page 1. ■ Then, you have to install the software version and the reagent applications by referring respectively to the procedures RAS517: Software version installation, page 1 and RAS518: Reagent applications installation, page 1.
RAS392G - 10
COMPUTER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Internal computer
3.1.4. To dismantle/replace the LCD touch screen
■ Unscrew
the four CHC screws.
■ Unplug
the three connectors at the back of the screen.
Touchscreen calibration (if necessary) ■ Check
that the touchscreen is properly calibrated.
■ If
this is not the case, open C:\Program Files\eGalaxTouch directory and run the eGalaxTouch.exe file.
■ From
the Tools tab, select 4 Points Calibration.
■ Press
OK.
Technical Manual RAA023
COMPUTER
RAS392G - 11
Internal computer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Touch
each of the four corners of the screen to calibrate the touchscreen.
■ Press
Apply, then OK.
Brightness adjustment (if necessary) Touchscreen brightness can be changed in the Windows 7 operating system. If needed: ■ Enter
Control Panel > Hardware and Sound > Power Options.
■ Move
the cursor at the bottom of the screen to change the brightness percentage (from 0% to 100%, default is 45%).
3.2.
Computer models < 1300013734
3.2.1. Hard drive replacement
Please note that: ■ computer models from "CCC014J" are equipped with a SATA hard drive, ■ computer models before "CCC014J" are equipped with an IDE hard drive. ■ Follow
the computer dismantling procedure. See 1. Computer dismantling, page 2.
■ Loosen
the 3 CHC screws located on the right side (close to the fan).
■ Unscrew
the 10 CHC screws, then remove the rear plate.
Loosen
■ Remove
the left angle plate as follows: - Unscrew the 6 CHC screws.
RAS392G - 12
COMPUTER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Internal computer
A
B
- Disconnect the flat cable (A) and the connector CN12 (B, use a flat screwdriver) from the left angle plate.
- Disconnect the audio connector CN2 from the mother board and remove the left angle plate.
Specific computer models before "CCC014H" For computer models before "CCC014H", you cannot disconnect the audio connector from the board. So, you have to unscrew the nut and remove the audio connector from the left angle plate.
■ Remove
the bottom angle plate as follows: - Unscrew the 5 CHC screws.
Technical Manual RAA023
COMPUTER
RAS392G - 13
Internal computer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
- Disconnect the connector (A) and the flat cable (B) from the bottom angle plate, then remove the bottom angle plate. A
B
When you disconnect (or reconnect) the flat cable (B) from the bottom angle plate, take care not to disconnect this flat cable from the daughter board or the daughter board from the mother board.
■ Unscrew
the 4 CHC screws and washers maintaining the "hard drive + CD-ROM drive" assembly. SATA hard drive
IDE hard drive
■ Unscrew the 6 CHC screws and washers maintaining the CD-ROM drive on the hard drive support and disconnect the hard drive connector (A).
■ Unscrew the 6 CHC screws and washers maintaining the CD-ROM drive on the hard drive support.
A
RAS392G - 14
COMPUTER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Internal computer
SATA hard drive
IDE hard drive
■ Turn
the hard drive support over and unscrew the 4 CHC screws to release the hard drive from its support.
■ Turn the hard drive support over, disconnect the flat cable from the CD-ROM drive and unscrew the 4 CHC screws to release the hard drive from its support.
■ Then, disconnect the flat cable from the hard drive.
■ Replace
the hard drive and reassemble in reverse order. When reassembling, do not tighten the different screws too much in order not to damage the hard drive or the CD-ROM drive. For the IDE hard drive, ensure that the flat cable is correctly plugged into the hard drive because 4 pins must be free.
Technical Manual RAA023
COMPUTER
RAS392G - 15
Internal computer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ The
hard drive is not loaded with the Windows master P400/C400. Therefore, you have to install the Windows master P400/C400 by referring to the procedure RAS533: Windows master installation, page 1. ■ Then, you have to install the software version and the reagent applications by referring respectively to the procedures RAS517: Software version installation, page 1 and RAS518: Reagent applications installation, page 1.
WARNING! Take care to clear the way of the 2 fans: no flat cables in front of the fans (overheating risk).
3.2.2. CD-ROM drive replacement ■ Follow
the hard drive replacement procedure to access the CD-ROM drive.
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws to release the CD-ROM drive.
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws to remove the support plate.
RAS392G - 16
COMPUTER
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Internal computer
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC screws to remove the board from the CD-ROM drive (take care not to lose the 2 crosspieces between the CDROM drive and the board).
■ Replace the CD-ROM drive and reassemble
in reverse order.
■ Ensure
that the flat cable is correctly plugged into the hard drive because 4 pins must be free. ■ Do not tighten the different screws too much in order not to damage the hard drive or the CD-ROM drive.
3.2.3. Touch screen replacement Touch screen dismantling ■ Follow
the computer dismantling procedure. See 1. Computer dismantling, page 2.
B
■ Disconnect
the flat cable from the touch screen board as follows: - Pull gently on the black part of the connector (A). - Pull on the flat cable (B).
A
The touch screen is fixed on the screen with 13 copper strips and 4 pieces of tape. ■ Remove ■ Cut
the 13 copper strips.
and remove the 4 pieces of tape.
■ Then,
remove the touch screen.
Technical Manual RAA023
COMPUTER
RAS392G - 17
Internal computer
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
New touch screen installation ■ Clean
the screen and the touch screen with soft paper and 70% alcohol.
■ Remove
any dust from the screen and the touch screen using a dusting spray.
■ Put
the touch screen on the 2 blank supports, the flat cable should be on the right side.
■ Adjust
the touch screen position to have its window centered with regards to the window of the screen. flat cable
■ Fix
the touch screen using the 13 copper strips included in the kit.
■ Reconnect
the flat cable to the touch screen board. blank supports
■ Ensure ■ Do
■ Carefully
that the brown band on the flat cable is in the correct position. not forget to block the connector.
hide the flat cable behind the screen.
■ Reassemble
the computer in reverse order.
Touch screen calibration ■ Connect ■ Go
the power supply cable and switch the instrument on.
to Services > Diagnostics and open the Windows Explorer.
■ Go
to C:\FIDTSERV and launch the calwin.exe file.
A white windows appears, with a red cross in the left upper corner. ■ Press
this cross, it will move to the next position.
■ Press
the red cross for the 9 positions, then press Enter twice. The touch screen is calibrated.
RAS392G - 18
COMPUTER
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS390D
Power supply replacement
RAS390: Power supply replacement
Concerns Power supply replacement Power supply LEDs check
Required tools Hexagonal keys Phillips screwdriver Voltmeter KIT, ANTISTATIC KIT MZZ015A (1207921015)
Required products None
Intervention time 0 h 30
Frequency On request
Specific kit or consumables None
Disposable gloves, eye protections and a lab coat must be worn by the operator. Local or national regulations must be applied in all the operations.
Power supply replacement
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
1. Power supply replacement ■ Switch ■ Open ■
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
the arms main cover.
Remove the sample covers, the power supply cover, the optic hatch and the reagent cover. See RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1.
■ Remove the left gusset plate by unscrewing
the 3 CHC screws on the side and loosening the 4 CHC screws at the rear of the instrument.
■ Unscrew
RAS390D - 2
the 2 CHC back screws.
ELECTRICITY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Power supply replacement
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC front screws (one with metallic collar maintaining the ISE ground wire and the reinforced cable).
■ Remove
the power supply and the recuperation jar stuck to it.
Specific ABX Pentra 400 V1 ABX Pentra 400 V1 are not equipped with a recuperation jar.
■ If
necessary slightly lift the reagent tray up as follows: - Loosen the 2 CHC screws and washers of the left reagent tray foot.
- Loosen the 2 CHC screws (one with washer and one with a ground wire) of the right reagent tray foot. - Carefully lift the reagent tray up.
■ Disconnect,
on the power supply, the three supply connectors.
Technical Manual RAA023
ELECTRICITY
RAS390D - 3
Power supply replacement
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
If the ABX Pentra 400 is not equipped with reinforced power supply cable:
■ Unscrew
the 2 CHC front screws (one with ISE ground wire).
■ Disconnect,
on the power supply, the three supply connectors.
■ Remove
the power supply and the recuperation jar stuck to it.
■ Remove
the recuperation jar from the old power supply.
■ Use
the double-sided adhesive tape stuck on the top of the new power supply to stick the recuperation jar in the same position as on the old power supply.
■ Connect
the three supply connectors.
If the ABX Pentra 400 is not equipped with reinforced power supply cable, connect the three supply connectors after power supply installation.
Reagent tray motor
■ Install
the new power supply with the recuperation jar. The larger part of the recuperation jar is positioned under the reagent tray motor.
■ Reassemble
in reverse order. Recuperation jar
If the reagent tray has been lifted up, check all the centering positions of the reagent and sample arms using the "Reag tray adjusting tool", the "Dummy reagent needle" and the "Dummy sample needle". See RAS385: Arms, page 1.
RAS390D - 4
ELECTRICITY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Power supply replacement
2. Power supply LEDs check
As the electronic devices are very sensitive to electrostatic discharges (ESD), the use of an antistatic kit is mandatory during boards handling/dismantling.
■ Connect
the power supply cable and switch the instrument on.
■ Remove
the mother board cover. See RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1.
■ Check on the mother board that the 4 LEDs
are lit:
Checking LEDs is enough. It is recommended not to check voltages with a voltmeter in order not to damage the board (in fact, the test points are really small and the risk of a shortcut is high). The following voltages are given for information only: - DS 13, - 5 V. - DS 14, + 5 V. - DS 15, VCC (+ 5 V). - DS 16, + 24 V.
Technical Manual RAA023
ELECTRICITY
RAS390D - 5
Power supply replacement
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Ground
■ If
one of the LEDs is not lit, use a voltmeter point to check the corresponding voltage on the connector.
■ Put
the covers back. -5V +5V
RAS390D - 6
ELECTRICITY
+5V
+ 24 V
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS391E
Mother board replacement
RAS391: Mother board replacement
Concerns Parameters backup and software version check Mother board replacement Embedded software version installation Restore parameters Check up
Required tools Hexagonal keys KIT, ANTISTATIC KIT MZZ015A (1207921015)
Required products None
Intervention time 1 h 00
Frequency On request
Specific kit or consumables None
Disposable gloves, eye protections and a lab coat must be worn by the operator. Local or national regulations must be applied in all the operations.
Mother board replacement
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
As the electronic devices are very sensitive to electrostatic discharges (ESD), the use of an antistatic kit is mandatory during boards handling/dismantling.
1. Parameters backup and software version check Before changing the board, to save all mechanical parameters (offset values, stepper motor values, etc.), proceed as follows: ■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics and press Back.
■ When
the following screen appears, click OK. The parameters are saved under D:\Backup\ParamOS9.bin.
Check the software version currently installed on the instrument. At the end of the procedure, you will need to install the same software version.
2. Mother board replacement ■ Switch
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
■ Remove
the mother board cover. See RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1.
■ Carefully
disconnect all the connectors from the mother board.
■ Unscrew
the 9 CHC M4 screws to remove the board from its plate.
■ Install
the new mother board on the plate and fasten the 9 CHC M4 screws.
■ Connect
all the connectors on the board (see Section 4: Electric and electronic principles, 1.4. Mother board connections, page 4-9).
RAS391E - 2
ELECTRICITY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Mother board replacement
3. Embedded software version installation
It is necessary to reinstall the software version embedded on the mother board (flash memory Eprom) because the latest software version has not been loaded on the new mother board.
■ Connect
the power supply cable and switch the instrument on.
■ After
the boot of the operating system (Windows progress bar), the screen becomes black, then blue. When the screen is blue, press Shift until the Windows login screen appears.
The left Shift key used to skip the automatic logon is no more functional under Windows 7. Press CTRL+ALT+DEL keys to logoff and change current user.
■ Log
in to Windows as administrator with administrator/admin as login/password.
■ Install the software version checked at chapter 1 by following the procedure RAS517: Software version
installation, page 1. ■ Make
sure that the following options are selected, if not select them: Download P400 Eprom Create a desktop icon.
■ When choosing the type of installation, select
Update in order not to lose the configuration (applications, calibrators, controls, settings, etc.) neither the patient results.
■ Shut
down and restart the instrument.
4. Restore parameters To restore all mechanical parameters on the new board, please proceed as follows: ■
At the end of the instrument start, an error message appears which demands to restore the parameters. The following screen appears:
■ Click
Default Restore File. The Default Restore File button allows you to restore the default file: D:\Backup\ParamOS9.bin. This is the last parameters backup file.
Technical Manual RAA023
ELECTRICITY
RAS391E - 3
Mother board replacement
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ It
is possible to select a previous parameters backup file and to do so: - Click Restore File. - Select the backup file you want to restore. - Click Open.
■ When
the following screen appears, click
OK.
■ Click
OK on the following screen. The parameters are restored.
5. Check up ■ After
having restored parameters, it is advisable to check the mechanical adjustments. See RAS378: 6 month maintenance, 6. To check the mechanical adjustments, page 5.
■ Follow
RAS391E - 4
the "Check up after intervention" procedure. See RAS393: Check up after intervention, page 1.
ELECTRICITY
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS394E
Sensors check and adjustment
RAS394: Sensors check and adjustment
Concerns Reagent and sample syringes home sensors Reagent tray home sensor Sample tray home sensor Reaction tray home sensor Mixer assembly motor home sensor "Mixer present switch" Reagent and sample arms home sensors Rack used segment (in position/full) sensors "New segment available" sensor Cuvette motion home sensor Cuvette changer horizontal motions home sensor Cuvette changer vertical motions home sensor "Handling cover cuvette segment closed" sensor "Main cover closed" sensor Needle heating sensor Reaction heating sensor Refrigerated area sensor Inner temperature sensor "Handling cover reagent closed" sensor Water tank empty sensor Waste tank full sensor Sample arm shock detection switch Computer wake up sensor Lamp power standby Lamp power full Low liquid level (cooling unit) Power correct
Required tools Hexagonal keys Flat screwdriver Phillips screwdriver
Disposable gloves, eye protections and a lab coat must be worn by the operator. Local or national regulations must be applied in all the operations.
Sensors check and adjustment
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
1. Reagent and sample syringes home sensors
■ Remove
the rear plate by unscrewing the 4 CHC screws to access the syringes home sensors. No adjustment available.
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Syringe.
sample syringe home sensor
reagent syringe home sensor
A
■ Select
the Reagent radio button (A), then press Check Home to move the reagent syringe to its home position. B
■ Make sure that the Home light (B) becomes
green.
■ Select
the Sample radio button (C), then press Check Home to move the sample syringe to its home position.
■ Make sure that the Home light (D) becomes
green.
RAS394E - 2
ELECTRICITY
C
D
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Sensors check and adjustment
2. Reagent tray home sensor
■ The
reagent tray home sensor is located under the reagent tray. No adjustment available.
A
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Tray.
■ Select
the Reagent radio button (A), then press Check Home to move the reagent tray to its home position.
B
■ Make sure that the Home light (B) becomes
green.
Technical Manual RAA023
ELECTRICITY
RAS394E - 3
Sensors check and adjustment
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
3. Sample tray home sensor
■ The
sample tray home sensor is located under the sample tray. No adjustment available.
A
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Tray.
■ Select
the Sample radio button (A), then press Check Home to move the sample tray to its home position.
B
■ Make sure that the Home light (B) becomes
green.
RAS394E - 4
ELECTRICITY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Sensors check and adjustment
4. Reaction tray home sensor
■ The
reaction tray home sensor is located under the reaction tray. No adjustment available.
A
B ■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Tray.
■ Select
the Reaction radio button (A), then press Check Home to move the reaction tray to its home position.
■ Make sure that the Home light (B) becomes
green.
Technical Manual RAA023
ELECTRICITY
RAS394E - 5
Sensors check and adjustment
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
5. Mixer assembly motor home sensor
■ The
mixer assembly motor home sensor is located at the rear of the mixer assembly, under its cover. No adjustment available.
A ■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Arms.
■ Select
the Mixer radio button (A), then press Check Home to move the mixer to its home position.
B
■ Make sure that the Home light (B) becomes
green.
RAS394E - 6
ELECTRICITY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Sensors check and adjustment
6. "Mixer present switch"
■ Remove
the rear plate by unscrewing the 8 CHC screws to access the "mixer present switch".
■ The "mixer present switch" is located under
the mixer assembly motor home sensor. The "mixer present switch" must be activated when the mixer assembly is in "present" position (i.e. low position).
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Sensors.
■ Manually
pull the mixer assembly up to its high position to deactivate the "mixer present switch".
■ Press
Read Sensor State.
■ Make
sure that the Mixer Present light (A) becomes red.
A
■ Manually push the mixer assembly down to
B
its low position to activate the "mixer present switch". ■ Press
Read Sensor State.
■ Make
sure that the Mixer Present light (B) becomes green.
If one of the positions is not correct, adjust the "mixer present switch" as follows: Unscrew the 2 CHC screws maintaining the switch, then move it up if the mixer assembly is not detected in low position (red light) or move it down if the mixer assembly is detected in high position (green light).
Technical Manual RAA023
ELECTRICITY
RAS394E - 7
Sensors check and adjustment
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
7. Reagent and sample arms home sensors
rotation home sensor ■ The
reagent and sample arms home sensors are located on the arms assembly. No adjustment available. vertical home sensor
■ Make
sure that the reagent arm is in low position in the wash tower before moving the sample arm. ■ Make sure that the sample arm is in its upper position (vertical home position) before moving the reagent arm. ■ Make sure that the sample and reagent arms are in their upper positions (vertical home position) before moving any tray.
■ Go
1
to Services > Diagnostics > Arms.
■ Select the sample arm Vertical radio button
(1), then press Check Home to move the sample arm to its vertical home position.
2
■ Make sure that the Home light (2) becomes
green. ■ Select
the sample arm Rotation radio button (3), then press Check Home to move the sample arm to its rotation home position.
3
■ Make sure that the Home light (4) becomes
green.
RAS394E - 8
4
ELECTRICITY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Sensors check and adjustment
5
■ Select
the reagent arm Vertical radio button (5), then press Check Home to move the reagent arm to its vertical home position.
6
■ Make sure that the Home light (6) becomes
green. ■ Select
the reagent arm Rotation radio button (7), then press Check Home to move the reagent arm to its rotation home position.
7
■ Make sure that the Home light (8) becomes
green.
8
8. Rack used segment (in position/full) sensors
■ The rack used segment sensors are located
A
as follows: A: Rack used segment in position B: Rack used segment full
B ■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Sensors.
■ Remove
the unload rack, then press Read Sensor State.
■ Make sure that the Rack Used Segment In
A
Position and the Rack Used Segment Full lights (A/B) become red. ■ Put
the unload rack back, then press Read Sensor State.
B
■ Make sure that the Rack Used Segment In
Position light (A) becomes green.
Technical Manual RAA023
ELECTRICITY
RAS394E - 9
Sensors check and adjustment
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
If the Rack Used Segment In Position light (A) stays red, it is possible to adjust the switch position as follows: Loosen the 2 CHC screws maintaining the switch, then adjust it. The switch must be activated when the unload rack is in position and deactivated when the rack is not in position. ■ Put
your finger on the "rack used segment full" sensor and press Read Sensor State.
■ Make
sure that the Rack Used Segment Full light (B) becomes green.
The "rack used segment full" sensor depends on the "rack used segment in position" sensor. If the unload rack is not in position, the Rack Used Segment Full light stays red.
9. "New segment available" sensor ■
The "new segment available" sensor is located on the load rack to check the presence of a new segment.
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Sensors.
■ Remove
the unload rack, then empty the load rack of all its cuvette segments.
■ Press
Read Sensor State.
■ Make
sure that the New Segment Available light becomes red.
■ Manually
place a cuvette segment in loading position.
■ Press
Read Sensor State.
■ Make
sure that the New Segment Available light becomes green.
RAS394E - 10
ELECTRICITY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Sensors check and adjustment
"New segment available" sensor adjustment ■ Remove ■ Cross
the unload rack, then empty the load rack of all its cuvette segments.
off the first cuvette of a cuvette segment.
■ Manually
place the cuvette segment in loading position. Place it in its two extreme positions as shown on the following pictures. Extreme position 1
Extreme position 2
Pressure point of cuvette edge
Pressure point of cuvette edge
Cuvette segment
Cuvette segment
Pressure point of cuvette edge
Pressure point of cuvette edge ■ Refer ■
to the beam impact on the two cuvette segment extreme positions.
Using the 2 CHC screws maintaining its support plate (A), adjust the angle of the "new segment available" sensor. The impact points of the beam have to be symmetric regarding to the edge of the cuvette placed in the extreme positions (B). A
B Cuvette
L1 ~ ~ L2 L1
L2
Beam
Technical Manual RAA023
ELECTRICITY
RAS394E - 11
Sensors check and adjustment
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
10. Cuvette motion home sensor
■ The
cuvette motion home sensor is located under the load rack, right behind the motor. No adjustment available.
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Cuvette Changer.
A
■ Select the Cuvette Motion radio button (A),
then press Check Home to move the cuvette motion to its home position. ■ Make sure that the Home light (B) becomes
B
green.
11. Cuvette changer horizontal motions home sensor
■ The
cuvette changer horizontal motions home sensor is located as shown on the following figure. No adjustment available.
RAS394E - 12
ELECTRICITY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Sensors check and adjustment
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Cuvette Changer.
A
■ Select the Horizontal Motions radio button
(A), then press Check Home to move the cuvette changer to its horizontal home position.
B
■ Make sure that the Home light (B) becomes
green.
12. Cuvette changer vertical motions home sensor ■ The
cuvette changer vertical motions home sensor is located as shown on the following picture and is not adjustable. The cuvette changer doesn’t stay in vertical home position (light is red). No check available.
Technical Manual RAA023
ELECTRICITY
RAS394E - 13
Sensors check and adjustment
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
13. "Handling cover cuvette segment closed" sensor
■ The
"handling cover cuvette segment closed" sensor is a switch located under the reaction tray door.
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Sensors.
■ Open
the reaction tray door.
■ Press
Read Sensor State.
■ Make
sure that the Handling Cover Cuvette segment closed light (A) becomes red.
A
■ Close
the reaction tray door, then press Read Sensor State.
■ Make
sure that the Handling Cover Cuvette segment closed light (A) becomes green.
It is possible to adjust the "handling cover cuvette segment closed" sensor by unscrewing the 2 CHC screws maintaining its support plate.
14. "Main cover closed" sensor
■ The
"main cover closed" sensor is a switch located under the main cover.
■ Go
A
to Services > Diagnostics > Sensors.
■ Open
the main cover.
■ Press
Read Sensor State.
■ Make
sure that the Main Cover Closed light (A) becomes red.
■ Close
the main cover, then press Read Sensor State.
■ Make
sure that the Main Cover Closed light (A) becomes green.
It is possible to adjust the "main cover closed" sensor by unscrewing the 2 CHC screws maintaining its support plate.
RAS394E - 14
ELECTRICITY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Sensors check and adjustment
15. Needle heating sensor
■ The needle
heating sensor is located within the reagent needle.
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Heating.
■ In
the Needle Heating area: - the Assigned Value should be adjusted to 37°C - the Current temperature should be 37°C +/- 0.5°C - the light (A) must be green.
Technical Manual RAA023
ELECTRICITY
A
RAS394E - 15
Sensors check and adjustment
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
16. Reaction heating sensor
■ The
reaction heating sensor is located within the reaction tray.
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Heating.
■ In
the Reaction Heating area: - the Assigned Value should be adjusted to 37°C - the Current temperature should be 37°C +/- 0.2°C - the light (A) must be green.
RAS394E - 16
ELECTRICITY
A
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Sensors check and adjustment
17. Refrigerated area sensor
■ The
refrigerated area sensor is located under the reagent tray.
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Heating.
■ In
the Refrigerated Area area: - the Assigned Value should be adjusted to 6°C - the Current temperature should be between 4°C and 10°C - the light (A) must be green.
Technical Manual RAA023
ELECTRICITY
A
RAS394E - 17
Sensors check and adjustment
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
18. Inner temperature sensor
■ The
inner temperature sensor is located on the frame of the instrument, near the arms assembly.
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Heating.
A
■ Check the inner temperature in the Current
field (A).
19. "Handling cover reagent closed" sensor
■ The "handling cover reagent closed" sensor
is a magnetic sensor located in the reagent tray foam. No adjustment available. ■ Go
A
to Services > Diagnostics > Sensors.
■ Open
the reagent cover.
■ Press
Read Sensor State.
■ Make
sure that the Handling Cover Reagent Closed light (A) becomes red.
■ Close
the reagent cover, then press Read Sensor State.
■ Make
sure that the Handling Cover Reagent Closed light (A) becomes green.
RAS394E - 18
ELECTRICITY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Sensors check and adjustment
20. Water tank empty sensor
■ Remove
the water detector from the water container.
■ Go
B
to Services > Diagnostics > Sensors.
■ Press
Read Sensor State.
■ Make sure that the Water Tank Empty light
(A) becomes green. ■ Move
the sensor up, then press Read Sensor State.
■ Make sure that the Water Tank Empty light
(B) becomes red.
A
21. Waste tank full sensor
■ Remove
the waste detector from the waste container.
■ Go
B
to Services > Diagnostics > Sensors.
■ Press
Read Sensor State.
■ Make sure that the Waste Tank Full light (A)
stays red. ■ Move
the sensor up, then press Read Sensor State.
■ Make sure that the Waste Tank Full light (B)
becomes green.
Technical Manual RAA023
A
ELECTRICITY
RAS394E - 19
Sensors check and adjustment
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
22. Sample arm shock detection switch
■ No
adjustment available. See RAS385: Arms, 8. Shock detection check, page 59.
23. Computer wake up sensor
■ The
computer wake up push-button is located on the right of the instrument.
■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Sensors.
■ Press
Read Sensor State.
■ Make
sure that the PC Wake up light (A) stays red.
■ Simultaneously
press the computer wake up push-button and the Read Sensor State button.
■ Make
sure that the PC Wake up light (A) becomes green. A
24. Lamp power standby ■ No
RAS394E - 20
check available.
ELECTRICITY
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Sensors check and adjustment
25. Lamp power full ■ In
Services > Diagnostics > Sensors, the Lamp Power Full light must be green. That means the lamp is functioning properly.
26. Low liquid level (cooling unit) ■ Go
to Services > Diagnostics > Sensors.
■ Press
Read Sensor State.
■ Make
sure that the Low Liquid Level (Cooling Unit) light becomes red.
■ Manually ■ Make
push the liquid level (red mark) down and press Read Sensor State simultaneously.
sure that the Low Liquid Level (Cooling Unit) light becomes green.
27. Power correct ■ In
Services > Diagnostics > Sensors, the Power Correct light must be green. That means the power supply is functioning properly.
Technical Manual RAA023
ELECTRICITY
RAS394E - 21
Sensors check and adjustment
RAS394E - 22
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
ELECTRICITY
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS387D
Syringe block assembly replacement
RAS387: Syringe block assembly replacement
Concerns Syringe block assembly dismantling (reagent or sample) Syringe block assembly mounting (reagent or sample)
Required tools Hexagonal keys
Required products Distilled water
Intervention time 0 h 15
Frequency On request
Specific kit or consumables None
Disposable gloves, eye protections and a lab coat must be worn by the operator. Local or national regulations must be applied in all the operations.
Syringe block assembly replacement
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
1. Syringe block assembly dismantling (reagent or sample) ■ Switch ■ Open
the instrument off.
the arms main cover.
■ Remove
the mother board cover. See RAS377: Covers dismantling, 16. Mother board cover, page 10.
■ Remove
the syringe cables from the adhesive holder located on the left side of the mother board.
D
D
C
■ Push
the syringes halfway down (A).
■ Loosen
the screw (B), then carefully unscrew and remove the glass barrel (C).
■ Loosen
the 4 silent-block screws (D) to remove the syringe block assembly.
A D
D B
RAS387D - 2
HYDRAULICS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Syringe block assembly replacement
■ Gently
pull the syringe block assembly and disconnect the motor, the switch and the ground wire.
■ Remove
the syringe block assembly.
2. Syringe block assembly mounting (reagent or sample) ■ Follow
the syringe block assembly dismantling procedure in reverse order. ■ Before
reinstalling the glass barrel, pump distilled water several times and ensure that the glass barrel is filled with water and no air bubbles are visible in the syringe. ■ Be very careful to correctly stretch the syringe cables again and replace them correctly on the adhesive holder. ■ Switch ■ Go
to Services > Customer Services > Cycles.
■ Run ■
the instrument on and wait for the end of initialization.
a Priming Cycle, then make sure that there are no air bubbles in the hydraulic circuit.
Perform the pressure sensors (reagent and sample) calibration. See RAS442: Pressure sensors, 3.3. To calibrate the pressure sensors, page 7.
Technical Manual RAA023
HYDRAULICS
RAS387D - 3
Syringe block assembly replacement
RAS387D - 4
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
HYDRAULICS
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS389F
Waste and water pumps replacement In this procedure, specific instructions are given for previous ABX Pentra 400 hardware versions: ■ V1 corresponds to instruments with serial numbers below 2000.
RAS389: Waste and water pumps replacement
Concerns Pumps dismantling Pumps replacement Water pump pressure check
Required tools Hexagonal keys Flat screwdriver Phillips screwdriver TOOL, BARFLEX (PRESS. 0-10BARS) MAM013AS (1207899013)
Required products None
Intervention time 1 h 00
Frequency On request
Specific kit or consumables None
Disposable gloves, eye protections and a lab coat must be worn by the operator. Local or national regulations must be applied in all the operations.
Waste and water pumps replacement
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
1. Pumps dismantling
■ Before
starting the pumps dismantling procedure, drain the hydraulic circuit as follows: - Go to Services > Customer Services > Cycles. - Press Draining (A), disconnect the water tank and press OK. - Then, press Priming Cycle (B).
■ Switch
B
A
the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
■ Remove
the covers (see RAS377: Covers dismantling, page 1): Remove the loader cover, the cuvettes hatch, the connection hatch and the cuvettes cover.
■ Remove
the rear plate by unscrewing the 8 CHC screws.
water pump ■ Loosen
the 4 CHC screws maintaining the pumps assembly and disconnect the ground wire. waste pump
RAS389F - 2
HYDRAULICS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Waste and water pumps replacement
waste pump black connector ■ Disconnect
the water pump connector (P56) at the rear of the instrument.
P56
■ Disconnect
the waste pump connectors (black and red wires).
waste pump red connector
P55
Specific ABX Pentra 400 V1 ■ Disconnect the water pump connector (P56)
at the rear of the instrument. ■ Disconnect
the waste pump connector
(P55). P56
■ Mark
the pumps tubings, then disconnect the front and rear tubings of the water pump and the 2 rear tubings of the waste pump.
■ Remove
Technical Manual RAA023
the pumps assembly.
HYDRAULICS
RAS389F - 3
Waste and water pumps replacement
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
2. Pumps replacement
The waste and water pumps are factory adjusted and do not require further adjustment.
The waste and water pumps are both provided with the pump support which is compatible with the old references of waste and water pumps.
Please refer to the picture below to fasten the waste and water pumps to their dedicated location on the pump support.
Old waste pump XBA528B (1209112528)
New water pump XEC202AS (1209179202)
Not used New waste pump XCA216BS (1209129216)
Old water pump XBA529D (1209114529) ■ Stick
the conductive fabric on the pump support (both provided in the kit).
15 mm
conductive fabric
RAS389F - 4
HYDRAULICS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Waste and water pumps replacement
■ Fasten the ground wire support (provided in
the kit) on the pump support.
■ Remove
the pump that you do not replace from the old pump support by unscrewing the 4 CHC screws.
■ Fasten
this pump to its dedicated location on the pump support.
■ Reinstall
the pumps assembly. IN OUT
■ Remove
the protections from the fittings of the new pump.
■ Connect
the front and rear tubings of the water pump and the 2 rear tubings of the waste pump by following the arrows marked on the top of the pumps.
IN
OUT
It might be necessary to cut the tubings to ensure a better connection with the fittings of the new pump.
Technical Manual RAA023
HYDRAULICS
RAS389F - 5
Waste and water pumps replacement
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
waste pump black connector ■ Connect the water pump connector (P56) at
P56
the rear of the instrument. ■ Connect the waste pump connectors (black
and red wires).
waste pump red connector
P55
Specific ABX Pentra 400 V1 ■ Connect
the water pump connector (P56) at the rear of the instrument.
■ Connect
the waste pump connector (P55). P56
Specific ABX Pentra 400 V1 If you have replaced the waste pump, use the CABLE, WST PUMP CONNECT ADAPTOR (provided in the kit) to connect the waste pump connectors to the connector P55. ■ Reassemble
RAS389F - 6
in reverse order.
HYDRAULICS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Waste and water pumps replacement
3. Water pump pressure check ■ Connect
the power supply cable and switch the instrument on.
■ Fill
up the hydraulic circuit as follows: - Go to Services > Customer Services > Cycles. - Reconnect the water tank, press Filling up (A) and press OK. - Then, press Priming Cycle (B) and make sure that there is no leak.
B
A
■ Check
the water pump pressure as follows: - Go to Services > Diagnostics > Syringe. - Open, then close the valves V1 to V5. - Open the valves V1 and V5.
- Connect a manometer to the water tank as shown on the following picture. - Switch the waste and water pumps on. - Make sure that the water pump pressure is about 2.1 bars ± 0.1. - Switch the water and waste pumps off. - Disconnect the manometer from the water tank and reconnect the water tank tubing. - Close the valves V1 and V5.
■
Perform the water pump flow check. See RAS378: 6 month maintenance, 10. To check the sample needle throughput, page 8.
■
Perform the pressure sensors (reagent and sample) calibration. See RAS442: Pressure sensors, 3.3. To calibrate the pressure sensors, page 7.
■ Follow
Technical Manual RAA023
the "Check up after intervention" procedure. See RAS393: Check up after intervention, page 1.
HYDRAULICS
RAS389F - 7
Waste and water pumps replacement
RAS389F - 8
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
HYDRAULICS
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS442D
Pressure sensors
RAS442: Pressure sensors
Concerns To replace the pressure sensors and board To adjust the pressure board voltage Pressure sensors activation, configuration, calibration
Required tools Hexagonal keys Flat screwdriver KIT, ANTISTATIC KIT MZZ015A (1207921015) Voltmeter
Required products None
Intervention time 1 h 00
Frequency On request
Specific kit or consumables KIT, WIRED PRESSURE SENSORS WITH PCB 1300015280
Disposable gloves, eye protections and a lab coat must be worn by the operator. Local or national regulations must be applied in all the operations.
Pressure sensors
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
1. To replace the pressure sensors and board
For instruments with a serial number lower than P4-4064 / C4-0305, if you need to replace the pressure sensors or the pressure board, you will have to replace both the pressure sensors and board for compatibility reasons.
As the electronic devices are very sensitive to electrostatic discharges (ESD), the use of an antistatic kit is mandatory during boards handling/dismantling.
1. Switch the instrument off and disconnect the power supply cable.
2. Remove the rear plate by unscrewing the four CHC screws.
J2
J1
3. Disconnect the reagent and sample pressure sensors (J1 and J2), as well as the flat cable (J3), from the pressure board.
J3
RAS442D - 2
HYDRAULICS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Pressure sensors
4. Open the arms main cover.
5. Unscrew the four CHC screws to remove the pressure sensors spacers from each side of the syringe block support. 6. Remove the pressure sensors.
7. Install the new pressure sensors. Make sure that the new pressure sensors are positioned correctly. The red square on the pressure sensor must be in front of the white square on the syringe block support.
8. Unscrew the five CHC screws to remove the pressure board.
9. Install the new pressure board and reassemble in reverse order. 10. Adjust the pressure board voltage. See 2. To adjust the pressure board voltage, page 4. 11. Perform the pressure sensors activation (if necessary), configuration and calibration. See 3. Pressure sensors activation, configuration, calibration, page 5.
Technical Manual RAA023
HYDRAULICS
RAS442D - 3
Pressure sensors
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
2. To adjust the pressure board voltage 1. Connect the power supply cable and switch the instrument on. 2. Remove the rear plate by unscrewing the four CHC screws.
The pressure board voltage adjustment has to be made without water in the hydraulic circuit. 3. Drain the hydraulic circuit as follows: - Go to Services > Customer Services > Cycles. - Press Draining (A), disconnect the water tank and press OK. - Then, press Priming Cycle (B).
B
A
Ground TP3
4. Adjust, with the potentiometer R16, the voltage between TP3 and the ground to 3.8 V DC +/- 0.05.
R16
5. Fill up the hydraulic circuit as follows: - Reconnect the water tank, press Filling up (C) and press OK. - Then, press Priming Cycle (B). 6. Put the rear plate back.
RAS442D - 4
HYDRAULICS
B
C
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Pressure sensors
3. Pressure sensors activation, configuration, calibration 3.1.
To activate the pressure sensors
1. Go to Services > System Configuration > Analyser. 2. Activate the reagent and sample pressure sensors.
Technical Manual RAA023
HYDRAULICS
RAS442D - 5
Pressure sensors
3.2.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
To configure the pressure sensors
1. Go to Services > Diagnostics > Pressure. 2. Check the values KA, KB, Low Pressure and High Pressure for the sample pressure sensor and modify them if necessary. 3. Check the values KA, KB, Low Pressure and High Pressure for the reagent pressure sensor and modify them if necessary.
RAS442D - 6
HYDRAULICS
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
3.3.
Pressure sensors
To calibrate the pressure sensors
1. Go to Services > Diagnostics > Pressure. 2. Select the Sample radio button (A). 3. Press Set Pressure (B). The system primes the fluids, then runs a 10 aspirations repetition with the syringe, alternating between low and high volumes. At the end of the cycle, the factors A and B of the calibration curve on water are displayed in the left window.
A
C
B
4. Note these results. 5. Perform this operation 3 times. 6. Make sure that the results of the factor A are between 4000 and 8000, and make sure that the difference between the 3 results of the factor A is not > 500. 7. If the results are correct, press OK to validate the calibration. The new factors are then displayed in the right window. 8. Select the Reagent radio button (C) and follow the same procedure as for the sample syringe. 9. Make sure that the results of the factor A are between 2500 and 3900, and make sure that the difference between the 3 results of the factor A is not > 500.
Technical Manual RAA023
HYDRAULICS
RAS442D - 7
Pressure sensors
RAS442D - 8
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
HYDRAULICS
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS533H
Windows master installation
RAS533: Windows master installation
Concerns Computer model check Windows master CD-ROM burning procedure Windows master installation
Required tools None
Required products None
Intervention time 1 h 00
Frequency On request
Specific kit or consumables KIT, WINDOWS MASTERS P400/C400 1300023765
Disposable gloves, eye protections and a lab coat must be worn by the operator. Local or national regulations must be applied in all the operations.
Windows master installation
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ The
Windows master must be used only in case of stability problems with Windows or to make functional new specifications. ■ This procedure will erase the data on drive C:\ or on drives C:\ and D:\ (instrument software and customer data will be deleted). ■ Then, you will have to install the software version (RAS517: Software version installation) and the reagent applications (RAS518: Reagent applications installation).
1. Computer model check As several computer models are available, a label, stuck on the rear plate, allows you to identify the computer model.
This label can be read from the optic hatch opening with the help of a flashlight, without dismantling the computer assembly first.
The table below indicates the Windows master to be used depending on the computer model. Computer assembly
since instrument serial #1
Windows master Ref.
Version2
CCC014A->F
N/A
NAJ047C (1207953047)
2005/12/20
CCC014G->H
P4-0853
NAJ047D (1207954047)
August 2007
CCC014J
P4-2166
NAJ047D (1207954047)
August 2007
CCC014K
P4-2349
NAJ119A (1207951119)
July 2011
CCC014L
P4-3214
NAJ119A (1207951119)
July 2011
CCC014M
P4-3391
NAJ119B (1207952119)
V1.0.0
CCC014N
P4-4000 / C4-0110
NAJ119B (1207952119)
V1.0.0
1300013734
P4-4072 / C4-0473
1300021186
V1.0.0.6
1
Please note that the computer assembly may have been changed on the instrument. In this case, do not take into account the instrument serial # mentioned above. 2 How to know the Windows master version you have on your instrument? Open the C:\ghost.ini file.
RAS533H - 2
SOFTWARE
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Windows master installation
2. Computer models from 1300013734 2.1.
Windows master bootable USB flash drive
The Windows masters for ABX Pentra 400 and Pentra C400 are available for download. The files to be downloaded have a *.zip extension and are named "Master_P400_PC400_V_1.0.0.6" for example. 1. Download the Windows master version you need depending on the computer model of the instrument. 2. Save the *.zip file on your laptop (do not save it on the instrument). 3. Insert a blank USB flash drive (4 GB minimum) into a USB port. 4. Press the Windows Start button and launch the cmd.exe file. 5. Enter "diskpart" and press Enter. 6. Enter "list disk" and press Enter to list the disks available on your laptop. 7. Select the blank USB flash drive (enter "select disk 1" for example) and press Enter.
Be careful to select the blank USB flash drive and not to select another disk because you will erase all data on the selected disk.
8. Enter "clean" and press Enter. 9. Enter "create partition primary" and press Enter. 10. Enter "active" and press Enter. 11. Enter "format fs=ntfs quick" and press Enter. 12. Enter "exit" and press Enter. 13. Copy and unzip the *.zip file on the bootable USB flash drive.
Technical Manual RAA023
SOFTWARE
RAS533H - 3
Windows master installation
2.2.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Boot sequence modification
1. Insert the Windows master USB flash drive into a USB port. To authorize the computer to boot on the USB flash drive, modify the System Boot into the BIOS as follows: 2. Switch the instrument on and press DEL when the following message appears: "Press DEL to run setup". 3. When the BIOS window appears, enter in the Boot menu. 4. Select Hard Drive BBS Priorities and press Enter.
5. Press Enter to change the Boot Option #1. 6. Select the connected USB flash drive and press Enter. The USB flash drive is named according to the manufacturer (ex: VERBATIM...). Do not select the line starting by "UEFI: ".
Hard Drive BSS Priorities 7. Press ESC to go back to the previous screen. 8. Change the Boot Option #2 to Disabled option.
Boot Menu 9. Press ESC and check the boot order: - Boot Option #1 [USB flash drive name] - Boot Option #2 [Disabled] 10. Press F4 to save modifications and choose YES to restart the computer. The computer automatically boots on the USB flash drive.
RAS533H - 4
SOFTWARE
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
2.3.
Windows master installation
Master installation
1. After the booting period, the following screen appears:
2. The following options are available: - Option 1 allows to install the Windows 7 operating system on C:\ partition and keeps the files of D:\ partition. - Option 2 allows to install the Windows 7 operating system on C:\ partition and to format the D:\ partition. - Option Q allows to cancel the image installation. Type "exit" to go back to system screen. 3. Type your choice (1, 2 or Q) and press Enter.
To cancel, press Q with the AZERTY keyboard and press A with the QWERTY keyboard.
4. At the end of the installation, the following screen appears.
5. Follow the instructions displayed: - Press any key from keyboard, - Wait for the screen to turn black, - Switch the instrument off, - Remove the USB key, - Switch the instrument on. At first restart, after performing the disk image installation, the operating system needs to load the proper drivers (USB peripherals). Wait for the full completion of drivers installation before going to next step. You can check it in the notification bar, on lower right corner of the screen.
Technical Manual RAA023
SOFTWARE
RAS533H - 5
Windows master installation
2.4.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Master installation check
1. Open the C:\ghost.ini file. 2. Make sure it contains the following informations:
3. Make sure that the Windows desktop wallpaper is the following:
The left Shift key used to skip the automatic logon is no more functional under Windows 7. Press CTRL+ALT+DEL keys to logoff and change current user.
2.5.
Printer installation
The following printer drivers are pre-installed but not loaded in Windows 7 after performing the master procedure. These models are the ones supplied by HORIBA Medical over the past years until now: ■ OKI
B4600
■ Epson
M2000
■ Epson
M2400
■ Epson
6200
■ Epson
WP4015
■ Epson
WF5110
To install a printer: 1. Open the Windows menu, click on Devices and Printers. 2. Connect one of these printers only by USB cable, and power on the printer. The drivers will be loaded after 1 minute. 3. Enter Control Panel > Hardware and Sound > Devices and Printers. 4. You must see your printer model appearing in the Printers and Faxes list. RAS533H - 6
SOFTWARE
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Windows master installation
5. Right click on the printer icon and select Printing preferences. 6. Change the paper size according to you country (A4, Letter, ...).
For the printer models listed above, printing operations have been tested and fully validated. Other printer models can be connected but HORIBA Medical cannot guarantee correct printing operations on all the printer models.
2.6.
Touchscreen calibration (if necessary)
1. Check that the touchscreen is properly calibrated. 2. If this is not the case, open C:\Program Files\eGalaxTouch directory and run the eGalaxTouch.exe file. 3. From the Tools tab, select 4 Points Calibration.
4. Press OK. 5. Touch each of the four corners of the screen to calibrate the touchscreen. 6. Press Apply, then OK.
2.7.
Brightness adjustment (if necessary)
Touchscreen brightness can be changed in the Windows 7 operating system. If needed: 1. Enter Control Panel > Hardware and Sound > Power Options. 2. Move the cursor at the bottom of the screen to change the brightness percentage (from 0% to 100%, default is 45%).
Technical Manual RAA023
SOFTWARE
RAS533H - 7
Windows master installation
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
3. Computer models < 1300013734 3.1.
Windows master CD-ROM burning procedure
The Windows masters for ABX Pentra 400 and Pentra C400 are available for download. The files to be downloaded have an *.iso extension and are named "Master_P400_PC400_V_1.0.0" for example. ■ Download the Windows master version you need depending on the computer model of the instrument. ■ Save
the *.iso file on your laptop (do not save it on the instrument).
■ Insert
3.2.
a blank CD-ROM in the CD writer.
■ Start
the CD burning software.
■ Burn
the ISO image to the CD-ROM.
Windows master installation ■ Open
the CD-ROM drive of the instrument.
■ Switch ■ Insert
the instrument off.
the CD-ROM into the CD-ROM drive.
■ Switch
the instrument on.
It is seriously recommended to wait one minute between the switch off and the switch on of the instrument, to prevent any damage to the power supply.
■ Press
Delete until the BIOS setting screen appears.
■ Select
the Advanced BIOS Features option and press Enter.
■ Select
CDROM in front of First Boot Device.
■ Press
F10 to save and exit. The instrument restarts and boots on the CD-ROM.
■
When the ABX HARD DRIVE LOADER screen appears, the instrument gives three options: (1), (2), (Q). (1) Load image to disk C:\ only . (2) Load image to disk C:\ and D:\ . (Q) Quit. Option (1): erases the data on drive C:\; installs Windows on drive C:\. Option (2): erases the data on drives C:\ and D:\; installs Windows on drive C:\ and creates a Backup folder on drive D:\. Option (Q): enables to quit the program.
■ Enter
1 and wait a few minutes for the following message: Please remove the CD-ROM and reboot the computer ... ...>
RAS533H - 8
SOFTWARE
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Windows master installation
■ Enter
exit and press Enter. The instrument reboots automatically.
■ While ■ At
the instrument reboots, remove the CD-ROM from the drive.
the end of the boot, the instrument asks for user confirmation to restart the computer.
■ Click
Yes.
■ After
the reboot, you are directly logged in to Windows, click Start and check if the Log Off function is displayed.
■ If
the Log Off function is not displayed, follow the procedure below to display it. - Right-click Start and click Properties.
The Taskbar and Start Menu Properties window is displayed. - Click the Start Menu tab. - Select the Classic Start menu option and click Customize...
- Select the Display Log Off option and click OK.
Technical Manual RAA023
SOFTWARE
RAS533H - 9
Windows master installation
RAS533H - 10
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
SOFTWARE
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS517C
Software version installation
RAS517: Software version installation
Concerns Software version downloading Software version installation
Required tools None
Required products None
Intervention time 0 h 15
Frequency On request
Specific kit or consumables Software version
Disposable gloves, eye protections and a lab coat must be worn by the operator. Local or national regulations must be applied in all the operations.
Software version installation
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
1. Software version downloading ■ Download ■ Unzip
the P400_SOFT_VX.X.X.zip file on a USB flash drive.
the file.
2. Software version installation ■ Log ■ Go
in to the instrument software as technician with tech/abxtech as login/password.
to Services > Diagnostics and open the Windows Explorer.
■ Press ■ Log
the Windows Start button, press Log Off abx... and then press Log Off.
in to Windows as administrator with administrator/admin as login/password.
■ Insert
the USB flash drive in a free USB port.
■ Press
the Windows Start button to open the menu and press Run.
■ Enter
"explorer" in the Open: field and press OK.
■ Open
the My Computer folder and select the USB flash drive.
■ Execute
the Setup.exe file by double-clicking it.
■ The
following message will appear: "This will install P400 Software. Do you wish to continue?".
■ Press
Yes.
■ Press
successively Next and Next.
■ Make
sure that the following options are selected. If not, select them: Download P400 Eprom Create a desktop icon.
■ Select
one of the two available types of installation: Update Full installation. ■ If
Full installation is selected when installing the software version, the complete configuration (applications, calibrators, controls, settings, etc.) will be lost. Then, you have to install the reagent applications again. See RAS518: Reagent applications installation, page 1. ■ If Update is selected, you will not lose the configuration (applications, calibrators, controls, settings, etc.) neither the patient results. ■ Press
Next.
■ Press
Install.
■ The
instrument will ask you: "Ready to Install?", press Yes.
■ The
Eprom will be updated automatically and then the software as well (it will take a few minutes).
RAS517C - 2
SOFTWARE
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Software version installation
If Full installation is selected, the following message will appear during the update: "The directory: "C:\Program Files\P400 Software\" already exists. Continue the task: "Download P400 Eprom", "Create a desktop icon", "Full installation"?". Press Yes. ■ Press
Finish and remove the USB flash drive.
■ Press
the Windows Start button, press Shutdown and then press Shutdown.
■
When getting the message "It is now safe to turn off your computer.", switch the instrument off and wait 10 seconds.
■ Switch
the instrument on.
If the following message appears during the start up: "Transmission not successful, do you want to continue to process queued messages?". Press Yes.
Technical Manual RAA023
SOFTWARE
RAS517C - 3
Software version installation
RAS517C - 4
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
SOFTWARE
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS518C
Reagent applications installation
RAS518: Reagent applications installation
Concerns Reagent applications downloading Reagent applications installation
Required tools None
Required products None
Intervention time 0 h 15
Frequency On request
Specific kit or consumables KIT, REAGENT APPLICATION P400 / PC400
Disposable gloves, eye protections and a lab coat must be worn by the operator. Local or national regulations must be applied in all the operations.
Reagent applications installation
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
1. Reagent applications downloading ■ Download ■ Unzip
the P400_APPLI_VX.XX.zip file on a USB flash drive.
the file.
2. Reagent applications installation 2.1.
On the ABX Pentra 400 ■ Go
to Services > Application Configuration > Applications.
■ From
the Applications list, press Import:
■ Install
your reagent applications support (CD-ROM or USB flash drive) on the instrument.
■ Select
the support type in the dialog box and press OK.
■ The applications update screen is displayed
(refer to the following example).
The applications for which an update is available on your support are listed in two tables: one for major parameter updates, another for minor parameter updates. ■ When
a major parameter is updated in an application, the current calibration for this test is lost. A new calibration must be performed. If the number of calibrator levels or the calibration predilution is modified, the calibrator target values for this test are also deleted and must be reconfigured.
■
When a minor parameter is updated in an application, the current calibration for this test is kept in memory. A new calibration is not required. For detailed information concerning major and minor parameters, refer to the ABX Pentra 400 user manual. Each table indicates the application code, the current application version number and modification date and time, the update application version number, if the application is selected to be updated.
■ Press
RAS518C - 2
Edit.
SOFTWARE
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■
Reagent applications installation
By default, all applications are selected to be updated. If necessary, deselect the applications that should not be updated. If an application is already present on the instrument with the same test name, the same application code or the same application local code but a different channel number, then the application is unselected by default and cannot be updated. The following message is displayed: "At least one application has the same name or code with different channel in the media." In this case, the test name, the application code or the application local code must be modified before updating this application.
■ Press
OK to validate. When an update of the reagent online help is available on your support and at least one application is unselected, a dialog box informs the user that the whole reagent online help is going to be updated whereas at least one application will not be updated. ■ Press
OK to validate.
■ Press
Cancel to cancel the applications update.
The selected applications are updated as well as: - the reagents used in these applications, - all diluents and cleaners, - the incompatibilities related to these applications and configured by HORIBA Medical, - the reagent online help (when an update is available on your support). It takes a few minutes. A dialog box informs you when the update is completed. ■ Press
Technical Manual RAA023
OK.
SOFTWARE
RAS518C - 3
Reagent applications installation
2.2.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
On the Pentra C400 ■ Go
to Services > Application Configuration > Applications.
■ From
the Applications list, press Import:
■ Install
your reagent applications support (CD-ROM or USB flash drive) on the instrument.
■ Select
the support type in the dialog box and press OK.
■ The applications update screen is displayed
(refer to the following example).
The applications for which an update is available on your support are listed in two tables: one for major parameter updates, another for minor parameter updates. ■ When
a major parameter is updated in an application, the current calibration for this test is lost. A new calibration must be performed. If the number of calibrator levels or the calibration predilution is modified, the calibrator target values for this test are also deleted and must be reconfigured.
■
When a minor parameter is updated in an application, the current calibration for this test is kept in memory. A new calibration is not required. For detailed information concerning major and minor parameters, refer to the Pentra C400 user manual. Each table indicates the application code, the current application version number and modification date and time, the update application version number, if the application is selected to be updated.
■ Press ■
Edit.
By default, all applications are selected to be updated. If necessary, deselect the applications that should not be updated. If an application is already present on the instrument with the same test name, the same application code or the same application local code but a different channel number, then the application is unselected by default and cannot be updated. The following message is displayed: "At least one application has the same name or code with different channel in the media." In this case, the test name, the application code or the application local code must be modified before updating this application.
■ Press
RAS518C - 4
OK to validate.
SOFTWARE
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Reagent applications installation
The restrictions below apply when updating the applications. - If an application is linked to a ratio and the parameters modified in this application are incompatible with the ratio, the application cannot be updated. In this case, the ratio must be deleted before updating the applications. Modification of the following method parameters could affect the ratio consistency: ■ pre-dilution parameters (diluent solution, factor, delay) ■ cleaning parameters ■ analysis cycles parameters The following modifications always affect the ratio consistency: ■ modification of the specimen type in the method parameters ■ modification of the basic unit ■ creation of an incompatibility for the methods used in the same ratio For detailed information, refer to the "Settings > Application Configuration" chapter of the Pentra C400 user manual. - If an application is linked to a profile and the sample type is modified in this application, the application cannot be updated. In this case, the profile must be deleted before updating the applications. - If a reagent is already present on the instrument with the same reagent short name but a different reagent number, the reagent cannot be updated. In this case, the reagent short name must be modified before updating the applications. - If the container type for a solution with a reagent number between 600 and 799 is changed, a dialog box informs the user that the solution will be deleted from the Reagent Configuration menu. ■
Press OK to validate. In this case, after the applications update, the container type must be reconfigured in Services > Application Configuration > Reagents and the solution in the Reagent Configuration menu.
■ Press
Cancel to cancel the applications update.
- When an update of the reagent online help is available on your support and at least one application is unselected, a dialog box informs the user that the whole reagent online help is going to be updated whereas at least one application will not be updated. ■ Press
OK to validate.
■ Press
Cancel to cancel the applications update.
The selected applications are updated as well as: - the reagents used in these applications, - all diluents and cleaners, - the incompatibilities related to these applications and configured by HORIBA Medical, - the reagent online help (when an update is available on your support). It takes a few minutes. A dialog box informs you when the update is completed. ■ Press
Technical Manual RAA023
OK.
SOFTWARE
RAS518C - 5
Reagent applications installation
RAS518C - 6
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
SOFTWARE
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS542F
Printer installation
RAS542: Printer installation
Concerns Overview Printer installation Preliminary Driver installation for EPSON WF-5110DW printer (for example) Printer selection Printer properties setup Printer connection
Required tools Driver delivered with the printer
Required products One of the listed printers
Intervention time 0 h 20
Frequency On request
Specific kit or consumables None
Disposable gloves, eye protections and a lab coat must be worn by the operator. Local or national regulations must be applied in all the operations.
Printer installation
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
1. Overview
Instrument ABX Pentra 400 / Pentra C400
OS Connection Printers
XP
Procedure
LPT1
EPL 5700/5800/5900 OKI B4200/4350/4600 EPSON M2000D/M2010D/M2400D 2. Printer installation, page 2
USB
EPSON WP-4015DN/WF-5110DW
2. Printer installation 2.1.
Preliminary
From the instrument application (Services > System Configuration > Printer), make sure that the printer is listed.
2.2.
■ If
it is, go directly to 2.3. Printer selection, page 5
■ If
not, go to 2.2. Driver installation for EPSON WF-5110DW printer (for example), page 2
Driver installation for EPSON WF-5110DW printer (for example)
In order to install an EPSON WF-5110DW printer on your instrument, you need to perform the following steps. ■ Copy ■ Go
the driver to a USB flash drive.
to Services > System Configuration > Printer.
■ Press
■ Click
RAS542F - 2
Edit and then Add Printer.
Next.
SOFTWARE
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Printer installation
■ Select
Local printer and click Next.
■ Select
the USB001 port and click Next.
■ Click
Have Disk.
■ Insert
your USB flash drive and click Browse.
Technical Manual RAA023
SOFTWARE
RAS542F - 3
Printer installation
■ Select
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
the E_JF1KKE.INF file and click
Open.
■ Click
OK and then Next.
■ Select
Yes and click Next.
■ Select
Do not share this printer and click
Next.
RAS542F - 4
SOFTWARE
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Select
■ Click
Printer installation
No and click Next.
Finish and remove the USB flash
drive.
Your printer has been installed.
2.3.
Printer selection
After installing your printer, check if it is set as default. To do that, you need to perform the following steps. ■ Go
to Services > System Configuration > Printer.
■ Press
Edit.
■ From
the Printer List, select the printer you want to set as default.
■ Press
Set Default Printer.
■ Press
OK to validate.
Technical Manual RAA023
SOFTWARE
RAS542F - 5
Printer installation
2.4.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Printer properties setup
■ Go
to Services > System Configuration > Printer.
■ Press
Edit.
■ Press
Printer Properties.
■ Select:
- Paper Source: Auto Select - Document Size: A4 - Paper Type: Plain paper - Color: Grayscale ■ Click
OK.
■ Press
2.5.
OK to validate.
Printer connection ■ Exit
the application and reboot the system.
■ Connect
the printer and switch it on. Please note that a USB cable, ref. DAC051A (1201891051), is delivered with the instrument in order to connect the printer to the instrument. In addition, a US power cable, ref. DAC012A (1201891012), is also delivered with the instrument for the printer connection (only for US).
■ Print
RAS542F - 6
a test page.
SOFTWARE
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS814A
External barcode reader
RAS814: External barcode reader
Concerns To install the barcode reader Barcode reader default configuration To set up the barcode reader To test the barcode reading
Required tools None
Required products None
Intervention time 0 h 20
Frequency On request
Specific kit or consumables KIT,INST.BARCODE PS2 TOUCH 65 XBA453D (1209114453)
Disposable gloves, eye protections and a lab coat must be worn by the operator. Local or national regulations must be applied in all the operations.
External barcode reader
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
1. To install the barcode reader 1. Exit the application and switch the instrument off. 2. The barcode reader is equipped with a "Y" connection. Connect the female end to the male end of the keyboard and connect the remaining end to the instrument. 3. Switch the instrument on.
2. Barcode reader default configuration The barcode reader has been set up so that it can read the following types of barcodes: ■ ITF
2/5 (2 of 5 interleaved) without check digit (16 characters max.)
■ Code
39 without check digit (16 characters max.)
■ Code
128 (99 characters max.)
■ Codabar
(16 characters max.)
This default configuration has been already done on the barcode reader. However, if you need to reset the barcode reader to the default configuration, you can follow the default configuration procedure (see below).
RAS814A - 2
SOFTWARE
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
External barcode reader
Enter or Exit Configuration
Factory Default Settings
KBD-AT-ALT
Global Suffix: NULL
GS1-AIM ID: Disable, Do not transmit GS1-128 labels
Code 39 Set Length
I 2 of 5 Set Length
Code 128 Set Length
Codabar Enable, Set Length
Codabar ST-SP Char not Xmit
UPC-A & UPC-E Disable
EAN 8 & EAN 13 Disable
Enter or Exit Configuration
Technical Manual RAA023
SOFTWARE
RAS814A - 3
External barcode reader
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
3. To set up the barcode reader 3.1.
ITF 2/5 with check digit (optional)
1. If the ITF 2/5 with check digit is used in the laboratory, you must set up the barcode reader as follows. Enter or Exit Configuration
I2of5 Check Character Calc = Check Std (Modulo 10)
I2of5 Check Character Transmission = Don't Send
Enter or Exit Configuration
2. To reset the barcode reader to the ITF 2/5 without check digit configuration (see below). Enter or Exit Configuration
I2of5 Check Character Calc = Don't Calculate
Enter or Exit Configuration
RAS814A - 4
SOFTWARE
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
3.2.
External barcode reader
Code 39 with check digit (optional)
1. If the Code 39 with check digit is used in the laboratory, you must set up the barcode reader as follows. Enter or Exit Configuration
Code 39 Check Character Calculation = Calculate Std Check
Code 39 Check Character Transmission = Don't Send
Enter or Exit Configuration
2. To reset the barcode reader to the Code 39 without check digit configuration (see below). Enter or Exit Configuration
Code 39 Check Character Calculation = Don't Calculate
Enter or Exit Configuration
Technical Manual RAA023
SOFTWARE
RAS814A - 5
External barcode reader
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
4. To test the barcode reading 4.1.
ITF 2/5 (2 of 5 interleaved)
With C/D on label Barcode checksum: Yes
Without C/D on label Barcode checksum: No
1224488
121314151617
If "12244881" is displayed, disable the check digit transmission (see 3.1. ITF 2/5 with check digit (optional), page 4).
4.2.
Code 39
Without C/D on label Barcode checksum: No
With C/D on label Barcode checksum: Yes
12345ABCDE If "12345ABCDEW" is displayed, disable the check digit transmission (see 3.2. Code 39 with check digit (optional), page 5).
4.3.
Code 128
Barcode checksum: No
RAS814A - 6
SOFTWARE
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
4.4.
External barcode reader
Codabar
Barcode checksum: No
37859
Technical Manual RAA023
123456/$
SOFTWARE
RAS814A - 7
External barcode reader
RAS814A - 8
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
SOFTWARE
Technical Manual RAA023
RAS624C
Cooling unit
RAS624: Cooling unit
Concerns Cooling unit dismantling Cooling unit parts replacement Air fan replacement Float switch replacement Control board replacement Pump replacement (for CU401 only) Bleed screw O-ring replacement (for CU401 only)
Required tools Hexagonal keys Phillips screwdriver Open-end wrench Pliers KIT, ANTISTATIC KIT MZZ015A (1207921015)
Required products None
Intervention time N/A
Frequency On request
Specific kit or consumables None
Disposable gloves, eye protections and a lab coat must be worn by the operator. Local or national regulations must be applied in all the operations.
Cooling unit
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
1. Cooling unit dismantling
To avoid any damage (compressor oil into the condenser), do not tilt the cooling unit during this operation.
■ Switch
the instrument off.
Remove the reagents from the reagent tray and place them in a refrigerated area.
■ Switch
the cooling unit off and disconnect the power supply cable.
CU400 cooling unit dismantling
■ Remove
the cooling unit cover by unscrewing the 6 cruciform screws.
■ Disconnect
the ground wire (located at the back left) from the cooling unit cover.
RAS624C - 2
COOLING UNIT
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Cooling unit
To avoid anything falling into the tank, put the lid on the hole.
CU401 cooling unit dismantling Remove the cooling unit covers as follows:
■ Press
push to open the top lid.
A
A
■ Unscrew
the 2 cruciform screws and washers at the top side of the unit (A). Then, fold away the front cover towards the front (B).
■ Remove
Technical Manual RAA023
C
the rubber corners (C).
C B
COOLING UNIT
RAS624C - 3
Cooling unit
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ At
the rear side of the unit, unscrew the 3 cruciform screws and washers maintaining the left side cover.
■ Slide this cover towards the back of the unit
and remove it. ■ Perform
the same operation for the right side cover.
■ Before
removing the right side cover, disconnect the ground wire.
■ Remove
RAS624C - 4
the back grid.
COOLING UNIT
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Cooling unit
2. Cooling unit parts replacement 2.1.
Air fan replacement ■ First,
perform the cooling unit dismantling procedure. See 1. Cooling unit dismantling, page 2.
CU400 air fan replacement
■ Remove
the air fan as follows: - Unscrew the 2 screws and washers located at the bottom of the air fan (A). - Disconnect the 2 power supply connectors from the air fan (B).
A B
A
C
- Unscrew the ground wire (C). - Cut the 2 Ty-Raps™ (D). Sticker
■ Replace
the air fan and reassemble in reverse order. D D
Ensure that the air fan is positioned in the correct direction: the sticker must be visible.
■ To
simplify the air fan reassembling, it is better to fasten the right screw first (when you are in front of the air fan with sticker visible). ■ In case the connectors are too loose, remove them and tighten them a little bit more with pliers. ■ Only fix the sheath and the ground wire with the Ty-Raps™, do not take the 2 power supply wires.
Technical Manual RAA023
COOLING UNIT
RAS624C - 5
Cooling unit
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
CU401 air fan replacement
A
■ Cut
the 2 Ty-Raps™ (A).
■ Disconnect
the 2 power supply connectors from the air fan (B).
■ Unscrew
B
the ground wire (C).
A C ■ Unscrew
■ Replace
the 3 screws and washers using an 7-mm open-end wrench and remove the air fan.
the air fan and reassemble in reverse order.
Ensure that the air fan is positioned in the correct direction: the sticker must be visible.
Sticker
RAS624C - 6
COOLING UNIT
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
2.2.
Cooling unit
Float switch replacement ■ First,
perform the cooling unit dismantling procedure. See 1. Cooling unit dismantling, page 2.
CU400 float switch replacement C1 R2
GR1
R4 R3
T1
D2
RC1
R1
REL1 TR1
■ On
■ Unscrew the
SK3
SK4
SK5
SSR1
SK1
S11
SK2
the control board, disconnect the float switch cable from the SU6 connector.
SU6
2 screws and remove the float
switch.
■ Unsolder ■ Solder ■ Install
Technical Manual RAA023
the 2 wires from the old float switch.
these wires on the new float switch.
the new float switch and reassemble in reverse order.
COOLING UNIT
RAS624C - 7
Cooling unit
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
CU401 float switch replacement
■ Cut
the Ty-Raps™ maintaining the float switch cable.
S11
SSR1
■ On the control board, lift up and disconnect
SK1
D2
RC1 REL1
GR1
T1 R1
C1
R2
R4 R3
■ Unscrew the
SK3
TR1
the float switch cable from the SU6 connector.
SK4
SK2
SK5
SU6
2 screws and remove the float
switch.
■ Replace
RAS624C - 8
the float switch and reassemble in reverse order.
COOLING UNIT
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
2.3.
Cooling unit
Control board replacement
As the electronic devices are very sensitive to electrostatic discharges (ESD), the use of an antistatic kit is mandatory during boards handling/dismantling.
CU400 control board replacement
■ From
the cooling unit rear, disconnect the cooling unit cable.
■ Unscrew
the 3 cruciform screws and washers supporting the control board support.
Technical Manual RAA023
COOLING UNIT
RAS624C - 9
Cooling unit
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Slowly
slide the control board support to the left side.
■ Carefully
disconnect all the connectors from the control board.
■ Unscrew
the 2 cruciform screws to remove the control board from its support.
■ Replace
the control board and reassemble in reverse order. Connect all the connectors as shown on the following diagram: C1 R4 R3
R1
T1
D2
RC1
R2
GR1
REL1
TR1
To compressor
SSR1
S11
SK2
To instrument connector
To float switch SK1
To ON/OFF switch
RAS624C - 10
SK3
To fan
SK4
To pump
SK5
SU6
To solenoid valve
COOLING UNIT
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Cooling unit
CU401 control board replacement ■ First,
perform the cooling unit dismantling procedure. See 1. Cooling unit dismantling, page 2.
■ Unscrew
the nut and disconnect the cooling unit cable located at the back of the control board (inside the cooling unit).
■ Carefully
disconnect all the connectors from the control board.
■ Unscrew
the 2 cruciform screws and remove the control board.
■ Replace
the control board and reassemble in reverse order. Connect all the connectors as shown on the following diagram: To solenoid valve
To pump
To fan
SK4
SK3
SK5
SU6
To ON/OFF switch
SK1
SSR1
To float switch
Technical Manual RAA023
D2
RC1 REL1
GR1
C1
R2
R1
R4 R3
T1
TR1
To instrument connector
SK2
S11
To compressor
COOLING UNIT
RAS624C - 11
Cooling unit
2.4.
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Pump replacement (for CU401 only)
The pump has to be replaced every 2 years.
■ First,
drain the cooling unit. See RAS379: Yearly maintenance, 2. Cooling unit, page 7.
■ Perform
the CU401 cooling unit dismantling procedure. See 1. Cooling unit dismantling, page 2.
■ At the back of the cooling
unit, unscrew the 2 cruciform screws and washers. Then, slightly pull away the IN/OUT plate towards the back.
Pay attention not to lose the 2 blue washers located at the back of the IN/OUT plate screws.
■ Remove
the top cover as follows: - At the front of the cooling unit, unscrew the 2 cruciform screws and washers located on both sides of the top cover. - Disconnect the ground wire. - Remove the top cover.
■ Cut
RAS624C - 12
the Ty-Raps™ maintaining the cables.
COOLING UNIT
Technical Manual RAA023
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
Cooling unit
SK5
SK1
B
D2
RC1 REL1
GR1
C1
R2
R4 R3
R1
T1
TR1
the control board, disconnect the float switch cable from the SU6 connector and the pump cable on the SK4 connector.
SK3
SK2
■ On
SK4
S11
SSR1
SU6
B
■ On
the pump: - Disconnect the ground wire (A). - Unscrew the 4 cruciform screws and washers (one with a ground wire) (B). A
B
B
■ Slightly
lift the pump up and towards the back to access the tubings.
■ Cut
and remove the 2 collars. Then, disconnect the tubings.
Technical Manual RAA023
COOLING UNIT
RAS624C - 13
Cooling unit
ABX Pentra 400/Pentra C400
■ Remove
the pump from the cooling unit.
■ Remove
the 2 casings from the pump
tubings. ■ Replace
the pump and reassemble in reverse order.
To reconnect the tubings, use the 2 collars provided with the pump. ■ Put the collar on the tubing and plug the tubing into the connector. ■ Then, with pliers, tighten both sides of the square part of the collar.
2.5.
Bleed screw O-ring replacement (for CU401 only) ■ First,
drain the cooling unit. See RAS379: Yearly maintenance, 2. Cooling unit, page 7.
bleed screw
■ Remove
the collar located inside the bleed screw with pliers.
■ Unscrew
the bleed screw.
■ Replace
the O-ring and reassemble in reverse order.
collar
RAS624C - 14
COOLING UNIT
Technical Manual RAA023